Skip to main content

Full text of "The Navy Electricity and Electronics Training Series: Module 10 Introduction To Wave Propagation, Transmission Lines, And Antennas"

See other formats


Navy  Electricity  and 
Electronics  Training  Series 

Module  10 — Introduction  to  Wave 
Propagation,  Transmission  Lines,  and 
Antennas 

NAVEDTRA  14182 


DISTRIBUTION  STATEMENT  A:  Approved  for  public  release;  distribution  is  unlimited. 


Although  the  words  "he,"  "him,"  and 
"his"  are  used  sparingly  in  this  course  to 
enhance  communication,  they  are  not 
intended  to  be  gender  driven  or  to  affront  or 
discriminate  against  anyone. 


DISTRIBUTION  STATEMENT  A:  Approved  for  public  release;  distribution  is  unlimited. 


PREFACE 


By  enrolling  in  this  self-study  course,  you  have  demonstrated  a  desire  to  improve  yourself  and  the  Navy. 
Remember,  however,  this  self-study  course  is  only  one  part  of  the  total  Navy  training  program.  Practical 
experience,  schools,  selected  reading,  and  your  desire  to  succeed  are  also  necessary  to  successfully  round 
out  a  fully  meaningful  training  program. 

COURSE  OVERVIEW:  To  introduce  the  student  to  the  subject  of  Wave  Propagation,  Transmission 
Lines,  and  Antennas  who  needs  such  a  background  in  accomplishing  daily  work  and/or  in  preparing  for 
further  study. 

THE  COURSE:  This  self-study  course  is  organized  into  subject  matter  areas,  each  containing  learning 
objectives  to  help  you  determine  what  you  should  learn  along  with  text  and  illustrations  to  help  you 
understand  the  information.  The  subject  matter  reflects  day-to-day  requirements  and  experiences  of 
personnel  in  the  rating  or  skill  area.  It  also  reflects  guidance  provided  by  Enlisted  Community  Managers 
(ECMs)  and  other  senior  personnel,  technical  references,  instructions,  etc.,  and  either  the  occupational  or 
naval  standards,  which  are  listed  in  the  Manual  of  Navy  Enlisted  Manpower  Personnel  Classifications 
and  Occupational  Standards,  NAVPERS  18068. 

THE  QUESTIONS:  The  questions  that  appear  in  this  course  are  designed  to  help  you  understand  the 
material  in  the  text. 

VALUE:  In  completing  this  course,  you  will  improve  your  military  and  professional  knowledge. 
Importantly,  it  can  also  help  you  study  for  the  Navy-wide  advancement  in  rate  examination.  If  you  are 
studying  and  discover  a  reference  in  the  text  to  another  publication  for  further  information,  look  it  up. 


1998  Edition  Prepared  by 
FCC( SW)  R.  Stephen  Howard  and  CW03  Harvey  D.  Vaughan 


Published  by 
NAVAL  EDUCATION  AND  TRAINING 
PROFESSIONAL  DEVELOPMENT 
AND  TECHNOLOGY  CENTER 


NAVSUP  Logistics  Tracking  Number 
0504-LP-026-8350 


i 


Sailor's  Creed 


"I  am  a  United  States  Sailor. 

I  will  support  and  defend  the 
Constitution  of  the  United  States  of 
America  and  I  will  obey  the  orders 
of  those  appointed  over  me. 

I  represent  the  fighting  spirit  of  the 
Navy  and  those  who  have  gone 
before  me  to  defend  freedom  and 
democracy  around  the  world. 

I  proudly  serve  my  country's  Navy 
combat  team  with  honor,  courage 
and  commitment. 

I  am  committed  to  excellence  and 
the  fair  treatment  of  all." 


ii 


TABLE  OF  CONTENTS 


CHAPTER  PAGE 

1.  Wave  Propagation   1-1 

2.  Radio  Wave  Propagation   2-1 

3.  Principles  of  Transmission  Lines   3-1 

4.  Antennas   4-1 

APPENDIX 

I.    Glossary   AI-1 

INDEX    INDEX- 1 


iii 


NAVY  ELECTRICITY  AND  ELECTRONICS  TRAINING 

SERIES 


The  Navy  Electricity  and  Electronics  Training  Series  (NEETS)  was  developed  for  use  by  personnel  in 
many  electrical-  and  electronic-related  Navy  ratings.  Written  by,  and  with  the  advice  of,  senior 
technicians  in  these  ratings,  this  series  provides  beginners  with  fundamental  electrical  and  electronic 
concepts  through  self-study.  The  presentation  of  this  series  is  not  oriented  to  any  specific  rating  structure, 
but  is  divided  into  modules  containing  related  information  organized  into  traditional  paths  of  instruction. 

The  series  is  designed  to  give  small  amounts  of  information  that  can  be  easily  digested  before  advancing 
further  into  the  more  complex  material.  For  a  student  just  becoming  acquainted  with  electricity  or 
electronics,  it  is  highly  recommended  that  the  modules  be  studied  in  their  suggested  sequence.  While 
there  is  a  listing  of  NEETS  by  module  title,  the  following  brief  descriptions  give  a  quick  overview  of  how 
the  individual  modules  flow  together. 

Module  1,  Introduction  to  Matter,  Energy,  and  Direct  Current,  introduces  the  course  with  a  short  history 
of  electricity  and  electronics  and  proceeds  into  the  characteristics  of  matter,  energy,  and  direct  current 
(dc).  It  also  describes  some  of  the  general  safety  precautions  and  first-aid  procedures  that  should  be 
common  knowledge  for  a  person  working  in  the  field  of  electricity.  Related  safety  hints  are  located 
throughout  the  rest  of  the  series,  as  well. 

Module  2,  Introduction  to  Alternating  Current  and  Transformers,  is  an  introduction  to  alternating  current 
(ac)  and  transformers,  including  basic  ac  theory  and  fundamentals  of  electromagnetism,  inductance, 
capacitance,  impedance,  and  transformers. 

Module  3,  Introduction  to  Circuit  Protection,  Control,  and  Measurement,  encompasses  circuit  breakers, 
fuses,  and  current  limiters  used  in  circuit  protection,  as  well  as  the  theory  and  use  of  meters  as  electrical 
measuring  devices. 

Module  4,  Introduction  to  Electrical  Conductors,  Wiring  Techniques,  and  Schematic  Reading,  presents 
conductor  usage,  insulation  used  as  wire  covering,  splicing,  termination  of  wiring,  soldering,  and  reading 
electrical  wiring  diagrams. 

Module  5,  Introduction  to  Generators  and  Motors,  is  an  introduction  to  generators  and  motors,  and 
covers  the  uses  of  ac  and  dc  generators  and  motors  in  the  conversion  of  electrical  and  mechanical 
energies. 

Module  6,  Introduction  to  Electronic  Emission,  Tubes,  and  Power  Supplies,  ties  the  first  five  modules 
together  in  an  introduction  to  vacuum  tubes  and  vacuum-tube  power  supplies. 

Module  7,  Introduction  to  Solid-State  Devices  and  Power  Supplies,  is  similar  to  module  6,  but  it  is  in 
reference  to  solid-state  devices. 

Module  8,  Introduction  to  Amplifiers,  covers  amplifiers. 

Module  9,  Introduction  to  Wave-Generation  and  Wave-Shaping  Circuits,  discusses  wave  generation  and 
wave-shaping  circuits. 

Module  10,  Introduction  to  Wave  Propagation,  Transmission  Lines,  and  Antennas,  presents  the 
characteristics  of  wave  propagation,  transmission  lines,  and  antennas. 


iv 


Module  11,  Microwave  Principles,  explains  microwave  oscillators,  amplifiers,  and  waveguides. 
Module  12,  Modulation  Principles,  discusses  the  principles  of  modulation. 

Module  13,  Introduction  to  Number  Systems  and  Logic  Circuits,  presents  the  fundamental  concepts  of 
number  systems,  Boolean  algebra,  and  logic  circuits,  all  of  which  pertain  to  digital  computers. 

Module  14,  Introduction  to  Microelectronics,  covers  microelectronics  technology  and  miniature  and 
microminiature  circuit  repair. 

Module  15,  Principles  of  Synchros,  Servos,  and  Gyros,  provides  the  basic  principles,  operations, 
functions,  and  applications  of  synchro,  servo,  and  gyro  mechanisms. 

Module  16,  Introduction  to  Test  Equipment,  is  an  introduction  to  some  of  the  more  commonly  used  test 
equipments  and  their  applications. 

Module  17,  Radio-Frequency  Communications  Principles,  presents  the  fundamentals  of  a  radio- 
frequency  communications  system. 

Module  18,  Radar  Principles,  covers  the  fundamentals  of  a  radar  system. 

Module  19,  The  Technician's  Handbook,  is  a  handy  reference  of  commonly  used  general  information, 
such  as  electrical  and  electronic  formulas,  color  coding,  and  naval  supply  system  data. 

Module  20,  Master  Glossary,  is  the  glossary  of  terms  for  the  series. 

Module  21,  Test  Methods  and  Practices,  describes  basic  test  methods  and  practices. 

Module  22,  Introduction  to  Digital  Computers,  is  an  introduction  to  digital  computers. 

Module  23,  Magnetic  Recording,  is  an  introduction  to  the  use  and  maintenance  of  magnetic  recorders  and 
the  concepts  of  recording  on  magnetic  tape  and  disks. 

Module  24,  Introduction  to  Fiber  Optics,  is  an  introduction  to  fiber  optics. 

Embedded  questions  are  inserted  throughout  each  module,  except  for  modules  19  and  20,  which  are 
reference  books.  If  you  have  any  difficulty  in  answering  any  of  the  questions,  restudy  the  applicable 
section. 

Although  an  attempt  has  been  made  to  use  simple  language,  various  technical  words  and  phrases  have 
necessarily  been  included.  Specific  terms  are  defined  in  Module  20,  Master  Glossary. 

Considerable  emphasis  has  been  placed  on  illustrations  to  provide  a  maximum  amount  of  information.  In 
some  instances,  a  knowledge  of  basic  algebra  may  be  required. 

Assignments  are  provided  for  each  module,  with  the  exceptions  of  Module  19,  The  Technician's 
Handbook;  and  Module  20,  Master  Glossary.  Course  descriptions  and  ordering  information  are  in 
NAVEDTRA  12061,  Catalog  of  Nonresident  Training  Courses. 


v 


Throughout  the  text  of  this  course  and  while  using  technical  manuals  associated  with  the  equipment  you 
will  be  working  on,  you  will  find  the  below  notations  at  the  end  of  some  paragraphs.  The  notations  are 
used  to  emphasize  that  safety  hazards  exist  and  care  must  be  taken  or  observed. 


WARNING 


AN  OPERATING  PROCEDURE,  PRACTICE,  OR  CONDITION,  ETC.,  WHICH  MAY 
RESULT  IN  INJURY  OR  DEATH  IF  NOT  CAREFULLY  OBSERVED  OR 
FOLLOWED. 


CAUTION 


AN  OPERATING  PROCEDURE,  PRACTICE,  OR  CONDITION,  ETC.,  WHICH  MAY 
RESULT  IN  DAMAGE  TO  EQUIPMENT  IF  NOT  CAREFULLY  OBSERVED  OR 
FOLLOWED. 


NOTE 


An  operating  procedure,  practice,  or  condition,  etc.,  which  is  essential  to  emphasize. 


vi 


INSTRUCTIONS  FOR  TAKING  THE  COURSE 


ASSIGNMENTS 

The  text  pages  that  you  are  to  study  are  listed  at 
the  beginning  of  each  assignment.  Study  these 
pages  carefully  before  attempting  to  answer  the 
questions.  Pay  close  attention  to  tables  and 
illustrations  and  read  the  learning  objectives. 
The  learning  objectives  state  what  you  should  be 
able  to  do  after  studying  the  material.  Answering 
the  questions  correctly  helps  you  accomplish  the 
objectives. 

SELECTING  YOUR  ANSWERS 

Read  each  question  carefully,  then  select  the 
BEST  answer.  You  may  refer  freely  to  the  text. 
The  answers  must  be  the  result  of  your  own 
work  and  decisions.  You  are  prohibited  from 
referring  to  or  copying  the  answers  of  others  and 
from  giving  answers  to  anyone  else  taking  the 
course. 

SUBMITTING  YOUR  ASSIGNMENTS 

To  have  your  assignments  graded,  you  must  be 
enrolled  in  the  course  with  the  Nonresident 
Training  Course  Administration  Branch  at  the 
Naval  Education  and  Training  Professional 
Development  and  Technology  Center 
(NETPDTC).  Following  enrollment,  there  are 
two  ways  of  having  your  assignments  graded: 
(1)  use  the  Internet  to  submit  your  assignments 
as  you  complete  them,  or  (2)  send  all  the 
assignments  at  one  time  by  mail  to  NETPDTC. 

Grading  on  the  Internet:  Advantages  to 
Internet  grading  are: 

•  you  may  submit  your  answers  as  soon  as 
you  complete  an  assignment,  and 

•  you  get  your  results  faster;  usually  by  the 
next  working  day  (approximately  24  hours). 

In  addition  to  receiving  grade  results  for  each 
assignment,  you  will  receive  course  completion 
confirmation  once  you  have  completed  all  the 


assignments.  To  submit  your  assignment 
answers  via  the  Internet,  go  to: 

http  ://courses.cnet.na  vy.mil 

Grading  by  Mail:  When  you  submit  answer 
sheets  by  mail,  send  all  of  your  assignments  at 
one  time.  Do  NOT  submit  individual  answer 
sheets  for  grading.  Mail  all  of  your  assignments 
in  an  envelope,  which  you  either  provide 
yourself  or  obtain  from  your  nearest  Educational 
Services  Officer  (ESO).  Submit  answer  sheets 
to: 

COMMANDING  OFFICER 
NETPDTC  N331 
6490  SAUFLEY  FIELD  ROAD 
PENSACOLA  FL  32559-5000 

Answer  Sheets:  All  courses  include  one 
"scannable"  answer  sheet  for  each  assignment. 
These  answer  sheets  are  preprinted  with  your 
SSN,  name,  assignment  number,  and  course 
number.  Explanations  for  completing  the  answer 
sheets  are  on  the  answer  sheet. 

Do  not  use  answer  sheet  reproductions:  Use 

only  the  original  answer  sheets  that  we 
provide — reproductions  will  not  work  with  our 
scanning  equipment  and  cannot  be  processed. 

Follow  the  instructions  for  marking  your 
answers  on  the  answer  sheet.  Be  sure  that  blocks 
1,  2,  and  3  are  filled  in  correctly.  This 
information  is  necessary  for  your  course  to  be 
properly  processed  and  for  you  to  receive  credit 
for  your  work. 

COMPLETION  TIME 

Courses  must  be  completed  within  12  months 
from  the  date  of  enrollment.  This  includes  time 
required  to  resubmit  failed  assignments. 


vii 


PASS/FAIL  ASSIGNMENT  PROCEDURES 

If  your  overall  course  score  is  3.2  or  higher,  you 
will  pass  the  course  and  will  not  be  required  to 
resubmit  assignments.  Once  your  assignments 
have  been  graded  you  will  receive  course 
completion  confirmation. 

If  you  receive  less  than  a  3.2  on  any  assignment 
and  your  overall  course  score  is  below  3.2,  you 
will  be  given  the  opportunity  to  resubmit  failed 
assignments.  You  may  resubmit  failed 
assignments  only  once.  Internet  students  will 
receive  notification  when  they  have  failed  an 
assignment— they  may  then  resubmit  failed 
assignments  on  the  web  site.  Internet  students 
may  view  and  print  results  for  failed 
assignments  from  the  web  site.  Students  who 
submit  by  mail  will  receive  a  failing  result  letter 
and  a  new  answer  sheet  for  resubmission  of  each 
failed  assignment. 

COMPLETION  CONFIRMATION 

After  successfully  completing  this  course,  you 
will  receive  a  letter  of  completion. 

ERRATA 

Errata  are  used  to  correct  minor  errors  or  delete 
obsolete  information  in  a  course.  Errata  may 
also  be  used  to  provide  instructions  to  the 
student.  If  a  course  has  an  errata,  it  will  be 
included  as  the  first  page(s)  after  the  front  cover. 
Errata  for  all  courses  can  be  accessed  and 
viewed/downloaded  at: 

http://www.advancement.cnet.navy.mil 

STUDENT  FEEDBACK  QUESTIONS 

We  value  your  suggestions,  questions,  and 
criticisms  on  our  courses.  If  you  would  like  to 
communicate  with  us  regarding  this  course,  we 
encourage  you,  if  possible,  to  use  e-mail.  If  you 
write  or  fax,  please  use  a  copy  of  the  Student 
Comment  form  that  follows  this  page. 


For  subject  matter  questions: 

E-mail:  n315.products@cnet.navy.mil 
Phone:      Comm:  (850)  452-1001,  ext.  1728 
DSN:  922-1001,  ext.  1728 
FAX:  (850)452-1370 
(Do  not  fax  answer  sheets.) 
Address:    COMMANDING  OFFICER 
NETPDTC  N315 
6490  SAUFLEY  FIELD  ROAD 
PENSACOLA  FL  32509-5237 

For  enrollment,  shipping,  grading,  or 
completion  letter  questions 

E-mail :     fleetservices  @  cnet .  navy .  mil 

Phone:      Toll  Free:  877-264-8583 

Comm:  (850)452-1511/1181/1859 
DSN:  922-1511/1181/1859 
FAX:  (850)452-1370 
(Do  not  fax  answer  sheets.) 

Address:    COMMANDING  OFFICER 
NETPDTC  N331 
6490  SAUFLEY  FIELD  ROAD 
PENSACOLA  FL  32559-5000 

NAVAL  RESERVE  RETIREMENT  CREDIT 

If  you  are  a  member  of  the  Naval  Reserve,  you 
will  receive  retirement  points  if  you  are 
authorized  to  receive  them  under  current 
directives  governing  retirement  of  Naval 
Reserve  personnel.  For  Naval  Reserve 
retirement,  this  course  is  evaluated  at  6  points. 
(Refer  to  Administrative  Procedures  for  Naval 
Reservists  on  Inactive  Duty,  BUPERSINST 
1001.39,  for  more  information  about  retirement 
points.) 


viii 


Student  Comments 


NEETS  Module  10 

Course  Title:  Introduction  to  Wave  Propagation,  Transmission  Lines,  and  Antennas 
NAVEDTRA:      14182  Date: 


We  need  some  information  about  you: 

Rate/Rank  and  Name:  SSN:  Command/Unit 


Street  Address:    City:    State/FPO:    Zip 

Your  comments,  suggestions,  etc.: 


Privacy  Act  Statement:  Under  authority  of  Title  5,  USC  301,  information  regarding  your  military  status  is 
requested  in  processing  your  comments  and  in  preparing  a  reply.  This  information  will  not  be  divulged  without 
written  authorization  to  anyone  other  than  those  within  POD  for  official  use  in  determining  performance.  


NETPDTC  1550/41  (Rev  4-00) 


ix 


CHAPTER  1 

WAVE  PROPAGATION 


LEARNING  OBJECTIVES 

Learning  objectives  are  stated  at  the  beginning  of  each  chapter.  These  learning  objectives  serve  as  a 
preview  of  the  information  you  are  expected  to  learn  in  the  chapter.  The  comprehensive  check  questions 
are  based  on  the  objectives.  By  successfully  completing  the  NRTC,  you  indicate  that  you  have  met  the 
objectives  and  have  learned  the  information.  The  learning  objectives  are  listed  below. 

Upon  completion  of  this  chapter,  you  should  be  able  to: 

1.  State  what  wave  motion  is,  define  the  terms  reflection,  refraction,  and  diffraction,  and  describe  the 
Doppler  effect. 

2.  State  what  sound  waves  are  and  define  a  propagating  medium. 

3.  List  and  define  terms  as  applied  to  sound  waves,  such  as  cycle,  frequency,  wavelength,  and 
velocity. 

4.  List  the  three  requirements  for  sound. 

5.  Define  pitch,  intensity,  loudness,  and  quality  and  their  application  to  sound  waves. 

6.  State  the  acoustical  effects  that  echoes,  reverberation,  resonance,  and  noise  have  on  sound  waves. 

7.  Define  light  waves  and  list  their  characteristics. 

8.  List  the  various  colors  of  light  and  define  the  terms  reflection,  refraction,  diffusion,  and  absorption 
as  applied  to  light  waves. 

9.  State  the  difference  between  sound  waves  and  light  waves. 

10.  State  the  electromagnetic  wave  theory  and  list  the  components  of  the  electromagnetic  wave. 


INTRODUCTION  TO  WAVE  PROPAGATION 

Of  the  many  technical  subjects  that  naval  personnel  are  expected  to  know,  probably  the  one  least 
susceptible  to  change  is  the  theory  of  wave  propagation.  The  basic  principles  that  enable  waves  to  be 
propagated  (transmitted)  through  space  are  the  same  today  as  they  were  70  years  ago.  One  would  think, 
then,  that  a  thorough  understanding  of  these  principles  is  a  relatively  simple  task.  For  the  electrical 
engineer  or  the  individual  with  a  natural  curiosity  for  the  unknown,  it  is  indeed  a  simple  task.  Most 
technicians,  however,  tend  to  view  wave  propagation  as  something  complex  and  confusing,  and  would 
just  as  soon  see  this  chapter  completely  disappear  from  training  manuals.  This  attitude  undoubtedly  stems 
from  the  fact  that  wave  propagation  is  an  invisible  force  that  cannot  be  detected  by  the  sense  of  sight  or 
touch.  Understanding  wave  propagation  requires  the  use  of  the  imagination  to  visualize  the  associated 
concepts  and  how  they  are  used  in  practical  application.  This  manual  was  developed  to  help  you  visualize 


1-1 


and  understand  those  concepts.  Through  ample  use  of  illustrations  and  a  step-by-step  transition  from  the 
simple  to  the  complex,  we  will  help  you  develop  a  better  understanding  of  wave  propagation.  In  this 
chapter,  we  will  discuss  propagation  theory  on  an  introductory  level,  without  going  into  the  technical 
details  that  concern  the  engineer.  However,  you  must  still  use  thought  and  imagination  to  understand  the 
new  ideas  and  concepts  as  they  are  presented. 

To  understand  radio  wave  propagation,  you  must  first  learn  what  wave  propagation  is  and  some  of 
the  basic  physics  or  properties  that  affect  propagation.  Many  of  these  properties  are  common  everyday 
occurrences,  with  which  you  are  already  familiar. 


WHAT  IS  PROPAGATION? 

Early  man  was  quick  to  recognize  the  need  to  communicate  beyond  the  range  of  the  human  voice.  To 
satisfy  this  need,  he  developed  alternate  methods  of  communication,  such  as  hand  gestures,  beating  on  a 
hollow  log,  and  smoke  signals.  Although  these  methods  were  effective,  they  were  still  greatly  limited  in 
range.  Eventually,  the  range  limitations  were  overcome  by  the  development  of  courier  and  postal  systems; 
but  there  was  then  a  problem  of  speed.  For  centuries  the  time  required  for  the  delivery  of  a  message 
depended  on  the  speed  of  a  horse. 

During  the  latter  part  of  the  19th  century,  both  distance  and  time  limitations  were  largely  overcome. 
The  invention  of  the  telegraph  made  possible  instantaneous  communication  over  long  wires.  Then  a  short 
time  later,  man  discovered  how  to  transmit  messages  in  the  form  of  RADIO  WAVES. 

As  you  will  learn  in  this  chapter,  radio  waves  are  propagated.  PROPAGATION  means  "movement 
through  a  medium."  This  is  most  easily  illustrated  by  light  rays.  When  a  light  is  turned  on  in  a  darkened 
room,  light  rays  travel  from  the  light  bulb  throughout  the  room.  When  a  flashlight  is  turned  on,  light  rays 
also  radiate  from  its  bulb,  but  are  focused  into  a  narrow  beam.  You  can  use  these  examples  to  picture  how 
radio  waves  propagate.  Like  the  light  in  the  room,  radio  waves  may  spread  out  in  all  directions.  They  can 
also  be  focused  (concentrated)  like  the  flashlight,  depending  upon  the  need.  Radio  waves  are  a  form  of 
radiant  energy,  similar  to  light  and  heat.  Although  they  can  neither  be  seen  nor  felt,  their  presence  can  be 
detected  through  the  use  of  sensitive  measuring  devices.  The  speed  at  which  both  forms  of  waves  travel  is 
the  same;  they  both  travel  at  the  speed  of  light. 

You  may  wonder  why  you  can  see  light  but  not  radio  waves,  which  consist  of  the  same  form  of 
energy  as  light.  The  reason  is  that  you  can  only  "see"  what  your  eyes  can  detect.  Your  eyes  can  detect 
radiant  energy  only  within  a  fixed  range  of  frequencies.  Since  the  frequencies  of  radio  waves  are  below 
the  frequencies  your  eyes  can  detect,  you  cannot  see  radio  waves. 

The  theory  of  wave  propagation  that  we  discuss  in  this  module  applies  to  Navy  electronic  equipment, 
such  as  radar,  navigation,  detection,  and  communication  equipment.  We  will  not  discuss  these  individual 
systems  in  this  module,  but  we  will  explain  them  in  future  modules. 

Ql.   What  is  propagation? 


PRINCIPLES  OF  WAVE  MOTION 

All  things  on  the  earth — on  the  land,  or  in  the  water — are  showered  continually  with  waves  of 
energy.  Some  of  these  waves  stimulate  our  senses  and  can  be  seen,  felt,  or  heard.  For  instance,  we  can  see 
light,  hear  sound,  and  feel  heat.  However,  there  are  some  waves  that  do  not  stimulate  our  senses.  For 

1-2 


example,  radio  waves,  such  as  those  received  by  our  portable  radio  or  television  sets,  cannot  be  seen, 
heard,  or  felt.  A  device  must  be  used  to  convert  radio  waves  into  light  (TV  pictures)  and  sound  (audio)  for 
us  to  sense  them. 

A  WAVE  can  be  defined  as  a  DISTURBANCE  (sound,  light,  radio  waves)  that  moves  through  a 
MEDIUM  (air,  water,  vacuum).  To  help  you  understand  what  is  meant  by  "a  disturbance  which  moves 
through  a  medium,"  picture  the  following  illustration.  You  are  standing  in  the  middle  of  a  wheat  field.  As 
the  wind  blows  across  the  field  toward  you,  you  can  see  the  wheat  stalks  bending  and  rising  as  the  force 
of  the  wind  moves  into  and  across  them.  The  wheat  appears  to  be  moving  toward  you,  but  it  isn't.  Instead, 
the  stalks  are  actually  moving  back  and  forth.  We  can  then  say  that  the  "medium"  in  this  illustration  is  the 
wheat  and  the  "disturbance"  is  the  wind  moving  the  stalks  of  wheat. 

WAVE  MOTION  can  be  defined  as  a  recurring  disturbance  advancing  through  space  with  or  without 
the  use  of  a  physical  medium.  Wave  motion,  therefore,  is  a  means  of  moving  or  transferring  energy  from 
one  point  to  another  point.  For  example,  when  sound  waves  strike  a  microphone,  sound  energy  is 
converted  into  electrical  energy.  When  light  waves  strike  a  phototransistor  or  radio  waves  strike  an 
antenna,  they  are  likewise  converted  into  electrical  energy.  Therefore,  sound,  light,  and  radio  waves  are 
all  forms  of  energy  that  are  moved  by  wave  motion.  We  will  discuss  sound  waves,  light  waves,  and  radio 
waves  later. 

Q2.  How  is  a  wave  defined  as  it  applies  to  wave  propagation? 

Q3.   What  is  wave  motion? 

Q4.   What  are  some  examples  of  wave  motion? 

WAVE  MOTION  IN  WATER 

A  type  of  wave  motion  familiar  to  almost  everyone  is  the  movement  of  waves  in  water.  We  will 
explain  these  waves  first  to  help  you  understand  wave  motion  and  the  terms  used  to  describe  it. 

Basic  wave  motion  can  be  shown  by  dropping  a  stone  into  a  pool  of  water  (see  figure  1-1).  As  the 
stone  enters  the  water,  a  surface  disturbance  is  created,  resulting  in  an  expanding  series  of  circular  waves. 
Figure  1-2  is  a  diagram  of  this  action.  View  A  shows  the  falling  stone  just  an  instant  before  it  strikes  the 
water.  View  B  shows  the  action  taking  place  at  the  instant  the  stone  strikes  the  surface,  pushing  the  water 
that  is  around  it  upward  and  outward.  In  view  C,  the  stone  has  sunk  deeper  into  the  water,  which  has 
closed  violently  over  it  causing  some  spray,  while  the  leading  wave  has  moved  outward.  An  instant  later, 
the  stone  has  sunk  out  of  sight,  leaving  the  water  disturbed  as  shown  in  view  D.  Here  the  leading  wave 
has  continued  to  move  outward  and  is  followed  by  a  series  of  waves  gradually  diminishing  in  amplitude. 
Meanwhile,  the  disturbance  at  the  original  point  of  contact  has  gradually  subsided. 


1-3 


Figure  1-1. — Formation  of  waves  in  water. 


SURFACE  OF  WATER 


B 


■falling  stone 


LEADING  WAVE  FORMS  AS 
STONE  STRIKES  WATER 


SPRAY 

LEADING  WAVE  MOVES  OUTWARD 


Figure  1-2. — How  a  falling  stone  creates  wave  motion  to  the  surface  of  water. 

In  this  example,  the  water  is  not  actually  being  moved  outward  by  the  motion  of  the  waves,  but  up 
and  down  as  the  waves  move  outward.  The  up  and  down  motion  is  transverse,  or  at  right  angles,  to  the 
outward  motion  of  the  waves.  This  type  of  wave  motion  is  called  TRANSVERSE  WAVE  MOTION. 


Q5.   What  type  of  wave  motion  is  represented  by  the  motion  of  water? 


1-4 


TRANSVERSE  WAVES 


To  explain  transverse  waves,  we  will  again  use  our  example  of  water  waves.  Figure  1-3  is  a  cross 
section  diagram  of  waves  viewed  from  the  side.  Notice  that  the  waves  are  a  succession  of  crests  and 
troughs.  The  wavelength  (one  360  degree  cycle)  is  the  distance  from  the  crest  of  one  wave  to  the  crest  of 
the  next,  or  between  any  two  similar  points  on  adjacent  waves.  The  amplitude  of  a  transverse  wave  is  half 
the  distance  measured  vertically  from  the  crest  to  the  trough.  Water  waves  are  known  as  transverse  waves 
because  the  motion  of  the  water  is  up  and  down,  or  at  right  angles  to  the  direction  in  which  the  waves  are 
traveling.  You  can  see  this  by  observing  a  cork  bobbing  up  and  down  on  water  as  the  waves  pass  by;  the 
cork  moves  very  little  in  a  sideways  direction.  In  figure  1-4,  the  small  arrows  show  the  up-and-down 
direction  the  cork  moves  as  the  transverse  wave  is  set  in  motion.  The  direction  the  wave  travels  is  shown 
by  the  large  arrow.  Radio  waves,  light  waves,  and  heat  waves  are  examples  of  transverse  waves. 


Figure  1-3. — Elements  of  a  wave. 


DIRECTION  OF 


WAVE  TRAVEL 


Figure  1-4. — Transverse  wave. 

LONGITUDINAL  WAVES 

In  the  previous  discussion,  we  listed  radio  waves,  light  waves,  and  heat  waves  as  examples  of 
transverse  waves,  but  we  did  not  mention  sound  waves.  Why?  Simply  because  sound  waves  are 
LONGITUDINAL  WAVES.  Unlike  transverse  waves,  which  travel  at  right  angles  to  the  direction  of 
propagation,  sound  waves  travel  back  and  forth  in  the  same  direction  as  the  wave  motion.  Therefore, 
longitudinal  waves  are  waves  in  which  the  disturbance  takes  place  in  the  direction  of  propagation. 
Longitudinal  waves  are  sometimes  called  COMPRESSION  WAVES. 

Waves  that  make  up  sound,  such  as  those  set  up  in  the  air  by  a  vibrating  tuning  fork,  are  longitudinal 
waves.  In  figure  1-5,  the  tuning  fork,  when  struck,  sets  up  vibrations.  As  the  tine  moves  in  an  outward 
direction,  the  air  immediately  in  front  of  it  is  compressed  (made  more  dense)  so  that  its  momentary 


1-5 


pressure  is  raised  above  that  at  other  points  in  the  surrounding  medium  (air).  Because  air  is  elastic,  the 
disturbance  is  transmitted  in  an  outward  direction  as  a  COMPRESSION  WAVE.  When  the  tine  returns 
and  moves  in  the  inward  direction,  the  air  in  front  of  the  tine  is  rarefied  (made  less  dense  or  expanded)  so 
that  its  pressure  is  lowered  below  that  of  the  other  points  in  the  surrounding  air.  The  rarefied  wave  is 
propagated  from  the  tuning  fork  and  follows  the  compressed  wave  through  the  medium  (air). 


Figure  1-5. — Sound  propagation  by  a  tuning  fork. 

Q6.   What  are  some  examples  of  transverse  waves? 
Q7.  What  example  of  a  longitudinal  wave  was  given  in  the  text? 
MEDIUM 

We  have  used  the  term  medium  in  describing  the  motion  of  waves.  Since  medium  is  a  term  that  is 
used  frequently  in  discussing  propagation,  it  needs  to  be  defined  so  you  will  understand  what  a  medium  is 
and  its  application  to  propagation. 

A  MEDIUM  is  the  vehicle  through  which  the  wave  travels  from  one  point  to  the  next.  The  vehicle 
that  carries  a  wave  can  be  just  about  anything.  An  example  of  a  medium,  already  mentioned,  is  air.  Air,  as 
defined  by  the  dictionary,  is  the  mixture  of  invisible,  odorless,  tasteless  gases  that  surrounds  the  earth  (the 
atmosphere).  Air  is  made  up  of  molecules  of  various  gases  (and  impurities).  We  will  call  these  molecules 
of  air  particles  of  air  or  simply  particles. 

Figure  1-6  will  help  you  to  understand  how  waves  travel  through  air.  The  object  producing  the  waves 
is  called  the  SOURCE — a  bell  in  this  illustration.  The  object  responding  to  the  waves  is  called  a 
DETECTOR  or  RECEIVER — in  this  case,  the  human  ear.  The  medium  is  air,  which  is  the  means  of 
conveying  the  waves  from  the  source  to  the  detector.  The  source,  detector,  and  medium  are  all  necessary 
for  wave  motion  and  wave  propagation  (except  for  electromagnetic  waves  which  require  no  medium). 
The  waves  shown  in  figure  1-6  are  sound  waves.  As  the  bell  is  rung,  the  particles  of  air  around  the  bell 
are  compressed  and  then  expanded.  This  compression  and  expansion  of  particles  of  air  set  up  a  wave 
motion  in  the  air.  As  the  waves  are  produced,  they  carry  energy  from  particle  to  particle  through  the 
medium  (air)  to  the  detector  (ear). 


1-6 


Figure  1-6. — The  three  elements  of  sound. 

Q8.   What  are  the  three  requirements  for  a  wave  to  be  propagated? 

TERMS  USED  IN  WAVE  MOTION 

There  are  a  number  of  special  terms  concerning  waves  that  you  should  know.  Many  of  the  terms, 
such  as  CYCLE,  WAVELENGTH,  AMPLITUDE,  and  FREQUENCY  were  introduced  in  previous 
NEETS  modules.  We  will  now  discuss  these  terms  in  detail  as  they  pertain  to  wave  propagation.  Before 
we  begin  our  discussion,  however,  note  that  in  the  figure,  wave  1  and  wave  2  have  equal  frequency  and 
wavelength  but  different  amplitudes.  The  REFERENCE  LINE  (also  known  as  REST  POSITION  or 
POINT  OF  ZERO  DISPLACEMENT)  is  the  position  that  a  particle  of  matter  would  have  if  it  were  not 
disturbed  by  wave  motion.  For  example,  in  the  case  of  the  water  wave,  the  reference  line  is  the  level  of 
the  water  when  no  wave  motion  is  present.  With  this  in  mind,  let's  go  on  to  our  discussion  of  the  four 
terms,  as  shown  in  figure  1-7. 


1-7 


(TOP  OR  CRESTJ 


^ —  1  CYCLE  — *J 


Figure  1-7. — Comparison  of  waves  with  different  amplitudes. 

Cycle 

Refer  to  wave  1  in  figure  1-7.  Notice  how  similar  it  is  to  the  sine  wave  you  have  already  studied.  All 
transverse  waves  appear  as  sine  waves  when  viewed  from  the  side.  In  figure  1-7,  wave  1  has  four 
complete  cycles.  Points  ABCDE  comprise  one  complete  cycle  having  a  maximum  value  above  and  a 
maximum  value  below  the  reference  line.  The  portion  above  the  reference  line  (between  points  A  and  C) 
is  called  a  POSITIVE  ALTERNATION  and  the  portion  below  the  reference  line  (between  points  C  and 
E)  is  known  as  a  NEGATIVE  ALTERNATION.  The  combination  of  one  complete  positive  and  one 
complete  negative  alternation  represents  one  cycle  of  the  wave.  At  point  E,  the  wave  begins  to  repeat 
itself  with  a  second  cycle  completed  at  point  I,  a  third  at  point  M,  etc.  The  peak  of  the  positive  alternation 
(maximum  value  above  the  line)  is  sometimes  referred  to  as  the  TOP  or  CREST,  and  the  peak  of  the 
negative  alternation  (maximum  value  below  the  line)  is  sometimes  called  the  BOTTOM  or  TROUGH,  as 
depicted  in  the  figure.  Therefore,  one  cycle  has  one  crest  and  one  trough. 

Wavelength 

A  WAVELENGTH  is  the  distance  in  space  occupied  by  one  cycle  of  a  radio  wave  at  any  given 
instant.  If  the  wave  could  be  frozen  in  place  and  measured,  the  wavelength  would  be  the  distance  from  the 
leading  edge  of  one  cycle  to  the  corresponding  point  on  the  next  cycle.  Wavelengths  vary  from  a  few 
hundredths  of  an  inch  at  extremely  high  frequencies  to  many  miles  at  extremely  low  frequencies; 
however,  common  practice  is  to  express  wavelengths  in  meters.  Therefore,  in  figure  1-7  (wave  1),  the 
distance  between  A  and  E,  or  B  and  F,  etc.,  is  one  wavelength.  The  Greek  letter  lambda  (K)  is  used  to 
signify  wavelength.  Why  lambda  and  not  "1"  or  "L"?  This  is  because  "L"  is  used  conventionally  as  the 


1-8 


symbol  for  inductance,  and  "1"  is  used  for  dimensional  length;  therefore,  X;  is  used  to  indicate  the  length 
of  waves. 

Amplitude 

Two  waves  may  have  the  same  wavelength,  but  the  crest  of  one  may  rise  higher  above  the  reference 
line  than  the  crest  of  the  other.  Compare  wave  1  and  wave  2  of  figure  1-7  again.  The  height  of  a  wave 
crest  above  the  reference  line  is  called  the  AMPLITUDE  of  the  wave.  The  amplitude  of  a  wave  gives  a 
relative  indication  of  the  amount  of  energy  the  wave  transmits.  A  continuous  series  of  waves,  such  as  A 
through  Q,  having  the  same  amplitude  and  wavelength,  is  called  a  train  of  waves  or  WAVE  TRAIN. 

Frequency  and  Time 

Time  is  an  important  factor  in  wave  studies.  When  a  wave  train  passes  through  a  medium,  a  certain 
number  of  individual  waves  pass  a  given  point  in  a  specific  unit  of  time.  For  example,  if  a  cork  on  a  water 
wave  rises  and  falls  once  every  second,  the  wave  makes  one  complete  up-and-down  vibration  every 
second.  The  number  of  vibrations,  or  cycles,  of  a  wave  train  in  a  unit  of  time  is  called  the  FREQUENCY 
of  the  wave  train  and  is  measured  in  HERTZ.  If  5  waves  pass  a  point  in  one  second,  the  frequency  of  the 
wave  train  is  5  cycles  per  second.  In  figure  1-7,  the  frequency  of  both  wave  1  and  wave  2  is  four  cycles 
per  second  (cycles  per  second  is  abbreviated  as  cps). 

In  1967,  in  honor  of  the  German  physicist  Heinrich  Hertz,  the  term  HERTZ  was  designated  for  use 
in  lieu  of  the  term  "cycle  per  second"  when  referring  to  the  frequency  of  radio  waves.  It  may  seem 
confusing  that  in  one  place  the  term  "cycle"  is  used  to  designate  the  positive  and  negative  alternations  of  a 
wave,  but  in  another  instance  the  term  "hertz"  is  used  to  designate  what  appears  to  be  the  same  thing.  The 
key  is  the  time  factor.  The  term  cycle  refers  to  any  sequence  of  events,  such  as  the  positive  and  negative 
alternations,  comprising  one  cycle  of  electrical  current.  The  term  hertz  refers  to  the  number  of 
occurrences  that  take  place  in  one  second. 

Q9.   What  is  a  cycle? 

Q10.  What  is  wavelength  (X)? 

CHARACTERISTICS  OF  WAVE  MOTION 

The  two  types  of  wave  motion,  transverse  and  longitudinal,  have  many  of  the  same  characteristics, 
such  as  frequency,  amplitude,  and  wavelength.  Another  important  characteristic  that  these  two  types  of 
wave  motion  share  is  VELOCITY.  Velocity  of  propagation  is  the  rate  at  which  the  disturbance  travels 
through  the  medium,  or  the  velocity  with  which  the  crest  of  the  wave  moves  along.  The  velocity  of  the 
wave  depends  both  on  the  type  of  wave  (light,  sound,  or  radio)  and  type  of  medium  (air,  water,  or  metal). 
If  longitudinal  waves  are  plotted  as  a  graph,  they  appear  as  transverse  waves.  This  fact  is  illustrated  in 
figure  1-8. 


1-9 


Figure  1-8. — Longitudinal  wave  represented  graphically  by  a  transverse  wave. 

The  frequency  of  a  longitudinal  wave,  like  that  of  a  transverse  wave,  is  the  number  of  complete 
cycles  the  wave  makes  during  a  specific  unit  of  time.  The  higher  the  frequency,  the  greater  is  the  number 
of  compressions  and  expansions  per  unit  of  time. 

In  the  two  types  of  wave  motion  described  in  the  preceding  discussion,  the  following  quantities  are 
of  interest: 

a.  The  PERIOD,  which  is  the  time  (T)  in  which  one  complete  vibratory  cycle  of  events  occurs, 

b.  The  FREQUENCY  OF  VIBRATION  (f),  which  is  the  number  of  cycles  taking  place  in  one 
second,  and 

c.  The  WAVELENGTH,  which  is  the  distance  the  disturbance  travels  during  one  period  of 
vibration. 

Now,  consider  the  following  concept.  If  a  vibrating  object  makes  a  certain  number  of  vibrations  per 
second,  then  1  second  divided  by  the  number  of  vibrations  is  equal  to  the  period  of  time  of  1  vibration.  In 
other  words,  the  period,  or  time,  of  1  vibration  is  the  reciprocal  of  the  frequency;  thus, 


time  (T)  of  one  vibration  = 
1 

frequency  (f) 
or 

-I 


If  you  know  the  velocity  of  a  wave,  you  can  determine  the  wavelength  by  dividing  the  velocity  by 
the  frequency.  As  an  equation: 


1-10 


mere: 


X  =  wavelength 

v  =  velocity  of  propagation 

f  =  frequency  of  vibration 

When  you  use  the  above  equation,  be  careful  to  express  velocity  and  wavelength  in  the  proper  units 
of  length.  For  example,  in  the  English  system,  if  the  velocity  (expressed  in  feet  per  second)  is  divided  by 
the  frequency  (expressed  in  cycles  per  second,  or  Hz),  the  wavelength  is  given  in  feet  per  cycle.  If  the 
metric  system  is  used  and  the  velocity  (expressed  in  meters  per  second)  is  divided  by  the  frequency 
(expressed  in  cycles  per  second),  the  wavelength  is  given  in  meters  per  cycle.  Be  sure  to  express  both  the 
wavelength  and  the  frequency  in  the  same  units.  (Feet  per  cycle  and  meters  per  cycle  are  normally 
abbreviated  as  feet  or  meters  because  one  wavelength  indicates  one  cycle.)  Because  this  equation  holds 
true  for  both  transverse  and  longitudinal  waves,  it  is  used  in  the  study  of  both  electromagnetic  waves  and 
sound  waves. 

Consider  the  following  example.  Two  cycles  of  a  wave  pass  a  fixed  point  every  second,  and  the 
velocity  of  the  wave  train  is  4  feet  per  second.  What  is  the  wavelength?  The  formula  for  determining 
wavelength  is  as  follows: 

V 

7 

wavelength  in  feet 
velocity  in  feet  per  second 
frequency  in  Hz 

4  feet  per  second 
2  Hz 


v 

7 

4  feet  per  second 
2~Hz 

2  feet 

NOTE:  In  problems  of  this  kind,  be  sure  NOT  to  confuse  wave  velocity  with  frequency. 
FREQUENCY  is  the  number  of  cycles  per  unit  of  time  (Hz).  WAVE  VELOCITY  is  the  speed  with  which 
a  wave  train  passes  a  fixed  point. 


Where: 

X  = 
v  = 
f  = 

Given: 

v  = 
f  = 

Solution: 

X  = 
X  = 


1-11 


Here  is  another  problem.  If  a  wave  has  a  velocity  of  1,100  feet  per  second  and  a  wavelength  of  30 
feet,  what  is  the  frequency  of  the  wave? 

By  transposing  the  general  equation: 

By  transposing  the  general  equation: 

X 

We  have  the  equation: 

X  =1 
f 


Given: 


v  =  1, 100  feetper  second 
X  =  30  feet 


Solution: 

£.  _  1.100  feet  per  second 
30  feet 

f  =  36.67Hz 
To  find  the  velocity,  rewrite  the  equation  as: 

v  =  Xf 

Let's  work  one  more  problem,  this  time  using  the  metric  system. 

Suppose  the  wavelength  is  0.4  meters  and  the  frequency  is  12  kHz.  What  is  the  velocity? 
Use  the  formula: 

velocity  =  wavelength  x  frequency  (v  =  Af) 
Given: 

wavelength  {X)  =  0.4  meters 
frequency  (f)  =  12kHz 


Solution: 


v  =  X  x  f 

v=  0.4  meters  x  12,000Hz 
v  =  4800  meters  per  second 


1-12 


Other  important  characteristics  of  wave  motion  are  reflection,  refraction,  diffraction,  and  the  Doppler 
effect.  Big  words,  but  the  concept  of  each  is  easy  to  see.  For  ease  of  understanding,  we  will  explain  the 
first  two  characteristics  using  light  waves,  and  the  last  two  characteristics  using  sound  waves.  You  should 
keep  in  mind  that  all  waves  react  in  a  similar  manner. 

Within  mediums,  such  as  air,  solids,  or  gases,  a  wave  travels  in  a  straight  line.  When  the  wave  leaves 
the  boundary  of  one  medium  and  enters  the  boundary  of  a  different  medium,  the  wave  changes  direction. 
For  our  purposes  in  this  module,  a  boundary  is  an  imaginary  line  that  separates  one  medium  from  another. 

When  a  wave  passes  through  one  medium  and  encounters  a  medium  having  different  characteristics, 
three  things  can  occur  to  the  wave:  (1)  Some  of  the  energy  can  be  reflected  back  into  the  initial  medium; 
(2)  some  of  the  energy  can  be  transmitted  into  the  second  medium  where  it  may  continue  at  a  different 
velocity;  or  (3)  some  of  the  energy  can  be  absorbed  by  the  medium.  In  some  cases,  all  three  processes 
(reflection,  transmission,  and  absorption)  may  occur  to  some  degree. 

Reflection 

REFLECTION  WAVES  are  simply  waves  that  are  neither  transmitted  nor  absorbed,  but  are  reflected 
from  the  surface  of  the  medium  they  encounter.  If  a  wave  is  directed  against  a  reflecting  surface,  such  as  a 
mirror,  it  will  reflect  or  "bounce"  from  the  mirror.  Refer  to  figure  1-9.  A  wave  directed  toward  the  surface 
of  the  mirror  is  called  the  INCIDENT  wave.  When  the  wave  bounces  off  of  the  mirror,  it  becomes  known 
as  the  REFLECTED  wave.  An  imaginary  line  perpendicular  to  the  mirror  at  the  point  at  which  the 
incident  wave  strikes  the  mirror's  surface  is  called  the  NORMAL,  or  perpendicular.  The  angle  between 
the  incident  wave  and  the  normal  is  called  the  ANGLE  OF  INCIDENCE.  The  angle  between  the  reflected 
wave  and  the  normal  is  called  the  ANGLE  OF  REFLECTION. 


PERPENDICULAR 


Figure  1-9. — Reflection  of  a  wave. 


1-13 


If  the  reflecting  surface  is  smooth  and  polished,  the  angle  between  the  incident  ray  and  the  normal 
will  be  the  same  as  the  angle  between  the  reflected  ray  and  the  normal.  This  conforms  to  the  law  of 
reflection  which  states:  The  angle  of  incidence  is  equal  to  the  angle  of  reflection. 

The  amount  of  incident  wave  energy  reflected  from  a  given  surface  depends  on  the  nature  of  the 
surface  and  the  angle  at  which  the  wave  strikes  the  surface.  As  the  angle  of  incidence  increases,  the 
amount  of  wave  energy  reflected  increases.  The  reflected  energy  is  the  greatest  when  the  wave  is  nearly 
parallel  to  the  reflecting  surface.  When  the  incident  wave  is  perpendicular  to  the  surface,  more  of  the 
energy  is  transmitted  into  the  substance  and  less  is  reflected.  At  any  incident  angle,  a  mirror  reflects 
almost  all  of  the  wave  energy,  while  a  dull,  black  surface  reflects  very  little. 

Qll.   What  is  the  law  of  reflection? 

Q12.   When  a  wave  is  reflected  from  a  surface,  energy  is  transferred.  When  is  the  transfer  of  energy 
greatest? 

Q13.   When  is  the  transfer  of  energy  minimum? 
Refraction 

When  a  wave  passes  from  one  medium  into  another  medium  that  has  a  different  velocity  of 
propagation,  a  change  in  the  direction  of  the  wave  will  occur.  This  changing  of  direction  as  the  wave 
enters  the  second  medium  is  called  REFRACTION.  As  in  the  discussion  of  reflection,  the  wave  striking 
the  boundary  (surface)  is  called  the  INCIDENT  WAVE,  and  the  imaginary  line  perpendicular  to  the 
boundary  is  called  the  NORMAL.  The  angle  between  the  incident  wave  and  the  normal  is  called  the 
ANGLE  OF  INCIDENCE.  As  the  wave  passes  through  the  boundary,  it  is  bent  either  toward  or  away 
from  the  normal.  The  angle  between  the  normal  and  the  path  of  the  wave  through  the  second  medium  is 
the  ANGLE  OF  REFRACTION. 

A  light  wave  passing  through  a  block  of  glass  is  shown  in  figure  1-10.  The  wave  moves  from  point  A 
to  B  at  a  constant  speed.  This  is  the  incident  wave.  As  the  wave  penetrates  the  glass  boundary  at  point  B, 
the  velocity  of  the  wave  is  slowed  down.  This  causes  the  wave  to  bend  toward  the  normal.  The  wave  then 
takes  the  path  from  point  B  to  C  through  the  glass  and  becomes  BOTH  the  refracted  wave  from  the  top 
surface  and  the  incident  wave  to  the  lower  surface.  As  the  wave  passes  from  the  glass  to  the  air  (the 
second  boundary),  it  is  again  refracted,  this  time  away  from  the  normal  and  takes  the  path  from  point  C  to 
D.  As  the  wave  passes  through  the  last  boundary,  its  velocity  increases  to  the  original  velocity.  As  figure 
1-10  shows,  refracted  waves  can  bend  toward  or  away  from  the  normal.  This  bending  depends  on  the 
velocity  of  the  wave  through  each  medium.  The  broken  line  between  points  B  and  E  is  the  path  that  the 
wave  would  travel  if  the  two  mediums  (air  and  glass)  had  the  same  density. 


1-14 


Figure  1-10. — Refraction  of  a  wave. 
To  summarize  what  figure  1-10  shows: 

1 .  If  the  wave  passes  from  a  less  dense  medium  to  a  more  dense  medium,  it  is  bent  toward  the 
normal,  and  the  angle  of  refraction  (r)  is  less  than  the  angle  of  incidence  (i). 

2.  If  the  wave  passes  from  a  more  dense  to  a  less  dense  medium,  it  is  bent  away  from  the  normal, 
and  the  angle  of  refraction  (r0  is  greater  than  the  angle  of  incidence  (ii). 

You  can  more  easily  understand  refraction  by  looking  at  figure  1-11.  There  is  a  plowed  field  in  the 
middle  of  a  parade  ground.  Think  of  the  incident  wave  as  a  company  of  recruits  marching  four  abreast  at 
an  angle  across  the  parade  ground  to  the  plowed  field,  then  crossing  the  plowed  field  and  coming  out  on 
the  other  side  onto  the  parade  ground  again.  As  the  recruits  march  diagonally  across  the  parade  ground 
and  begin  to  cross  the  boundary  onto  the  plowed  field,  the  front  line  is  slowed  down.  Because  the  recruits 
arrive  at  the  boundary  at  different  times,  they  will  begin  to  slow  down  at  different  times  (number  1  slows 
down  first  and  number  4  slows  down  last  in  each  line).  The  net  effect  is  a  bending  action.  When  the 
recruits  leave  the  plowed  field  and  reenter  the  parade  ground,  the  reverse  action  takes  place. 


1-15 


Figure  1-11. — Analogy  of  refraction. 

Q14.  A  refracted  wave  occurs  when  a  wave  passes  from  one  medium  into  another  medium.  What 
determines  the  angle  of  refraction? 

Diffraction 

DIFFRACTION  is  the  bending  of  the  wave  path  when  the  waves  meet  an  obstruction.  The  amount  of 
diffraction  depends  on  the  wavelength  of  the  wave.  Higher  frequency  waves  are  rarely  diffracted  in  the 
normal  world  that  surrounds  us.  Since  light  waves  are  high  frequency  waves,  you  will  rarely  see  light 
diffracted.  You  can,  however,  observe  diffraction  in  sound  waves  by  listening  to  music.  Suppose  you  are 
outdoors  listening  to  a  band.  If  you  step  behind  a  solid  obstruction,  such  as  a  brick  wall,  you  will  hear 
mostly  low  notes.  This  is  because  the  higher  notes,  having  short  wave  lengths,  undergo  little  or  no 
diffraction  and  pass  by  or  over  the  wall  without  wrapping  around  the  wall  and  reaching  your  ears.  The 
low  notes,  having  longer  wavelengths,  wrap  around  the  wall  and  reach  your  ears.  This  leads  to  the  general 
statement  that  lower  frequency  waves  tend  to  diffract  more  than  higher  frequency  waves.  Broadcast  band 
(AM  band)  radio  waves  (lower  frequency  waves)  often  travel  over  a  mountain  to  the  opposite  side  from 
their  source  because  of  diffraction,  while  higher  frequency  TV  and  FM  signals  from  the  same  source  tend 
to  be  stopped  by  the  mountain. 

Doppler  Effect 

The  last,  but  equally  important,  characteristic  of  a  wave  that  we  will  discuss  is  the  Doppler  effect. 
The  DOPPLER  EFFECT  is  the  apparent  change  in  frequency  or  pitch  when  a  sound  source  moves  either 
toward  or  away  from  the  listener,  or  when  the  listener  moves  either  toward  or  away  from  the  sound 
source.  This  principle,  discovered  by  the  Austrian  physicist  Christian  Doppler,  applies  to  all  wave  motion. 

The  apparent  change  in  frequency  between  the  source  of  a  wave  and  the  receiver  of  the  wave  is 
because  of  relative  motion  between  the  source  and  the  receiver.  To  understand  the  Doppler  effect,  first 
assume  that  the  frequency  of  a  sound  from  a  source  is  held  constant.  The  wavelength  of  the  sound  will 
also  remain  constant.  If  both  the  source  and  the  receiver  of  the  sound  remain  stationary,  the  receiver  will 


1-16 


hear  the  same  frequency  sound  produced  by  the  source.  This  is  because  the  receiver  is  receiving  the  same 
number  of  waves  per  second  that  the  source  is  producing.  Now,  if  either  the  source  or  the  receiver  or  both 
move  toward  the  other,  the  receiver  will  perceive  a  higher  frequency  sound.  This  is  because  the  receiver 
will  receive  a  greater  number  of  sound  waves  per  second  and  interpret  the  greater  number  of  waves  as  a 
higher  frequency  sound.  Conversely,  if  the  source  and  the  receiver  are  moving  apart,  the  receiver  will 
receive  a  smaller  number  of  sound  waves  per  second  and  will  perceive  a  lower  frequency  sound.  In  both 
cases,  the  frequency  of  the  sound  produced  by  the  source  will  have  remained  constant. 

For  example,  the  frequency  of  the  whistle  on  a  fast-moving  train  sounds  increasingly  higher  in  pitch 
as  the  train  is  approaching  than  when  the  train  is  departing.  Although  the  whistle  is  generating  sound 
waves  of  a  constant  frequency,  and  though  they  travel  through  the  air  at  the  same  velocity  in  all 
directions,  the  distance  between  the  approaching  train  and  the  listener  is  decreasing.  As  a  result,  each 
wave  has  less  distance  to  travel  to  reach  the  observer  than  the  wave  preceding  it.  Thus,  the  waves  arrive 
with  decreasing  intervals  of  time  between  them. 

These  apparent  changes  in  frequency,  called  the  Doppler  effect,  affect  the  operation  of  equipment 
used  to  detect  and  measure  wave  energy.  In  dealing  with  electromagnetic  wave  propagation,  the  Doppler 
principle  is  used  in  equipment  such  as  radar,  target  detection,  weapons  control,  navigation,  and  sonar. 

Q15.   The  apparent  change  in  frequency  or  pitch  because  of  motion  is  explained  by  what  effect? 


SOUND  WAVES 

The  study  of  sound  is  important  because  of  the  role  sound  plays  in  the  depth  finding  equipment 
(fathometer)  and  underwater  detection  equipment  (sonar)  used  by  the  Navy. 

As  you  know,  sound  travels  through  a  medium  by  wave  motion.  Although  sound  waves  and  the 
electromagnetic  waves  used  in  the  propagation  of  radio  and  radar  differ,  both  types  of  waves  have  many 
of  the  same  characteristics.  Studying  the  principles  of  sound-wave  motion  will  help  you  understand  the 
actions  of  both  sound  waves  and  the  more  complex  radio  and  radar  electromagnetic  waves.  The  major 
differences  among  sound  waves,  heat  waves,  and  light  waves  are  (1)  their  frequencies;  (2)  their  types;  the 
mediums  through  which  they  travel;  and  the  velocities  at  which  they  travel. 

SOUND— WHAT  IS  IT? 

The  word  SOUND  is  used  in  everyday  speech  to  signify  a  variety  of  things.  One  definition  of  sound 
is  the  sensation  of  hearing.  Another  definition  refers  to  a  stimulus  that  is  capable  of  producing  the 
sensation  of  hearing.  A  third  definition  limits  sound  to  what  is  actually  heard  by  the  human  ear. 

In  the  study  of  physics,  sound  is  defined  as  a  range  of  compression-wave  frequencies  to  which  the 
human  ear  is  sensitive.  For  the  purpose  of  this  chapter,  however,  we  need  to  broaden  the  definition  of 
sound  to  include  compression  waves  that  are  not  always  audible  to  the  human  ear.  To  distinguish 
frequencies  in  the  audible  range  from  those  outside  that  range,  the  words  SONIC,  ULTRASONIC,  and 
INFRASONIC  are  used.  Sounds  capable  of  being  heard  by  the  human  ear  are  called  SONICS.  The  normal 
hearing  range  extends  from  about  20  to  20,000  hertz.  However,  to  establish  a  standard  sonic  range,  the 
Navy  has  set  an  arbitrary  upper  limit  for  sonics  at  10,000  hertz  and  a  lower  limit  at  15  hertz.  Even  though 
the  average  person  can  hear  sounds  above  10,000  hertz,  it  is  standard  practice  to  refer  to  sounds  above 
that  frequency  as  ultrasonic.  Sounds  between  15  hertz  and  10,000  hertz  are  called  sonic,  while  sounds 
below  15  hertz  are  known  as  infrasonic  (formerly  referred  to  as  subsonic)  sounds. 


1-17 


Q16.   What  term  describes  sounds  capable  of  being  heard  by  the  human  ear? 


Q17.  Are  all  sounds  audible  to  the  human  ear?  Why? 

REQUIREMENTS  FOR  SOUND 

Recall  that  sound  waves  are  compression  waves.  The  existence  of  compression  waves  depends  on 
the  transfer  of  energy.  To  produce  vibrations  that  become  sounds,  a  mechanical  device  (the  source)  must 
first  receive  an  input  of  energy.  Next,  the  device  must  be  in  contact  with  a  medium  that  will  receive  the 
sound  energy  and  carry  it  to  a  receiver.  If  the  device  is  not  in  contact  with  a  medium,  the  energy  will  not 
be  transferred  to  a  receiver,  and  there  will  be  no  sound. 

Thus,  three  basic  elements  for  transmission  and  reception  of  sound  must  be  present  before  a  sound 
can  be  produced.  They  are  (1)  the  source  (or  transmitter),  (2)  a  medium  for  carrying  the  sound  (air,  water, 
metal,  etc.),  and  (3)  the  detector  (or  receiver). 

A  simple  experiment  provides  convincing  evidence  that  a  medium  must  be  present  if  sound  is  to  be 
transferred.  In  figure  1-12,  an  electric  bell  is  suspended  by  rubber  bands  in  a  bell  jar  from  which  the  air 
can  be  removed.  An  external  switch  is  connected  from  a  battery  to  the  bell  so  the  bell  may  be  rung 
intermittently.  As  the  air  is  pumped  out,  the  sound  from  the  bell  becomes  weaker  and  weaker.  If  a  perfect 
vacuum  could  be  obtained,  and  if  no  sound  were  conducted  out  of  the  jar  by  the  rubber  bands,  the  sound 
from  the  bell  would  be  completely  inaudible.  In  other  words,  sound  cannot  be  transmitted  through  a 
vacuum.  When  the  air  is  admitted  again,  the  sound  is  as  loud  as  it  was  at  the  beginning.  This  experiment 
shows  that  when  air  is  in  contact  with  the  vibrating  bell,  it  carries  energy  to  the  walls  of  the  jar,  which  in 
turn  are  set  in  vibration.  Thus,  the  energy  passes  into  the  air  outside  of  the  jar  and  then  on  to  the  ear  of  the 
observer.  This  experiment  illustrates  that  sound  cannot  exist  in  empty  space  (or  a  vacuum). 


Any  object  that  moves  rapidly  back  and  forth,  or  vibrates,  and  thus  disturbs  the  medium  around  it 
may  be  considered  a  source  for  sound.  Bells,  speakers,  and  stringed  instruments  are  familiar  sound 
sources. 


RUBBER  BANDS 


TO 

VACUUM  -+ 
PUMP 


Figure  1-12. — No  air,  no  sound. 


1-18 


The  material  through  which  sound  waves  travel  is  called  the  medium.  The  density  of  the  medium 
determines  the  ease,  distance,  and  speed  of  sound  transmission.  The  higher  the  density  of  the  medium,  the 
slower  sound  travels  through  it. 

The  detector  acts  as  the  receiver  of  the  sound  wave.  Because  it  does  not  surround  the  source  of  the 
sound  wave,  the  detector  absorbs  only  part  of  the  energy  from  the  wave  and  sometimes  requires  an 
amplifier  to  boost  the  weak  signal. 

As  an  illustration  of  what  happens  if  one  of  these  three  elements  is  not  present,  let's  refer  to  our 
experiment  in  which  a  bell  was  placed  in  a  jar  containing  a  vacuum.  You  could  see  the  bell  being  struck, 
but  you  could  hear  no  sound  because  there  was  no  medium  to  transmit  sound  from  the  bell  to  you.  Now 
let's  look  at  another  example  in  which  the  third  element,  the  detector,  is  missing.  You  see  a  source  (such 
as  an  explosion)  apparently  producing  a  sound,  and  you  know  the  medium  (air)  is  present,  but  you  are  too 
far  away  to  hear  the  noise.  Thus,  as  far  as  you  are  concerned,  there  is  no  detector  and,  therefore,  no  sound. 
We  must  assume,  then,  that  sound  can  exist  only  when  a  source  transmits  sound  through  a  medium,  which 
passes  it  to  a  detector.  Therefore,  in  the  absence  of  any  one  of  the  basic  elements  (source,  medium, 
detector)  there  can  be  NO  sound. 

Q18.  Sound  waves  transmitted  from  a  source  are  sometimes  weak  when  they  reach  the  detector.  What 
instrument  is  needed  to  boost  the  weak  signal? 

TERMS  USED  IN  SOUND  WAVES 

Sound  waves  vary  in  length  according  to  their  frequency.  A  sound  having  a  long  wavelength  is  heard 
at  a  low  pitch  (low  frequency);  one  with  a  short  wavelength  is  heard  at  a  high  pitch  (high  frequency).  A 
complete  wavelength  is  called  a  cycle.  The  distance  from  one  point  on  a  wave  to  the  corresponding  point 
on  the  next  wave  is  a  wavelength.  The  number  of  cycles  per  second  (hertz)  is  the  frequency  of  the  sound. 
The  frequency  of  a  sound  wave  is  also  the  number  of  vibrations  per  second  produced  by  the  sound  source. 

Q19.   What  are  the  three  basic  requirements  for  sound? 

CHARACTERISTICS  OF  SOUND 

Sound  waves  travel  at  great  distances  in  a  very  short  time,  but  as  the  distance  increases  the  waves 
tend  to  spread  out.  As  the  sound  waves  spread  out,  their  energy  simultaneously  spreads  through  an 
increasingly  larger  area.  Thus,  the  wave  energy  becomes  weaker  as  the  distance  from  the  source  is 
increased. 

Sounds  may  be  broadly  classified  into  two  general  groups.  One  group  is  NOISE,  which  includes 
sounds  such  as  the  pounding  of  a  hammer  or  the  slamming  of  a  door.  The  other  group  is  musical  sounds, 
or  TONES.  The  distinction  between  noise  and  tone  is  based  on  the  regularity  of  the  vibrations,  the  degree 
of  damping,  and  the  ability  of  the  ear  to  recognize  components  having  a  musical  sequence.  You  can  best 
understand  the  physical  difference  between  these  kinds  of  sound  by  comparing  the  waveshape  of  a 
musical  note,  depicted  in  view  A  of  figure  1-13,  with  the  waveshape  of  noise,  shown  in  view  B.  You  can 
see  by  the  comparison  of  the  two  waveshapes,  that  noise  makes  a  very  irregular  and  haphazard  curve  and 
a  musical  note  makes  a  uniform  and  regular  curve. 


1-19 


AAA/W 

A    MUSICAL  NOTE 


Figure  1-13. — Musical  sound  versus  noise. 

Sound  has  three  basic  characteristics:  pitch,  intensity,  and  quality.  Each  of  these  three  characteristics 
is  associated  with  one  of  the  properties  of  the  source  or  the  type  of  waves  which  it  produces.  The  pitch 
depends  upon  the  frequency  of  the  waves;  the  intensity  depends  upon  the  amplitude  of  the  waves;  and  the 
quality  depends  upon  the  form  of  the  waves.  With  the  proper  combination  of  these  characteristics,  the 
tone  is  pleasant  to  the  ear.  With  the  wrong  combination,  the  sound  quality  turns  into  noise. 

The  Pitch  of  Sound 

The  term  PITCH  is  used  to  describe  the  frequency  of  a  sound.  An  object  that  vibrates  many  times  per 
second  produces  a  sound  with  a  high  pitch,  as  with  a  police  whistle.  The  slow  vibrations  of  the  heavier 
strings  of  a  violin  cause  a  low-pitched  sound.  Thus,  the  frequency  of  the  wave  determines  pitch.  When  the 
frequency  is  low,  sound  waves  are  long;  when  it  is  high,  the  waves  are  short.  A  sound  can  be  so  high  in 
frequency  that  the  waves  reaching  the  ear  cannot  be  heard.  Likewise,  some  frequencies  are  so  low  that  the 
eardrums  do  not  convert  them  into  sound.  The  range  of  sound  that  the  human  ear  can  detect  varies  with 
each  individual. 

The  Intensity  of  Sound 

The  intensity  of  sound,  at  a  given  distance,  depends  upon  the  amplitude  of  the  waves.  Thus,  a  tuning 
fork  gives  out  more  energy  in  the  form  of  sound  when  struck  hard  than  when  struck  gently.  You  should 
remember  that  when  a  tuning  fork  is  struck,  the  sound  is  omnidirectional  (heard  in  all  directions),  because 
the  sound  waves  spread  out  in  all  directions,  as  shown  in  figure  1-14.  You  can  see  from  the  figure  that  as 
the  distance  between  the  waves  and  the  sound  source  increases,  the  energy  in  each  wave  spreads  over  a 
greater  area;  hence,  the  intensity  of  the  sound  decreases.  The  speaking  tubes  sometimes  used  aboard  a 
ship  prevent  the  sound  waves  from  spreading  in  all  directions  by  concentrating  them  in  one  desired 
direction  (unidirectional),  producing  greater  intensity.  Therefore,  the  sound  is  heard  almost  at  its  original 
intensity  at  the  opposite  end  of  the  speaking  tube.  The  unidirectional  megaphone  and  the  directional 
loudspeaker  also  prevent  sound  waves  from  spreading  in  all  directions. 


1-20 


Figure  1-14. — Sound  waves  spread  in  all  directions. 

Sound  intensity  and  loudness  are  often  mistakenly  interpreted  as  having  the  same  meaning.  Although 
they  are  related,  they  are  not  the  same.  Sound  INTENSITY  is  a  measure  of  the  sound  energy  of  a  wave. 
LOUDNESS,  on  the  other  hand,  is  the  sensation  the  intensity  (and  sometimes  frequency)  the  sound  wave 
produces  on  the  ear.  Increasing  the  intensity  causes  an  increase  in  loudness  but  not  in  a  direct  proportion. 
For  instance,  doubling  the  loudness  of  a  sound  requires  about  a  tenfold  increase  in  the  intensity  of  the 
sound. 

Sound  Quality 

Most  sounds,  including  musical  notes,  are  not  pure  tones.  They  are  a  mixture  of  different  frequencies 
(tones).  A  tuning  fork,  when  struck,  produces  a  pure  tone  of  a  specific  frequency.  This  pure  tone  is 
produced  by  regular  vibrations  of  the  source  (tines  of  the  tuning  fork).  On  the  other  hand,  scraping  your 
fingernails  across  a  blackboard  only  creates  noise,  because  the  vibrations  are  irregular.  Each  individual 
pipe  of  a  pipe  organ  is  similar  to  a  tuning  fork,  and  each  pipe  produces  a  tone  of  a  specific  frequency.  But 
sounding  two  or  more  pipes  at  the  same  time  produces  a  complex  waveform.  A  tone  that  closely  imitates 
any  of  the  vowel  sounds  can  be  produced  by  selecting  the  proper  pipes  and  sounding  them  at  the  same 
time.  Figure  1-15  illustrates  the  combining  of  two  pure  tones  to  make  a  COMPLEX  WAVE. 


TOME  A 


TONE  B 


RESULTANT 
TONE  C 


Figure  1-15. — Combination  of  tones. 

The  QUALITY  of  a  sound  depends  on  the  complexity  of  its  sound  waves,  such  as  the  waves  shown 
in  tone  C  of  figure  1-15.  Almost  all  sounds  (musical  and  vocal  included)  have  complicated  (complex) 


1-21 


waveforms.  Tone  A  is  a  simple  wave  of  a  specific  frequency  that  can  be  produced  by  a  tuning  fork,  piano, 
organ,  or  other  musical  instrument.  Tone  B  is  also  a  simple  wave  but  at  a  different  frequency.  When  the 
two  tones  are  sounded  together,  the  complex  waveform  in  tone  C  is  produced.  Note  that  tone  C  has  the 
same  frequency  as  tone  A  with  an  increase  in  amplitude.  The  human  ear  could  easily  distinguish  between 
tone  A  and  tone  C  because  of  the  quality.  Therefore,  we  can  say  that  quality  distinguishes  tones  of  like 
pitch  and  loudness  when  sounded  on  different  types  of  musical  instruments.  It  also  distinguishes  the 
voices  of  different  persons. 

Q20.  What  are  the  two  general  groups  of  sound? 

Q21.  What  are  the  three  basic  characteristics  of  sound? 

Q22.   What  is  the  normal  audible  range  of  the  human  ear? 

Q23.  What  is  intensity  as  it  pertains  to  sound? 

Q24.   What  characteristic  of  sound  enables  a  person  to  distinguish  one  musical  instrument  from 
another,  if  they  are  all  playing  the  same  note? 

ELASTICITY  AND  DENSITY  AND  VELOCITY  OF  TRANSMISSION 

Sound  waves  travel  through  any  medium  to  a  velocity  that  is  controlled  by  the  medium.  Varying  the 
frequency  and  intensity  of  the  sound  waves  will  not  affect  the  speed  of  propagation.  The  ELASTICITY 
and  DENSITY  of  a  medium  are  the  two  basic  physical  properties  that  govern  the  velocity  of  sound 
through  the  medium. 

Elasticity  is  the  ability  of  a  strained  body  to  recover  its  shape  after  deformation,  as  from  a  vibration 
or  compression.  The  measure  of  elasticity  of  a  body  is  the  force  it  exerts  to  return  to  its  original  shape. 

The  density  of  a  medium  or  substance  is  the  mass  per  unit  volume  of  the  medium  or  substance. 
Raising  the  temperature  of  the  medium  (which  decreases  its  density)  has  the  effect  of  increasing  the 
velocity  of  sound  through  the  medium. 

The  velocity  of  sound  in  an  elastic  medium  is  expressed  by  the  formula: 


Even  though  solids  such  as  steel  and  glass  are  far  more  dense  than  air,  their  elasticity's  are  so  much 
greater  that  the  velocities  of  sound  in  them  are  1 5  times  greater  than  the  velocity  of  sound  in  air.  Using 
elasticity  as  a  rough  indication  of  the  speed  of  sound  in  a  given  medium,  we  can  state  as  a  general  rule 
that  sound  travels  faster  in  harder  materials  (such  as  steel),  slower  in  liquids,  and  slowest  in  gases. 
Density  has  the  opposite  effect  on  the  velocity  of  sound,  that  is,  with  other  factors  constant,  a  denser 
material  (such  as  lead)  passes  sound  slower. 

At  a  given  temperature  and  atmospheric  pressure,  all  sound  waves  travel  in  air  at  the  same  speed. 
Thus  the  velocity  that  sound  will  travel  through  air  at  32°  F  (0°  C)  is  1,087  feet  per  second.  But  for 
practical  purposes,  the  speed  of  sound  in  air  may  be  considered  as  1,100  feet  per  second.  Table  1-1  gives 
a  comparison  of  the  velocity  of  sound  in  various  mediums. 


1-22 


Table  1-1. — Comparison  of  Velocity  of  Sound  in  Various  Mediums 


MEDIUM 

TEMPERATURE 

VELOCITY 

op 

°C 

(FT/SEC) 

AIR 

32 

0 

1,087 

AIR 

68 

20 

1,127 

ALUMINUM 

68 

20 

16,700 

CARBON  DIOXIDE 

32 

0 

856 

FRESH  WATER 

32 

0 

4,629 

FRESH  WATER 

68 

20 

4,805 

HYDROGEN 

32 

0 

4,219 

LEAD 

32 

20 

4,030 

SALT  WATER 

32 

0 

4,800 

SALT  WATER 

68 

20 

4,953 

STEEL 

32 

0 

16,410 

STEEL 

68 

20 

16,850 

Q25.  How  does  density  and  temperature  affect  the  velocity  of  sound? 
ACOUSTICS 

The  science  of  sound  is  called  ACOUSTICS.  This  subject  could  fill  volumes  of  technical  books,  but 
we  will  only  scratch  the  surface  in  this  chapter.  We  will  present  important  points  that  you  will  need  for  a 
better  understanding  of  sound  waves. 

Acoustics,  like  sound,  relates  to  the  sense  of  hearing.  It  also  deals  with  the  production,  control, 
transmission,  reception,  and  the  effects  of  sound.  For  the  present,  we  are  concerned  only  with  the  last 
relationship — the  effects  of  sound.  These  same  effects  will  be  used  throughout  your  study  of  wave 
propagation. 

Echo 

An  ECHO  is  the  reflection  of  the  original  sound  wave  as  it  bounces  off  a  distant  surface.  Just  as  a 
rubber  ball  bounces  back  when  it  is  thrown  against  a  hard  surface,  sound  waves  also  bounce  off  most 
surfaces.  As  you  have  learned  from  the  study  of  the  law  of  conservation  of  energy,  a  rubber  ball  never 
bounces  back  with  as  much  energy  as  the  initial  bounce.  Similarly,  a  reflected  sound  wave  is  not  as  loud 
as  the  original  sound  wave.  In  both  cases,  some  of  the  energy  is  absorbed  by  the  reflecting  surface.  Only  a 
portion  of  the  original  sound  is  reflected,  and  only  a  portion  of  the  reflected  sound  returns  to  the  listener. 
For  this  reason,  an  echo  is  never  as  loud  as  the  original  sound. 

Sound  reflections  (echoes)  have  many  applications  in  the  Navy.  The  most  important  of  these 
applications  can  be  found  in  the  use  of  depth  finding  equipment  (the  fathometer)  and  sonar.  The 
fathometer  sends  sound-wave  pulses  from  the  bottom  of  the  ship  and  receives  echoes  from  the  ocean  floor 
to  indicate  the  depth  of  the  ocean  beneath  the  ship.  The  sonar  transmits  a  pulse  of  sound  energy  and 
receives  the  echo  to  indicate  range  and  bearing  of  objects  or  targets  in  the  ocean  depths. 

Refraction 

When  sound  waves  traveling  at  different  velocities  pass  obliquely  (at  an  angle)  from  one  medium 
into  another,  the  waves  are  refracted;  that  is,  their  line  of  travel  is  bent.  Refraction  occurs  gradually  when 
one  part  of  a  sound  wave  is  traveling  faster  than  the  other  parts.  For  example,  the  wind  a  few  feet  above 


1-23 


the  surface  of  the  earth  has  a  greater  velocity  than  that  near  the  surface  because  friction  retards  the  lower 
layers  (see  figure  1-16).  The  velocity  of  the  wind  is  added  to  the  velocity  of  the  sound  through  the  air.  The 
result  is  that  the  upper  portion  of  the  sound  wave  moves  faster  than  the  lower  portion  and  causes  a  gradual 
change  in  the  direction  of  travel  of  the  wave.  Refraction  causes  sound  to  travel  farther  with  the  wind  than 
against  it. 


Figure  1-16. — Refraction  of  sound. 

Reverberation 

In  empty  rooms  or  other  confined  spaces,  sound  may  be  reflected  several  times  to  cause  what  is 
known  as  reverberation.  REVERBERATION  is  the  multiple  reflections  of  sound  waves.  Reverberations 
seem  to  prolong  the  time  during  which  a  sound  is  heard.  Examples  of  this  often  occur  in  nature.  For 
instance,  the  discharge  of  lightning  causes  a  sharp,  quick  sound.  By  the  time  this  sound  has  reached  the 
ears  of  a  distant  observer,  it  is  usually  drawn  out  into  a  prolonged  roar  by  reverberations  that  we  call 
thunder.  A  similar  case  often  arises  with  underwater  sound  equipment.  Reverberations  from  nearby  points 
may  continue  for  such  a  long  time  that  they  interfere  with  the  returning  echoes  from  targets. 

Interference 

Any  disturbance,  man-made  or  natural,  that  causes  an  undesirable  response  or  the  degradation  of  a 
wave  is  referred  to  as  INTERFERENCE. 

Two  sound  waves  moving  simultaneously  through  the  same  medium  will  advance  independently, 
each  producing  a  disturbance  as  if  the  other  were  not  present.  If  the  two  waves  have  the  same 
frequency — in  phase  with  each  other — and  are  moving  in  the  same  direction,  they  are  additive  and  are 
said  to  interfere  constructively.  If  the  two  waves  have  the  same  frequency  and  are  moving  in  the  same 
direction,  but  out  of  phase  with  each  other,  they  are  subtractive  and  are  said  to  interfere  destructively.  If 
these  two  subtractive  waves  have  equal  amplitudes,  the  waves  cancel  each  other.  This  addition  or 
subtraction  of  waves  is  often  called  interference. 

Resonance 

At  some  time  during  your  life  you  probably  observed  someone  putting  his  or  her  head  into  an  empty 
barrel  or  other  cavity  and  making  noises  varying  in  pitch.  When  that  person's  voice  reached  a  certain 
pitch,  the  tone  produced  seemed  much  louder  than  the  others.  The  reason  for  this  phenomenon  is  that  at 
that  a  certain  pitch  the  frequency  of  vibrations  of  the  voice  matched  the  resonant  (or  natural)  frequency  of 
the  cavity.  The  resonant  frequency  of  a  cavity  is  the  frequency  at  which  the  cavity  body  will  begin  to 
vibrate  and  create  sound  waves.  When  the  resonant  frequency  of  the  cavity  was  reached,  the  sound  of  the 
voice  was  reinforced  by  the  sound  waves  created  by  the  cavity,  resulting  in  a  louder  tone. 


1-24 


This  phenomenon  occurs  whenever  the  frequency  of  vibrations  is  the  same  as  the  natural  frequency 
of  a  cavity,  and  is  called  RESONANCE. 


The  most  complex  sound  wave  that  can  be  produced  is  noise.  Noise  has  no  tonal  quality.  It  distracts 
and  distorts  the  sound  quality  that  was  intended  to  be  heard.  NOISE  is  generally  an  unwanted  disturbance 
caused  by  spurious  waves  originating  from  man-made  or  natural  sources,  such  as  a  jet  breaking  the  sound 
barrier,  or  thunder. 

Q26.   What  term  is  used  in  describing  the  science  of  sound? 

Q27.  A  sound  wave  that  is  reflected  back  toward  the  source  is  known  as  what  type  of  sound? 
Q28.   What  is  the  term  for  multiple  reflections  of  sound  waves? 

Q29.  A  cavity  that  vibrates  at  its  natural  frequency  produces  a  louder  sound  than  at  other  frequencies. 
What  term  is  used  to  describe  this  phenomenon? 

Q30.   What  do  we  call  a  disturbance  that  distracts  or  distorts  the  quality  of  sound? 


Technicians  maintain  equipment  that  use  frequencies  from  one  end  of  the  electromagnetic  spectrum 
to  the  other — from  low-frequency  radio  waves  to  high-frequency  X-rays  and  cosmic  rays.  Visible  light  is 
a  small  but  very  important  part  of  this  electromagnetic  spectrum. 

Most  of  the  important  terms  that  pertain  to  the  behavior  of  waves,  such  as  reflection,  refraction, 
diffraction,  etc.,  were  discussed  earlier  in  this  chapter.  We  will  now  discuss  how  these  terms  are  used  in 
understanding  light  and  light  waves.  The  relationship  between  light  and  light  waves  (rays)  is  the  same  as 
sound  and  sound  waves. 

Light  is  a  form  of  energy.  It  can  be  produced  by  various  means  (mechanical,  electrical,  chemical, 
etc.).  We  can  see  objects  because  the  light  rays  they  give  off  or  reflect  reach  our  eyes.  If  the  object  is  the 
source  of  light  energy,  it  is  called  luminous.  If  the  object  is  not  the  source  of  light  but  reflects  light,  it  is 
called  an  illuminated  body. 


PROPAGATION  OF  LIGHT 

The  exact  nature  of  light  is  not  fully  understood,  although  scientists  have  been  studying  the  subject 
for  many  centuries.  Some  experiments  seem  to  show  that  light  is  composed  of  tiny  particles,  and  some 
suggest  that  it  is  made  up  of  waves. 

One  theory  after  another  attracted  the  approval  and  acceptance  of  physicists.  Today,  some  scientific 
phenomena  can  be  explained  only  by  the  wave  theory  and  others  only  by  the  particle  theory.  Physicists, 
constantly  searching  for  some  new  discovery  that  would  bring  these  two  theories  into  agreement, 
gradually  have  come  to  accept  a  theory  that  combines  the  principles  of  the  two  theories. 

According  to  the  view  now  generally  accepted,  light  is  a  form  of  electromagnetic  radiation;  that  is, 
light  and  similar  forms  of  radiation  are  made  up  of  moving  electric  and  magnetic  fields.  These  two  fields 
will  be  explained  thoroughly  later  in  this  chapter. 


Noise 


LIGHT  WAVES 


1-25 


ELECTROMAGNETIC  THEORY  OF  LIGHT 


James  Clark  Maxwell,  a  brilliant  Scottish  scientist  Of  the  middle  19th  century,  showed,  by 
constructing  an  oscillating  electrical  circuit,  that  electromagnetic  waves  could  move  through  empty  space. 
Light  eventually  was  proved  to  be  electromagnetic. 

Current  light  theory  says  that  light  is  made  up  of  very  small  packets  of  electromagnetic  energy  called 
PHOTONS  (the  smallest  unit  of  radiant  energy).  These  photons  move  at  a  constant  speed  in  the  medium 
through  which  they  travel.  Photons  move  at  a  faster  speed  through  a  vacuum  than  they  do  in  the 
atmosphere,  and  at  a  slower  speed  through  water  than  air. 

The  electromagnetic  energy  of  light  is  a  form  of  electromagnetic  radiation.  Light  and  similar  forms 
of  radiation  are  made  up  of  moving  electric  and  magnetic  forces  and  move  as  waves.  Electromagnetic 
waves  move  in  a  manner  similar  to  the  waves  produced  by  the  pebble  dropped  in  the  pool  of  water 
discussed  earlier  in  this  chapter.  The  transverse  waves  of  light  from  a  light  source  spread  out  in  expanding 
circles  much  like  the  waves  in  the  pool.  However,  the  waves  in  the  pool  are  very  slow  and  clumsy  in 
comparison  with  light,  which  travels  approximately  186,000  miles  per  second. 

Light  radiates  from  its  source  in  all  directions  until  absorbed  or  diverted  by  some  substance  (fig. 
1-17).  The  lines  drawn  from  the  light  source  (a  light  bulb  in  this  instance)  to  any  point  on  one  of  these 
waves  indicate  the  direction  in  which  the  waves  are  moving.  These  lines,  called  radii  of  the  spheres,  are 
formed  by  the  waves  and  are  called  LIGHT  RAYS. 


LIGHT  RAYS  WAVEFRONTS 


Figure  1-17. — Waves  and  radii  from  a  nearby  light  source. 

Although  single  rays  of  light  do  not  exist,  light  "rays"  as  used  in  illustrations  are  a  convenient 
method  used  to  show  the  direction  in  which  light  is  traveling  at  any  point. 

A  large  volume  of  light  is  called  a  beam;  a  narrow  beam  is  called  a  pencil;  and  the  smallest  portion 
of  a  pencil  is  called  a  light  ray.  A  ray  of  light,  can  be  illustrated  as  a  straight  line.  This  straight  line  drawn 
from  a  light  source  will  represent  an  infinite  number  of  rays  radiating  in  all  directions  from  the  source. 

Q31.  What  are  three  means  of  producing  light? 

Q32.   What  is  the  smallest  unit  of  radiant  energy? 


1-26 


FREQUENCIES  AND  WAVELENGTHS 


Compared  to  sound  waves,  the  frequency  of  light  waves  is  very  high  and  the  wavelength  is  very 
short.  To  measure  these  wavelengths  more  conveniently,  a  special  unit  of  measure  called  an 
ANGSTROM  UNIT,  or  more  usually,  an  ANGSTROM  (A)  was  devised.  Another  common  unit  used  to 
measure  these  waves  is  the  millimicron  (mil),  which  is  one  millionth  of  a  millimeter.  One  mF  equals  ten 


angstroms.  One  angstrom  equals  1055  m. 

Q33.  What  unit  is  used  to  measure  the  different  wavelengths  of  light? 

FREQUENCIES  AND  COLOR 

For  our  discussion  of  light  wave  waves,  we  will  use  the  millimicron  measurement.  The  wavelength 
of  a  light  determines  the  color  of  the  light.  Figure  1-18  indicates  that  light  with  a  wavelength  of  700 
millimicrons  is  red,  and  that  light  with  a  wavelength  of  500  millimicrons  is  blue-green.  This  illustration 
shows  approximate  wavelengths  of  the  different  colors  in  the  visible  spectrum.  In  actual  fact,  the  color  of 
light  depends  on  its  frequency,  not  its  wavelength.  However,  light  is  measured  in  wavelengths. 


SCREEN  WITH  SLIT 
ADMITTING  RAYS  OF 
SUNLIGHT  (WHITE) 


GROUND  GLASS 
SCREEN 


RED 


□RANGE 


TELLOV 


GREEN 


BLUE  GREEN 
BLUE 


INDIGO 


VIOLET 


ULTRA 
VIOLET 


(INVISIBLE) 


600  mjr 
580 

520m,a- 
500m^- 
4T0m^- 
44-Om^" 
400m>i' 


Figure  1-18. — Use  of  a  prism  to  split  white  light  into  different  colors. 

When  the  wavelength  of  700  millimicrons  is  measured  in  a  medium  such  as  air,  it  produces  the  color 
red,  but  the  same  wave  measured  in  a  different  medium  will  have  a  different  wavelength.  When  red  light 
which  has  been  traveling  in  air  enters  glass,  it  loses  speed.  Its  wavelength  becomes  shorter  or  compressed, 
but  it  continues  to  be  red.  This  illustrates  that  the  color  of  light  depends  on  frequency  and  not  on 
wavelength.  The  color  scale  in  figure  1-18  is  based  on  the  wavelengths  in  air. 

When  a  beam  of  white  light  (sunlight)  is  passed  through  a  PRISM,  as  shown  in  figure  1-18,  it  is 
refracted  and  dispersed  (the  phenomenon  is  known  as  DISPERSION)  into  its  component  wavelengths. 
Each  of  these  wavelengths  causes  a  different  reaction  of  the  eye,  which  sees  the  various  colors  that 
compose  the  visible  spectrum.  The  visible  spectrum  is  recorded  as  a  mixture  of  red,  orange,  yellow, 
green,  blue,  indigo,  and  violet.  White  light  results  when  the  PRIMARIES  (red,  green,  and  blue)  are  mixed 


1-27 


together  in  overlapping  beams  of  light.  (NOTE:  These  are  not  the  primaries  used  in  mixing  pigments, 
such  as  in  paint.)  Furthermore,  the  COMPLEMENTARY  or  SECONDARY  colors  (magenta,  yellow,  and 
cyan)  may  be  shown  with  equal  ease  by  mixing  any  two  of  the  primary  colors  in  overlapping  beams  of 
light.  Thus,  red  and  green  light  mixed  in  equal  intensities  will  make  yellow  light;  green  and  blue  will 
produce  cyan  (blue-green  light);  and  blue  and  red  correctly  mixed  will  produce  magenta  (a  purplish  red 
light). 

LIGHT  AND  COLOR 

All  objects  absorb  some  of  the  light  that  falls  on  them.  An  object  appears  to  be  a  certain  color 
because  it  absorbs  all  of  the  light  waves  except  those  whose  frequency  corresponds  to  that  particular 
color.  Those  waves  are  reflected  from  the  surface,  strike  your  eye,  and  cause  you  to  see  the  particular 
color.  The  color  of  an  object  therefore  depends  on  the  frequency  of  the  electromagnetic  wave  reflected. 

LUMINOUS  BODIES 

Certain  bodies,  such  as  the  sun,  a  gas  flame,  and  an  electric  light  filament,  are  visible  because  they 
are  light  sources.  They  are  called  SELF-LUMINOUS  bodies.  Objects  other  than  self-luminous  bodies 
become  visible  only  when  they  are  in  the  presence  of  light  from  luminous  bodies. 

Most  NONLUMINOUS  bodies  are  visible  because  they  diffuse  or  reflect  the  light  that  falls  on  them. 
A  good  example  of  a  nonluminous  diffusing  body  is  the  moon,  which  shines  only  because  the  sunlight 
falling  onto  its  surface  is  diffused. 

Black  objects  do  not  diffuse  or  reflect  light.  They  are  visible  only  when  outlined  against  a 
background  of  light  from  a  luminous  or  diffusing  body. 

PROPERTIES  OF  LIGHT 

When  light  waves,  which  travel  in  straight  lines,  encounter  any  substance,  they  are  either 
transmitted,  refracted,  reflected,  or  absorbed.  This  is  illustrated  in  figure  1-19.  When  light  strikes  a 
substance,  some  absorption  and  some  reflection  always  take  place.  No  substance  completely  transmits, 
reflects,  or  absorbs  all  of  the  light  rays  that  reach  its  surface.  Substances  that  transmit  almost  all  the  light 
waves  that  fall  upon  them  are  said  to  be  TRANSPARENT.  A  transparent  substance  is  one  through  which 
you  can  see  clearly.  Clear  glass  is  transparent  because  it  transmits  light  rays  without  diffusing  them  (view 
A  of  figure  1-20).  There  is  no  known  perfectly  transparent  substance,  but  many  substances  are  nearly  so. 
Substances  through  which  some  light  rays  can  pass  but  through  which  objects  cannot  be  seen  clearly 
because  the  rays  are  diffused  are  called  TRANSLUCENT  (view  B  of  figure  1-20).  The  frosted  glass  of  a 
light  bulb  and  a  piece  of  oiled  paper  are  examples  of  translucent  materials.  Substances  that  do  not  transmit 
any  light  rays  are  called  OPAQUE  (view  C  of  figure  1-20).  Opaque  substances  can  either  reflect  or  absorb 
all  of  the  light  rays  that  fall  upon  them. 


1-28 


^^XlNCID 


ENT  LIGHT  RAYS 


REFLECTED 

RAYS 

ABSORBED 
RAYS 

TRANSMITTED 
RAYS 


Figure  1-19. — Light  waves  reflected,  absorbed,  and  transmitted. 


INCIDENT  TRANSMITTED 
LIGHT  LIGHT 


A.  TRANSPARENT 


INCIDENT  TRANSMITTED 
LIGHT  LIGHT 


B.  TRANSLUCENT 


INCIDENT 
LIGHT 


LIGHT 
ABSORBED 


C.  OPAQUE 


Figure  1-20. — Transparent,  translucent,  and  opaque  substances. 

Q34.   What  are  the  three  primary  colors  of  light? 
Q35.  What  are  the  three  secondary  colors  of  light? 


1-29 


Q36.  White  light  falls  upon  a  dull,  rough,  dark-brown  object.  Will  the  light  primarily  be  reflected, 
diffused,  or  absorbed  by  the  object? 

Q37.  What  color  will  be  emitted  by  a  dull,  rough,  black  object  when  white  light  falls  upon  it? 

Q38.  A  substance  that  transmits  light  but  through  which  an  object  cannot  be  seen  clearly  is  known  as 
what  kind  of  substance? 

Speed  of  Light 

You  probably  have  heard  people  say,  "quick  as  lightning"  or  "fast  as  light"  to  describe  rapid  motion; 
nevertheless,  it  is  difficult  to  realize  how  fast  light  actually  travels.  Not  until  recent  years  have  scientists 
been  able  to  measure  accurately  the  speed  of  light. 

Prior  to  the  middle  17th  century,  scientists  thought  that  light  required  no  time  at  all  to  pass  from  the 
source  to  the  observer.  Then  in  1675,  Ole  Roemer,  a  Danish  astronomer,  discovered  that  light  travels 
approximately  186,000  miles  per  second  in  space.  At  this  velocity,  a  light  beam  can  circle  the  earth  7  1/2 
times  in  one  second. 

The  speed  of  light  depends  on  the  medium  through  which  the  light  travels.  In  empty  space,  the  speed 
is  186,000  (1.86  x  105)  miles  per  second.  It  is  almost  the  same  in  air.  In  water,  it  slows  down  to 
approximately  140,000  (1.4  x  105)  miles  per  second.  In  glass,  the  speed  of  light  is  124,000  (1.24  x  10 5) 
miles  per  second.  In  other  words,  the  speed  of  light  decreases  as  the  density  of  the  substance  through 
which  the  light  passes  increases. 

The  velocity  of  light,  which  is  the  same  as  the  velocity  of  other  electromagnetic  waves,  is  considered 
to  be  constant,  at  186,000  miles  per  second.  If  expressed  in  meters,  it  is  300,000,000  meters  per  second. 

Reflection  of  Light 

Light  waves  obey  the  law  of  reflection  in  the  same  manner  as  other  types  of  waves.  Consider  the 
straight  path  of  a  light  ray  admitted  through  a  narrow  slit  into  a  darkened  room.  The  straight  path  of  the 
beam  is  made  visible  by  illuminated  dust  particles  suspended  in  the  air.  If  the  light  beam  is  made  to  fall 
onto  the  surface  of  a  mirror  or  other  reflecting  surface,  however,  the  direction  of  the  beam  changes 
sharply.  The  light  can  be  reflected  in  almost  any  direction  depending  on  the  angle  at  which  the  mirror  is 
held. 

As  shown  earlier  in  figure  1-9,  if  a  light  beam  strikes  a  mirror,  the  angle  at  which  the  beam  is 
reflected  depends  on  the  angle  at  which  it  strikes  the  mirror.  The  beam  approaching  the  mirror  is  the 
INCIDENT  or  striking  beam,  and  the  beam  leaving  the  mirror  is  the  REFLECTED  beam. 

The  term  "reflected  light"  simply  refers  to  light  waves  that  are  neither  transmitted  nor  absorbed,  but 
are  thrown  back  from  the  surface  of  the  medium  they  encounter. 

You  will  see  this  application  used  in  our  discussion  of  radio  waves  (chapter  2)  and  antennas  (chapter 

4). 

Q39.  At  what  speed  does  light  travel? 
Refraction  of  Light 

The  change  of  direction  that  occurs  when  a  ray  of  light  passes  from  one  transparent  substance  into 
another  of  different  density  is  called  refraction.  Refraction  is  due  to  the  fact  that  light  travels  at  various 


1-30 


speeds  in  different  transparent  substances.  For  example,  water  never  appears  as  deep  as  it  really  is,  and 
objects  under  water  appear  to  be  closer  to  the  surface  than  they  really  are.  A  bending  of  the  light  rays 
causes  these  impressions. 

Another  example  of  refraction  is  the  apparent  bending  of  a  spoon  when  it  is  immersed  in  a  cup  of 
water.  The  bending  seems  to  take  place  at  the  surface  of  the  water,  or  exactly  at  the  point  where  there  is  a 
change  of  density.  Obviously,  the  spoon  does  not  bend  from  the  pressure  of  the  water.  The  light  forming 
the  image  of  the  spoon  is  bent  as  it  passes  from  the  water  (a  medium  of  high  density)  to  the  air  (a  medium 
of  comparatively  low  density). 

Without  refraction,  light  waves  would  pass  in  straight  lines  through  transparent  substances  without 
any  change  of  direction.  Refer  back  to  figure  1-10,  which  shows  refraction  of  a  wave.  As  you  can  see,  all 
rays  striking  the  glass  at  any  angle  other  than  perpendicular  are  refracted.  However,  the  perpendicular  ray, 
which  enters  the  glass  normal  to  the  surface,  continues  through  the  glass  and  into  the  air  in  a  straight  line 
no  refraction  takes  place. 

Diffusion  of  Light 

When  light  is  reflected  from  a  mirror,  the  angle  of  reflection  of  each  ray  equals  the  angle  of 
incidence.  When  light  is  reflected  from  a  piece  of  plain  white  paper,  however,  the  reflected  beam  is 
scattered,  or  DIFFUSED,  as  shown  in  figure  1-21.  Because  the  surface  of  the  paper  is  not  smooth,  the 
reflected  light  is  broken  up  into  many  light  beams  that  are  reflected  in  all  directions. 


Absorption  of  Light 

You  have  just  seen  that  a  light  beam  is  reflected  and  diffused  when  it  falls  onto  a  piece  of  white 
paper.  If  a  light  beam  falls  onto  a  piece  of  black  paper,  the  black  paper  absorbs  most  of  the  light  rays  and 
very  little  light  is  reflected  from  the  paper.  If  the  surface  on  which  the  light  beam  falls  is  perfectly  black, 
there  is  no  reflection;  that  is,  the  light  is  totally  absorbed.  No  matter  what  kind  of  surface  light  falls  on, 
however,  some  of  the  light  is  absorbed. 

Q40.  A  light  wave  enters  a  sheet  of  glass  at  a  perfect  right  angle  to  the  surface.  Is  the  majority  of  the 
wave  reflected,  refracted,  transmitted,  or  absorbed? 

Q41.   When  light  strikes  a  piece  of  white  paper,  the  light  is  reflected  in  all  directions.  What  do  we  call 
this  scattering  of  light? 


Figure  1-21. — Diffusion  of  light. 


1-31 


COMPARISON  OF  LIGHT  WAVES  WITH  SOUND  WAVES 


There  are  two  main  differences  between  sound  waves  and  light  waves.  The  first  difference  is  in 
velocity.  Sound  waves  travel  through  air  at  the  speed  of  approximately  1,100  feet  per  second;  light  waves 
travel  through  air  and  empty  space  at  a  speed  of  approximately  186,000  miles  per  second.  The  second 
difference  is  that  sound  is  composed  of  longitudinal  waves  (alternate  compressions  and  expansions  of 
matter)  and  light  is  composed  of  transverse  waves  in  an  electromagnetic  field. 

Although  both  are  forms  of  wave  motion,  sound  requires  a  solid,  liquid,  or  gaseous  medium;  whereas 
light  travels  through  empty  space.  The  denser  the  medium,  the  greater  the  speed  of  sound.  The  opposite  is 
true  of  light.  Light  travels  approximately  one -third  slower  in  water  than  in  air.  Sound  travels  through  all 
substances,  but  light  cannot  pass  through  opaque  materials. 

Frequency  affects  both  sound  and  light.  A  certain  range  of  sound  frequencies  produces  sensations 
that  you  can  hear.  A  slow  vibration  (low  frequency)  in  sound  gives  the  sensation  of  a  low  note.  A  more 
rapid  sound  vibration  (higher  frequency)  produces  a  higher  note.  Likewise,  a  certain  range  of  light 
frequencies  produces  sensations  that  you  can  see.  Violet  light  is  produced  at  the  high-frequency  end  of  the 
light  spectrum,  while  red  light  is  produced  at  the  low-frequency  end  of  the  light  spectrum.  A  change  in 
frequency  of  sound  waves  causes  an  audible  sensation — a  difference  in  pitch.  A  change  in  the  frequency 
of  a  light  wave  causes  a  visual  sensation — a  difference  in  color. 

For  a  comparison  of  light  waves  with  sound  waves,  see  table  1-2. 


Table  1-2. — Comparison  of  Light  Waves  and  Sound  Waves 


SOUND  WAVES 

LIGHT  WAVES 

VELOCITY  IN  AIR 
FORM 

WAVE  COMPOSITION 
TRANSMITTING  MEDIUM 

RELATION  OF 
TRANSMITTING  MEDIUM 
VELOCITY  TO  VELOCITY 
SENSATIONS  PRODUCED 
VARIATIONS  IN 
SENSATIONS  PRODUCED 

APPROXIMATELY  1,100  FEET 
PER  SECOND 

A  FORM  OF  WAVE  MOTION 

LONGITUDINAL 

ALL  SUBSTANCES 

THE  DENSER  THE  MEDIUM, 
THE  GREATER  THE  SPEED 

HEARING 

A  LOW  FREQUENCY  CAUSES 
A  LOW  NOTE;  A  HIGH 
FREQUENCY,  A  HIGH  NOTE 

APPROXIMATELY  186,000 

MILES  PER  SECOND 

A  FORM  OF  WAVE  MOTION 

TRANSVERSE 

EMPTY  SPACE  AND  ALL 

SUBSTANCES  EXCEPT 

OPAQUE  MATERIALS 

THE  DENSER  THE  MEDIUM, 

THE  SLOWER  THE  SPEED 

SEEING 

A  LOW  FREQUENCY  CAUSES 
RED  LIGHT;  A  HIGH 
FREQUENCY,  VIOLET  LIGHT 

Q42.   What  three  examples  of  electromagnetic  energy  are  mentioned  in  the  text? 

Q43.   What  is  the  main  difference  between  the  bulk  of  the  electromagnetic  spectrum  and  the  visual 
spectrum? 


1-32 


ELECTROMAGNETIC  SPECTRUM 


Light  is  one  kind  of  electromagnetic  energy.  There  are  many  other  types,  including  heat  energy  and 
radio  energy.  The  only  difference  between  the  various  types  of  electromagnetic  energy  is  the  frequency  of 
their  waves  (rate  of  vibration).  The  term  SPECTRUM  is  used  to  designate  the  entire  range  of 
electromagnetic  waves  arranged  in  order  of  their  frequencies.  The  VISIBLE  SPECTRUM  contains  only 
those  waves  which  stimulate  the  sense  of  sight.  You,  as  a  technician,  might  be  expected  to  maintain 
equipment  that  uses  electromagnetic  waves  within,  above,  and  below  the  visible  spectrum. 

There  are  neither  sharp  dividing  lines  nor  gaps  in  the  ELECTROMAGNETIC  SPECTRUM.  Figure 
1-22  illustrates  how  portions  of  the  electromagnetic  spectrum  overlap.  Notice  that  only  a  small  portion  of 
the  electromagnetic  spectrum  contains  visible  waves,  or  light,  which  can  be  seen  by  the  human  eye. 


XRAY  - 

ULTRAVIOLET  _ 

LIGHT 
VISIBLE  LIGHT 


INFRA-RED- 


MICRO- . 
WAVES 


RADAR  - 


COMMUN- 
ICATIONS 


COSMIC 
GAMMA 
ETC. 


EHF 


SHF 


UHF 


VHF 


HF 


MF 


LF 


VLF 


TERA(T)+1012 
GIGA(G)  109 
EGA  (M)  10  6 

3X1017(300,000THz) 
3XlC6(30,0O0THz) 

3X1(Jl5(3,000THz) 
3X1014(3Q0THz) 


3X1013(30THz) 


3X1012(3THz) 


3  X10M  (300GHz) 
3X1Q10(30GHz) 
3X1Q9  (3GHz) 
3X1Q8  (300  MHz) 

3X107  (30MHz) 

3X106  (3MHz) 

3X105  (30OHz) 
3X10  4  (30Hz) 
3X103  (3Hz) 

Figure  1-22. — Electromagnetic  spectrum. 


ELECTROMAGNETIC  WAVES 


In  general,  the  same  principles  and  properties  of  light  waves  apply  to  the  communications 
electromagnetic  waves  you  are  about  to  study.  The  electromagnetic  field  is  used  to  transfer  energy  (as 
communications)  from  point  to  point.  We  will  introduce  the  basic  ANTENNA  as  the  propagation  source 
of  these  electromagnetic  waves. 


1-33 


THE  BASIC  ANTENNA 


The  study  of  antennas  and  electromagnetic  wave  propagation  is  essential  to  a  complete 
understanding  of  radio  communication,  radar,  loran,  and  other  electronic  systems.  Figure  1-23  shows  a 
simple  radio  communication  system.  In  the  illustration,  the  transmitter  is  an  electronic  device  that 
generates  radio-frequency  energy.  The  energy  travels  through  a  transmission  line  (we  will  discuss  this  in 
chapter  3)  to  an  antenna.  The  antenna  converts  the  energy  into  radio  waves  that  radiate  into  space  from 
the  antenna  at  the  speed  of  light.  The  radio  waves  travel  through  the  atmosphere  or  space  until  they  are 
either  reflected  by  an  object  or  absorbed.  If  another  antenna  is  placed  in  the  path  of  the  radio  waves,  it 
absorbs  part  of  the  waves  and  converts  them  to  energy.  This  energy  travels  through  another  transmission 
line  and  is  fed  to  a  receiver.  From  this  example,  you  can  see  that  the  requirements  for  a  simple 
communications  system  are  (1)  transmitting  equipment,  (2)  transmission  line,  (3)  transmitting  antenna, 
(4)  medium,  (5)  receiving  antenna,  and  (6)  receiving  equipment. 


Figure  1-23. — Simple  radio  communication  system. 

An  antenna  is  a  conductor  or  a  set  of  conductors  used  either  to  radiate  electromagnetic  energy  into 
space  or  to  collect  this  energy  from  space.  Figure  1-24  shows  an  antenna.  View  A  is  a  drawing  of  an 
actual  antenna;  view  B  is  a  cut-away  view  of  the  antenna;  and  view  C  is  a  simplified  diagram  of  the 
antenna. 


1-34 


C.  SIMPLIFIED  DIAGRAM 

Figure  1-24. — Antenna. 

COMPONENTS  OF  THE  ELECTROMAGNETIC  WAVE 

An  electromagnetic  wave  consists  of  two  primary  components — an  ELECTRIC  FIELD  and  a 
MAGNETIC  FIELD.  The  electric  field  results  from  the  force  of  voltage,  and  the  magnetic  field  results 
from  the  flow  of  current. 


Although  electromagnetic  fields  that  are  radiated  are  commonly  considered  to  be  waves,  under 
certain  circumstances  their  behavior  makes  them  appear  to  have  some  of  the  properties  of  particles.  In 
general,  however,  it  is  easier  to  picture  electromagnetic  radiation  in  space  as  horizontal  and  vertical  lines 
of  force  oriented  at  right  angles  to  each  other.  These  lines  of  force  are  made  up  of  an  electric  field  (E)  and 
a  magnetic  field  (H),  which  together  make  up  the  electromagnetic  field  in  space. 

The  electric  and  magnetic  fields  radiated  from  an  antenna  form  the  electromagnetic  field.  This  field 
is  responsible  for  the  transmission  and  reception  of  electromagnetic  energy  through  free  space.  An 
antenna,  however,  is  also  part  of  the  electrical  circuit  of  a  transmitter  or  a  receiver  and  is  equivalent  to  a 
circuit  containing  inductance,  capacitance,  and  resistance.  Therefore,  the  antenna  can  be  expected  to 
display  definite  voltage  and  current  relationships  with  respect  to  a  given  input.  A  current  through  the 
antenna  produces  a  magnetic  field,  and  a  charge  on  the  antenna  produces  an  electric  field.  These  two 
fields  combine  to  form  the  INDUCTION  field.  To  help  you  gain  a  better  understanding  of  antenna  theory, 
we  must  review  some  basic  electrical  concepts.  We  will  review  voltage  and  its  electric  field,  current  and 
its  magnetic  field,  and  their  relationship  to  propagation  of  electrical  energy. 

Q44.   What  are  the  two  components  (fields)  that  make  up  the  electromagnetic  wave? 


1-35 


Q45.   What  do  we  call  a  conductor  (or  set  of  conductors)  that  radiates  electromagnetic  energy  into 
space  ? 

Electric  Field 

Around  every  electrically  charged  object  is  a  force  field  that  can  be  detected  and  measured.  This 
force  field  can  cause  electric  charges  to  move  in  the  field.  When  an  object  is  charged  electrically,  there  is 
either  a  greater  or  a  smaller  concentration  of  electrons  than  normal.  Thus,  a  difference  of  potential  exists 
between  a  charged  object  and  an  uncharged  object.  An  electric  field  is,  therefore,  associated  with  a 
difference  of  potential,  or  a  voltage. 

This  invisible  field  of  force  is  commonly  represented  by  lines  that  are  drawn  to  show  the  paths  along 
which  the  force  acts.  The  lines  representing  the  electric  field  are  drawn  in  the  direction  that  a  single 
positive  charge  would  normally  move  under  the  influence  of  that  field.  A  large  electric  force  is  shown  by 
a  large  concentration  of  lines;  a  weak  force  is  indicated  by  a  few  lines. 

When  a  capacitor  is  connected  across  a  source  of  voltage,  such  as  a  battery,  it  is  charged  by  a 
particular  amount,  depending  on  the  voltage  and  the  value  of  capacitance.  (See  figure  1-25.)  Because  of 
the  emf  (electromotive  force)  of  the  battery,  negative  charges  flow  to  the  lower  plate,  leaving  the  upper 
plate  positively  charged.  Along  with  the  growth  of  charge,  the  electric  field  is  also  building  up.  The  flux 
lines  are  directed  from  the  positive  to  the  negative  charges  and  at  right  angles  to  the  plates.  When  the 
capacitor  is  fully  charged,  the  voltage  of  the  capacitor  is  equal  to  the  voltage  of  the  source  and  opposite  in 
polarity.  The  charged  capacitor  stores  the  energy  in  the  form  of  an  electric  field.  It  can  be  said,  therefore, 
that  an  electric  field  indicates  voltage. 


Figure  1-25. — Electric  fields  between  plates. 

If  the  two  plates  of  the  capacitor  are  spread  farther  apart,  the  electric  field  must  curve  to  meet  the 
plates  at  right  angles  (fig.  1-26).  The  straight  lines  in  view  A  of  figure  1-26  become  arcs  in  view  B,  and 
approximately  semicircles  in  view  C,  where  the  plates  are  in  a  straight  line.  Instead  of  flat  metal  plates,  as 
in  the  capacitor,  the  two  elements  can  take  the  form  of  metal  rods  or  wires  and  form  the  basic  antenna. 


1-36 


+ 


Figure  1-26. — Electric  fields  between  plates  at  different  angles. 

In  figure  1-27,  two  rods  replace  the  plates  of  the  capacitor,  and  the  battery  is  replaced  by  an  ac 
source  generating  a  60-hertz  signal.  On  the  positive  alternation  of  the  60-hertz  generator,  the  electric  field 
extends  from  the  positively  charged  rod  to  the  negatively  charged  rod,  as  shown.  On  the  negative 
alternation,  the  charge  is  reversed.  The  previous  explanation  of  electrons  moving  from  one  plate  to  the 
other  of  the  capacitor  in  figure  1-25  can  also  be  applied  to  the  rods  in  figure  1-27. 


Figure  1-27. — Electric  fields  between  elements. 


1-37 


The  polarity  of  charges  and  the  direction  of  the  electric  fields  will  reverse  polarity  and  direction 
periodically  at  the  frequency  of  the  voltage  source.  The  electric  field  will  build  up  from  zero  to  maximum 
in  one  direction  and  then  collapse  back  to  zero.  Next,  the  field  will  build  up  to  maximum  in  the  opposite 
direction  and  then  collapse  back  to  zero.  This  complete  reversal  occurs  during  a  single  cycle  of  the  source 
voltage.  The  HALF-WAVE  DIPOLE  ANTENNA  (two  separate  rods  in  line  as  illustrated  in  figure  1-27) 
is  the  fundamental  element  normally  used  as  a  starting  point  of  reference  in  any  discussion  concerning  the 
radiation  of  electromagnetic  energy  into  space.  If  rf  energy  from  the  ac  generator  (or  transmitter)  is 
supplied  to  the  element  of  an  antenna,  the  voltage  across  the  antenna  lags  the  current  by  90  degrees.  The 
antenna  acts  as  if  it  were  a  capacitor. 

Magnetic  Field 

When  current  flows  through  a  conductor,  a  magnetic  field  is  set  up  in  the  area  surrounding  the 
conductor.  In  fact,  any  moving  electrical  charge  will  create  a  magnetic  field.  The  magnetic  field  is  a 
region  in  space  where  a  magnetic  force  can  be  detected  and  measured.  There  are  two  other  fields 
involved — an  INDUCTION  FIELD,  which  exists  close  to  the  conductor  carrying  the  current,  and  the 
RADIATION  FIELD,  which  becomes  detached  from  the  current-carrying  rod  and  travels  through  space. 

To  represent  the  magnetic  field,  lines  of  force  are  again  used  to  illustrate  the  energy.  Magnetic  lines 
are  not  drawn  between  the  rods,  nor  between  high-  and  low-potential  points,  as  the  E  lines  that  were 
discussed  earlier.  Magnetic  lines  are  created  by  the  flow  of  current  rather  than  the  force  of  voltage.  The 
magnetic  lines  of  force,  therefore,  are  drawn  at  right  angles  to  the  direction  of  current  flow. 

The  magnetic  fields  that  are  set  up  around  two  parallel  rods,  as  shown  in  figure  1-28  view  A,  are  in 
maximum  opposition.  Rod  1  contains  a  current  flowing  from  the  generator,  while  rod  2  contains  a  current 
flowing  toward  the  generator.  As  a  result,  the  direction  of  the  magnetic  field  surrounding  rod  1  is  opposite 
the  direction  of  the  magnetic  field  surrounding  rod  2.  This  will  cause  cancellation  of  part  or  all  of  both 
magnetic  fields  with  a  resultant  decrease  in  radiation  of  the  electromagnetic  energy.  View  B  illustrates  the 
fact  that  if  the  far  ends  of  rods  1  and  2  are  separated  from  each  other  while  the  rods  are  still  connected  to 
the  generator  at  the  near  ends,  more  space,  and  consequently  less  opposition,  will  occur  between  the 
magnetic  fields  of  the  two  rods.  View  C  illustrates  the  fact  that  placing  the  rods  in  line  makes  the  currents 
through  both  rods  flow  in  the  same  direction.  Therefore,  the  two  magnetic  fields  are  in  the  same  direction; 
thus,  maximum  electromagnetic  radiation  into  space  can  be  obtained. 


1-38 


Figure  1-28. — Magnetic  fields  around  elements. 

Magnetic  lines  of  force  are  indicated  by  the  letter  H  and  are  called  H  lines.  The  direction  of  the 
magnetic  lines  may  be  determined  by  use  of  the  left-hand  rule  for  a  conductor:  If  you  grasp  the  conductor 
in  your  left  hand  with  the  thumb  extended  in  the  direction  of  the  current  flow,  your  fingers  will  point  in 
the  direction  of  the  magnetic  lines  of  force.  In  view  C  of  figure  1-28,  the  direction  of  current  flow  is 
upward  along  both  halves  of  the  elements  (conductors).  The  lines  of  magnetic  force  (flux)  form 
concentric  loops  that  are  perpendicular  to  the  direction  of  current  flow.  The  arrowheads  on  the  loops 
indicate  the  direction  of  the  field.  The  left-hand  rule  is  used  to  determine  the  direction  of  the  magnetic 
field  and  is  illustrated  in  figure  1-29.  If  the  thumb  of  the  left  hand  is  extended  in  the  direction  of  current 
flow  and  the  fingers  clenched,  then  the  rough  circles  formed  by  the  fingers  indicate  the  direction  of  the 
magnetic  field. 


DIRECTION  OF 
CURRENT  FLOW 


Figure  1-29. — Left-hand  rule  for  conducting  elements. 


1-39 


Q46.  What  do  we  call  the  field  that  is  created  between  two  rods  when  a  voltage  is  applied  to  them? 

Q47.   When  current  flows  through  a  conductor,  afield  is  created  around  the  conductor.  What  do  we 
call  this  field? 

Combined  Electric  and  Magnetic  Fields 

The  generator,  shown  in  figure  1-30,  provides  the  voltage,  which  creates  an  electric  field,  and 
current,  which  creates  a  magnetic  field.  This  source  voltage  and  current  build  up  to  maximum  values  in 
one  direction  during  one  half-cycle,  and  then  build  up  to  maximum  values  in  the  other  direction  during 
the  next  half-cycle.  Both  the  electric  and  magnetic  fields  alternate  from  minimum  through  maximum 
values  in  synchronization  with  the  changing  voltage  and  current.  The  electric  and  magnetic  fields  reach 
their  maximum  intensity  a  quarter-cycle  apart.  These  fields  form  the  induction  field.  Since  the  current  and 
voltage  that  produce  these  E  and  H  fields  are  90  degrees  out  of  phase,  the  fields  will  also  be  90  degrees 
out  of  phase. 


Figure  1-30. — Relationship  of  E-lines,  and  current  flow. 

Q48.  An  induction  field  is  created  around  a  conductor  when  current  flows  through  it.  What  do  we  call 
the  field  that  detaches  itself  from  the  conductor  and  travels  through  space? 


1-40 


SUMMARY 


Now  that  you  have  completed  this  chapter,  let's  review  some  of  the  new  terms,  concepts,  and  ideas 
you  have  learned.  You  should  have  a  thorough  understanding  of  these  principles  before  moving  on  to 
chapter  2. 

WAVE  PROPAGATION  is  an  invisible  force  that  enables  man  to  communicate  over  long 
distances.  Wave  transmission  can  take  many  forms,  such  as  LIGHT,  SOUND,  and  RADIO. 

LIGHT  is  a  form  of  wave  motion  that  can  be  seen.  Heat  cannot  normally  be  seen,  but  can  be  felt. 
Radio  waves  cannot  be  seen  or  felt. 

WAVE  MOTION  can  be  seen  in  action  by  throwing  a  pebble  into  a  pool  of  still  water.  The  ripples 
that  move  toward  the  edge  of  the  pool  demonstrate  the  PROPAGATION  theory. 


The  TRANSVERSE  WAVE  is  a  type  of  wave  motion.  Radio,  light,  and  heat  waves  are  examples  of 
transverse  waves. 


1-41 


The  LONGITUDINAL  WAVE  is  another  type  of  wave  motion.  The  sound  wave  is  the  only 
example  of  a  longitudinal  wave  given  in  this  text. 


SOURCE,  MEDIUM,  AND  DETECTOR  (RECEIVER)  are  the  three  requirements  for  all  wave 
motion. 


A  SOURCE  can  be  anything  that  emits  or  expends  energy  (waves). 

The  MEDIUM  is  the  vehicle  for  carrying  waves  from  one  point  to  another.  Water,  air,  metal,  empty 
space,  etc.,  are  examples  of  a  medium.  Empty  space  is  considered  a  medium  for  electro-magnetic  waves 
but  not  a  medium  for  sound  waves. 

The  SOUND  DETECTOR  absorbs  the  waves  emitted  by  the  source.  The  human  ear  is  an  example 
of  a  detector. 

HERTZ,  which  is  abbreviated  Hz,  is  used  in  lieu  of  "cycle  per  second"  when  referring  to  radio 
frequencies. 

VELOCITY  OF  PROPAGATION  is  the  speed  (or  rate)  at  which  the  crest  of  a  wave  moves 
through  a  medium.  Velocity  can  be  calculated  by  using  the  formula: 

V  =  Xf 

Where  v  is  velocity  of  propagation  and  is  expressed  in  feet  (meters)  per  second,  A,  is  the  wavelength 
in  feet  (meters),  and  f  is  the  frequency  in  hertz. 

REFLECTION  occurs  when  a  wave  strikes  an  object  and  bounces  back  (toward  the  source).  The 
wave  that  moves  from  the  source  to  the  object  is  called  the  INCIDENT  WAVE,  and  the  wave  that  moves 
away  from  the  object  is  called  the  REFLECTED  WAVE. 


1-42 


PERPENDICULAR 


The  LAW  OF  REFLECTION  states: 

The  angle  of  incidence  is  equal  to  the  angle  of  reflection. 

REFRACTION  occurs  when  a  wave  traveling  through  two  different  mediums  passes  through  the 
BOUNDARY  of  the  mediums  and  bends  toward  or  away  from  the  NORMAL. 


INCIDENT  NORMAL 


NORMAL 


DIFFRACTION  can  account  for  the  ability  of  the  AM  radio  waves  (due  to  their  low  frequency)  to 
travel  over  a  mountain,  while  FM  and  TV  signals  (due  to  their  higher  frequencies)  are  blocked. 


1-43 


The  DOPPLER  EFFECT  is  the  apparent  change  in  frequency  of  a  source  as  it  moves  toward  or 
away  from  a  detector.  It  can  affect  the  operation  of  equipment  used  to  detect  and  measure  wave  energy. 

SOUND  can  be  audible  to  the  human  ear  or  it  can  be  outside  the  hearing  range. 

NOISE  AND  TONES  are  the  two  general  groups  that  broadly  classify  ALL  sounds. 

wvw 

A    MUSICAL  NOTE 


B  NOISE 

PITCH,  INTENSITY,  AND  QUALITY  are  the  three  basic  characteristics  of  sound.  Pitch  describes 
the  frequency  of  sound.  Intensity  describes  how  much  energy  is  transmitted.  Quality  enables  us  to 
distinguish  one  sound  from  another. 

The  DENSITY  of  a  MEDIUM,  TEMPERATURE,  and  ATMOSPHERIC  PRESSURE  affect  the 
velocity  of  sound.  If  temperature,  density,  or  pressure  increases,  the  velocity  of  sound  increases  and  vice 
versa. 

ACOUSTICS  is  the  science  of  sound  and  relates  to  the  sense  of  hearing. 

ECHO  is  an  example  of  reflection.  Sound  echoes  are  used  in  sonar  and  depth  finders  to  determine  or 
measure  the  range  of  an  object  or  the  depth  of  the  ocean  bottom. 

REVERBERATION  is  the  multiple  reflections  of  sound  waves.  The  prolonged  roar  of  thunder  is 
caused  by  reverberations.  With  underwater  sound  equipment,  reverberations  of  nearby  objects  may 
interfere  with  returning  echoes  from  actual  targets. 

INTERFERENCE  occurs  when  two  waves  move  simultaneously  through  a  medium.  They  can 
interfere  constructively,  destructively,  or  produce  a  resultant  of  zero. 

RESONANCE  occurs  when  an  objects  vibrates  (or  resonates)  at  its  natural  frequency.  When 
different  frequencies  are  produced  inside  a  cavity,  the  sound  from  the  cavity  sounds  louder  at  its  resonant 
frequency  than  at  all  other  frequencies. 

NOISE  is  any  disturbance  that  distracts  from  or  distorts  the  quality  of  sound. 

A  PHOTON  is  the  smallest  unit  of  radiant  energy  that  makes  up  light  waves  and  radio  waves. 

ANGSTROM  (A)  units  are  used  for  measuring  the  wavelength  of  light.  One  angstrom  =  1055  10  m. 


1-44 


The  VISIBLE  SPECTRUM  contains  all  the  colors  between  infrared  and  ultraviolet.  INFRA-RED 
and  ULTRA-VIOLET  are  invisible  to  the  human  eye. 

The  PRIMARY  COLORS  of  light  are  red,  green,  and  blue.  These  primaries  can  be  mixed  to  make 
any  color  between  red  and  violet.  If  the  three  colors  are  mixed  equally,  they  produce  white  light. 


The  COMPLEMENTARY  COLORS  of  light  are  magenta,  yellow,  and  cyan.  They  are  produced 
by  mixing  any  two  of  the  primary  colors  together  in  overlapping  beams. 

The  SPEED  OF  LIGHT  in  empty  space  is  considered  to  be  186,000  miles  per  second  (or 
300,000,000  meters  per  second).  This  speed  varies  in  different  mediums,  but  the  constant  of  186,000 
miles  per  second  is  always  used  as  the  speed  of  light. 

The  ELECTROMAGNETIC  SPECTRUM  is  the  complete  range  of  electromagnetic  frequencies 
from  3  kHz  to  beyond  300,000  THz.  Audio  frequencies  (15  Hz-20  kHz)  are  not  electromagnetic  energy 
and  are  not  included  in  the  electromagnetic  spectrum. 


1-45 


TERA|T1=1012 
COSMIC^.  GIGAfGHO3 
GAMA  MEGA(M)10& 


ETC. 


XRAY- 


ULTRAVIOLET. 
LIGHT 


VISIBLE  LIGHT 


INFRA-RED 


MICRO- 
WAVES 


RADAR 


COMMUNI- 
CATIONS 


EHF 


SHF 


UHF 


VHF 


HF 


MF 


LF 


3X101T  (300,000TH=) 

3X1016(30,000TH=) 
3X1015  (3,000TH=) 
3X1(H*(3CiOTH=) 

3X1013  (30TH=) 
3X101S(3TH=) 

3X1Q11  (300GH=) 
3X1010  (30GH=) 
3X10^  (3GH=) 

3X1Ci3(300MH=) 

3X10T(30MH=) 
3X10&f3MH=) 

3X105  (300  H=J 
3X10*  (30H=) 
3X103(3H=) 


The  ELECTROMAGNETIC  FIELD  consists  of  an  ELECTRIC  FIELD  and  a  MAGNETIC 

FIELD.  These  fields  are  responsible  for  the  transmission  and  reception  of  electromagnetic  energy 
through  free  space. 


ANSWERS  TO  QUESTIONS  Ql.  THROUGH  Q48. 

Al.  Propagation  means  spreading  out. 

A2.  A  wave  is  a  disturbance  which  moves  through  a  medium. 

A3.  A  means  of  transferring  energy  from  one  place  to  another. 

A4.  Sound  waves,  light  waves,  radio  waves,  heat  waves,  water  waves. 

A5.  Transverse  waves. 

A6.  Radio  waves,  light  waves,  and  heat  waves. 


1-46 


A  7.  A  sound  wave. 

A8.  A  source,  medium,  and  detector  ( receiver). 

A9.  A  sequence  of  events,  such  as  the  positive  and  negative  alternation  of  electrical  current. 

A10.  The  space  occupied  by  one  cycle  of  a  radio  wave  at  any  given  instant. 

All.  The  law  of  reflection  states:  The  angle  of  incidence  is  equal  to  the  angle  of  reflection. 

A12.  When  the  incident  wave  is  nearly  parallel  with  the  surface. 

A13.  When  the  incident  wave  is  perpendicular  to  the  surface.  Also  a  dull  (or  black)  surface  reflects  very 
little  regardless  of  the  angle. 

A14.  The  density  of  the  two  mediums,  and  the  velocity  of  the  waves. 

A15.  The  Doppler  effect. 

A16.  Sonics. 

Al  7.  No.  The  average  human  ear  cannot  hear  all  sounds  in  the  infrasonic  and  ultrasonic  regions. 

A18.  An  amplifier. 

A19.  A  source,  medium,  and  detector  (receiver). 

A20.  Noise  and  tones. 

A21.  Pitch,  intensity,  and  quality. 

A22.  20  Hz  to  20  kHz. 

A23.  The  amount  of  energy  transmitted  from  a  source. 

A24.  Quality. 

A25.  Velocity  increases  as  density  decreases  and  temperature  increases. 

A26.  Acoustics. 

A27.  Echo. 

A28.  Reverberation. 

A29.  Resonance. 

A30.  Noise. 

A31.  Mechanical,  electrical,  and  chemical. 

A32.  A  photon. 

A33.  Angstrom  unit. 

A34.  Red,  green  and  blue. 

1-47 


CHAPTER  2 

RADIO  WAVE  PROPAGATION 


LEARNING  OBJECTIVES 

Upon  completion  of  this  unit,  you  should  be  able  to: 

1 .  State  what  the  electromagnetic  field  is  and  what  components  make  up  the  electromagnetic  field. 

2.  State  the  difference  between  the  induction  field  and  the  radiation  field. 

3.  State  what  radio  waves  are. 

4.  List  the  components  of  a  radio  wave  and  define  the  terms  cycle,  frequency,  harmonics,  period, 
wavelength,  and  velocity  as  applied  to  radio  wave  propagation. 

5.  Compute  the  wavelength  of  radio  waves. 

6.  State  how  radio  waves  are  polarized,  vertically  and  horizontally. 

7.  State  what  reflection,  refraction,  and  diffraction  are  as  applied  to  radio  waves. 

8.  State  what  influence  the  Earth's  atmosphere  has  on  radio  waves  and  list  the  different  layers  of  the 
Earth's  atmosphere. 

9.  Identify  a  ground  wave,  a  sky  wave,  and  state  the  effects  of  the  ionosphere  on  the  sky  wave. 

1 0.  Identify  the  structure  of  the  ionosphere. 

11.  Define  density  of  layer,  frequency,  angle  of  incidence,  skip  distance,  and  skip  zone. 

12.  Describe  propagation  paths. 

13.  Describe  fading,  multipath  fading,  and  selective  fading.  Describe  propagation  paths. 

14.  State  how  transmission  losses  affect  radio  wave  propagation. 

15.  State  how  electromagnetic  interference,  man-made/natural  interference,  and  ionospheric 
disturbances  affect  radio  wave  propagation.  State  how  transmission  losses  affect  radio  wave 
propagation. 

1 6.  Identify  variations  in  the  ionosphere. 

17.  Identify  the  maximum,  optimum,  and  lowest  usable  frequencies  of  radio  waves. 

18.  State  what  temperature  inversion  is,  how  frequency  predictions  are  made,  and  how  weather  affects 
frequency. 

19.  State  what  tropospheric  scatter  is  and  how  it  affects  radio  wave  propagation. 


2-1 


ELECTROMAGNETIC  FIELDS 


The  way  energy  is  propagated  into  free  space  is  a  source  of  great  dispute  among  people  concerned 
with  it.  Although  many  theories  have  been  proposed,  the  following  theory  adequately  explains  the 
phenomena  and  has  been  widely  accepted.  There  are  two  basic  fields  associated  with  every  antenna;  an 
INDUCTION  FIELD  and  a  RADIATION  FIELD.  The  field  associated  with  the  energy  stored  in  the 
antenna  is  the  induction  field.  This  field  is  said  to  provide  no  part  in  the  transmission  of  electromagnetic 
energy  through  free  space.  However,  without  the  presence  of  the  induction  field,  there  would  be  no 
energy  radiated. 

INDUCTION  FIELD 

Figure  2-1,  a  low-frequency  generator  connected  to  an  antenna,  will  help  you  understand  how  the 
induction  field  is  produced.  Let's  follow  the  generator  through  one  cycle  of  operation. 


ANTENNA 


Figure  2-1. — Induction  field  about  an  antenna. 


2-2 


Initially,  you  can  consider  that  the  generator  output  is  zero  and  that  no  fields  exist  about  the  antenna, 
as  shown  in  view  A.  Now  assume  that  the  generator  produces  a  slight  potential  and  has  the  instantaneous 
polarity  shown  in  view  B.  Because  of  this  slight  potential,  the  antenna  capacitance  acts  as  a  short, 
allowing  a  large  flow  of  current  (I)  through  the  antenna  in  the  direction  shown.  This  current  flow,  in  turn, 
produces  a  large  magnetic  field  about  the  antenna.  Since  the  flow  of  current  at  each  end  of  the  antenna  is 
minimum,  the  corresponding  magnetic  fields  at  each  end  of  the  antenna  are  also  minimum.  As  time 
passes,  charges,  which  oppose  antenna  current  and  produce  an  electrostatic  field  (E  field),  collect  at  each 
end  of  the  antenna.  Eventually,  the  antenna  capacitance  becomes  fully  charged  and  stops  current  flow 
through  the  antenna.  Under  this  condition,  the  electrostatic  field  is  maximum,  and  the  magnetic  field  (H 
field)  is  fully  collapsed,  as  shown  in  view  C. 

As  the  generator  potential  decreases  back  to  zero,  the  potential  of  the  antenna  begins  to  discharge. 
During  the  discharging  process,  the  electrostatic  field  collapses  and  the  direction  of  current  flow  reverses, 
as  shown  in  view  D.  When  the  current  again  begins  to  flow,  an  associated  magnetic  field  is  generated. 
Eventually,  the  electrostatic  field  completely  collapses,  the  generator  potential  reverses,  and  current  is 
maximum,  as  shown  in  view  E.  As  charges  collect  at  each  end  of  the  antenna,  an  electrostatic  field  is 
produced  and  current  flow  decreases.  This  causes  the  magnetic  field  to  begin  collapsing.  The  collapsing 
magnetic  field  produces  more  current  flow,  a  greater  accumulation  of  charge,  and  a  greater  electrostatic 
field.  The  antenna  gradually  reaches  the  condition  shown  in  view  F,  where  current  is  zero  and  the 
collected  charges  are  maximum. 

As  the  generator  potential  again  decreases  toward  zero,  the  antenna  begins  to  discharge  and  the 
electrostatic  field  begins  to  collapse.  When  the  generator  potential  reaches  zero,  discharge  current  is 
maximum  and  the  associated  magnetic  field  is  maximum.  A  brief  time  later,  generator  potential  reverses, 
and  the  condition  shown  in  view  B  recurs. 

NOTE:  The  electric  field  (E  field)  and  the  electrostatic  field  (E  field)  are  the  same.  They  will  be 
used  interchangeably  throughout  this  text. 

The  graph  shown  in  figure  2-2  shows  the  relationship  between  the  magnetic  (H)  field  and  the  electric 
(E)  field  plotted  against  time.  Note  that  the  two  fields  are  90  degrees  out  of  phase  with  each  other.  If  you 
compare  the  graph  in  figure  2-2  with  figure  2-1,  you  will  notice  that  the  two  fields  around  the  antenna  are 
displaced  90  degrees  from  each  other  in  space.  (The  H  field  exists  in  a  plane  perpendicular  to  the  antenna. 
The  E  field  exists  in  a  plane  parallel  with  the  antenna,  as  shown  in  figure  2-1 .) 


0°     90°    180°   270°  360°  90' 


 TIME  *- 

Figure  2-2. — Phase  relationship  of  induction  field  components. 


2-3 


All  the  energy  supplied  to  the  induction  field  is  returned  to  the  antenna  by  the  collapsing  E  and  H 
fields.  No  energy  from  the  induction  field  is  radiated  from  the  antenna.  Therefore,  the  induction  field  is 
considered  a  local  field  and  plays  no  part  in  the  transmission  of  electromagnetic  energy.  The  induction 
field  represents  only  the  stored  energy  in  the  antenna  and  is  responsible  only  for  the  resonant  effects  that 
the  antenna  reflects  to  the  generator. 

RADIATION  FIELDS 

The  E  and  H  fields  that  are  set  up  in  the  transfer  of  energy  through  space  are  known  collectively  as 
the  radiation  field.  This  radiation  field  is  responsible  for  electromagnetic  radiation  from  the  antenna.  The 
radiation  field  decreases  as  the  distance  from  the  antenna  is  increased.  Because  the  decrease  is  linear,  the 
radiation  field  reaches  great  distances  from  the  antenna. 

Let's  look  at  a  half-wave  antenna  to  illustrate  how  this  radiation  actually  takes  place.  Simply  stated,  a 
half-wave  antenna  is  one  that  has  an  electrical  length  equal  to  half  the  wavelength  of  the  signal  being 
transmitted.  Assume,  for  example,  that  a  transmitter  is  operating  at  30  megahertz.  If  a  half-wave  antenna 
is  used  with  the  transmitter,  the  antenna's  electrical  length  would  have  to  be  at  least  1 6  feet  long.  (The 
formula  used  to  compute  the  electrical  length  of  an  antenna  will  be  explained  in  chapter  4.)  When  power 
is  delivered  to  the  half-wave  antenna,  both  an  induction  field  and  a  radiation  field  are  set  up  by  the 
fluctuating  energy.  At  the  antenna,  the  intensities  of  these  fields  are  proportional  to  the  amount  of  power 
delivered  to  the  antenna  from  a  source  such  as  a  transmitter.  At  a  short  distance  from  the  antenna  and 
beyond,  only  the  radiation  field  exists.  This  radiation  field  is  made  up  of  an  electric  component  and  a 
magnetic  component  at  right  angles  to  each  other  in  space  and  varying  together  in  intensity. 

With  a  high-frequency  generator  (a  transmitter)  connected  to  the  antenna,  the  induction  field  is 
produced  as  described  in  the  previous  section.  However,  the  generator  potential  reverses  before  the 
electrostatic  field  has  had  time  to  collapse  completely.  The  reversed  generator  potential  neutralizes  the 
remaining  antenna  charges,  leaving  a  resultant  E  field  in  space. 

Figure  2-3  is  a  simple  picture  of  an  E  field  detaching  itself  from  an  antenna.  (The  H  field  will  not  be 
considered,  although  it  is  present.)  In  view  A  the  voltage  is  maximum  and  the  electric  field  has  maximum 
intensity.  The  lines  of  force  begin  at  the  end  of  the  antenna  that  is  positively  charged  and  extend  to  the 
end  of  the  antenna  that  is  negatively  charged.  Note  that  the  outer  E  lines  are  stretched  away  from  the  inner 
lines.  This  is  because  of  the  repelling  force  that  takes  place  between  lines  of  force  in  the  same  direction. 
As  the  voltage  drops  (view  B),  the  separated  charges  come  together,  and  the  ends  of  the  lines  move 
toward  the  center  of  the  antenna.  But,  since  lines  of  force  in  the  same  direction  repel  each  other,  the 
centers  of  the  lines  are  still  being  held  out. 


2-4 


MAXIMUM  APPLIED 
VOLTAGE 


DECREASED  APPLIED 
VOLTAGE 


OK  O  O  %  0' 


ZERO  APPLIED 
VOLTAGE 


INCREASED  APPLIED 
VOLTAGE 


NOTE:    ONLV  ELECTRIC  (E)  FIELD  5H0WN 


Figure  2-3. — Radiation  from  an  antenna. 

As  the  voltage  approaches  zero  (view  B),  some  of  the  lines  collapse  back  into  the  antenna.  At  the 
same  time,  the  ends  of  other  lines  begin  to  come  together  to  form  a  complete  loop.  Notice  the  direction  of 
these  lines  of  force  next  to  the  antenna  in  view  C.  At  this  point  the  voltage  on  the  antenna  is  zero.  As  the 
charge  starts  to  build  up  in  the  opposite  direction  (view  D),  electric  lines  of  force  again  begin  at  the 
positive  end  of  the  antenna  and  stretch  to  the  negative  end  of  the  antenna.  These  lines  of  force,  being  in 
the  same  direction  as  the  sides  of  the  closed  loops  next  to  the  antenna,  repel  the  closed  loops  and  force 
them  out  into  space  at  the  speed  of  light.  As  these  loops  travel  through  space,  they  generate  a  magnetic 
field  in  phase  with  them. 

Since  each  successive  E  field  is  generated  with  a  polarity  that  is  opposite  the  preceding  E  field  (that 
is,  the  lines  of  force  are  opposite),  an  oscillating  electric  field  is  produced  along  the  path  of  travel.  When 
an  electric  field  oscillates,  a  magnetic  field  having  an  intensity  that  varies  directly  with  that  of  the  E  field 
is  produced.  The  variations  in  magnetic  field  intensity,  in  turn,  produce  another  E  field.  Thus,  the  two 
varying  fields  sustain  each  other,  resulting  in  electromagnetic  wave  propagation. 

During  this  radiation  process,  the  E  and  H  fields  are  in  phase  in  time  but  physically  displaced  90 
degrees  in  space.  Thus,  the  varying  magnetic  field  produces  a  varying  electric  field;  and  the  varying 
electric  field,  in  turn,  sustains  the  varying  magnetic  field.  Each  field  supports  the  other,  and  neither  can  be 
propagated  by  itself.  Figure  2-4  shows  a  comparison  between  the  induction  field  and  the  radiation  field. 


2-5 


DIRECTION  OF 
PROPAGATION 


A   INDUCTION  FIELD 


DIRECTION  OF 
PROPAGATION 


B   RADIATION  FIELD 


Figure  2-4. — E  and  H  components  of  induction  and  radiation  fields. 

Ql.   Which  two  composite  fields  (composed  of  E  and  H  fields)  are  associated  with  every  antenna? 
Q2.   What  composite  field  (composed  of  E  and  H  fields)  is  found  stored  in  the  antenna? 
Q3.   What  composite  field  (composed  of  E  and  H  fields)  is  propagated  into  free  space? 


RADIO  WAVES 

An  energy  wave  generated  by  a  transmitter  is  called  a  RADIO  WAVE.  The  radio  wave  radiated  into 
space  by  the  transmitting  antenna  is  a  very  complex  form  of  energy  containing  both  electric  and  magnetic 
fields.  Because  of  this  combination  of  fields,  radio  waves  are  also  referred  to  as  ELECTROMAGNETIC 
RADIATION. 

This  discussion  will  explain  the  Earth's  atmosphere  and  its  effect  on  radio  waves.  All  the  principles 
of  wave  motion  that  were  discussed  in  chapter  1  also  apply  to  radio  waves. 

NOTE:  The  term  radio  wave  is  not  limited  to  communications  equipment  alone.  The  term  applies  to 
all  equipment  that  generate  signals  in  the  form  of  electromagnetic  energy. 

COMPONENTS  OF  RADIO  WAVES 

The  basic  shape  of  the  wave  generated  by  a  transmitter  is  that  of  a  sine  wave.  The  wave  radiated  out 
into  space,  however,  may  or  may  not  retain  the  characteristics  of  the  sine  wave. 


2-6 


A  sine  wave  can  be  one  cycle  or  many  cycles.  Recall  from  chapter  1  that  the  number  of  cycles  of  a 
sine  wave  that  are  completed  in  1  second  is  known  as  the  frequency  of  the  sine  wave.  For  example,  60 
cycles  of  ordinary  house  current  occur  each  second,  so  house  current  is  said  to  have  a  frequency  of  60 
cycles  per  second  or  60  hertz. 

The  frequencies  falling  between  3000  hertz  (3  kHz)  and  300,000,000,000  hertz  (300  GHz)  are  called 
RADIO  FREQUENCIES  (abbreviated  rf)  since  they  are  commonly  used  in  radio  communications.  This 
part  of  the  radio  frequency  spectrum  is  divided  into  bands,  each  band  being  10  times  higher  in  frequency 
than  the  one  immediately  below  it.  This  arrangement  serves  as  a  convenient  way  to  remember  the  range 
of  each  band.  The  rf  bands  are  shown  in  table  2-1.  The  usable  radio-frequency  range  is  roughly  10 
kilohertz  to  1 00  gigahertz. 


Table  2-1. — Radio  Frequency  Bands 


DESCRIPTION 

ABBREVIATION 

FREQUENCY 

Very  low 

VLF 

3  to  30  KHz 

Low 

LF 

30  to  300  KHz 

Medium 

MF 

300  to  3000  KHz 

High 

HF 

3  to  30  MHz 

Very  high 

VHF 

30  to  300  MHz 

Ultrahigh 

UHF 

300  to  3000  MHz 

Super  high 

SHF 

3  to  30  GHz 

Extremely  high 

EHF 

30  to  300  GHz 

Any  frequency  that  is  a  whole  number  multiple  of  a  smaller  basic  frequency  is  known  as  a 
HARMONIC  of  that  basic  frequency.  The  basic  frequency  itself  is  called  the  first  harmonic  or,  more 
commonly,  the  FUNDAMENTAL  FREQUENCY.  A  frequency  that  is  twice  as  great  as  the  fundamental 
frequency  is  called  the  second  harmonic;  a  frequency  three  times  as  great  is  the  third  harmonic;  and  so  on. 
For  example: 

First  harmonic  (Fundamental  frequency)  3000  kHz 

Second  harmonic  6000  kHz 

Third  harmonic  9000  kHz 

The  PERIOD  of  a  radio  wave  is  simply  the  amount  of  time  required  for  the  completion  of  one  full 
cycle.  If  a  sine  wave  has  a  frequency  of  2  hertz,  each  cycle  has  a  duration,  or  period,  of  one-half  second. 
If  the  frequency  is  1 0  hertz,  the  period  of  each  cycle  is  one -tenth  of  a  second.  Since  the  frequency  of  a 
radio  wave  is  the  number  of  cycles  that  are  completed  in  one  second,  you  should  be  able  to  see  that  as  the 
frequency  of  a  radio  wave  increases,  its  period  decreases. 

A  wavelength  is  the  space  occupied  by  one  full  cycle  of  a  radio  wave  at  any  given  instant. 
Wavelengths  are  expressed  in  meters  (1  meter  is  equal  to  3.28  feet).  You  need  to  have  a  good 
understanding  of  frequency  and  wavelength  to  be  able  to  select  the  proper  antenna(s)  for  use  in  successful 


2-7 


communications.  The  relationship  between  frequency,  wavelength,  and  antennas  will  be  discussed  in 
chapter  4  of  this  module. 

The  velocity  (or  speed)  of  a  radio  wave  radiated  into  free  space  by  a  transmitting  antenna  is  equal  to 
the  speed  of  light — 186,000  miles  per  second  or  300,000,000  meters  per  second.  Because  of  various 
factors,  such  as  barometric  pressure,  humidity,  molecular  content,  etc.,  radio  waves  travel  inside  the 
Earth's  atmosphere  at  a  speed  slightly  less  than  the  speed  of  light.  Normally,  in  discussions  of  the  velocity 
of  radio  waves,  the  velocity  referred  to  is  the  speed  at  which  radio  waves  travel  in  free  space. 

The  frequency  of  a  radio  wave  has  nothing  to  do  with  its  velocity.  A  5-megahertz  wave  travels 
through  space  at  the  same  velocity  as  a  1 0-megahertz  wave.  However,  the  velocity  of  radio  waves  is  an 
important  factor  in  making  wavelength-to-frequency  conversions,  the  subject  of  our  next  discussion. 

Q4.   What  is  the  term  used  to  describe  the  basic  frequency  of  a  radio  wave? 

Q5.   What  is  the  term  used  to  describe  a  whole  number  multiple  of  the  basic  frequency  of  a  radio 
wave? 

WAVELENGTH-TO-FREQUENCY  CONVERSIONS 

Radio  waves  are  often  referred  to  by  their  wavelength  in  meters  rather  than  by  frequency.  For 
example,  most  people  have  heard  commercial  radio  stations  make  announcements  similar  to  the 
following:  "Station  WXYZ  operating  on  240  meters..."  To  tune  receiving  equipment  that  is  calibrated  by 
frequency  to  such  a  station,  you  must  first  convert  the  designated  wavelength  to  its  equivalent  frequency. 

As  discussed  earlier,  a  radio  wave  travels  300,000,000  meters  a  second  (speed  of  light);  therefore,  a 
radio  wave  of  1  hertz  would  have  traveled  a  distance  (or  wavelength)  of  300,000,000  meters.  Obviously 
then,  if  the  frequency  of  the  wave  is  increased  to  2  hertz,  the  wavelength  will  be  cut  in  half  to 
150,000,000  meters.  This  illustrates  the  principle  that  the  HIGHER  THE  FREQUENCY,  the  SHORTER 
THE  WAVELENGTH. 

Wavelength-to-frequency  conversions  of  radio  waves  are  really  quite  simple  because  wavelength  and 
frequency  are  reciprocals:  Either  one  divided  into  the  velocity  of  a  radio  wave  yields  the  other. 
Remember,  the  formula  for  wavelength  is: 


Where: 


Y  0  " 


x 


X  =  wavelength  in  meters 


v  =  velocity  of  radio  wave 
(speed  of  light) 

f  =  frequency  of  radio  wave 
(in  Hz,  kHz  or  Mhz) 


The  wavelength  in  meters  divided  into  300,000,000  yields  the  frequency  of  a  radio  wave  in  hertz. 
Likewise,  the  wavelength  divided  into  300,000  yields  the  frequency  of  a  radio  wave  in  kilohertz,  and  the 
wavelength  divided  into  300  yields  the  frequency  in  megahertz. 


2-8 


Now,  let  us  apply  the  formula  to  determine  the  frequency  to  which  the  receiving  equipment  must  be 
tuned  to  receive  station  WXYZ  operating  on  240  meters.  Radio  wave  frequencies  are  normally  expressed 
in  kilohertz  or  megahertz. 

To  find  the  frequency  in  hertz,  use  the  formula: 

f  =  1 

X 

Given: 

v  =  300,000,000  meters  per  second 
^  =  240  meters 
Solution: 

f  _    300,000,000  meters  per  second 

240  meters 
f  =  1,250,000  Hz 


To  find  the  frequency  in  kilohertz,  use  the  formula: 

300,000 


f, 


[kHz] 


X 


Given: 

X  =  240  meters 

Solution: 

f       =  300,000 
m*]    240  meters 

f  =  1250kHz 
To  find  the  frequency  in  megahertz,  use  the  formula: 

r        _  300 
MMHz]  ~ 


Given: 

X=  240  meters 

Solution: 

f  300 
f[MH3]  =  240  meters 

f  =  1.25MHz 


2-9 


Q6.  It  is  known  that  WWV  operates  on  a  frequency  of  10  megahertz.  What  is  the  wavelength  ofWWV? 


Q7.  A  station  is  known  to  operate  at  60-meters.  What  is  the  frequency  of  the  unknown  station? 
POLARIZATION 

For  maximum  absorption  of  energy  from  the  electromagnetic  fields,  the  receiving  antenna  must  be 
located  in  the  plane  of  polarization.  This  places  the  conductor  of  the  antenna  at  right  angles  to  the 
magnetic  lines  of  force  moving  through  the  antenna  and  parallel  to  the  electric  lines,  causing  maximum 
induction. 

Normally,  the  plane  of  polarization  of  a  radio  wave  is  the  plane  in  which  the  E  field  propagates  with 
respect  to  the  Earth.  If  the  E  field  component  of  the  radiated  wave  travels  in  a  plane  perpendicular  to  the 
Earth's  surface  (vertical),  the  radiation  is  said  to  be  VERTICALLY  POLARIZED,  as  shown  in  figure  2-5, 
view  A.  If  the  E  field  propagates  in  a  plane  parallel  to  the  Earth's  surface  (horizontal),  the  radiation  is  said 
to  be  HORIZONTALLY  POLARIZED,  as  shown  in  view  B. 


VERTICAL 
ANTENNA 


WAVE  FRONT 


ELECTRIC  LINES 


MAGNETIC  LINES 


Figure  2-5. — Vertical  and  horizontal  polarization. 

The  position  of  the  antenna  in  space  is  important  because  it  affects  the  polarization  of  the 
electromagnetic  wave.  When  the  transmitting  antenna  is  close  to  the  ground,  vertically  polarized  waves 
cause  a  greater  signal  strength  along  the  Earth's  surface.  On  the  other  hand,  antennas  high  above  the 
ground  should  be  horizontally  polarized  to  get  the  greatest  possible  signal  strength  to  the  Earth's  surface. 
Vertically  and  horizontally  polarized  antennas  will  be  discussed  in  more  detail  in  chapter  4. 

The  radiated  energy  from  an  antenna  is  in  the  form  of  an  expanding  sphere.  Any  small  section  of  this 
sphere  is  perpendicular  to  the  direction  the  energy  travels  and  is  called  a  WAVEFRONT.  All  energy  on  a 
wavefront  is  in  phase.  Usually  all  points  on  the  wavefront  are  at  equal  distances  from  the  antenna.  The 
farther  the  wavefront  is  from  the  antenna,  the  less  spherical  the  wave  appears.  At  a  considerable  distance 
the  wavefront  can  be  considered  as  a  plane  surface  at  a  right  angle  to  the  direction  of  propagation. 


2-10 


If  you  know  the  directions  of  the  E  and  H  components,  you  can  use  the  "right-hand  rule"  (see  figure 
2-6)  to  determine  the  direction  of  wave  propagation.  This  rule  states  that  if  the  thumb,  forefinger,  and 
middle  finger  of  the  right  hand  are  extended  so  they  are  mutually  perpendicular,  the  middle  finger  will 
point  in  the  direction  of  wave  propagation  if  the  thumb  points  in  the  direction  of  the  E  field  and  the 
forefinger  points  in  the  direction  of  the  H  field.  Since  both  the  E  and  H  fields  reverse  directions 
simultaneously,  propagation  of  a  particular  wavefront  is  always  in  the  same  direction  (away  from  the 
antenna). 


Q8.  If  a  transmitting  antenna  is  placed  close  to  the  ground,  how  should  the  antenna  be  polarized  to 
give  the  greatest  signal  strength? 

Q9.  In  the  right-hand  rule  for  propagation,  the  thumb  points  in  the  direction  of  the  E  field  and  the 
forefinger  points  in  the  direction  of  the  H  field.  In  what  direction  does  the  middle  finger  point? 

ATMOSPHERIC  PROPAGATION 

Within  the  atmosphere,  radio  waves  can  be  reflected,  refracted,  and  diffracted  like  light  and  heat 
waves. 


Radio  waves  may  be  reflected  from  various  substances  or  objects  they  meet  during  travel  between 
the  transmitting  and  receiving  sites.  The  amount  of  reflection  depends  on  the  reflecting  material.  Smooth 
metal  surfaces  of  good  electrical  conductivity  are  efficient  reflectors  of  radio  waves.  The  surface  of  the 
Earth  itself  is  a  fairly  good  reflector.  The  radio  wave  is  not  reflected  from  a  single  point  on  the  reflector 
but  rather  from  an  area  on  its  surface.  The  size  of  the  area  required  for  reflection  to  take  place  depends  on 
the  wavelength  of  the  radio  wave  and  the  angle  at  which  the  wave  strikes  the  reflecting  substance. 

When  radio  waves  are  reflected  from  flat  surfaces,  a  phase  shift  in  the  alternations  of  the  wave 
occurs.  Figure  2-7  shows  two  radio  waves  being  reflected  from  the  Earth's  surface.  Notice  that  the 
positive  and  negative  alternations  of  radio  waves  (A)  and  (B)  are  in  phase  with  each  other  in  their  paths 
toward  the  Earth's  surface.  After  reflection  takes  place,  however,  the  waves  are  approximately  180 
degrees  out  of  phase  from  their  initial  relationship.  The  amount  of  phase  shift  that  occurs  is  not  constant. 


DIRECTION  OF  WAVE 
PROPAGATION 


Figure  2-6. — Right-hand  rule  for  propagation. 


Reflection 


2-11 


It  depends  on  the  polarization  of  the  wave  and  the  angle  at  which  the  wave  strikes  the  reflecting  surface. 
Radio  waves  that  keep  their  phase  relationships  after  reflection  normally  produce  a  stronger  signal  at  the 
receiving  site.  Those  that  are  received  out  of  phase  produce  a  weak  or  fading  signal.  The  shifting  in  the 
phase  relationships  of  reflected  radio  waves  is  one  of  the  major  reasons  for  fading.  Fading  will  be 
discussed  in  more  detail  later  in  this  chapter. 


EARTH'S  SUHFACE 


Figure  2-7. — Phase  shift  of  reflected  radio  waves. 

Refraction 

Another  phenomenon  common  to  most  radio  waves  is  the  bending  of  the  waves  as  they  move  from 
one  medium  into  another  in  which  the  velocity  of  propagation  is  different.  This  bending  of  the  waves  is 
called  refraction.  For  example,  suppose  you  are  driving  down  a  smoothly  paved  road  at  a  constant  speed 
and  suddenly  one  wheel  goes  off  onto  the  soft  shoulder.  The  car  tends  to  veer  off  to  one  side.  The  change 
of  medium,  from  hard  surface  to  soft  shoulder,  causes  a  change  in  speed  or  velocity.  The  tendency  is  for 
the  car  to  change  direction.  This  same  principle  applies  to  radio  waves  as  changes  occur  in  the  medium 
through  which  they  are  passing.  As  an  example,  the  radio  wave  shown  in  figure  2-8  is  traveling  through 
the  Earth's  atmosphere  at  a  constant  speed.  As  the  wave  enters  the  dense  layer  of  electrically  charged  ions, 
the  part  of  the  wave  that  enters  the  new  medium  first  travels  faster  than  the  parts  of  the  wave  that  have  not 
yet  entered  the  new  medium.  This  abrupt  increase  in  velocity  of  the  upper  part  of  the  wave  causes  the 
wave  to  bend  back  toward  the  Earth.  This  bending,  or  change  of  direction,  is  always  toward  the  medium 
that  has  the  lower  velocity  of  propagation. 


2-12 


Figure  2-8. — Radio  wave  refraction. 

Radio  waves  passing  through  the  atmosphere  are  affected  by  certain  factors,  such  as  temperature, 
pressure,  humidity,  and  density.  These  factors  can  cause  the  radio  waves  to  be  refracted.  This  effect  will 
be  discussed  in  greater  detail  later  in  this  chapter. 

Diffraction 

A  radio  wave  that  meets  an  obstacle  has  a  natural  tendency  to  bend  around  the  obstacle  as  illustrated 
in  figure  2-9.  The  bending,  called  diffraction,  results  in  a  change  of  direction  of  part  of  the  wave  energy 
from  the  normal  line-of-sight  path.  This  change  makes  it  possible  to  receive  energy  around  the  edges  of 
an  obstacle  as  shown  in  view  A  or  at  some  distances  below  the  highest  point  of  an  obstruction,  as  shown 
in  view  B.  Although  diffracted  rf  energy  usually  is  weak,  it  can  still  be  detected  by  a  suitable  receiver. 
The  principal  effect  of  diffraction  extends  the  radio  range  beyond  the  visible  horizon.  In  certain  cases,  by 
using  high  power  and  very  low  frequencies,  radio  waves  can  be  made  to  encircle  the  Earth  by  diffraction. 


A    TOP  VIEW 


B    SIDE  VIEW 


Figure  2-9. — Diffraction  around  an  object. 


2-13 


Q10.   What  is  one  of  the  major  reasons  for  the  fading  of  radio  waves  which  have  been  reflected  from  a 
surface? 


THE  EFFECT  OF  THE  EARTH'S  ATMOSPHERE  ON  RADIO  WAVES 

This  discussion  of  electromagnetic  wave  propagation  is  concerned  mainly  with  the  properties  and 
effects  of  the  medium  located  between  the  transmitting  antenna  and  the  receiving  antenna.  While  radio 
waves  traveling  in  free  space  have  little  outside  influence  affecting  them,  radio  waves  traveling  within  the 
Earth's  atmosphere  are  affected  by  varying  conditions.  The  influence  exerted  on  radio  waves  by  the 
Earth's  atmosphere  adds  many  new  factors  to  complicate  what  at  first  seems  to  be  a  relatively  simple 
problem.  These  complications  are  because  of  a  lack  of  uniformity  within  the  Earth's  atmosphere. 
Atmospheric  conditions  vary  with  changes  in  height,  geographical  location,  and  even  with  changes  in 
time  (day,  night,  season,  year).  A  knowledge  of  the  composition  of  the  Earth's  atmosphere  is  extremely 
important  for  understanding  wave  propagation. 

The  Earth's  atmosphere  is  divided  into  three  separate  regions,  or  layers.  They  are  the 
TROPOSPHERE,  the  STRATOSPHERE,  and  the  IONOSPHERE.  The  layers  of  the  atmosphere  are 
illustrated  in  figure  2-10. 


T.S  —■ 


SEA 
LEVEL 


IONOSPHERE 


-40-  C 


STRATOSPHERE 


-40- F 

-112" F 
50"  F 


Figure  2-10. — Layers  of  the  earth's  atmosphere. 

TROPOSPHERE 

The  troposphere  is  the  portion  of  the  Earth's  atmosphere  that  extends  from  the  surface  of  the  Earth  to 
a  height  of  about  3.7  miles  (6  km)  at  the  North  Pole  or  the  South  Pole  and  1 1.2  miles  (18  km)  at  the 


2-14 


equator.  Virtually  all  weather  phenomena  take  place  in  the  troposphere.  The  temperature  in  this  region 
decreases  rapidly  with  altitude,  clouds  form,  and  there  may  be  much  turbulence  because  of  variations  in 
temperature,  density,  and  pressure.  These  conditions  have  a  great  effect  on  the  propagation  of  radio 
waves,  which  will  be  explained  later  in  this  chapter. 

STRATOSPHERE 

The  stratosphere  is  located  between  the  troposphere  and  the  ionosphere.  The  temperature  throughout 
this  region  is  considered  to  be  almost  constant  and  there  is  little  water  vapor  present.  The  stratosphere  has 
relatively  little  effect  on  radio  waves  because  it  is  a  relatively  calm  region  with  little  or  no  temperature 
changes. 

IONOSPHERE 

The  ionosphere  extends  upward  from  about  31.1  miles  (50  km)  to  a  height  of  about  250  miles  (402 
km).  It  contains  four  cloud-like  layers  of  electrically  charged  ions,  which  enable  radio  waves  to  be 
propagated  to  great  distances  around  the  Earth.  This  is  the  most  important  region  of  the  atmosphere  for 
long  distance  point-to-point  communications.  This  region  will  be  discussed  in  detail  a  little  later  in  this 
chapter. 

Qll.   What  are  the  three  layers  of  the  atmosphere? 

Q12.   Which  layer  of  the  atmosphere  has  relatively  little  effect  on  radio  waves? 

RADIO  WAVE  TRANSMISSION 

There  are  two  principal  ways  in  which  electromagnetic  (radio)  energy  travels  from  a  transmitting 
antenna  to  a  receiving  antenna.  One  way  is  by  GROUND  WAVES  and  the  other  is  by  SKY  WAVES. 
Ground  waves  are  radio  waves  that  travel  near  the  surface  of  the  Earth  (surface  and  space  waves).  Sky 
waves  are  radio  waves  that  are  reflected  back  to  Earth  from  the  ionosphere.  (See  figure  2-1 1 .) 


Figure  2-11. — Ground  waves  and  sky  waves. 


2-15 


Ground  Waves 

The  ground  wave  is  actually  composed  of  two  separate  component  waves.  These  are  known  as  the 
SURFACE  WAVE  and  the  SPACE  WAVE  (fig.  2-11).  The  determining  factor  in  whether  a  ground  wave 
component  is  classified  as  a  space  wave  or  a  surface  wave  is  simple.  A  surface  wave  travels  along  the 
surface  of  the  Earth.  A  space  wave  travels  over  the  surface. 

SURFACE  WAVE. — The  surface  wave  reaches  the  receiving  site  by  traveling  along  the  surface  of 
the  ground  as  shown  in  figure  2-12.  A  surface  wave  can  follow  the  contours  of  the  Earth  because  of  the 
process  of  diffraction.  When  a  surface  wave  meets  an  object  and  the  dimensions  of  the  object  do  not 
exceed  its  wavelength,  the  wave  tends  to  curve  or  bend  around  the  object.  The  smaller  the  object,  the 
more  pronounced  the  diffractive  action  will  be. 


As  a  surface  wave  passes  over  the  ground,  the  wave  induces  a  voltage  in  the  Earth.  The  induced 
voltage  takes  energy  away  from  the  surface  wave,  thereby  weakening,  or  attenuating,  the  wave  as  it 
moves  away  from  the  transmitting  antenna.  To  reduce  the  attenuation,  the  amount  of  induced  voltage 
must  be  reduced.  This  is  done  by  using  vertically  polarized  waves  that  minimize  the  extent  to  which  the 
electric  field  of  the  wave  is  in  contact  with  the  Earth.  When  a  surface  wave  is  horizontally  polarized,  the 
electric  field  of  the  wave  is  parallel  with  the  surface  of  the  Earth  and,  therefore,  is  constantly  in  contact 
with  it.  The  wave  is  then  completely  attenuated  within  a  short  distance  from  the  transmitting  site.  On  the 
other  hand,  when  the  surface  wave  is  vertically  polarized,  the  electric  field  is  vertical  to  the  Earth  and 
merely  dips  into  and  out  of  the  Earth's  surface.  For  this  reason,  vertical  polarization  is  vastly  superior  to 
horizontal  polarization  for  surface  wave  propagation. 

The  attenuation  that  a  surface  wave  undergoes  because  of  induced  voltage  also  depends  on  the 
electrical  properties  of  the  terrain  over  which  the  wave  travels.  The  best  type  of  surface  is  one  that  has 
good  electrical  conductivity.  The  better  the  conductivity,  the  less  the  attenuation.  Table  2-2  gives  the 
relative  conductivity  of  various  surfaces  of  the  Earth. 


Figure  2-12. — Surface  wave  propagation. 


2-16 


Table  2-2. — Surface  Conductivity 


SURFACE 

RELATIVE  CONDUCTIVITY 

Sea  water 

Good 

Flat,  loamy  soil 

Fair 

Large  bodies  of  fresh  water 

Fair 

Rocky  terrain 

Poor 

Desert 

Poor 

Jungle 

Unusable 

Another  major  factor  in  the  attenuation  of  surface  waves  is  frequency.  Recall  from  earlier 
discussions  on  wavelength  that  the  higher  the  frequency  of  a  radio  wave,  the  shorter  its  wavelength  will 
be.  These  high  frequencies,  with  their  shorter  wavelengths,  are  not  normally  diffracted  but  are  absorbed 
by  the  Earth  at  points  relatively  close  to  the  transmitting  site.  You  can  assume,  therefore,  that  as  the 
frequency  of  a  surface  wave  is  increased,  the  more  rapidly  the  surface  wave  will  be  absorbed,  or 
attenuated,  by  the  Earth.  Because  of  this  loss  by  attenuation,  the  surface  wave  is  impractical  for  long- 
distance transmissions  at  frequencies  above  2  megahertz.  On  the  other  hand,  when  the  frequency  of  a 
surface  wave  is  low  enough  to  have  a  very  long  wavelength,  the  Earth  appears  to  be  very  small,  and 
diffraction  is  sufficient  for  propagation  well  beyond  the  horizon.  In  fact,  by  lowering  the  transmitting 
frequency  into  the  very  low  frequency  (vlf)  range  and  using  very  high-powered  transmitters,  the  surface 
wave  can  be  propagated  great  distances.  The  Navy's  extremely  high-powered  vlf  transmitters  are  actually 
capable  of  transmitting  surface  wave  signals  around  the  Earth  and  can  provide  coverage  to  naval  units 
operating  anywhere  at  sea. 

SPACE  WAVE. — The  space  wave  follows  two  distinct  paths  from  the  transmitting  antenna  to  the 
receiving  antenna — one  through  the  air  directly  to  the  receiving  antenna,  the  other  reflected  from  the 
ground  to  the  receiving  antenna.  This  is  illustrated  in  figure  2-13.  The  primary  path  of  the  space  wave  is 
directly  from  the  transmitting  antenna  to  the  receiving  antenna.  So,  the  receiving  antenna  must  be  located 
within  the  radio  horizon  of  the  transmitting  antenna.  Because  space  waves  are  refracted  slightly,  even 
when  propagated  through  the  troposphere,  the  radio  horizon  is  actually  about  one-third  farther  than  the 
line-of-sight  or  natural  horizon. 


2-17 


Figure  2-13. — Space  wave  propagation. 

Although  space  waves  suffer  little  ground  attenuation,  they  nevertheless  are  susceptible  to  fading. 
This  is  because  space  waves  actually  follow  two  paths  of  different  lengths  (direct  path  and  ground 
reflected  path)  to  the  receiving  site  and,  therefore,  may  arrive  in  or  out  of  phase.  If  these  two  component 
waves  are  received  in  phase,  the  result  is  a  reinforced  or  stronger  signal.  Likewise,  if  they  are  received  out 
of  phase,  they  tend  to  cancel  one  another,  which  results  in  a  weak  or  fading  signal. 

Q13.   What  is  the  determining  factor  in  classifying  whether  a  radio  wave  is  a  ground  wave  or  a  space 
wave? 

Q14.   What  is  the  best  type  of  surface  or  terrain  to  use  for  radio  wave  transmission? 

Q15.   What  is  the  primary  difference  between  the  radio  horizon  and  the  natural  horizon? 

Q16.   What  three  factors  must  be  considered  in  the  transmission  of  a  surface  wave  to  reduce 
attenuation? 

Sky  Wave 

The  sky  wave,  often  called  the  ionospheric  wave,  is  radiated  in  an  upward  direction  and  returned  to 
Earth  at  some  distant  location  because  of  refraction  from  the  ionosphere.  This  form  of  propagation  is 
relatively  unaffected  by  the  Earth's  surface  and  can  propagate  signals  over  great  distances.  Usually  the 
high  frequency  (hf)  band  is  used  for  sky  wave  propagation.  The  following  in-depth  study  of  the 
ionosphere  and  its  effect  on  sky  waves  will  help  you  to  better  understand  the  nature  of  sky  wave 
propagation. 

STRUCTURE  OF  THE  IONOSPHERE 

As  we  stated  earlier,  the  ionosphere  is  the  region  of  the  atmosphere  that  extends  from  about  30  miles 
above  the  surface  of  the  Earth  to  about  250  miles.  It  is  appropriately  named  the  ionosphere  because  it 
consists  of  several  layers  of  electrically  charged  gas  atoms  called  ions.  The  ions  are  formed  by  a  process 
called  ionization. 


2-18 


Ionization 

Ionization  occurs  when  high  energy  ultraviolet  light  waves  from  the  sun  enter  the  ionospheric  region 
of  the  atmosphere,  strike  a  gas  atom,  and  literally  knock  an  electron  free  from  its  parent  atom.  A  normal 
atom  is  electrically  neutral  since  it  contains  both  a  positive  proton  in  its  nucleus  and  a  negative  orbiting 
electron.  When  the  negative  electron  is  knocked  free  from  the  atom,  the  atom  becomes  positively  charged 
(called  a  positive  ion)  and  remains  in  space  along  with  the  free  electron,  which  is  negatively  charged.  This 
process  of  upsetting  electrical  neutrality  is  known  as  IONIZATION. 

The  free  negative  electrons  subsequently  absorb  part  of  the  ultraviolet  energy,  which  initially  freed 
them  from  their  atoms.  As  the  ultraviolet  light  wave  continues  to  produce  positive  ions  and  negative 
electrons,  its  intensity  decreases  because  of  the  absorption  of  energy  by  the  free  electrons,  and  an  ionized 
layer  is  formed.  The  rate  at  which  ionization  occurs  depends  on  the  density  of  atoms  in  the  atmosphere 
and  the  intensity  of  the  ultraviolet  light  wave,  which  varies  with  the  activity  of  the  sun. 

Since  the  atmosphere  is  bombarded  by  ultraviolet  light  waves  of  different  frequencies,  several 
ionized  layers  are  formed  at  different  altitudes.  Lower  frequency  ultraviolet  waves  penetrate  the 
atmosphere  the  least;  therefore,  they  produce  ionized  layers  at  the  higher  altitudes.  Conversely,  ultraviolet 
waves  of  higher  frequencies  penetrate  deeper  and  produce  layers  at  the  lower  altitudes. 

An  important  factor  in  determining  the  density  of  ionized  layers  is  the  elevation  angle  of  the  sun, 
which  changes  frequently.  For  this  reason,  the  height  and  thickness  of  the  ionized  layers  vary,  depending 
on  the  time  of  day  and  even  the  season  of  the  year. 

Recombination 

Recall  that  the  process  of  ionization  involves  ultraviolet  light  waves  knocking  electrons  free  from 
their  atoms.  A  reverse  process  called  RECOMBINATION  occurs  when  the  free  electrons  and  positive 
ions  collide  with  each  other.  Since  these  collisions  are  inevitable,  the  positive  ions  return  to  their  original 
neutral  atom  state. 

The  recombination  process  also  depends  on  the  time  of  day.  Between  the  hours  of  early  morning  and 
late  afternoon,  the  rate  of  ionization  exceeds  the  rate  of  recombination.  During  this  period,  the  ionized 
layers  reach  their  greatest  density  and  exert  maximum  influence  on  radio  waves.  During  the  late  afternoon 
and  early  evening  hours,  however,  the  rate  of  recombination  exceeds  the  rate  of  ionization,  and  the 
density  of  the  ionized  layers  begins  to  decrease.  Throughout  the  night,  density  continues  to  decrease, 
reaching  a  low  point  just  before  sunrise. 

Four  Distinct  Layers 

The  ionosphere  is  composed  of  three  layers  designated  D,  E,  and  F,  from  lowest  level  to  highest 
level  as  shown  in  figure  2-14.  The  F  layer  is  further  divided  into  two  layers  designated  Fl  (the  lower 
layer)  and  F2  (the  higher  layer).  The  presence  or  absence  of  these  layers  in  the  ionosphere  and  their  height 
above  the  Earth  varies  with  the  position  of  the  sun.  At  high  noon,  radiation  in  the  ionosphere  directly 
above  a  given  point  is  greatest.  At  night  it  is  minimum.  When  the  radiation  is  removed,  many  of  the 
particles  that  were  ionized  recombine.  The  time  interval  between  these  conditions  finds  the  position  and 
number  of  the  ionized  layers  within  the  ionosphere  changing.  Since  the  position  of  the  sun  varies  daily, 
monthly,  and  yearly,  with  respect  to  a  specified  point  on  Earth,  the  exact  position  and  number  of  layers 
present  are  extremely  difficult  to  determine.  However,  the  following  general  statements  can  be  made: 


2-19 


RADIATION 
FROM  SUN 


Figure  2-14. — Layers  of  the  ionosphere. 

a.  The  D  layer  ranges  from  about  30  to  55  miles.  Ionization  in  the  D  layer  is  low  because  it  is  the 
lowest  region  of  the  ionosphere.  This  layer  has  the  ability  to  refract  signals  of  low  frequencies. 
High  frequencies  pass  right  through  it  and  are  attenuated.  After  sunset,  the  D  layer  disappears 
because  of  the  rapid  recombination  of  ions. 

b.  The  E  layer  limits  are  from  about  55  to  90  miles.  This  layer  is  also  known  as  the  Kennelly- 
Heaviside  layer,  because  these  two  men  were  the  first  to  propose  its  existence.  The  rate  of  ionic 
recombination  in  this  layer  is  rather  rapid  after  sunset  and  the  layer  is  almost  gone  by  midnight. 
This  layer  has  the  ability  to  refract  signals  as  high  as  20  megahertz.  For  this  reason,  it  is  valuable 
for  communications  in  ranges  up  to  about  1500  miles. 

c.  The  F  layer  exists  from  about  90  to  240  miles.  During  the  daylight  hours,  the  F  layer  separates 
into  two  layers,  the  Fl  and  F2  layers.  The  ionization  level  in  these  layers  is  quite  high  and  varies 
widely  during  the  day.  At  noon,  this  portion  of  the  atmosphere  is  closest  to  the  sun  and  the  degree 
of  ionization  is  maximum.  Since  the  atmosphere  is  rarefied  at  these  heights,  recombination  occurs 
slowly  after  sunset.  Therefore,  a  fairly  constant  ionized  layer  is  always  present.  The  F  layers  are 
responsible  for  high-frequency,  long  distance  transmission. 

Ql  7.   What  causes  ionization  to  occur  in  the  ionosphere? 

Q18.  How  are  the  four  distinct  layers  of  the  ionosphere  designated? 

Q19.   What  is  the  height  of  the  individual  layers  of  the  ionosphere? 

REFRACTION  IN  THE  IONOSPHERE 

When  a  radio  wave  is  transmitted  into  an  ionized  layer,  refraction,  or  bending  of  the  wave,  occurs. 
As  we  discussed  earlier,  refraction  is  caused  by  an  abrupt  change  in  the  velocity  of  the  upper  part  of  a 
radio  wave  as  it  strikes  or  enters  a  new  medium.  The  amount  of  refraction  that  occurs  depends  on  three 
main  factors:  (1)  the  density  of  ionization  of  the  layer,  (2)  the  frequency  of  the  radio  wave,  and  (3)  the 
angle  at  which  the  wave  enters  the  layer. 


2-20 


Density  of  Layer 

Figure  2-15  illustrates  the  relationship  between  radio  waves  and  ionization  density.  Each  ionized 
layer  has  a  central  region  of  relatively  dense  ionization,  which  tapers  off  in  intensity  both  above  and 
below  the  maximum  region.  As  a  radio  wave  enters  a  region  of  INCREASING  ionization,  the  increase  in 
velocity  of  the  upper  part  of  the  wave  causes  it  to  be  bent  back  TOWARD  the  Earth.  While  the  wave  is  in 
the  highly  dense  center  portion  of  the  layer,  however,  refraction  occurs  more  slowly  because  the  density 
of  ionization  is  almost  uniform.  As  the  wave  enters  into  the  upper  part  of  the  layer  of  DECREASING 
ionization,  the  velocity  of  the  upper  part  of  the  wave  decreases,  and  the  wave  is  bent  AWAY  from  the 
Earth. 


Figure  2-15. — Effects  of  ionospheric  density  on  radio  waves. 

If  a  wave  strikes  a  thin,  very  highly  ionized  layer,  the  wave  may  be  bent  back  so  rapidly  that  it  will 
appear  to  have  been  reflected  instead  of  refracted  back  to  Earth.  To  reflect  a  radio  wave,  the  highly 
ionized  layer  must  be  approximately  no  thicker  than  one  wavelength  of  the  radio  wave.  Since  the  ionized 
layers  are  often  several  miles  thick,  ionospheric  reflection  is  more  likely  to  occur  at  long  wavelengths 
(low  frequencies). 

Frequency 

For  any  given  time,  each  ionospheric  layer  has  a  maximum  frequency  at  which  radio  waves  can  be 
transmitted  vertically  and  refracted  back  to  Earth.  This  frequency  is  known  as  the  CRITICAL 
FREQUENCY.  It  is  a  term  that  you  will  hear  frequently  in  any  discussion  of  radio  wave  propagation. 
Radio  waves  transmitted  at  frequencies  higher  than  the  critical  frequency  of  a  given  layer  will  pass 
through  the  layer  and  be  lost  in  space;  but  if  these  same  waves  enter  an  upper  layer  with  a  higher  critical 
frequency,  they  will  be  refracted  back  to  Earth.  Radio  waves  of  frequencies  lower  than  the  critical 
frequency  will  also  be  refracted  back  to  Earth  unless  they  are  absorbed  or  have  been  refracted  from  a 


2-21 


lower  layer.  The  lower  the  frequency  of  a  radio  wave,  the  more  rapidly  the  wave  is  refracted  by  a  given 
degree  of  ionization.  Figure  2-16  shows  three  separate  waves  of  different  frequencies  entering  an 
ionospheric  layer  at  the  same  angle.  Notice  that  the  5-megahertz  wave  is  refracted  quite  sharply.  The 
20-megahertz  wave  is  refracted  less  sharply  and  returned  to  Earth  at  a  greater  distance.  The 
1 00-megahertz  wave  is  obviously  greater  than  the  critical  frequency  for  that  ionized  layer  and,  therefore, 
is  not  refracted  but  is  passed  into  space. 


Angle  of  Incidence 

The  rate  at  which  a  wave  of  a  given  frequency  is  refracted  by  an  ionized  layer  depends  on  the  angle 
at  which  the  wave  enters  the  layer.  Figure  2-17  shows  three  radio  waves  of  the  same  frequency  entering  a 
layer  at  different  angles.  The  angle  at  which  wave  A  strikes  the  layer  is  too  nearly  vertical  for  the  wave  to 
be  refracted  to  Earth.  As  the  wave  enters  the  layer,  it  is  bent  slightly  but  passes  through  the  layer  and  is 
lost.  When  the  wave  is  reduced  to  an  angle  that  is  less  than  vertical  (wave  B),  it  strikes  the  layer  and  is 
refracted  back  to  Earth.  The  angle  made  by  wave  B  is  called  the  CRITICAL  ANGLE  for  that  particular 
frequency.  Any  wave  that  leaves  the  antenna  at  an  angle  greater  than  the  critical  angle  will  penetrate  the 
ionospheric  layer  for  that  frequency  and  then  be  lost  in  space.  Wave  C  strikes  the  ionosphere  at  the 
smallest  angle  at  which  the  wave  can  be  refracted  and  still  return  to  Earth.  At  any  smaller  angle,  the  wave 
will  be  refracted  but  will  not  return  to  Earth. 


100  MHz 


Figure  2-16. — Frequency  versus  refraction  and  distance. 


2-22 


Figure  2-17. — Different  incident  angles  of  radio  waves. 

As  the  frequency  of  the  radio  wave  is  increased,  the  critical  angle  must  be  reduced  for  refraction  to 
occur.  This  is  illustrated  in  figure  2-18.  The  2-megahertz  wave  strikes  the  layer  at  the  critical  angle  for 
that  frequency  and  is  refracted  back  to  Earth.  Although  the  5-megahertz  wave  (broken  line)  strikes  the 
ionosphere  at  a  lesser  angle,  it  nevertheless  penetrates  the  layer  and  is  lost.  As  the  angle  is  lowered  from 
the  vertical,  however,  a  critical  angle  for  the  5-megahertz  wave  is  reached,  and  the  wave  is  then  refracted 
to  Earth. 


5MHs  WAVE 
^  NOT  REFRACTED 


IONOSPHERE  '  <*.... 

■   ■  ■  j.  ■  ■ 


Figure  2-18. — Effects  of  frequency  on  the  critical  angle. 


Q20.   What  factor  determines  whether  a  radio  wave  is  reflected  or  refracted  by  the  ionosphere? 

Q21.  There  is  a  maximum  frequency  at  which  vertically  transmitted  radio  waves  can  be  refracted  back 
to  Earth.  What  is  this  maximum  frequency  called? 

Q22.   What  three  main  factors  determine  the  amount  of  refraction  in  the  ionosphere? 


2-23 


Skip  Distance/Skip  Zone 


In  figure  2-19,  note  the  relationship  between  the  sky  wave  skip  distance,  the  skip  zone,  and  the 
ground  wave  coverage.  The  SKIP  DISTANCE  is  the  distance  from  the  transmitter  to  the  point  where  the 
sky  wave  is  first  returned  to  Earth.  The  size  of  the  skip  distance  depends  on  the  frequency  of  the  wave,  the 
angle  of  incidence,  and  the  degree  of  ionization  present. 


Figure  2-19. — Relationship  between  skip  zone,  skip  distance,  and  ground  wave. 

The  SKIP  ZONE  is  a  zone  of  silence  between  the  point  where  the  ground  wave  becomes  too  weak 
for  reception  and  the  point  where  the  sky  wave  is  first  returned  to  Earth.  The  size  of  the  skip  zone 
depends  on  the  extent  of  the  ground  wave  coverage  and  the  skip  distance.  When  the  ground  wave 
coverage  is  great  enough  or  the  skip  distance  is  short  enough  that  no  zone  of  silence  occurs,  there  is  no 
skip  zone. 

Occasionally,  the  first  sky  wave  will  return  to  Earth  within  the  range  of  the  ground  wave.  If  the  sky 
wave  and  ground  wave  are  nearly  of  equal  intensity,  the  sky  wave  alternately  reinforces  and  cancels  the 
ground  wave,  causing  severe  fading.  This  is  caused  by  the  phase  difference  between  the  two  waves,  a 
result  of  the  longer  path  traveled  by  the  sky  wave. 

PROPAGATION  PATHS 

The  path  that  a  refracted  wave  follows  to  the  receiver  depends  on  the  angle  at  which  the  wave  strikes 
the  ionosphere.  You  should  remember,  however,  that  the  rf  energy  radiated  by  a  transmitting  antenna 
spreads  out  with  distance.  The  energy  therefore  strikes  the  ionosphere  at  many  different  angles  rather  than 
a  single  angle. 

After  the  rf  energy  of  a  given  frequency  enters  an  ionospheric  region,  the  paths  that  this  energy 
might  follow  are  many.  It  may  reach  the  receiving  antenna  via  two  or  more  paths  through  a  single  layer.  It 


2-24 


may  also,  reach  the  receiving  antenna  over  a  path  involving  more  than  one  layer,  by  multiple  hops 
between  the  ionosphere  and  Earth,  or  by  any  combination  of  these  paths. 

Figure  2-20  shows  how  radio  waves  may  reach  a  receiver  via  several  paths  through  one  layer.  The 
various  angles  at  which  rf  energy  strikes  the  layer  are  represented  by  dark  lines  and  designated  as  rays  1 
through  6. 


Figure  2-20. — Ray  paths  for  a  fixed  frequency  with  varying  angles  of  incidence. 

When  the  angle  is  relatively  low  with  respect  to  the  horizon  (ray  1),  there  is  only  slight  penetration  of 
the  layer  and  the  propagation  path  is  long.  When  the  angle  of  incidence  is  increased  (rays  2  and  3),  the 
rays  penetrate  deeper  into  the  layer  but  the  range  of  these  rays  decreases.  When  a  certain  angle  is  reached 
(ray  3),  the  penetration  of  the  layer  and  rate  of  refraction  are  such  that  the  ray  is  first  returned  to  Earth  at  a 
minimal  distance  from  the  transmitter.  Notice,  however,  that  ray  3  still  manages  to  reach  the  receiving  site 
on  its  second  refraction  (called  a  hop)  from  the  ionospheric  layer. 

As  the  angle  is  increased  still  more  (rays  4  and  5),  the  rf  energy  penetrates  the  central  area  of 
maximum  ionization  of  the  layer.  These  rays  are  refracted  rather  slowly  and  are  eventually  returned  to 
Earth  at  great  distances.  As  the  angle  approaches  vertical  incidence  (ray  6),  the  ray  is  not  returned  at  all, 
but  passes  on  through  the  layer. 

ABSORPTION  IN  THE  IONOSPHERE 

Many  factors  affect  a  radio  wave  in  its  path  between  the  transmitting  and  receiving  sites.  The  factor 
that  has  the  greatest  adverse  effect  on  radio  waves  is  ABSORPTION.  Absorption  results  in  the  loss  of 
energy  of  a  radio  wave  and  has  a  pronounced  effect  on  both  the  strength  of  received  signals  and  the 
ability  to  communicate  over  long  distances. 

You  learned  earlier  in  the  section  on  ground  waves  that  surface  waves  suffer  most  of  their  absorption 
losses  because  of  ground-induced  voltage.  Sky  waves,  on  the  other  hand,  suffer  most  of  their  absorption 
losses  because  of  conditions  in  the  ionosphere.  Note  that  some  absorption  of  sky  waves  may  also  occur  at 
lower  atmospheric  levels  because  of  the  presence  of  water  and  water  vapor.  However,  this  becomes 
important  only  at  frequencies  above  10,000  megahertz. 


2-25 


Most  ionospheric  absorption  occurs  in  the  lower  regions  of  the  ionosphere  where  ionization  density 
is  greatest.  As  a  radio  wave  passes  into  the  ionosphere,  it  loses  some  of  its  energy  to  the  free  electrons  and 
ions.  If  these  high-energy  free  electrons  and  ions  do  not  collide  with  gas  molecules  of  low  energy,  most  of 
the  energy  lost  by  the  radio  wave  is  reconverted  into  electromagnetic  energy,  and  the  wave  continues  to 
be  propagated  with  little  change  in  intensity.  However,  if  the  high-energy  free  electrons  and  ions  do 
collide  with  other  particles,  much  of  this  energy  is  lost,  resulting  in  absorption  of  the  energy  from  the 
wave.  Since  absorption  of  energy  depends  on  collision  of  the  particles,  the  greater  the  density  of  the 
ionized  layer,  the  greater  the  probability  of  collisions;  therefore,  the  greater  the  absorption.  The  highly 
dense  D  and  E  layers  provide  the  greatest  absorption  of  radio  waves. 

Because  the  amount  of  absorption  of  the  sky  wave  depends  on  the  density  of  the  ionosphere,  which 
varies  with  seasonal  and  daily  conditions,  it  is  impossible  to  express  a  fixed  relationship  between  distance 
and  signal  strength  for  ionospheric  propagation.  Under  certain  conditions,  the  absorption  of  energy  is  so 
great  that  communicating  over  any  distance  beyond  the  line  of  sight  is  difficult. 

FADING 

The  most  troublesome  and  frustrating  problem  in  receiving  radio  signals  is  variations  in  signal 
strength,  most  commonly  known  as  FADING.  There  are  several  conditions  that  can  produce  fading. 
When  a  radio  wave  is  refracted  by  the  ionosphere  or  reflected  from  the  Earth's  surface,  random  changes  in 
the  polarization  of  the  wave  may  occur.  Vertically  and  horizontally  mounted  receiving  antennas  are 
designed  to  receive  vertically  and  horizontally  polarized  waves,  respectively.  Therefore,  changes  in 
polarization  cause  changes  in  the  received  signal  level  because  of  the  inability  of  the  antenna  to  receive 
polarization  changes. 

Fading  also  results  from  absorption  of  the  rf  energy  in  the  ionosphere.  Absorption  fading  occurs  for  a 
longer  period  than  other  types  of  fading,  since  absorption  takes  place  slowly. 

Usually,  however,  fading  on  ionospheric  circuits  is  mainly  a  result  of  multipath  propagation. 

Multipath  Fading 

MULTIPATH  is  simply  a  term  used  to  describe  the  multiple  paths  a  radio  wave  may  follow  between 
transmitter  and  receiver.  Such  propagation  paths  include  the  ground  wave,  ionospheric  refraction, 
reradiation  by  the  ionospheric  layers,  reflection  from  the  Earth's  surface  or  from  more  than  one 
ionospheric  layer,  etc.  Figure  2-2 1  shows  a  few  of  the  paths  that  a  signal  can  travel  between  two  sites  in  a 
typical  circuit.  One  path,  XYZ,  is  the  basic  ground  wave.  Another  path,  XEA,  refracts  the  wave  at  the  E 
layer  and  passes  it  on  to  the  receiver  at  A.  Still  another  path,  XFZFA,  results  from  a  greater  angle  of 
incidence  and  two  refractions  from  the  F  layer.  At  point  Z,  the  received  signal  is  a  combination  of  the 
ground  wave  and  the  sky  wave.  These  two  signals  having  traveled  different  paths  arrive  at  point  Z  at 
different  times.  Thus,  the  arriving  waves  may  or  may  not  be  in  phase  with  each  other.  Radio  waves  that 
are  received  in  phase  reinforce  each  other  and  produce  a  stronger  signal  at  the  receiving  site.  Conversely, 
those  that  are  received  out  of  phase  produce  a  weak  or  fading  signal.  Small  alternations  in  the 
transmission  path  may  change  the  phase  relationship  of  the  two  signals,  causing  periodic  fading.  This 
condition  occurs  at  point  A.  At  this  point,  the  double-hop  F  layer  signal  may  be  in  or  out  of  phase  with  the 
signal  arriving  from  the  E  layer. 


2-26 


Figure  2-21. — Multipath  transmission. 


Multipath  fading  may  be  minimized  by  practices  called  SPACE  DIVERSITY  and  FREQUENCY 
DIVERSITY.  In  space  diversity,  two  or  more  receiving  antennas  are  spaced  some  distance  apart.  Fading 
does  not  occur  simultaneously  at  both  antennas;  therefore,  enough  output  is  almost  always  available  from 
one  of  the  antennas  to  provide  a  useful  signal.  In  frequency  diversity,  two  transmitters  and  two  receivers 
are  used,  each  pair  tuned  to  a  different  frequency,  with  the  same  information  being  transmitted 
simultaneously  over  both  frequencies.  One  of  the  two  receivers  will  almost  always  provide  a  useful 
signal. 

Selective  Fading 

Fading  resulting  from  multipath  propagation  is  variable  with  frequency  since  each  frequency  arrives 
at  the  receiving  point  via  a  different  radio  path.  When  a  wide  band  of  frequencies  is  transmitted 
simultaneously,  each  frequency  will  vary  in  the  amount  of  fading.  This  variation  is  called  SELECTIVE 
FADING.  When  selective  fading  occurs,  all  frequencies  of  the  transmitted  signal  do  not  retain  their 
original  phases  and  relative  amplitudes.  This  fading  causes  severe  distortion  of  the  signal  and  limits  the 
total  signal  transmitted. 

Q23.   What  is  the  skip  zone  of  a  radio  wave? 

Q24.   Where  does  the  greatest  amount  of  ionospheric  absorption  occur  in  the  ionosphere? 
Q25.   What  is  meant  by  the  term  "multipath  "? 

Q26.   When  a  wide  band  of  frequencies  is  transmitted  simultaneously,  each  frequency  will  vary  in  the 
amount  of fading.  What  is  this  variable  fading  called? 

TRANSMISSION  LOSSES 

All  radio  waves  propagated  over  ionospheric  paths  undergo  energy  losses  before  arriving  at  the 
receiving  site.  As  we  discussed  earlier,  absorption  in  the  ionosphere  and  lower  atmospheric  levels  account 
for  a  large  part  of  these  energy  losses.  There  are  two  other  types  of  losses  that  also  significantly  affect  the 
ionospheric  propagation  of  radio  waves.  These  losses  are  known  as  ground  reflection  loss  and  free  space 
loss.  The  combined  effects  of  absorption,  ground  reflection  loss,  and  free  space  loss  account  for  most  of 
the  energy  losses  of  radio  transmissions  propagated  by  the  ionosphere. 


2-27 


Ground  Reflection  Loss 

When  propagation  is  accomplished  via  multihop  refraction,  rf  energy  is  lost  each  time  the  radio  wave 
is  reflected  from  the  Earth's  surface.  The  amount  of  energy  lost  depends  on  the  frequency  of  the  wave,  the 
angle  of  incidence,  ground  irregularities,  and  the  electrical  conductivity  of  the  point  of  reflection. 

Free  space  Loss 

Normally,  the  major  loss  of  energy  is  because  of  the  spreading  out  of  the  wave  front  as  it  travels  away 
from  the  transmitter.  As  the  distance  increases,  the  area  of  the  wavefront  spreads  out,  much  like  the  beam 
of  a  flashlight.  This  means  the  amount  of  energy  contained  within  any  unit  of  area  on  the  wavefront  will 
decrease  as  distance  increases.  By  the  time  the  energy  arrives  at  the  receiving  antenna,  the  wavefront  is  so 
spread  out  that  the  receiving  antenna  extends  into  only  a  very  small  fraction  of  the  wavefront.  This  is 
illustrated  in  figure  2-22. 


v/";  .  7      .     ONOSFHERE  -    .     .  " 


Figure  2-22. — Free  space  loss  principle. 


ELECTROMAGNETIC  INTERFERENCE  (EMI) 

The  transmission  losses  just  discussed  are  not  the  only  factors  that  interfere  with  communications. 
An  additional  factor  that  can  interfere  with  radio  communications  is  the  presence  of 
ELECTROMAGNETIC  INTERFERENCE  (EMI).  This  interference  can  result  in  annoying  or  impossible 
operating  conditions.  Sources  of  emi  are  both  man-made  and  natural. 

Man-Made  Interference 

Man-made  interference  may  come  from  several  sources.  Some  of  these  sources,  such  as  oscillators, 
communications  transmitters,  and  radio  transmitters,  may  be  specifically  designed  to  generate  radio 
frequency  energy.  Some  electrical  devices  also  generate  radio  frequency  energy,  although  they  are  not 
specifically  designed  for  this  purpose.  Examples  are  ignition  systems,  generators,  motors,  switches, 
relays,  and  voltage  regulators.  The  intensity  of  man-made  interference  may  vary  throughout  the  day  and 
drop  off  to  a  low  level  at  night  when  many  of  these  sources  are  not  being  used.  Man-made  interference 
may  be  a  critical  limiting  factor  at  radio  receiving  sites  located  near  industrial  areas. 


2-28 


Natural  Interference 

Natural  interference  refers  to  the  static  that  you  often  hear  when  listening  to  a  radio.  This 
interference  is  generated  by  natural  phenomena,  such  as  thunderstorms,  snowstorms,  cosmic  sources,  and 
the  sun.  The  energy  released  by  these  sources  is  transmitted  to  the  receiving  site  in  roughly  the  same 
manner  as  radio  waves.  As  a  result,  when  ionospheric  conditions  are  favorable  for  the  long  distance 
propagation  of  radio  waves,  they  are  likewise  favorable  for  the  propagation  of  natural  interference. 
Natural  interference  is  very  erratic,  particularly  in  the  hf  band,  but  generally  will  decrease  as  the  operating 
frequency  is  increased  and  wider  bandwidths  are  used.  There  is  little  natural  interference  above  30 
megahertz. 

Control  of  EMI 

Electromagnetic  interference  can  be  reduced  or  eliminated  by  using  various  suppression  techniques. 
The  amount  of  emi  that  is  produced  by  a  radio  transmitter  can  be  controlled  by  cutting  transmitting 
antennas  to  the  correct  frequency,  limiting  bandwidth,  and  using  electronic  filtering  networks  and  metallic 
shielding. 

Radiated  emi  during  transmission  can  be  controlled  by  the  physical  separation  of  the  transmitting 
and  receiving  antennas,  the  use  of  directional  antennas,  and  limiting  antenna  bandwidth. 

Q27.   What  are  the  two  main  sources  of  emi  with  which  radio  waves  must  compete? 

Q28.  Thunderstorms,  snowstorms,  cosmic  sources,  the  sun,  etc.,  are  a  few  examples  of  emi  sources. 
What  type  of  emi  comes  from  these  sources? 

Q29.  Motors,  switches,  voltage  regulators,  generators,  etc.,  are  a  few  examples  of  emi  sources.  What 
type  of  emi  comes  from  these  sources? 

Q30.   What  are  three  ways  of  controlling  the  amount  of  transmitter-generated  emi? 

Q31.   What  are  three  ways  of  controlling  radiated  emi  during  transmission? 

VARIATIONS  IN  THE  IONOSPHERE 

Because  the  existence  of  the  ionosphere  is  directly  related  to  radiations  emitted  from  the  sun,  the 
movement  of  the  Earth  about  the  sun  or  changes  in  the  sun's  activity  will  result  in  variations  in  the 
ionosphere.  These  variations  are  of  two  general  types:  (1)  those  which  are  more  or  less  regular  and  occur 
in  cycles  and,  therefore,  can  be  predicted  in  advance  with  reasonable  accuracy,  and  (2)  those  which  are 
irregular  as  a  result  of  abnormal  behavior  of  the  sun  and,  therefore,  cannot  be  predicted  in  advance.  Both 
regular  and  irregular  variations  have  important  effects  on  radio  wave  propagation. 

Regular  Variations 

The  regular  variations  that  affect  the  extent  of  ionization  in  the  ionosphere  can  be  divided  into  four 
main  classes:  daily,  seasonal,  1 1 -year,  and  27-day  variations. 

DAILY. — Daily  variations  in  the  ionosphere  are  a  result  of  the  24-hour  rotation  of  the  Earth  about 
its  axis.  Daily  variations  of  the  different  layers  (fig.  2-14)  are  summarized  as  follows: 

•   The  D  layer  reflects  vlf  waves;  is  important  for  long  range  vlf  communications;  refracts  If  and  mf 
waves  for  short  range  communications;  absorbs  hf  waves;  has  little  effect  on  vhf  and  above;  and 
disappears  at  night. 


2-29 


•  In  the  E  layer,  ionization  depends  on  the  angle  of  the  sun.  The  E  layer  refracts  hf  waves  during 
the  day  up  to  20  megahertz  to  distances  of  about  1200  miles.  Ionization  is  greatly  reduced  at 
night. 

•  Structure  and  density  of  the  F  region  depend  on  the  time  of  day  and  the  angle  of  the  sun.  This 
region  consists  of  one  layer  during  the  night  and  splits  into  two  layers  during  daylight  hours. 

•  Ionization  density  of  the  F 1  layer  depends  on  the  angle  of  the  sun.  Its  main  effect  is  to  absorb  hf 
waves  passing  through  to  the  F2  layer. 

•  The  F2  layer  is  the  most  important  layer  for  long  distance  hf  communications.  It  is  a  very  variable 
layer  and  its  height  and  density  change  with  time  of  day,  season,  and  sunspot  activity. 

SEASONAL. — Seasonal  variations  are  the  result  of  the  Earth  revolving  around  the  sun;  the  relative 
position  of  the  sun  moves  from  one  hemisphere  to  the  other  with  changes  in  seasons.  Seasonal  variations 
of  the  D,  E,  and  Fl  layers  correspond  to  the  highest  angle  of  the  sun;  thus  the  ionization  density  of  these 
layers  is  greatest  during  the  summer.  The  F2  layer,  however,  does  not  follow  this  pattern;  its  ionization  is 
greatest  in  winter  and  least  in  summer,  the  reverse  of  what  might  be  expected.  As  a  result,  operating 
frequencies  for  F2  layer  propagation  are  higher  in  the  winter  than  in  the  summer. 

ELEVEN-YEAR  SUN  SPOT  CYCLE.— One  of  the  most  notable  phenomena  on  the  surface  of  the 
sun  is  the  appearance  and  disappearance  of  dark,  irregularly  shaped  areas  known  as  SUNSPOTS.  The 
exact  nature  of  sunspots  is  not  known,  but  scientists  believe  they  are  caused  by  violent  eruptions  on  the 
sun  and  are  characterized  by  unusually  strong  magnetic  fields.  These  sunspots  are  responsible  for 
variations  in  the  ionization  level  of  the  ionosphere.  Sunspots  can,  of  course,  occur  unexpectedly,  and  the 
life  span  of  individual  sunspots  is  variable;  however,  a  regular  cycle  of  sunspot  activity  has  also  been 
observed.  This  cycle  has  both  a  minimum  and  maximum  level  of  sunspot  activity  that  occur 
approximately  every  1 1  years. 

During  periods  of  maximum  sunspot  activity,  the  ionization  density  of  all  layers  increases.  Because 
of  this,  absorption  in  the  D  layer  increases  and  the  critical  frequencies  for  the  E,  Fl,  and  F2  layers  are 
higher.  At  these  times,  higher  operating  frequencies  must  be  used  for  long  distance  communications. 

27-DAY  SUNSPOT  CYCLE. — The  number  of  sunspots  in  existence  at  any  one  time  is  continually 
subject  to  change  as  some  disappear  and  new  ones  emerge.  As  the  sun  rotates  on  its  own  axis,  these 
sunspots  are  visible  at  27-day  intervals,  the  approximate  period  required  for  the  sun  to  make  one  complete 
rotation. 

The  27-day  sunspot  cycle  causes  variations  in  the  ionization  density  of  the  layers  on  a  day-to-day 
basis.  The  fluctuations  in  the  F2  layer  are  greater  than  for  any  other  layer.  For  this  reason,  precise 
predictions  on  a  day-to-day  basis  of  the  critical  frequency  of  the  F2  layer  are  not  possible.  In  calculating 
frequencies  for  long-distance  communications,  allowances  for  the  fluctuations  of  the  F2  layer  must  be 
made. 

Irregular  Variations 

Irregular  variations  in  ionospheric  conditions  also  have  an  important  effect  on  radio  wave 
propagation.  Because  these  variations  are  irregular  and  unpredictable,  they  can  drastically  affect 
communications  capabilities  without  any  warning. 

The  more  common  irregular  variations  are  sporadic  E,  sudden  ionospheric  disturbances,  and 
ionospheric  storms. 


2-30 


SPORADIC  E. — Irregular  cloud-like  patches  of  unusually  high  ionization,  called  sporadic  E,  often 
form  at  heights  near  the  normal  E  layer.  Exactly  what  causes  this  phenomenon  is  not  known,  nor  can  its 
occurrence  be  predicted.  It  is  known  to  vary  significantly  with  latitude,  and  in  the  northern  latitudes,  it 
appears  to  be  closely  related  to  the  aurora  borealis  or  northern  lights. 

At  times  the  sporadic  E  is  so  thin  that  radio  waves  penetrate  it  easily  and  are  returned  to  earth  by  the 
upper  layers.  At  other  times,  it  extends  up  to  several  hundred  miles  and  is  heavily  ionized. 

These  characteristics  may  be  either  harmful  or  helpful  to  radio  wave  propagation.  For  example, 
sporadic  E  may  blank  out  the  use  of  higher,  more  favorable  ionospheric  layers  or  cause  additional 
absorption  of  the  radio  wave  at  some  frequencies.  Also,  it  can  cause  additional  multipath  problems  and 
delay  the  arrival  times  of  the  rays  of  rf  energy. 

On  the  other  hand,  the  critical  frequency  of  the  sporadic  E  is  very  high  and  can  be  greater  than 
double  the  critical  frequency  of  the  normal  ionospheric  layers.  This  condition  may  permit  the  long 
distance  transmission  of  signals  at  unusually  high  frequencies.  It  may  also  permit  short  distance 
communications  to  locations  that  would  normally  be  in  the  skip  zone. 

The  sporadic  E  can  form  and  disappear  in  a  short  time  during  either  the  day  or  night.  However,  it 
usually  does  not  occur  at  the  same  time  at  all  transmitting  or  receiving  stations. 

SUDDEN  IONOSPHERIC  DISTURBANCES.— The  most  startling  of  the  ionospheric 
irregularities  is  known  as  a  SUDDEN  IONOSPHERIC  DISTURBANCE  (sid).  These  disturbances  may 
occur  without  warning  and  may  prevail  for  any  length  of  time,  from  a  few  minutes  to  several  hours.  When 
sid  occurs,  long  distance  propagation  of  hf  radio  waves  is  almost  totally  "blanked  out."  The  immediate 
effect  is  that  radio  operators  listening  on  normal  frequencies  are  inclined  to  believe  their  receivers  have 
gone  dead. 

When  sid  has  occurred,  examination  of  the  sun  has  revealed  a  bright  solar  eruption.  All  stations  lying 
wholly,  or  in  part,  on  the  sunward  side  of  the  Earth  are  affected.  The  solar  eruption  produces  an  unusually 
intense  burst  of  ultraviolet  light,  which  is  not  absorbed  by  the  F2,  Fl,  and  E  layers,  but  instead  causes  a 
sudden  abnormal  increase  in  the  ionization  density  of  the  D  layer.  As  a  result,  frequencies  above  1  or  2 
megahertz  are  unable  to  penetrate  the  D  layer  and  are  usually  completely  absorbed  by  the  layer. 

IONOSPHERIC  STORMS. — Ionospheric  storms  are  disturbances  in  the  Earth's  magnetic  field. 
They  are  associated,  in  a  manner  not  fully  understood,  with  both  solar  eruptions  and  the  27-day  intervals, 
thus  corresponding  to  the  rotation  of  the  sun. 

Scientists  believe  that  ionospheric  storms  result  from  particle  radiation  from  the  sun.  Particles 
radiated  from  a  solar  eruption  have  a  slower  velocity  than  ultraviolet  light  waves  produced  by  the 
eruption.  This  would  account  for  the  18-hour  or  so  time  difference  between  a  sid  and  an  ionospheric 
storm.  An  ionospheric  storm  that  is  associated  with  sunspot  activity  may  begin  anytime  from  2  days 
before  an  active  sunspot  crosses  the  central  meridian  of  the  sun  until  four  days  after  it  passes  the  central 
meridian.  At  times,  however,  active  sunspots  have  crossed  the  central  region  of  the  sun  without  any 
ionospheric  storms  occurring.  Conversely,  ionospheric  storms  have  occurred  when  there  were  no  visible 
spots  on  the  sun  and  no  preceding  sid.  As  you  can  see,  some  correlation  between  ionospheric  storms,  sid, 
and  sunspot  activity  is  possible,  but  there  are  no  hard  and  fast  rules.  Ionospheric  storms  can  occur 
suddenly  without  warning. 

The  most  prominent  effects  of  ionospheric  storms  are  a  turbulent  ionosphere  and  very  erratic  sky 
wave  propagation.  Critical  frequencies  are  lower  than  normal,  particularly  for  the  F2  layer.  Ionospheric 
storms  affect  the  higher  F2  layer  first,  reducing  its  ion  density.  Lower  layers  are  not  appreciably  affected 
by  the  storms  unless  the  disturbance  is  great.  The  practical  effect  of  ionospheric  storms  is  that  the  range  of 


2-31 


frequencies  that  can  be  used  for  communications  on  a  given  circuit  is  much  smaller  than  normal,  and 
communications  are  possible  only  at  the  lower  working  frequencies. 

Q32.   What  are  the  two  general  types  of  variations  in  the  ionosphere? 

Q33.   What  is  the  main  difference  between  these  two  types  of  variations? 

Q34.   What  are  the  four  main  classes  of  regular  variation  which  affect  the  extent  of  ionization  in  the 
ionosphere? 

Q35.   What  are  the  three  more  common  types  of  irregular  variations  in  the  ionosphere? 

FREQUENCY  SELECTION  CONSIDERATIONS 

Up  to  this  point,  we  have  covered  various  factors  that  control  the  propagation  of  radio  waves  through 
the  ionosphere,  such  as  the  structure  of  the  ionosphere,  the  incidence  angle  of  radio  waves,  operating 
frequencies,  etc.  There  is  a  very  good  reason  for  studying  radio  wave  propagation.  You  must  have  a 
thorough  knowledge  of  radio  wave  propagation  to  exercise  good  judgment  when  you  select  transmitting 
and  receiving  antennas  and  operating  frequencies.  Selection  of  a  suitable  operating  frequency  (within  the 
bounds  of  frequency  allocations  and  availability)  is  of  prime  importance  in  maintaining  reliable 
communications. 

For  successful  communications  between  any  two  specified  locations  at  any  given  time  of  the  day, 
there  is  a  maximum  frequency,  a  lowest  frequency,  and  an  optimum  frequency  that  can  be  used. 

Maximum  Usable  Frequency 

As  we  discussed  earlier,  the  higher  the  frequency  of  a  radio  wave,  the  lower  the  rate  of  refraction  by 
an  ionized  layer.  Therefore,  for  a  given  angle  of  incidence  and  time  of  day,  there  is  a  maximum  frequency 
that  can  be  used  for  communications  between  two  given  locations.  This  frequency  is  known  as  the 
MAXIMUM  USABLE  FREQUENCY  (muf). 

Waves  at  frequencies  above  the  muf  are  normally  refracted  so  slowly  that  they  return  to  Earth 
beyond  the  desired  location,  or  pass  on  through  the  ionosphere  and  are  lost.  You  should  understand, 
however,  that  use  of  an  established  muf  certainly  does  not  guarantee  successful  communications  between 
a  transmitting  site  and  a  receiving  site.  Variations  in  the  ionosphere  may  occur  at  any  time  and 
consequently  raise  or  lower  the  predetermined  muf.  This  is  particularly  true  for  radio  waves  being 
refracted  by  the  highly  variable  F2  layer. 

The  muf  is  highest  around  noon  when  ultraviolet  light  waves  from  the  sun  are  the  most  intense.  It 
then  drops  rather  sharply  as  recombination  begins  to  take  place. 

Lowest  Usable  Frequency 

As  there  is  a  maximum  operating  frequency  that  can  be  used  for  communications  between  two 
points,  there  is  also  a  minimum  operating  frequency.  This  is  known  as  the  LOWEST  USABLE 
FREQUENCY  (luf). 

As  the  frequency  of  a  radio  wave  is  lowered,  the  rate  of  refraction  increases.  So  a  wave  whose 
frequency  is  below  the  established  luf  is  refracted  back  to  Earth  at  a  shorter  distance  than  desired,  as 
shown  in  figure  2-23. 


2-32 


":  v  .    'ionosphere  ^ 


Figure  2-23. — Refraction  of  frequency  below  the  lowest  usable  frequency  (luf). 

The  transmission  path  that  results  from  the  rate  of  refraction  is  not  the  only  factor  that  determines  the 
luf.  As  a  frequency  is  lowered,  absorption  of  the  radio  wave  increases.  A  wave  whose  frequency  is  too 
low  is  absorbed  to  such  an  extent  that  it  is  too  weak  for  reception.  Likewise,  atmospheric  noise  is  greater 
at  lower  frequencies;  thus,  a  low-frequency  radio  wave  may  have  an  unacceptable  signal-to-noise  ratio. 

For  a  given  angle  of  incidence  and  set  of  ionospheric  conditions,  the  luf  for  successful 
communications  between  two  locations  depends  on  the  refraction  properties  of  the  ionosphere,  absorption 
considerations,  and  the  amount  of  atmospheric  noise  present. 

Optimum  Working  Frequency 

Neither  the  muf  nor  the  luf  is  a  practical  operating  frequency.  While  radio  waves  at  the  luf  can  be 
refracted  back  to  Earth  at  the  desired  location,  the  signal-to-noise  ratio  is  still  much  lower  than  at  the 
higher  frequencies,  and  the  probability  of  multipath  propagation  is  much  greater.  Operating  at  or  near  the 
muf  can  result  in  frequent  signal  fading  and  dropouts  when  ionospheric  variations  alter  the  length  of  the 
transmission  path. 

The  most  practical  operating  frequency  is  one  that  you  can  rely  on  with  the  least  amount  of 
problems.  It  should  be  high  enough  to  avoid  the  problems  of  multipath,  absorption,  and  noise  encountered 
at  the  lower  frequencies;  but  not  so  high  as  to  result  in  the  adverse  effects  of  rapid  changes  in  the 
ionosphere. 

A  frequency  that  meets  the  above  criteria  has  been  established  and  is  known  as  the  OPTIMUM 
WORKING  FREQUENCY.  It  is  abbreviated  "fot"  from  the  initial  letters  of  the  French  words  for 
optimum  working  frequency,  "frequence  optimum  de  travail."  The  fot  is  roughly  about  85  percent  of  the 
muf  but  the  actual  percentage  varies  and  may  be  either  considerably  more  or  less  than  85  percent. 

Q36.   What  do  the  letters  muf,  luf,  and  fot  stand  for? 

Q37.   When  is  muf  at  its  highest  and  why? 

Q38.   What  happens  to  the  radio  wave  if  the  luf  is  too  low? 


2-33 


Q39.   What  are  some  disadvantages  of  operating  transmitters  at  or  near  the  luf? 
Q40.   What  are  some  disadvantages  of  operating  a  transmitter  at  or  near  the  muf? 
Q41.   What  is  fat? 

WEATHER  VERSUS  PROPAGATION 

Weather  is  an  additional  factor  that  affects  the  propagation  of  radio  waves.  In  this  section,  we  will 
explain  how  and  to  what  extent  the  various  weather  phenomena  affect  wave  propagation. 

Wind,  air  temperature,  and  water  content  of  the  atmosphere  can  combine  in  many  ways.  Certain 
combinations  can  cause  radio  signals  to  be  heard  hundreds  of  miles  beyond  the  ordinary  range  of  radio 
communications.  Conversely,  a  different  combination  of  factors  can  cause  such  attenuation  of  the  signal 
that  it  may  not  be  heard  even  over  a  normally  satisfactory  path.  Unfortunately,  there  are  no  hard  and  fast 
rules  on  the  effects  of  weather  on  radio  transmissions  since  the  weather  is  extremely  complex  and  subject 
to  frequent  change.  We  will,  therefore,  limit  our  discussion  on  the  effects  of  weather  on  radio  waves  to 
general  terms. 

PRECIPITATION  ATTENUATION 

Calculating  the  effect  of  weather  on  radio  wave  propagation  would  be  comparatively  simple  if  there 
were  no  water  or  water  vapor  in  the  atmosphere.  However,  some  form  of  water  (vapor,  liquid,  or  solid)  is 
always  present  and  must  be  considered  in  all  calculations.  Before  we  begin  discussing  the  specific  effects 
that  individual  forms  of  precipitation  (rain,  snow,  fog)  have  on  radio  waves,  you  should  understand  that 
attenuation  because  of  precipitation  is  generally  proportionate  to  the  frequency  and  wavelength  of  the 
radio  wave.  For  example,  rain  has  a  pronounced  effect  on  waves  at  microwave  frequencies.  However,  rain 
hardly  affects  waves  with  long  wavelengths  (hf  range  and  below).  You  can  assume,  then,  that  as  the 
wavelength  becomes  shorter  with  increases  in  frequency,  precipitation  has  an  increasingly  important 
attenuation  effect  on  radio  waves.  Conversely,  you  can  assume  that  as  the  wavelength  becomes  longer 
with  decreases  in  frequency,  precipitation  has  little  attenuation  effect. 

Rain 

Attenuation  because  of  raindrops  is  greater  than  attenuation  because  of  other  forms  of  precipitation. 
Attenuation  may  be  caused  by  absorption,  in  which  the  raindrop,  acting  as  a  poor  dielectric,  absorbs 
power  from  the  radio  wave  and  dissipates  the  power  by  heat  loss  or  by  scattering  (fig.  2-24).  Raindrops 
cause  greater  attenuation  by  scattering  than  by  absorption  at  frequencies  above  1 00  megahertz.  At 
frequencies  above  6  gigahertz,  attenuation  by  raindrop  scatter  is  even  greater. 


2-34 


Fog 

In  the  discussion  of  attenuation,  fog  may  be  considered  as  another  form  of  rain.  Since  fog  remains 
suspended  in  the  atmosphere,  the  attenuation  is  determined  by  the  quantity  of  water  per  unit  volume  and 
by  the  size  of  the  droplets.  Attenuation  because  of  fog  is  of  minor  importance  at  frequencies  lower  than  2 
gigahertz.  However,  fog  can  cause  serious  attenuation  by  absorption,  at  frequencies  above  2  gigahertz. 

Snow 

The  scattering  effect  because  of  snow  is  difficult  to  compute  because  of  irregular  sizes  and  shapes  of 
the  flakes.  While  information  on  the  attenuating  effect  of  snow  is  limited,  scientists  assume  that 
attenuation  from  snow  is  less  than  from  rain  falling  at  an  equal  rate.  This  assumption  is  borne  out  by  the 
fact  that  the  density  of  rain  is  eight  times  the  density  of  snow.  As  a  result,  rain  falling  at  1  inch  per  hour 
would  have  more  water  per  cubic  inch  than  snow  falling  at  the  same  rate. 

Hail 

Attenuation  by  hail  is  determined  by  the  size  of  the  stones  and  their  density.  Attenuation  of  radio 
waves  by  scattering  because  of  hailstones  is  considerably  less  than  by  rain. 

TEMPERATURE  INVERSION 

Under  normal  atmospheric  conditions,  the  warmest  air  is  found  near  the  surface  of  the  Earth.  The  air 
gradually  becomes  cooler  as  altitude  increases.  At  times,  however,  an  unusual  situation  develops  in  which 
layers  of  warm  air  are  formed  above  layers  of  cool  air.  This  condition  is  known  as  TEMPERATURE 
INVERSION.  These  temperature  inversions  cause  channels,  or  ducts,  of  cool  air  to  be  sandwiched 
between  the  surface  of  the  Earth  and  a  layer  of  warm  air,  or  between  two  layers  of  warm  air. 

If  a  transmitting  antenna  extends  into  such  a  duct  of  cool  air,  or  if  the  radio  wave  enters  the  duct  at  a 
very  low  angle  of  incidence,  vhf  and  uhf  transmissions  may  be  propagated  far  beyond  normal 
line-of-sight  distances.  When  ducts  are  present  as  a  result  of  temperature  inversions,  good  reception  of 
vhf  and  uhf  television  signals  from  a  station  located  hundreds  of  miles  away  is  not  unusual.  These  long 


2-35 


distances  are  possible  because  of  the  different  densities  and  refractive  qualities  of  warm  and  cool  air.  The 
sudden  change  in  density  when  a  radio  wave  enters  the  warm  air  above  a  duct  causes  the  wave  to  be 
refracted  back  toward  Earth.  When  the  wave  strikes  the  Earth  or  a  warm  layer  below  the  duct,  it  is  again 
reflected  or  refracted  upward  and  proceeds  on  through  the  duct  with  a  multiple-hop  type  of  action.  An 
example  of  the  propagation  of  radio  waves  by  ducting  is  shown  in  figure  2-25. 


Figure  2-25. — Duct  effect  caused  by  temperature  inversion. 


Q42.  How  do  raindrops  affect  radio  waves? 

Q43.  How  does  fog  affect  radio  waves  at  frequencies  above  2  gigahertz? 

Q44.  How  is  the  term  "temperature  inversion"  used  when  referring  to  radio  waves? 

Q45.  How  does  temperature  inversion  affect  radio  transmission? 

TROPOSPHERIC  PROPAGATION 

As  the  lowest  region  of  the  Earth's  atmosphere,  the  troposphere  extends  from  the  Earth's  surface  to  a 
height  of  slightly  over  7  miles.  Virtually  all  weather  phenomena  occur  in  this  region.  Generally,  the 
troposphere  is  characterized  by  a  steady  decrease  in  both  temperature  and  pressure  as  height  is  increased. 
However,  the  many  changes  in  weather  phenomena  cause  variations  in  humidity  and  an  uneven  heating  of 
the  Earth's  surface.  As  a  result,  the  air  in  the  troposphere  is  in  constant  motion.  This  motion  causes  small 
turbulences,  or  eddies,  to  be  formed,  as  shown  by  the  bouncing  of  aircraft  entering  turbulent  areas  of  the 
atmosphere.  These  turbulences  are  most  intense  near  the  Earth's  surface  and  gradually  diminish  with 
height.  They  have  a  refractive  quality  that  permits  the  refracting  or  scattering  of  radio  waves  with  short 
wavelengths.  This  scattering  provides  enhanced  communications  at  higher  frequencies. 

Recall  that  in  the  relationship  between  frequency  and  wavelength,  wavelength  decreases  as 
frequency  increases  and  vice  versa.  Radio  waves  of  frequencies  below  30  megahertz  normally  have 
wavelengths  longer  than  the  size  of  weather  turbulences.  These  radio  waves  are,  therefore,  affected  very 
little  by  the  turbulences.  On  the  other  hand,  as  the  frequency  increases  into  the  vhf  range  and  above,  the 
wavelengths  decrease  in  size,  to  the  point  that  they  become  subject  to  tropospheric  scattering.  The  usable 
frequency  range  for  tropospheric  scattering  is  from  about  100  megahertz  to  10  gigahertz. 


2-36 


TROPOSPHERIC  SCATTERING 


When  a  radio  wave  passing  through  the  troposphere  meets  a  turbulence,  it  makes  an  abrupt  change  in 
velocity.  This  causes  a  small  amount  of  the  energy  to  be  scattered  in  a  forward  direction  and  returned  to 
Earth  at  distances  beyond  the  horizon.  This  phenomenon  is  repeated  as  the  radio  wave  meets  other 
turbulences  in  its  path.  The  total  received  signal  is  an  accumulation  of  the  energy  received  from  each  of 
the  turbulences. 

This  scattering  mode  of  propagation  enables  vhf  and  uhf  signals  to  be  transmitted  far  beyond  the 
normal  line-of-sight.  To  better  understand  how  these  signals  are  transmitted  over  greater  distances,  you 
must  first  consider  the  propagation  characteristics  of  the  space  wave  used  in  vhf  and  uhf  line-of-sight 
communications.  When  the  space  wave  is  transmitted,  it  undergoes  very  little  attenuation  within  the 
line-of-sight  horizon.  When  it  reaches  the  horizon,  the  wave  is  diffracted  and  follows  the  Earth's 
curvature.  Beyond  the  horizon,  the  rate  of  attenuation  increases  very  rapidly  and  signals  soon  become 
very  weak  and  unusable. 

Tropospheric  scattering,  on  the  other  hand,  provides  a  usable  signal  at  distances  beyond  the  point 
where  the  diffracted  space  wave  drops  to  an  unusable  level.  This  is  because  of  the  height  at  which 
scattering  takes  place.  The  turbulence  that  causes  the  scattering  can  be  visualized  as  a  relay  station  located 
above  the  horizon;  it  receives  the  transmitted  energy  and  then  reradiates  it  in  a  forward  direction  to  some 
point  beyond  the  line-of-sight  distance.  A  high  gain  receiving  antenna  aimed  toward  this  scattered  energy 
can  then  capture  it. 

The  magnitude  of  the  received  signal  depends  on  the  number  of  turbulences  causing  scatter  in  the 
desired  direction  and  the  gain  of  the  receiving  antenna.  The  scatter  area  used  for  tropospheric  scatter  is 
known  as  the  scatter  volume.  The  angle  at  which  the  receiving  antenna  must  be  aimed  to  capture  the 
scattered  energy  is  called  the  scatter  angle.  The  scatter  volume  and  scatter  angle  are  shown  in  figure  2-26. 


Figure  2-26. — Tropospheric  scattering  propagation. 


The  signal  take-off  angle  (transmitting  antenna's  angle  of  radiation)  determines  the  height  of  the 
scatter  volume  and  the  size  of  the  scatter  angle.  A  low  signal  take-off  angle  produces  a  low  scatter 
volume,  which  in  turn  permits  a  receiving  antenna  that  is  aimed  at  a  low  angle  to  the  scatter  volume  to 
capture  the  scattered  energy. 

As  the  signal  take-off  angle  is  increased,  the  height  of  the  scatter  volume  is  increased.  When  this 
occurs,  the  amount  of  received  energy  decreases.  There  are  two  reasons  for  this:  (1)  scatter  angle 


2-37 


increases  as  the  height  of  the  scatter  volume  is  increased;  (2)  the  amount  of  turbulence  decreases  with 
height.  As  the  distance  between  the  transmitting  and  receiving  antennas  is  increased,  the  height  of  the 
scatter  volume  must  also  be  increased.  The  received  signal  level,  therefore,  decreases  as  circuit  distance  is 
increased. 

The  tropospheric  region  that  contributes  most  strongly  to  tropospheric  scatter  propagation  lies  near 
the  midpoint  between  the  transmitting  and  receiving  antennas  and  just  above  the  radio  horizon  of  the 
antennas. 

Since  tropospheric  scatter  depends  on  turbulence  in  the  atmosphere,  changes  in  atmospheric 
conditions  have  an  effect  on  the  strength  of  the  received  signal.  Both  daily  and  seasonal  variations  in 
signal  strength  occur  as  a  result  of  changes  in  the  atmosphere.  These  variations  are  called  long-term 
fading. 

In  addition  to  long-term  fading,  the  tropospheric  scatter  signal  often  is  characterized  by  very  rapid 
fading  because  of  multipath  propagation.  Since  the  turbulent  condition  is  constantly  changing,  the  path 
lengths  and  individual  signal  levels  are  also  changing,  resulting  in  a  rapidly  changing  signal.  Although  the 
signal  level  of  the  received  signal  is  constantly  changing,  the  average  signal  level  is  stable;  therefore,  no 
complete  fade  out  occurs. 

Another  characteristic  of  a  tropospheric  scatter  signal  is  its  relatively  low  power  level.  Since  very 
little  of  the  scattered  energy  is  reradiated  toward  the  receiver,  the  efficiency  is  very  low  and  the  signal 
level  at  the  final  receiver  point  is  low.  Initial  input  power  must  be  high  to  compensate  for  the  low 
efficiency  in  the  scatter  volume.  This  is  accomplished  by  using  high-power  transmitters  and  high-gain 
antennas,  which  concentrate  the  transmitted  power  into  a  beam,  thus  increasing  the  intensity  of  energy  of 
each  turbulence  in  the  volume.  The  receiver  must  also  be  very  sensitive  to  detect  the  low-level  signals. 

APPLICATION  OF  TROPOSPHERIC  SCATTERING 

Tropospheric  scatter  propagation  is  used  for  point-to-point  communications.  A  correctly  designed 
tropospheric  scatter  circuit  will  provide  highly  reliable  service  for  distances  ranging  from  50  miles  to  500 
miles.  Tropospheric  scatter  systems  may  be  particularly  useful  for  communications  to  locations  in  rugged 
terrain  that  are  difficult  to  reach  with  other  methods  of  propagation.  One  reason  for  this  is  that  the 
tropospheric  scatter  circuit  is  not  affected  by  ionospheric  and  auroral  disturbances. 

Q46.  In  what  layer  of  the  atmosphere  does  virtually  all  weather  phenomena  occur? 

Q47.   Which  radio  frequency  bands  use  the  tropospheric  scattering  principle  for  propagation  of  radio 
waves? 

Q48.   Where  is  the  tropospheric  region  that  contributes  most  strongly  to  tropospheric  scatter 
propagation? 


SUMMARY 

Now  that  you  have  completed  this  chapter,  let's  review  some  of  the  new  terms,  concepts,  and  ideas 
that  you  have  learned.  You  should  have  a  thorough  understanding  of  these  principles  before  moving  on  to 
chapter  3. 

The  INDUCTION  FIELD  contains  an  E  field  and  an  H  field  and  is  localized  near  the  antenna.  The 
E  and  H  fields  of  the  induction  field  are  90  degrees  out  of  phase  with  each  other. 


2-38 


The  RADIATION  FIELD  contains  E  and  H  fields  that  are  propagated  from  the  antenna  into  space 
in  the  form  of  electromagnetic  waves.  The  E  and  H  fields  of  the  radiation  field  are  in  phase  with  each 
other. 

A  HARMONIC  FREQUENCY  is  any  frequency  that  is  a  whole  number  multiple  of  a  smaller  basic 
frequency.  For  example,  a  radio  wave  transmitted  at  a  fundamental  frequency  of  3000  hertz  can  have  a 
second  harmonic  of  6000  hertz,  a  third  harmonic  frequency  of  9000  hertz,  etc.,  transmitted  at  the  same 
time. 

A  VERTICALLY  POLARIZED  antenna  transmits  an  electromagnetic  wave  with  the  E  field 
perpendicular  to  the  Earth's  surface.  A  HORIZONTALLY  POLARIZED  antenna  transmits  a  radio 
wave  with  the  E  field  parallel  to  the  Earth's  surface. 


ELECTRIC  LINES  MAGNETIC  LINES 


A  WAVEFRONT  is  a  small  section  of  an  expanding  sphere  of  radiated  energy  and  is  perpendicular 
to  the  direction  of  travel  from  the  antenna. 

RADIO  WAVES  are  electromagnetic  waves  that  can  be  reflected,  refracted,  and  diffracted  in  the 
atmosphere  like  light  and  heat  waves. 

REFLECTED  RADIO  WAVES  are  waves  that  have  been  reflected  from  a  surface  and  are  180 
degrees  out  of  phase  with  the  initial  wave. 


2-39 


EARTH'S  SURFACE 


The  Earth's  atmosphere  is  divided  into  three  separate  layers:  The  TROPOSPHERE, 
STRATOSPHERE,  and  IONOSPHERE. 

The  TROPOSPHERE  is  the  region  of  the  atmosphere  where  virtually  all  weather  phenomena  take 
place.  In  this  region,  rf  energy  is  greatly  affected. 

The  STRATOSPHERE  has  a  constant  temperature  and  has  little  effect  on  radio  waves. 

The  IONOSPHERE  contains  four  cloud-like  layers  of  electrically  charged  ions  which  aid  in  long 
distance  communications. 

GROUND  WAVES  and  SKY  WAVES  are  the  two  basic  types  of  radio  waves  that  transmit  energy 
from  the  transmitting  antenna  to  the  receiving  antenna. 


GROUND  WAVES  are  composed  of  two  separate  component  waves:  the  SURFACE  WAVE  and 
the  SPACE  WAVE. 


2-40 


SURFACE  WAVES  travel  along  the  contour  of  the  Earth  by  diffraction. 


SPACE  WAVES  can  travel  through  the  air  directly  to  the  receiving  antenna  or  can  be  reflected  from 
the  surface  of  the  Earth. 


SKY  WAVES,  often  called  ionospheric  waves,  are  radiated  in  an  upward  direction  and  returned  to 
Earth  at  some  distant  location  because  of  refraction. 

NATURAL  HORIZON  is  the  line-of-sight  horizon. 

RADIO  HORIZON  is  one-third  farther  than  the  natural  horizon. 

The  IONOSPHERE  consists  of  several  layers  of  ions,  formed  by  the  process  called  ionization. 

IONIZATION  is  the  process  of  knocking  electrons  free  from  their  parent  atom,  thus  upsetting 
electrical  neutrality. 

RECOMBINATION  is  the  opposite  of  ionization;  that  is,  the  free  ions  combine  with  positive  ions, 
causing  the  positive  ions  to  return  to  their  original  neutral  atom  state. 


2-41 


The  D  LAYER  is  the  lowest  region  of  the  ionosphere  and  refracts  signals  of  low  frequencies  back  to 
Earth. 

The  E  LAYER  is  present  during  the  daylight  hours;  refracts  signals  as  high  as  20  megahertz  back  to 
Earth;  and  is  used  for  communications  up  to  1 500  miles. 


The  F  LAYER  is  divided  into  the  Fl  and  F2  layers  during  the  day  but  combine  at  night  to  form  one 
layer.  This  layer  is  responsible  for  high-frequency,  long-range  transmission. 

The  CRITICAL  FREQUENCY  is  the  maximum  frequency  that  a  radio  wave  can  be  transmitted 
vertically  and  still  be  refracted  back  to  Earth. 


The  CRITICAL  ANGLE  is  the  maximum  and/or  minimum  angle  that  a  radio  wave  can  be 
transmitted  and  still  be  refracted  back  to  Earth. 


2-42 


SMHsVAVE 
^  NOT  REFRACTED 


IONOSPHERE  ....<.■■■'■-■■ 


SKIP  DISTANCE  is  the  distance  between  the  transmitter  and  the  point  where  the  sky  wave  first 
returns  to  Earth. 

SKIP  ZONE  is  the  zone  of  silence  between  the  point  where  the  ground  wave  becomes  too  weak  for 
reception  and  the  point  where  the  sky  wave  is  first  returned  to  Earth. 


FADING  is  caused  by  variations  in  signal  strength,  such  as  absorption  of  the  rf  energy  by  the 
ionosphere. 


2-43 


MULTIPATH  FADING  occurs  when  a  transmitted  signal  divides  and  takes  more  than  one  path  to  a 
receiver  and  some  of  the  signals  arrive  out  of  phase,  resulting  in  a  weak  or  fading  signal. 


Some  TRANSMISSION  LOSSES  that  affect  radio-wave  propagation  are  ionospheric  absorption, 
ground  reflection,  and  free-space  losses. 

ELECTROMAGNETIC  INTERFERENCE  (emi),  both  natural  and  man-made,  interfere  with 
radio  communications. 

The  MAXIMUM  USABLE  FREQUENCY  (muf)  is  the  highest  frequency  that  can  be  used  for 
communications  between  two  locations  at  a  given  angle  of  incidence  and  time  of  day. 

The  LOWEST  USABLE  FREQUENCY  (luf)  is  the  lowest  frequency  that  can  be  used  for 
communications  between  two  locations. 


IONOSPHERE      :'V\  Y; 


2-44 


OPTIMUM  WORKING  FREQUENCY  (fot)  is  the  most  practical  operating  frequency  and  the  one 
that  can  be  relied  on  to  have  the  fewest  problems. 

PRECIPITATION  ATTENUATION  can  be  caused  by  rain,  fog,  snow,  and  hail;  and  can  affect 
overall  communications  considerably. 

TEMPERATURE  INVERSION  causes  channels,  or  ducts,  of  cool  air  to  form  between  layers  of 
warm  air,  which  can  cause  radio  waves  to  travel  far  beyond  the  normal  line-of-sight  distances. 


TROPOSPHERIC  PROPAGATION  uses  the  scattering  principle  to  achieve  beyond  the 
line-of-sight  radio  communications  within  the  troposphere. 


2-45 


ANSWERS  TO  QUESTIONS  Ql.  THROUGH  Q48. 

Al.  Induction  field  and  radiation  field. 

A2.  Induction  field. 

A3.  Radiation  field. 

A4.  Fundamental  frequency. 

A5.  Harmonic  frequency  or  harmonics. 

A6.  30  meters. 

A7.  5  megahertz. 

A8.  Vertically  polarized. 

A9.  Direction  of  wave  propagation. 

A 10.  Shifting  in  the  phase  relationships  of  the  wave. 

All.  Troposphere,  stratosphere,  and  ionosphere. 

All.  Stratosphere. 

A13.  Whether  the  component  of  the  wave  is  travelling  along  the  surface  or  over  the  surface  of  the  earth. 

A14.  Radio  horizon  is  about  1/3  farther. 

A15.  Sea  water. 

A16.  (a)  electrical  properties  of  the  terrain  (b)  frequency  (c)  polarization  of  the  antenna 

A 17.  High  energy  ultraviolet  light  waves  from  the  sun. 

A18.  D,  E,  F1}  and  F2  layers. 

A19.  D  layer  is  30-55  miles,  E  layer  55-90  miles,  and  F  layers  are  90-240  miles. 

A20.  Thickness  of  ionized  layer. 

A21.  Critical  frequency. 

A22.  (a)  density  of  ionization  of  the  layer  (b)  frequency  (c)  angle  at  which  it  enters  the  layer 

A23.  A  zone  of  silence  between  the  ground  wave  and  sky  wave  where  there  is  no  reception. 

A24.  Where  ionization  density  is  greatest. 

A25.  A  term  used  to  describe  the  multiple  pattern  a  radio  wave  may  follow. 

A26.  Selective  fading. 

A27.  Natural  and  man-made  interference. 


2-46 


A28.  Natural. 
A29.  Man-made. 

A30.  (a)  filtering  and  shielding  of  the  transmitter  (b)  limiting  bandwidth  (c)  cutting  the  antenna  to  the 
correct  frequency 

A31.   (a)  physical  separation  of  the  antenna  (b)  limiting  bandwidth  of  the  antenna  (c)  use  of  directional 
antennas 

A32.  Regular  and  irregular  variations. 

A33.  Regular  variations  can  be  predicted  but  irregular  variations  are  unpredictable. 

A34.  Daily,  seasonal,  11-year,  and  27-days  variation. 

A35.  Sporadic  E,  sudden  disturbances,  and  ionospheric  storms. 

A36.  Muf  is  maximum  usable  frequency.  Luf  is  lowest  usable  frequency.  Fot  is  commonly  known  as 
optimum  working  frequency. 

A3  7.  Muf  is  highest  around  noon.  Ultraviolet  light  waves  from  the  sun  are  most  intense. 

A38.   When  luf  is  too  low  it  is  absorbed  and  is  too  weak  for  reception. 

A39.  Signal-to-noise  ratio  is  low  and  the  probability  of  multipath  propagation  is  greater. 

A40.  Frequent  signal  fading  and  dropouts. 

A41.  Fot  is  the  most  practical  operating  frequency  that  can  be  relied  on  to  avoid  problems  of  multipath, 
absorbtion,  and  noise. 

A42.  They  can  cause  attenuation  by  scattering. 

A43.  It  can  cause  attenuation  by  absorbtion. 

A44.  It  is  a  condition  where  layers  of  warm  air  are  formed  above  layers  of  cool  air. 

A45.  It  can  cause  vhf  and  uhf  transmission  to  be  propagated  far  beyond  normal  line-of-sight  distances. 

A46.  Troposphere. 

A47.  Vhf  and  above. 

A48.  Near  the  mid-point  between  the  transmitting  and  receiving  antennas,  just  above  the  radio  horizon. 


2-47 


CHAPTER  3 

PRINCIPLES  OF  TRANSMISSION  LINES 


LEARNING  OBJECTIVES 

Upon  completion  of  this  chapter,  you  will  be  able  to: 

1.  State  what  a  transmission  line  is  and  how  transmission  lines  are  used. 

2.  Explain  the  operating  principles  of  transmission  lines. 

3.  Describe  the  five  types  of  transmission  lines. 

4.  State  the  length  of  a  transmission  line. 

5.  Explain  the  theory  of  the  transmission  line. 

6.  Define  the  term  LUMPED  CONSTANTS  in  relation  to  a  transmission  line. 

7.  Define  the  term  DISTRIBUTED  CONSTANTS  in  relation  to  a  transmission  line. 

8.  Define  LEAKAGE  CURRENT. 

9.  Describe  how  the  electromagnetic  lines  of  force  around  a  transmission  line  are  affected  by  the 
distributed  constants. 

10.  Define  the  term  CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE  and  explain  how  it  affects  the  transfer  of 
energy  along  a  transmission  line. 

11.  State  how  the  energy  transfer  along  a  transmission  line  is  affected  by  characteristic  impedance  and 
the  infinite  line. 

12.  Identify  the  cause  of  and  describe  the  characteristics  of  reflections  on  a  transmission  line. 

13.  Define  the  term  STANDING  WAVES  as  applied  to  a  transmission  line. 

14.  Describe  how  standing  waves  are  produced  on  a  transmission  line  and  identify  the  types  of 
terminations. 

15.  Describe  the  types  of  standing-wave  ratios. 

INTRODUCTION  TO  TRANSMISSION  LINES 

A  TRANSMISSION  LINE  is  a  device  designed  to  guide  electrical  energy  from  one  point  to  another. 
It  is  used,  for  example,  to  transfer  the  output  rf  energy  of  a  transmitter  to  an  antenna.  This  energy  will  not 
travel  through  normal  electrical  wire  without  great  losses.  Although  the  antenna  can  be  connected  directly 
to  the  transmitter,  the  antenna  is  usually  located  some  distance  away  from  the  transmitter.  On  board  ship, 


3-1 


the  transmitter  is  located  inside  a  radio  room  and  its  associated  antenna  is  mounted  on  a  mast.  A 
transmission  line  is  used  to  connect  the  transmitter  and  the  antenna. 

The  transmission  line  has  a  single  purpose  for  both  the  transmitter  and  the  antenna.  This  purpose  is 
to  transfer  the  energy  output  of  the  transmitter  to  the  antenna  with  the  least  possible  power  loss.  How  well 
this  is  done  depends  on  the  special  physical  and  electrical  characteristics  (impedance  and  resistance)  of 
the  transmission  line. 


TERMINOLOGY 


All  transmission  lines  have  two  ends  (see  figure  3-1).  The  end  of  a  two-wire  transmission  line 
connected  to  a  source  is  ordinarily  called  the  INPUT  END  or  the  GENERATOR  END.  Other  names 
given  to  this  end  are  TRANSMITTER  END,  SENDING  END,  and  SOURCE.  The  other  end  of  the  line  is 
called  the  OUTPUT  END  or  RECEIVING  END.  Other  names  given  to  the  output  end  are  LOAD  END 
and  SINK. 


Figure  3-1. — Basic  transmission  line. 

You  can  describe  a  transmission  line  in  terms  of  its  impedance.  The  ratio  of  voltage  to  current 
(Ein/Iin)  at  the  input  end  is  known  as  the  INPUT  IMPEDANCE  (Zin).  This  is  the  impedance  presented  to 
the  transmitter  by  the  transmission  line  and  its  load,  the  antenna.  The  ratio  of  voltage  to  current  at  the 
output  (Eout/Iout)  end  is  known  as  the  OUTPUT  IMPEDANCE  (Zout).  This  is  the  impedance  presented  to 
the  load  by  the  transmission  line  and  its  source.  If  an  infinitely  long  transmission  line  could  be  used,  the 
ratio  of  voltage  to  current  at  any  point  on  that  transmission  line  would  be  some  particular  value  of 
impedance.  This  impedance  is  known  as  the  CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE. 

Ql.   What  connecting  link  is  used  to  transfer  energy  from  a  radio  transmitter  to  its  antenna  located  on 
the  mast  of  a  ship? 

Q2.   What  term  is  used  for  the  end  of  the  transmission  line  that  is  connected  to  a  transmitter? 

Q3.   What  term  is  used  for  the  end  of  the  transmission  line  that  is  connected  to  an  antenna? 

TYPES  OF  TRANSMISSION  MEDIUMS 

The  Navy  uses  many  different  types  of  TRANSMISSION  MEDIUMS  in  its  electronic  applications. 
Each  medium  (line  or  wave  guide)  has  a  certain  characteristic  impedance  value,  current-carrying  capacity, 
and  physical  shape  and  is  designed  to  meet  a  particular  requirement. 


3-2 


The  five  types  of  transmission  mediums  that  we  will  discuss  in  this  chapter  include 
PARALLEL-LINE,  TWISTED  PAIR,  SHIELDED  PAIR,  COAXIAL  LINE,  and  WAVEGUIDES.  The 
use  of  a  particular  line  depends,  among  other  things,  on  the  applied  frequency,  the  power-handling 
capabilities,  and  the  type  of  installation. 

NOTE:  In  the  following  paragraphs,  we  will  mention  LOSSES  several  times.  We  will  discuss  these 
losses  more  thoroughly  under  "LOSSES  IN  TRANSMISSION  LINES." 

Two- Wire  Open  Line 

One  type  of  parallel  line  is  the  TWO- WIRE  OPEN  LINE  illustrated  in  figure  3-2.  This  line  consists 
of  two  wires  that  are  generally  spaced  from  2  to  6  inches  apart  by  insulating  spacers.  This  type  of  line  is 
most  often  used  for  power  lines,  rural  telephone  lines,  and  telegraph  lines.  It  is  sometimes  used  as  a 
transmission  line  between  a  transmitter  and  an  antenna  or  between  an  antenna  and  a  receiver.  An 
advantage  of  this  type  of  line  is  its  simple  construction.  The  principal  disadvantages  of  this  type  of  line 
are  the  high  radiation  losses  and  electrical  noise  pickup  because  of  the  lack  of  shielding.  Radiation  losses 
are  produced  by  the  changing  fields  created  by  the  changing  current  in  each  conductor. 


Another  type  of  parallel  line  is  the  TWO- WIRE  RIBBON  (TWIN  LEAD)  illustrated  in  figure  3-3. 
This  type  of  transmission  line  is  commonly  used  to  connect  a  television  receiving  antenna  to  a  home 
television  set.  This  line  is  essentially  the  same  as  the  two-wire  open  line  except  that  uniform  spacing  is 
assured  by  embedding  the  two  wires  in  a  low-loss  dielectric,  usually  polyethylene.  Since  the  wires  are 
embedded  in  the  thin  ribbon  of  polyethylene,  the  dielectric  space  is  partly  air  and  partly  polyethylene. 


INSULATING 
SPACERS 


Figure  3-2. — Parallel  two-wire  line. 


LOW  -  LOSS 
DIELECTRIC 


Figure  3-3. — Two-wire  ribbon  type  line. 


3-3 


Twisted  Pair 

The  TWISTED  PAIR  transmission  line  is  illustrated  in  figure  3-4.  As  the  name  implies,  the  line 
consists  of  two  insulated  wires  twisted  together  to  form  a  flexible  line  without  the  use  of  spacers.  It  is  not 
used  for  transmitting  high  frequency  because  of  the  high  dielectric  losses  that  occur  in  the  rubber 
insulation.  When  the  line  is  wet,  the  losses  increase  greatly. 


Figure  3-4. — Twisted  pair. 

Shielded  Pair 

The  SHIELDED  PAIR,  shown  in  figure  3-5,  consists  of  parallel  conductors  separated  from  each 
other  and  surrounded  by  a  solid  dielectric.  The  conductors  are  contained  within  a  braided  copper  tubing 
that  acts  as  an  electrical  shield.  The  assembly  is  covered  with  a  rubber  or  flexible  composition  coating 
that  protects  the  line  from  moisture  and  mechanical  damage.  Outwardly,  it  looks  much  like  the  power 
cord  of  a  washing  machine  or  refrigerator. 


DIELECTRIC 


Figure  3-5. — Shielded  pair. 

The  principal  advantage  of  the  shielded  pair  is  that  the  conductors  are  balanced  to  ground;  that  is,  the 
capacitance  between  the  wires  is  uniform  throughout  the  length  of  the  line.  This  balance  is  due  to  the 
uniform  spacing  of  the  grounded  shield  that  surrounds  the  wires  along  their  entire  length.  The  braided 
copper  shield  isolates  the  conductors  from  stray  magnetic  fields. 

Coaxial  Lines 

There  are  two  types  of  COAXIAL  LINES,  RIGID  (AIR)  COAXIAL  LINE  and  FLEXIBLE  (SOLID) 
COAXIAL  LINE.  The  physical  construction  of  both  types  is  basically  the  same;  that  is,  each  contains  two 
concentric  conductors. 


3-4 


The  rigid  coaxial  line  consists  of  a  central,  insulated  wire  (inner  conductor)  mounted  inside  a  tubular 
outer  conductor.  This  line  is  shown  in  figure  3-6.  In  some  applications,  the  inner  conductor  is  also  tubular. 
The  inner  conductor  is  insulated  from  the  outer  conductor  by  insulating  spacers  or  beads  at  regular 
intervals.  The  spacers  are  made  of  Pyrex,  polystyrene,  or  some  other  material  that  has  good  insulating 
characteristics  and  low  dielectric  losses  at  high  frequencies. 


OUTER 
CONDUCTOR 


INNER 
CONDUCTOR 


CABLE  WITH  WASHER  INSULATOR 

Figure  3-6. — Air  coaxial  line. 

The  chief  advantage  of  the  rigid  line  is  its  ability  to  minimize  radiation  losses.  The  electric  and 
magnetic  fields  in  a  two-wire  parallel  line  extend  into  space  for  relatively  great  distances  and  radiation 
losses  occur.  However,  in  a  coaxial  line  no  electric  or  magnetic  fields  extend  outside  of  the  outer 
conductor.  The  fields  are  confined  to  the  space  between  the  two  conductors,  resulting  in  a  perfectly 
shielded  coaxial  line.  Another  advantage  is  that  interference  from  other  lines  is  reduced. 

The  rigid  line  has  the  following  disadvantages:  (1)  it  is  expensive  to  construct;  (2)  it  must  be  kept  dry 
to  prevent  excessive  leakage  between  the  two  conductors;  and  (3)  although  high-frequency  losses  are 
somewhat  less  than  in  previously  mentioned  lines,  they  are  still  excessive  enough  to  limit  the  practical 
length  of  the  line. 

Leakage  caused  by  the  condensation  of  moisture  is  prevented  in  some  rigid  line  applications  by  the 
use  of  an  inert  gas,  such  as  nitrogen,  helium,  or  argon.  It  is  pumped  into  the  dielectric  space  of  the  line  at 
a  pressure  that  can  vary  from  3  to  35  pounds  per  square  inch.  The  inert  gas  is  used  to  dry  the  line  when  it 
is  first  installed  and  pressure  is  maintained  to  ensure  that  no  moisture  enters  the  line. 

Flexible  coaxial  lines  (figure  3-7)  are  made  with  an  inner  conductor  that  consists  of  flexible  wire 
insulated  from  the  outer  conductor  by  a  solid,  continuous  insulating  material.  The  outer  conductor  is  made 
of  metal  braid,  which  gives  the  line  flexibility.  Early  attempts  at  gaining  flexibility  involved  using  rubber 
insulators  between  the  two  conductors.  However,  the  rubber  insulators  caused  excessive  losses  at  high 
frequencies. 


3-5 


POLYETHYLENE 


Figure  3-7. — Flexible  coaxial  line. 

Because  of  the  high-frequency  losses  associated  with  rubber  insulators,  polyethylene  plastic  was 
developed  to  replace  rubber  and  eliminate  these  losses.  Polyethylene  plastic  is  a  solid  substance  that 
remains  flexible  over  a  wide  range  of  temperatures.  It  is  unaffected  by  seawater,  gasoline,  oil,  and  most 
other  liquids  that  may  be  found  aboard  ship.  The  use  of  polyethylene  as  an  insulator  results  in  greater 
high-frequency  losses  than  the  use  of  air  as  an  insulator.  However,  these  losses  are  still  lower  than  the 
losses  associated  with  most  other  solid  dielectric  materials. 

Waveguides 

The  WAVEGUIDE  is  classified  as  a  transmission  line.  However,  the  method  by  which  it  transmits 
energy  down  its  length  differs  from  the  conventional  methods.  Waveguides  are  cylindrical,  elliptical,  or 
rectangular  (cylindrical  and  rectangular  shapes  are  shown  in  figure  3-8).  The  rectangular  waveguide  is 
used  more  frequently  than  the  cylindrical  waveguide. 


CYLINDRICAL  RECTANGULAR 


Figure  3-8. — Waveguides. 

The  term  waveguide  can  be  applied  to  all  types  of  transmission  lines  in  the  sense  that  they  are  all 
used  to  guide  energy  from  one  point  to  another.  However,  usage  has  generally  limited  the  term  to  mean  a 
hollow  metal  tube  or  a  dielectric  transmission  line.  In  this  chapter,  we  use  the  term  waveguide  only  to 
mean  "hollow  metal  tube."  It  is  interesting  to  note  that  the  transmission  of  electromagnetic  energy  along  a 
waveguide  travels  at  a  velocity  somewhat  slower  than  electromagnetic  energy  traveling  through  free 
space. 

A  waveguide  may  be  classified  according  to  its  cross  section  (rectangular,  elliptical,  or  circular),  or 
according  to  the  material  used  in  its  construction  (metallic  or  dielectric).  Dielectric  waveguides  are 


3-6 


seldom  used  because  the  dielectric  losses  for  all  known  dielectric  materials  are  too  great  to  transfer  the 
electric  and  magnetic  fields  efficiently. 

The  installation  of  a  complete  waveguide  transmission  system  is  somewhat  more  difficult  than  the 
installation  of  other  types  of  transmission  lines.  The  radius  of  bends  in  the  waveguide  must  measure 
greater  than  two  wavelengths  at  the  operating  frequency  of  the  equipment  to  avoid  excessive  attenuation. 
The  cross  section  must  remain  uniform  around  the  bend.  These  requirements  hamper  installation  in 
confined  spaces.  If  the  waveguide  is  dented,  or  if  solder  is  permitted  to  run  inside  the  joints,  the 
attenuation  of  the  line  is  greatly  increased.  Dents  and  obstructions  in  the  waveguide  also  reduce  its 
breakdown  voltage,  thus  limiting  the  waveguide's  power-handling  capability  because  of  possible  arc  over. 
Great  care  must  be  exercised  during  installation;  one  or  two  carelessly  made  joints  can  seriously  inhibit 
the  advantage  of  using  the  waveguide. 

We  will  not  consider  the  waveguide  operation  in  this  module,  since  waveguide  theory  is  discussed  in 
NEETS,  Module  1 1 ,  Microwave  Principles. 

Q4.  List  the  five  types  of  transmission  lines  in  use  today. 

Q5.  Name  two  of  the  three  described  uses  of  a  two-wire  open  line. 

Q6.  What  are  the  two  primary  disadvantages  of  a  two- wire  open  line? 

Q7.  What  type  of  transmission  line  is  often  used  to  connect  a  television  set  to  its  antenna? 

Q8.  What  is  the  primary  advantage  of  the  shielded  pair? 

Q9.  What  are  the  two  types  of  coaxial  lines  in  use  today? 

Q10.  What  is  the  chief  advantage  of  the  air  coaxial  line? 

Qll.  List  the  three  disadvantages  of  the  air  coaxial  line. 

Q12.  List  the  two  common  types  of  waveguides  in  use  today. 

LOSSES  IN  TRANSMISSION  LINES 

The  discussion  of  transmission  lines  so  far  has  not  directly  addressed  LINE  LOSSES;  actually  some 
line  losses  occur  in  all  lines.  Line  losses  may  be  any  of  three  types — COPPER,  DIELECTRIC,  and 
RADIATION  or  INDUCTION  LOSSES. 

NOTE:  Transmission  lines  are  sometimes  referred  to  as  rf  lines.  In  this  text  the  terms  are  used 
interchangeably. 

Copper  Losses 

One  type  of  copper  loss  is  I2R  LOSS.  In  rf  lines  the  resistance  of  the  conductors  is  never  equal  to 
zero.  Whenever  current  flows  through  one  of  these  conductors,  some  energy  is  dissipated  in  the  form  of 
heat.  This  heat  loss  is  a  POWER  LOSS.  With  copper  braid,  which  has  a  resistance  higher  than  solid 
tubing,  this  power  loss  is  higher. 

Another  type  of  copper  loss  is  due  to  SKIN  EFFECT.  When  dc  flows  through  a  conductor,  the 
movement  of  electrons  through  the  conductor's  cross  section  is  uniform.  The  situation  is  somewhat 
different  when  ac  is  applied.  The  expanding  and  collapsing  fields  about  each  electron  encircle  other 
electrons.  This  phenomenon,  called  SELF  INDUCTION,  retards  the  movement  of  the  encircled  electrons. 


3-7 


The  flux  density  at  the  center  is  so  great  that  electron  movement  at  this  point  is  reduced.  As  frequency  is 
increased,  the  opposition  to  the  flow  of  current  in  the  center  of  the  wire  increases.  Current  in  the  center  of 
the  wire  becomes  smaller  and  most  of  the  electron  flow  is  on  the  wire  surface.  When  the  frequency 
applied  is  100  megahertz  or  higher,  the  electron  movement  in  the  center  is  so  small  that  the  center  of  the 
wire  could  be  removed  without  any  noticeable  effect  on  current.  You  should  be  able  to  see  that  the 
effective  cross-sectional  area  decreases  as  the  frequency  increases.  Since  resistance  is  inversely 
proportional  to  the  cross-sectional  area,  the  resistance  will  increase  as  the  frequency  is  increased.  Also, 
since  power  loss  increases  as  resistance  increases,  power  losses  increase  with  an  increase  in  frequency 
because  of  skin  effect. 

Copper  losses  can  be  minimized  and  conductivity  increased  in  an  rf  line  by  plating  the  line  with 
silver.  Since  silver  is  a  better  conductor  than  copper,  most  of  the  current  will  flow  through  the  silver  layer. 
The  tubing  then  serves  primarily  as  a  mechanical  support. 

Dielectric  Losses 

DIELECTRIC  LOSSES  result  from  the  heating  effect  on  the  dielectric  material  between  the 
conductors.  Power  from  the  source  is  used  in  heating  the  dielectric.  The  heat  produced  is  dissipated  into 
the  surrounding  medium.  When  there  is  no  potential  difference  between  two  conductors,  the  atoms  in  the 
dielectric  material  between  them  are  normal  and  the  orbits  of  the  electrons  are  circular.  When  there  is  a 
potential  difference  between  two  conductors,  the  orbits  of  the  electrons  change.  The  excessive  negative 
charge  on  one  conductor  repels  electrons  on  the  dielectric  toward  the  positive  conductor  and  thus  distorts 
the  orbits  of  the  electrons.  A  change  in  the  path  of  electrons  requires  more  energy,  introducing  a  power 
loss. 

The  atomic  structure  of  rubber  is  more  difficult  to  distort  than  the  structure  of  some  other  dielectric 
materials.  The  atoms  of  materials,  such  as  polyethylene,  distort  easily.  Therefore,  polyethylene  is  often 
used  as  a  dielectric  because  less  power  is  consumed  when  its  electron  orbits  are  distorted. 

Radiation  and  Induction  Losses 

RADIATION  and  INDUCTION  LOSSES  are  similar  in  that  both  are  caused  by  the  fields 
surrounding  the  conductors.  Induction  losses  occur  when  the  electromagnetic  field  about  a  conductor  cuts 
through  any  nearby  metallic  object  and  a  current  is  induced  in  that  object.  As  a  result,  power  is  dissipated 
in  the  object  and  is  lost. 

Radiation  losses  occur  because  some  magnetic  lines  of  force  about  a  conductor  do  not  return  to  the 
conductor  when  the  cycle  alternates.  These  lines  of  force  are  projected  into  space  as  radiation  and  this 
results  in  power  losses.  That  is,  power  is  supplied  by  the  source,  but  is  not  available  to  the  load. 

Q13.  What  are  the  three  types  of  line  losses  associated  with  transmission  lines? 

Q14.  Losses  caused  by  skin  effect  and  the  I2R  (power)  loss  are  classified  as  what  type  of  loss? 

Q15.   What  types  of  losses  cause  the  dielectric  material  between  the  conductors  to  be  heated? 

LENGTH  OF  A  TRANSMISSION  LINE 

A  transmission  line  is  considered  to  be  electrically  short  when  its  physical  length  is  short  compared 
to  a  quarter- wavelength  (1/4A)  of  the  energy  it  is  to  carry. 

NOTE:  In  this  module,  for  ease  of  reading,  the  value  of  the  wavelength  will  be  spelled  out  in  some 
cases,  and  in  other  cases,  the  numerical  value  will  be  used. 


3-8 


A  transmission  line  is  electrically  long  when  its  physical  length  is  long  compared  to  a  quarter- 
wavelength  of  the  energy  it  is  to  carry.  You  must  understand  that  the  terms  "short"  and  "long"  are  relative 
ones.  For  example,  a  line  that  has  a  physical  length  of  3  meters  (approximately  10  feet)  is  considered 
quite  short  electrically  if  it  transmits  a  radio  frequency  of  30  kilohertz.  On  the  other  hand,  the  same 
transmission  line  is  considered  electrically  long  if  it  transmits  a  frequency  of  30,000  megahertz. 

To  show  the  difference  in  physical  and  electrical  lengths  of  the  lines  mentioned  above,  compute  the 
wavelength  of  the  two  frequencies,  taking  the  30-kilohertz  example  first: 


Given: 
X 

Where: 


v 

7 


X  =  Wavelength 
v  =  Velocity  of  rf  in  free  space 
f  =  Frequency  of  transmission 
Hi  =  Cycles  per  second 


X 


300  xioe  meters  /second 
30  xio3  cycles /second  (Hz) 


X  =  10  x  103  meters/cycle 
X  =  10,000  meters,  or  approxiamtely 
6  miles  for  complete  wavelength 


Now,  computing  the  wavelength  for  the  line  carrying  30,000  megahertz: 

V 

7 


x=l 


^  =      300  xlOe  meters  /second 
30,000  x  I0e  cycles  /second  (Hi) 

^  =  meter  /  cycle 

100  * 

X  =.01  meter,  or  approximately  .03  foot 
for  a  complete  wavelength 


Thus,  you  can  see  that  a  3-meter  line  is  electrically  very  short  for  a  frequency  of  30  kilohertz.  Also, 
the  3-meter  line  is  electrically  very  long  for  a  frequency  of  30,000  megahertz. 

When  power  is  applied  to  a  very  short  transmission  line,  practically  all  of  it  reaches  the  load  at  the 
output  end  of  the  line.  This  very  short  transmission  line  is  usually  considered  to  have  practically  no 
electrical  properties  of  its  own,  except  for  a  small  amount  of  resistance. 


3-9 


However,  the  picture  changes  considerably  when  a  long  line  is  used.  Since  most  transmission  lines 
are  electrically  long  (because  of  the  distance  from  transmitter  to  antenna),  the  properties  of  such  lines 
must  be  considered.  Frequently,  the  voltage  necessary  to  drive  a  current  through  a  long  line  is 
considerably  greater  than  the  amount  that  can  be  accounted  for  by  the  impedance  of  the  load  in  series  with 
the  resistance  of  the  line. 


TRANSMISSION  LINE  THEORY 

The  electrical  characteristics  of  a  two-wire  transmission  line  depend  primarily  on  the  construction  of 
the  line.  The  two-wire  line  acts  like  a  long  capacitor.  The  change  of  its  capacitive  reactance  is  noticeable 
as  the  frequency  applied  to  it  is  changed.  Since  the  long  conductors  have  a  magnetic  field  about  them 
when  electrical  energy  is  being  passed  through  them,  they  also  exhibit  the  properties  of  inductance.  The 
values  of  inductance  and  capacitance  presented  depend  on  the  various  physical  factors  that  we  discussed 
earlier.  For  example,  the  type  of  line  used,  the  dielectric  in  the  line,  and  the  length  of  the  line  must  be 
considered.  The  effects  of  the  inductive  and  capacitive  reactances  of  the  line  depend  on  the  frequency 
applied.  Since  no  dielectric  is  perfect,  electrons  manage  to  move  from  one  conductor  to  the  other  through 
the  dielectric.  Each  type  of  two-wire  transmission  line  also  has  a  conductance  value.  This  conductance 
value  represents  the  value  of  the  current  flow  that  may  be  expected  through  the  insulation.  If  the  line  is 
uniform  (all  values  equal  at  each  unit  length),  then  one  small  section  of  the  line  may  represent  several 
feet.  This  illustration  of  a  two-wire  transmission  line  will  be  used  throughout  the  discussion  of 
transmission  lines;  but,  keep  in  mind  that  the  principles  presented  apply  to  all  transmission  lines.  We  will 
explain  the  theories  using  LUMPED  CONSTANTS  and  DISTRIBUTED  CONSTANTS  to  further 
simplify  these  principles. 

LUMPED  CONSTANTS 

A  transmission  line  has  the  properties  of  inductance,  capacitance,  and  resistance  just  as  the  more 
conventional  circuits  have.  Usually,  however,  the  constants  in  conventional  circuits  are  lumped  into  a 
single  device  or  component.  For  example,  a  coil  of  wire  has  the  property  of  inductance.  When  a  certain 
amount  of  inductance  is  needed  in  a  circuit,  a  coil  of  the  proper  dimensions  is  inserted.  The  inductance  of 
the  circuit  is  lumped  into  the  one  component.  Two  metal  plates  separated  by  a  small  space,  can  be  used  to 
supply  the  required  capacitance  for  a  circuit.  In  such  a  case,  most  of  the  capacitance  of  the  circuit  is 
lumped  into  this  one  component.  Similarly,  a  fixed  resistor  can  be  used  to  supply  a  certain  value  of  circuit 
resistance  as  a  lumped  sum.  Ideally,  a  transmission  line  would  also  have  its  constants  of  inductance, 
capacitance,  and  resistance  lumped  together,  as  shown  in  figure  3-9.  Unfortunately,  this  is  not  the  case. 
Transmission  line  constants  are  distributed,  as  described  below. 


3-10 


TRANS- 
MITTER 


Ft 


X 
"L 


L 


R 


-WV 


ANTENNA 


Figure  3-9. — Equivalent  circuit  of  a  two- wire  transmission  line. 

DISTRIBUTED  CONSTANTS 

Transmission  line  constants,  called  distributed  constants,  are  spread  along  the  entire  length  of  the 
transmission  line  and  cannot  be  distinguished  separately.  The  amount  of  inductance,  capacitance,  and 
resistance  depends  on  the  length  of  the  line,  the  size  of  the  conducting  wires,  the  spacing  between  the 
wires,  and  the  dielectric  (air  or  insulating  medium)  between  the  wires.  The  following  paragraphs  will  be 
useful  to  you  as  you  study  distributed  constants  on  a  transmission  line. 

Inductance  of  a  Transmission  Line 

When  current  flows  through  a  wire,  magnetic  lines  of  force  are  set  up  around  the  wire.  As  the  current 
increases  and  decreases  in  amplitude,  the  field  around  the  wire  expands  and  collapses  accordingly.  The 
energy  produced  by  the  magnetic  lines  of  force  collapsing  back  into  the  wire  tends  to  keep  the  current 
flowing  in  the  same  direction.  This  represents  a  certain  amount  of  inductance,  which  is  expressed  in 
microhenrys  per  unit  length.  Figure  3-10  illustrates  the  inductance  and  magnetic  fields  of  a  transmission 
line. 


0  Q  OlQ  0  0  QqQ  HQ  Qp  0  0  0  fljfl  flj  Q  Q  U  fl  0  0  DiQ  QQ.P  0 


ISIQ  Q  Q.Q  P  QQpODPQ3QQQQtQQQ0C0OQOQ 


n 

ft 

\5 


Figure  3-10. — Distributed  inductance 


3-11 


Capacitance  of  a  Transmission  Line 

Capacitance  also  exists  between  the  transmission  line  wires,  as  illustrated  in  figure  3-11.  Notice  that 
the  two  parallel  wires  act  as  plates  of  a  capacitor  and  that  the  air  between  them  acts  as  a  dielectric.  The 
capacitance  between  the  wires  is  usually  expressed  in  picofarads  per  unit  length.  This  electric  field 
between  the  wires  is  similar  to  the  field  that  exists  between  the  two  plates  of  a  capacitor. 


Figure  3-11. — Distributed  capacitance. 

Resistance  of  a  Transmission  Line 

The  transmission  line  shown  in  figure  3-12  has  electrical  resistance  along  its  length.  This  resistance 
is  usually  expressed  in  ohms  per  unit  length  and  is  shown  as  existing  continuously  from  one  end  of  the 
line  to  the  other. 


A/VWWWVWWWWWVWWWSAMAAW 


wwwwwvwww/wvwvwvw/ww 


Figure  3-12. — Distributed  resistance. 

Q16.   What  must  the  physical  length  of  a  transmission  line  be  if  it  will  be  operated  at  15,000,000  Hz? 
Use  the  formula: 


Q17.   What  are  two  of  the  three  physical  factors  that  determine  the  values  of  capacitance  and 
inductance  of  a  transmission  line? 

Q18.  A  transmission  line  is  said  to  have  distributed  constants  of  inductance,  capacitance,  and 
resistance  along  the  line.  What  units  of  measurement  are  used  to  express  these  constants? 

Leakage  Current 

Since  any  dielectric,  even  air,  is  not  a  perfect  insulator,  a  small  current  known  as  LEAKAGE 
CURRENT  flows  between  the  two  wires.  In  effect,  the  insulator  acts  as  a  resistor,  permitting  current  to 
pass  between  the  two  wires.  Figure  3-13  shows  this  leakage  path  as  resistors  in  parallel  connected 
between  the  two  lines.  This  property  is  called  CONDUCTANCE  (G)  and  is  the  opposite  of  resistance. 


3-12 


Conductance  in  transmission  lines  is  expressed  as  the  reciprocal  of  resistance  and  is  usually  given  in 
micromhos  per  unit  length. 


Figure  3-13. — Leakage  in  a  transmission  line. 

ELECTROMAGNETIC  FIELDS  ABOUT  A  TRANSMISSION  LINE 

The  distributed  constants  of  resistance,  inductance,  and  capacitance  are  basic  properties  common  to 
all  transmission  lines  and  exist  whether  or  not  any  current  flow  exists.  As  soon  as  current  flow  and 
voltage  exist  in  a  transmission  line,  another  property  becomes  quite  evident.  This  is  the  presence  of  an 
electromagnetic  field,  or  lines  of  force,  about  the  wires  of  the  transmission  line.  The  lines  of  force 
themselves  are  not  visible;  however,  understanding  the  force  that  an  electron  experiences  while  in  the 
field  of  these  lines  is  very  important  to  your  understanding  of  energy  transmission. 

There  are  two  kinds  of  fields;  one  is  associated  with  voltage  and  the  other  with  current.  The  field 
associated  with  voltage  is  called  the  ELECTRIC  (E)  FIELD.  It  exerts  a  force  on  any  electric  charge 
placed  in  it.  The  field  associated  with  current  is  called  a  MAGNETIC  (H)  FIELD,  because  it  tends  to 
exert  a  force  on  any  magnetic  pole  placed  in  it.  Figure  3-14  illustrates  the  way  in  which  the  E  fields  and  H 
fields  tend  to  orient  themselves  between  conductors  of  a  typical  two-wire  transmission  line.  The 
illustration  shows  a  cross  section  of  the  transmission  lines.  The  E  field  is  represented  by  solid  lines  and 
the  H  field  by  dotted  lines.  The  arrows  indicate  the  direction  of  the  lines  of  force.  Both  fields  normally 
exist  together  and  are  spoken  of  collectively  as  the  electromagnetic  field. 


Figure  3-14. — Fields  between  conductors. 


3-13 


CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE  OF  A  TRANSMISSION  LINE 

You  learned  earlier  that  the  maximum  (and  most  efficient)  transfer  of  electrical  energy  takes  place 
when  the  source  impedance  is  matched  to  the  load  impedance.  This  fact  is  very  important  in  the  study  of 
transmission  lines  and  antennas.  If  the  characteristic  impedance  of  the  transmission  line  and  the  load 
impedance  are  equal,  energy  from  the  transmitter  will  travel  down  the  transmission  line  to  the  antenna 
with  no  power  loss  caused  by  reflection. 

Definition  and  Symbols 

Every  transmission  line  possesses  a  certain  CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE,  usually  designated 
as  Z0.  Z0  is  the  ratio  of  E  to  I  at  every  point  along  the  line.  If  a  load  equal  to  the  characteristic  impedance 
is  placed  at  the  output  end  of  any  length  of  line,  the  same  impedance  will  appear  at  the  input  terminals  of 
the  line.  The  characteristic  impedance  is  the  only  value  of  impedance  for  any  given  type  and  size  of  line 
that  acts  in  this  way.  The  characteristic  impedance  determines  the  amount  of  current  that  can  flow  when  a 
given  voltage  is  applied  to  an  infinitely  long  line.  Characteristic  impedance  is  comparable  to  the 
resistance  that  determines  the  amount  of  current  that  flows  in  a  dc  circuit. 

In  a  previous  discussion,  lumped  and  distributed  constants  were  explained.  Figure  3-15,  view  A, 
shows  the  properties  of  resistance,  inductance,  capacitance,  and  conductance  combined  in  a  short  section 
of  two-wire  transmission  line.  The  illustration  shows  the  evenly  distributed  capacitance  as  a  single 
lumped  capacitor  and  the  distributed  conductance  as  a  lumped  leakage  path.  Lumped  values  may  be  used 
for  transmission  line  calculations  if  the  physical  length  of  the  line  is  very  short  compared  to  the 
wavelength  of  energy  being  transmitted.  Figure  3-15,  view  B,  shows  all  four  properties  lumped  together 
and  represented  by  their  conventional  symbols. 

L,  R 


B.   EQUIVALENT  CIRCUIT 

Figure  3-15. — Short  section  of  two-wire  transmission  line  and  equivalent  circuit. 

Q19.  Describe  the  leakage  current  in  a  transmission  line  and  in  what  unit  it  is  expressed. 


3-14 


Q20.  All  the  power  sent  down  a  transmission  line  from  a  transmitter  can  be  transferred  to  an  antenna 
under  what  optimum  conditions? 


Q21.   What  symbol  is  used  to  designate  the  characteristic  impedance  of  a  line,  and  what  two  variables 
does  it  compare? 

Characteristic  Impedance  and  the  Infinite  Line 

Several  short  sections,  as  shown  in  figure  3-15,  can  be  combined  to  form  a  large  transmission  line,  as 
shown  in  figure  3-16.  Current  will  flow  if  voltage  is  applied  across  points  K  and  L.  In  fact,  any  circuit, 
such  as  that  represented  in  figure  3-16,  view  A,  has  a  certain  current  flow  for  each  value  of  applied 
voltage.  The  ratio  of  the  voltage  to  the  current  is  the  impedance  (Z). 

Recall  that: 


I 


B 


s.  u .  w 

EQUIVALENT  DIAGRAM  OF  A 
I  f 


CONDUCTANCE  G  IS  NEGLECTED 


R 

AN  IMPEDANCE 
MEASURING 
DEVICE 
MEASURES 
Z0  HERE 

s 


ADDITONAL 
SECTIONSTO 
INFINITY 


K 

IMPEDANCE 
MEASURING 
DEVICESTILL 
MEASURES 
Z0  HERE 
L  a  


-AV  ^ 


PLACEALUMPED 
LOAD  EQUAL  TO 
Z.  HERE 


Figure  3-16. — Characteristic  impedance. 


3-15 


The  impedance  presented  to  the  input  terminals  of  the  transmission  line  is  not  merely  the  resistance 
of  the  wire  in  series  with  the  impedance  of  the  load.  The  effects  of  series  inductance  and  shunt 
capacitance  of  the  line  itself  may  overshadow  the  resistance,  and  even  the  load,  as  far  as  the  input 
terminals  are  concerned. 

To  find  the  input  impedance  of  a  transmission  line,  determine  the  impedance  of  a  single  section  of 
line.  The  impedance  between  points  K  and  L,  in  view  B  of  figure  3-16,  can  be  calculated  by  the  use  of 
series-parallel  impedance  formulas,  provided  the  impedance  across  points  M  and  N  is  known.  But  since 
this  section  is  merely  one  small  part  of  a  longer  line,  another  similar  section  is  connected  to  points  M  and 
N.  Again,  the  impedance  across  points  K  and  L  of  the  two  sections  can  be  calculated,  provided  the 
impedance  of  the  third  section  is  known.  This  process  of  adding  one  section  to  another  can  be  repeated 
endlessly.  The  addition  of  each  section  produces  an  impedance  across  points  K  and  L  of  a  new  and  lower 
value.  However,  after  many  sections  have  been  added,  each  successive  added  section  has  less  and  less 
effect  on  the  impedance  across  points  K  and  L.  If  sections  are  added  to  the  line  endlessly,  the  line  is 
infinitely  long,  and  a  certain  finite  value  of  impedance  across  points  K  and  L  is  finally  reached. 

In  this  discussion  of  transmission  lines,  the  effect  of  conductance  (G)  is  minor  compared  to  that  of 
inductance  (L)  and  capacitance  (C),  and  is  frequently  neglected.  In  figure  3-16,  view  C,  G  is  omitted  and 
the  inductance  and  resistance  of  each  line  can  be  considered  as  one  line. 

Let  us  assume  that  the  sections  of  view  C  continue  to  the  right  with  an  infinite  number  of  sections. 
When  an  infinite  number  of  sections  extends  to  the  right,  the  impedance  appearing  across  K  and  L  is  Z0. 
If  the  line  is  cut  at  R  and  S,  an  infinite  number  of  sections  still  extends  to  the  right  since  the  line  is  endless 
in  that  direction.  Therefore,  the  impedance  now  appearing  across  points  R  and  S  is  also  Z0,  as  illustrated 
in  view  D.  You  can  see  that  if  only  the  first  three  sections  are  taken  and  a  load  impedance  of  Zo  is 
connected  across  points  R  and  S,  the  impedance  across  the  input  terminals  K  and  L  is  still  Z0.  The  line 
continues  to  act  as  an  infinite  line.  This  is  illustrated  in  view  E. 

Figure  3-17,  view  A,  illustrates  how  the  characteristic  impedance  of  an  infinite  line  can  be 
calculated.  Resistors  are  added  in  series  parallel  across  terminals  K  and  L  in  eight  steps,  and  the  resultant 
impedances  are  noted.  In  step  1  the  impedance  is  infinite;  in  step  2  the  impedance  is  110  ohms.  In  step  3 
the  impedance  becomes  62.1  ohms,  a  change  of  47.9  ohms.  In  step  4  the  impedance  is  48.5  ohms,  a 
change  of  only  13.6  ohms.  The  resultant  changes  in  impedance  from  each  additional  increment  become 
progressively  smaller.  Eventually,  practically  no  change  in  impedance  results  from  further  additions  to  the 
line.  The  total  impedance  of  the  line  at  this  point  is  said  to  be  at  its  characteristic  impedance;  which,  in 
this  case,  is  37  ohms.  This  means  that  an  infinite  line  constructed  as  indicated  in  step  8  could  be 
effectively  replaced  by  a  37-ohm  resistor.  View  B  shows  a  37-ohm  resistor  placed  in  the  line  at  various 
points  to  replace  the  infinite  line  of  step  8  in  view  A.  There  is  no  change  in  total  impedance. 


3-16 


Figure  3-17. — Termination  of  a  line. 


In  figure  3-17,  resistors  were  used  to  show  impedance  characteristics  for  the  sake  of  simplicity. 
Figuring  the  actual  impedance  of  a  line  having  reactance  is  very  similar,  with  inductance  taking  the  place 
of  the  series  resistors  and  capacitance  taking  the  place  of  the  shunt  resistors.  The  characteristic  impedance 
of  lines  in  actual  use  normally  lies  between  50  and  600  ohms. 

When  a  transmission  line  is  "short"  compared  to  the  length  of  the  radio-frequency  waves  it  carries, 
the  opposition  presented  to  the  input  terminals  is  determined  primarily  by  the  load  impedance.  A  small 
amount  of  power  is  dissipated  in  overcoming  the  resistance  of  the  line.  However,  when  the  line  is  "long" 
and  the  load  is  an  incorrect  impedance,  the  voltages  necessary  to  drive  a  given  amount  of  current  through 
the  line  cannot  be  accounted  for  by  considering  just  the  impedance  of  the  load  in  series  with  the 


3-17 


impedance  of  the  line.  The  line  has  properties  other  than  resistance  that  affect  input  impedance.  These 
properties  are  inductance  in  series  with  the  line,  capacitance  across  the  line,  resistance  leakage  paths 
across  the  line,  and  certain  radiation  losses. 

Q22.   What  is  the  range  of  the  characteristic  impedance  of  lines  used  in  actual  practice? 

VOLTAGE  CHANGE  ALONG  A  TRANSMISSION  LINE 

Let  us  summarize  what  we  have  just  discussed.  In  an  electric  circuit,  energy  is  stored  in  electric  and 
magnetic  fields.  These  fields  must  be  brought  to  the  load  to  transmit  that  energy.  At  the  load,  energy 
contained  in  the  fields  is  converted  to  the  desired  form  of  energy. 

Transmission  of  Energy 

When  the  load  is  connected  directly  to  the  source  of  energy,  or  when  the  transmission  line  is  short, 
problems  concerning  current  and  voltage  can  be  solved  by  applying  Ohm's  law.  When  the  transmission 
line  becomes  long  enough  so  the  time  difference  between  a  change  occurring  at  the  generator  and  the 
change  appearing  at  the  load  becomes  appreciable,  analysis  of  the  transmission  line  becomes  important. 

Dc  Applied  to  a  Transmission  Line 

In  figure  3-18,  a  battery  is  connected  through  a  relatively  long  two-wire  transmission  line  to  a  load  at 
the  far  end  of  the  line.  At  the  instant  the  switch  is  closed,  neither  current  nor  voltage  exists  on  the  line. 
When  the  switch  is  closed,  point  A  becomes  a  positive  potential,  and  point  B  becomes  negative.  These 
points  of  difference  in  potential  move  down  the  line.  However,  as  the  initial  points  of  potential  leave 
points  A  and  B,  they  are  followed  by  new  points  of  difference  in  potential  which  the  battery  adds  at  A  and 
B.  This  is  merely  saying  that  the  battery  maintains  a  constant  potential  difference  between  points  A  and 
B.  A  short  time  after  the  switch  is  closed,  the  initial  points  of  difference  in  potential  have  reached  points 
A'  and  B';  the  wire  sections  from  points  A  to  A'  and  points  B  to  B'  are  at  the  same  potential  as  A  and  B, 
respectively.  The  points  of  charge  are  represented  by  plus  (+)  and  minus  (-)  signs  along  the  wires.  The 
directions  of  the  currents  in  the  wires  are  represented  by  the  arrowheads  on  the  line,  and  the  direction  of 
travel  is  indicated  by  an  arrow  below  the  line.  Conventional  lines  of  force  represent  the  electric  field  that 
exists  between  the  opposite  kinds  of  charge  on  the  wire  sections  from  A  to  A'  and  B  to  B'.  Crosses  (tails 
of  arrows)  indicate  the  magnetic  field  created  by  the  electric  field  moving  down  the  line.  The  moving 
electric  field  and  the  accompanying  magnetic  field  constitute  an  electromagnetic  wave  that  is  moving 
from  the  generator  (battery)  toward  the  load.  This  wave  travels  at  approximately  the  speed  of  light  in  free 
space.  The  energy  reaching  the  load  is  equal  to  that  developed  at  the  battery  (assuming  there  are  no  losses 
in  the  transmission  line).  If  the  load  absorbs  all  of  the  energy,  the  current  and  voltage  will  be  evenly 
distributed  along  the  line. 


3-18 


DIRECTION  OF  TRAVEL 


Figure  3-18. — Dc  voltage  applied  to  a  line. 


Ac  Applied  to  a  Transmission  Line 

When  the  battery  of  figure  3-18  is  replaced  by  an  ac  generator  (fig.  3-19),  each  successive 
instantaneous  value  of  the  generator  voltage  is  propagated  down  the  line  at  the  speed  of  light.  The  action 
is  similar  to  the  wave  created  by  the  battery  except  that  the  applied  voltage  is  sinusoidal  instead  of 
constant.  Assume  that  the  switch  is  closed  at  the  moment  the  generator  voltage  is  passing  through  zero 
and  that  the  next  half  cycle  makes  point  A  positive.  At  the  end  of  one  cycle  of  generator  voltage,  the 
current  and  voltage  distribution  will  be  as  shown  in  figure  3-19. 


3-19 


+  +  +  +  +  + 


sw 


AC 

GENERATOR 


r  ft " 


+  +  +  +  + 


A" 


L 
0 
A 
D 


B" 


Figure  3-19. — Ac  voltage  applied  to  a  line. 

In  this  illustration  the  conventional  lines  of  force  represent  the  electric  fields.  For  simplicity,  the 
magnetic  fields  are  not  shown.  Points  of  charge  are  indicated  by  plus  (+)  and  minus  (-)  signs,  the  larger 
signs  indicating  points  of  higher  amplitude  of  both  voltage  and  current.  Short  arrows  indicate  direction  of 
current  (electron  flow).  The  waveform  drawn  below  the  transmission  line  represents  the  voltage  (E)  and 
current  (I)  waves.  The  line  is  assumed  to  be  infinite  in  length  so  there  is  no  reflection.  Thus,  traveling 
sinusoidal  voltage  and  current  waves  continually  travel  in  phase  from  the  generator  toward  the  load,  or  far 
end  of  the  line.  Waves  traveling  from  the  generator  to  the  load  are  called  INCIDENT  WAVES.  Waves 
traveling  from  the  load  back  to  the  generator  are  called  REFLECTED  WAVES  and  will  be  explained  in 
later  paragraphs. 

Dc  Applied  to  an  Infinite  Line 

Figure  3-20  shows  a  battery  connected  to  a  circuit  that  is  the  equivalent  of  a  transmission  line.  In  this 
line  the  series  resistance  and  shunt  conductance  are  not  shown.  In  the  following  discussion  the  line  will  be 
considered  to  have  no  losses. 


3-20 


Figure  3-20. — Dc  applied  to  an  equivalent  transmission  line. 


As  the  switch  is  closed,  the  battery  voltage  is  applied  to  the  input  terminals  of  the  line.  Now,  C 1  has 
no  charge  and  appears,  effectively,  as  a  short  circuit  across  points  A  and  B.  The  full  battery  voltage 
appears  across  inductor  LI.  Inductor  LI  opposes  the  change  of  current  (0  now)  and  limits  the  rate  of 
charge  of  CI. 

Capacitor  C2  cannot  begin  to  charge  until  after  CI  has  charged.  No  current  can  flow  beyond  points 
A  and  B  until  CI  has  acquired  some  charge.  As  the  voltage  across  CI  increases,  current  through  L2  and 
C2  charges  C2.  This  action  continues  down  the  line  and  charges  each  capacitor,  in  turn,  to  the  battery 
voltage.  Thus  a  voltage  wave  is  traveling  along  the  line.  Beyond  the  wavefront,  the  line  is  uncharged. 
Since  the  line  is  infinitely  long,  there  will  always  be  more  capacitors  to  be  charged,  and  current  will  not 
stop  flowing.  Thus  current  will  flow  indefinitely  in  the  line. 

Notice  that  current  flows  to  charge  the  capacitors  along  the  line.  The  flow  of  current  is  not  advanced 
along  the  line  until  a  voltage  is  developed  across  each  preceding  capacitor.  In  this  manner  voltage  and 
current  move  down  the  line  together  in  phase. 

Ac  Applied  to  an  Infinite  Line 

An  rf  line  displays  similar  characteristics  when  an  ac  voltage  is  applied  to  its  sending  end  or  input 
terminals.  In  figure  3-21,  view  A,  an  ac  voltage  is  applied  to  the  line  represented  by  the  circuit  shown. 


3-21 


AC 

GENERATOR 


W  X  Y 

frriTTT-|Z0 


A.  CIRCUIT 


100  V  

70  V 


-70  V 


VOLTAGE 
AT  POINT  W 


T1     T2     T3     T4     T5     T6     T7  T8 
I  TIME- 
t  I 
I  I, 


VOLTAGE 
AT  POINT  X 


VOLTAGE 
AT  POINTY 


-70  V 


70  V 


70  V 


B.  TRAVELING  WAVE 


Figure  3-21. — Ac  applied  to  an  equivalent  transmission  line. 

In  view  B  the  generator  voltage  starts  from  zero  (Tl)  and  produces  the  voltage  shown.  As  soon  as  a 
small  voltage  change  is  produced,  it  starts  its  journey  down  the  line  while  the  generator  continues  to 
produce  new  voltages  along  a  sine  curve.  At  T2  the  generator  voltage  is  70  volts.  The  voltages  still  move 
along  the  line  until,  at  T3,  the  first  small  change  arrives  at  point  W,  and  the  voltage  at  that  point  starts 
increasing.  At  T5,  the  same  voltage  arrives  at  point  X  on  the  line.  Finally,  at  T7,  the  first  small  change 
arrives  at  the  receiving  end  of  the  line.  Meanwhile,  all  the  changes  in  the  sine  wave  produced  by  the 
generator  pass  each  point  in  turn.  The  amount  of  time  required  for  the  changes  to  travel  the  length  of  the 
line  is  the  same  as  that  required  for  a  dc  voltage  to  travel  the  same  distance. 

At  T7,  the  voltage  at  the  various  points  on  the  line  is  as  follows: 


At  the  generator:  -100  V 

At  point  W:  0  V 

At  point  X:  +100  V 

At  point  Y:  0  V 


If  these  voltages  are  plotted  along  the  length  of  the  line,  the  resulting  curve  is  like  the  one  shown  in 
figure  3-22,  view  A.  Note  that  such  a  curve  of  instantaneous  voltages  resembles  a  sine  wave.  The  changes 
in  voltage  that  occur  between  T7  and  T 8  are  as  follows: 


3-22 


At  the  generator: 
At  point  W: 
At  point  X: 
At  point  Y: 


Rise  from 
Drop  from 
Drop  from 
Rise  from 


-100  V  to  -70  V 
0  V  to  -70  V 
+100  V  to  +70  V 
0  V  to  +  70  V 


+100 


-100 


POINT  PERFORMING 
X  END 

-  I 


LENGTH  OF  LINE 
A.  VOLTAGE  ON  LINE  AT  TIME  T7 


B.  VOLTAGES  ON  LINE  AT  TIME  T8  (DOTTED  LINE 
IS  T7  VOLTAGE  PER  REFERENCE) 


+100 
+70 


C.  A  CURVE  OF  READINGS  ON  ANA.C.  METER 
WOULD  SHOW  THE  EFFECTIVE  OR  RMS  VOLTAGE 
TO  BE  THE  SAME  OVER  LENGTH  OF  LINE 


Figure  3-22. — Instantaneous  voltages  along  a  transmission  line. 

A  plot  of  these  new  voltages  produces  the  solid  curve  shown  in  figure  3-22,  view  B.  For  reference, 
the  curve  from  T7  is  drawn  as  a  dotted  line.  The  solid  curve  has  exactly  the  same  shape  as  the  dotted 
curve,  but  has  moved  to  the  right  by  the  distance  X.  Another  plot  at  T9  would  show  a  new  curve  similar 
to  the  one  at  T8,  but  moved  to  the  right  by  the  distance  Y. 

By  analyzing  the  points  along  the  graph  just  discussed,  you  should  be  able  to  see  that  the  actions 
associated  with  voltage  changes  along  an  rf  line  are  as  follows: 

1.  All  instantaneous  voltages  of  the  sine  wave  produced  by  the  generator  travel  down  the  line  in  the 
order  they  are  produced. 

2.  At  any  point,  a  sine  wave  can  be  obtained  if  all  the  instantaneous  voltages  passing  the  point  are 
plotted.  An  oscilloscope  can  be  used  to  plot  these  values  of  instantaneous  voltages  against  time. 


3-23 


3.  The  instantaneous  voltages  (oscilloscope  displays)  are  the  same  in  all  cases  except  that  a  phase 
difference  exists  in  the  displays  seen  at  different  points  along  the  line.  The  phase  changes 
continually  with  respect  to  the  generator  until  the  change  is  360  degrees  over  a  certain  length  of 
line. 

4.  All  parts  of  a  sine  wave  pass  every  point  along  the  line.  A  plot  of  the  readings  of  an  ac  meter 
(which  reads  the  effective  value  of  the  voltage  over  a  given  time)  taken  at  different  points  along 
the  line  shows  that  the  voltage  is  constant  at  all  points.  This  is  shown  in  view  C  of  figure  3-22. 

5.  Since  the  line  is  terminated  with  a  resistance  equal  to  Z  0,  the  energy  arriving  at  the  end  of  the 
line  is  absorbed  by  the  resistance. 

VELOCITY  OF  WAVE  PROPAGATION 

If  a  voltage  is  initially  applied  to  the  sending  end  of  a  line,  that  same  voltage  will  appear  later  some 
distance  from  the  sending  end.  This  is  true  regardless  of  any  change  in  voltage,  whether  the  change  is  a 
jump  from  zero  to  some  value  or  a  drop  from  some  value  to  zero.  The  voltage  change  will  be  conducted 
down  the  line  at  a  constant  rate. 

Recall  that  the  inductance  of  a  line  delays  the  charging  of  the  line  capacitance.  The  velocity  of 
propagation  is  therefore  related  to  the  values  of  L  and  C.  If  the  inductance  and  capacitance  of  the  rf  line 
are  known,  the  time  required  for  any  waveform  to  travel  the  length  of  the  line  can  be  determined.  To  see 
how  this  works,  observe  the  following  relationship: 

Q  =  IT 

This  formula  shows  that  the  total  charge  or  quantity  is  equal  to  the  current  multiplied  by  the  time  the 
current  flows.  Also: 

Q  =  CE 

This  formula  shows  that  the  total  charge  on  a  capacitor  is  equal  to  the  capacitance  multiplied  by  the 
voltage  across  the  capacitor. 

If  the  switch  in  figure  3-23  is  closed  for  a  given  time,  the  quantity  (Q)  of  electricity  leaving  the 
battery  can  be  computed  by  using  the  equation  Q  =  IT.  The  electricity  leaves  the  battery  and  goes  into  the 
line,  where  a  charge  is  built  up  on  the  capacitors.  The  amount  of  this  charge  is  computed  by  using  the 
equation  Q  =  CE. 


3-24 


TO 
INFINITY 


B  D  F  H 


Figure  3-23. — Dc  applied  to  an  equivalent  transmission  line. 


Since  none  of  the  charge  is  lost,  the  total  charge  leaving  the  battery  during  T  is  equal  to  the  total 
charge  on  the  line.  Therefore: 


As  each  capacitor  accumulates  a  charge  equal  to  CE,  the  voltage  across  each  inductor  must  change. 
As  CI  in  figure  3-23  charges  to  a  voltage  of  E,  point  A  rises  to  a  potential  of  E  volts  while  point  B  is  still 
at  zero  volts.  This  makes  E  appear  across  L2.  As  C2  charges,  point  B  rises  to  a  potential  of  E  volts  as  did 
point  A.  At  this  time,  point  B  is  at  E  volts  and  point  C  rises.  Thus,  we  have  a  continuing  action  of  voltage 
moving  down  the  infinite  line. 

In  an  inductor,  these  circuit  components  are  related,  as  shown  in  the  formula 


This  shows  that  the  voltage  across  the  inductor  is  directly  proportional  to  inductance  and  the  change 
in  current,  but  inversely  proportional  to  a  change  in  time.  Since  current  and  time  start  from  zero,  the 
change  in  time  (AT)  and  the  change  in  current  (AI)  are  equal  to  the  final  time  (T)  and  final  current  (I).  For 
this  case  the  equation  becomes: 


If  voltage  E  is  applied  for  time  (T)  across  the  inductor  (L),  the  final  current  (I)  will  flow.  The 
following  equations  show  how  the  three  terms  (T,  L,  and  C)  are  related: 


For  convenience,  you  can  find  T  in  terms  of  L  and  C  in  the  following  manner.  Multiply  the  left  and 
right  member  of  each  equation  as  follows: 


Q  =  IT  =  CE 


ET  =  LI 


IT  =  CE 
ET=LI 


3-25 


(IT)(ET)  =  (CE)(LI) 


Then: 


EIT2  =  LCEI 


Dividing  by  (EI):  T2  =  LC 


and 


T=  VLC 


This  final  equation  is  used  for  finding  the  time  required  for  a  voltage  change  to  travel  a  unit  length, 
since  L  and  C  are  given  in  terms  of  unit  length.  The  velocity  of  the  waves  may  be  found  by: 


Where:  D  is  the  physical  length  of  a  unit 

This  is  the  rate  at  which  the  wave  travels  over  a  unit  length.  The  units  of  L  and  C  are  henrys  and 
farads,  respectively.  T  is  in  seconds  per  unit  length  and  V  is  in  unit  lengths  per  second. 

DETERMINING  CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE 

As  previously  discussed,  an  infinite  transmission  line  exhibits  a  definite  input  impedance.  This 
impedance  is  the  CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE  and  is  independent  of  line  length.  The  exact  value 
of  this  impedance  is  the  ratio  of  the  input  voltage  to  the  input  current.  If  the  line  is  infinite  or  is  terminated 
in  a  resistance  equal  to  the  characteristic  impedance,  voltage  and  current  waves  traveling  the  line  are  in 
phase.  To  determine  the  characteristic  impedance  or  voltage-to-current  ratio,  use  the  following  procedure: 


V=—  or  V  = 
T 


D 


Divide  the  equation: 


ET  =  LI  by  LT  =  CE 


ET 


LI 


IT 


CE 


Multiply  by  — : 


E2T  LIE 


CEI 


Simplify: 


L 


C 


3-26 


Take  the  square  root: 


E  JT 

—  =  J—  =  Zfj (characteristic  impedance) 


Example: 


A  problem  using  this  equation  will  illustrate  how  to  determine  the  characteristics  of  a  transmission 
line.  Assume  that  the  line  shown  in  figure  3-23  is  1000  feet  long.  A  100-foot  (approximately  30.5  meter) 
section  is  measured  to  determine  L  and  C.  The  section  is  found  to  have  an  inductance  of  0.25  millihenries 
and  a  capacitance  of  1000  picofarads.  Find  the  characteristic  impedance  of  the  line  and  the  velocity  of  the 
wave  on  the  line. 


The  characteristic  impedance  is: 
Zn  =  JLC 


=  J  0.25  xlQ~3 
°  VlOOOxlO"12 

Z0  Wo.25xl06 

Z0  =0.5xl03 

Z0  =  500Q 

If  any  other  unit  length  had  been  considered,  the  values  of  L  and  C  would  be  different,  but  their  ratio 
would  remain  the  same  as  would  the  characteristic  impedance. 


The  formula  forT  is: 


T  =  Vo.25xlO  3  x  1000  x  10  12 


T  =  V.025  xl0-12 

T  =  0.5xlO~6  second 
T  =  0.5  microsecond 


3-27 


The  formula  for  the  velocity  of  a  wave  is: 
T 

_       100  feet 
O.SxlO"6  second 

V=  200  xio6feet/5econd 

V=  200,000,000  feet  Second 


REFLECTIONS  ON  A  TRANSMISSION  LINE 


Transmission  line  characteristics  are  based  on  an  infinite  line.  A  line  cannot  always  be  terminated  in 
its  characteristic  impedance  since  it  is  sometimes  operated  as  an  OPEN-ENDED  line  and  other  times  as  a 
SHORT-CIRCUIT  at  the  receiving  end.  If  the  line  is  open-ended,  it  has  a  terminating  impedance  that  is 
infinitely  large.  If  a  line  is  not  terminated  in  characteristic  impedance,  it  is  said  to  be  finite. 

When  a  line  is  not  terminated  in  Z0,  the  incident  energy  is  not  absorbed  but  is  returned  along  the  only 
path  available — the  transmission  line.  Thus,  the  behavior  of  a  finite  line  may  be  quite  different  from  that 
of  the  infinite  line. 

REFLECTION  OF  DC  VOLTAGE  FROM  AN  OPEN  CIRCUIT 

The  equivalent  circuit  of  an  open-ended  transmission  line  is  shown  in  figure  3-24,  view  A.  Again, 
losses  are  to  be  considered  as  negligible,  and  L  is  lumped  in  one  branch.  Assume  that  (1)  the  battery  in 
this  circuit  has  an  internal  impedance  equal  to  the  characteristic  impedance  of  the  transmission  line 
(Zi=  Z0);  (2)  the  capacitors  in  the  line  are  not  charged  before  the  battery  is  connected;  and  (3)  since  the 
line  is  open-ended,  the  terminating  impedance  is  infinitely  large. 


3-28 


B 


-E/2 1  1  1 

o  iq=^TH 

%\   I   ! 

VOLTAGE  AND  CURRENT  CHANGE  MOVES 
DOWN  LINE 


VOLTAGE  REFLECTED  0 
IN  PHASE 

-E/2 


CURRENT  REFLECTED  0 
OUT  OF  PHASE  L 


WHOLE  LINE 
CHARGED  TO  E 

D  -E 

CURRENT  0 
IS  ZERO 


Figure  3-24. — Reflection  from  an  open-ended  line. 

When  the  battery  is  connected  to  the  sending  end  as  shown,  a  negative  voltage  moves  down  the  line. 
This  voltage  charges  each  capacitor,  in  turn,  through  the  preceding  inductor.  Since  Z;  equals  Z0,  one-half 
the  applied  voltage  will  appear  across  the  internal  battery  impedance,  Z;,  and  one-half  across  the 
impedance  of  the  line,  Z0.  Each  capacitor  is  then  charged  to  E/2  (view  B).  When  the  last  capacitor  in  the 
line  is  charged,  there  is  no  voltage  across  the  last  inductor  and  current  flow  through  the  last  inductor 
stops.  With  no  current  flow  to  maintain  it,  the  magnetic  field  in  the  last  inductor  collapses  and  forces 
current  to  continue  to  flow  in  the  same  direction  into  the  last  capacitor.  Because  the  direction  of  current 
has  not  changed,  the  capacitor  charges  in  the  same  direction,  thereby  increasing  the  charge  in  the 
capacitor.  Since  the  energy  in  the  magnetic  field  equals  the  energy  in  the  capacitor,  the  energy  transfer  to 
the  capacitor  doubles  the  voltage  across  the  capacitor.  The  last  capacitor  is  now  charged  to  E  volts  and  the 
current  in  the  last  inductor  drops  to  zero. 

At  this  point,  the  same  process  takes  place  with  the  next  to  the  last  inductor  and  capacitor.  When  the 
magnetic  field  about  the  inductor  collapses,  current  continues  to  flow  into  the  next  to  the  last  capacitor, 
charging  it  to  E  volts.  This  action  continues  backward  down  the  line  until  the  first  capacitor  has  been  fully 
charged  to  the  applied  voltage.  This  change  of  voltage,  moving  backward  down  the  line,  can  be  thought  of 
in  the  following  manner.  The  voltage,  arriving  at  the  end  of  the  line,  finds  no  place  to  go  and  returns  to 
the  sending  end  with  the  same  polarity  (view  C).  Such  action  is  called  REFLECTION. 

When  a  reflection  of  voltage  occurs  on  an  open-ended  line,  the  polarity  is  unchanged.  The  voltage 
change  moves  back  to  the  source,  charging  each  capacitor  in  turn  until  the  first  capacitor  is  charged  to  the 


3-29 


source  voltage  and  the  action  stops  (view  D).  As  each  capacitor  is  charged,  current  in  each  inductor  drops 
to  zero,  effectively  reflecting  the  current  with  the  opposite  polarity  (view  C).  Reflected  current  of 
opposite  polarity  cancels  the  original  current  at  each  point,  and  the  current  drops  to  zero  at  that  point. 
When  the  last  capacitor  is  charged,  the  current  from  the  source  stops  flowing  (view  D). 

Important  facts  to  remember  in  the  reflection  of  dc  voltages  in  open-ended  lines  are: 

•  Voltage  is  reflected  from  an  open  end  without  change  in  polarity,  amplitude,  or  shape. 

•  Current  is  reflected  from  an  open  end  with  opposite  polarity  and  without  change  in  amplitude  or 
shape. 

REFLECTION  OF  DC  VOLTAGE  FROM  A  SHORT  CIRCUIT 

A  SHORT-CIRCUITED  line  affects  voltage  change  differently  from  the  way  an  open-circuited  line 
affects  it.  The  voltage  across  a  perfect  short  circuit  must  be  zero;  therefore,  no  power  can  be  absorbed  in 
the  short,  and  the  energy  is  reflected  toward  the  generator. 

The  initial  circuit  is  shown  in  figure  3-25,  view  A.  The  initial  voltage  and  current  waves  (view  B)  are 
the  same  as  those  given  for  an  infinite  line.  In  a  short-circuited  line  the  voltage  change  arrives  at  the  last 
inductor  in  the  same  manner  as  the  waves  on  an  open-ended  line.  In  this  case,  however,  there  is  no 
capacitor  to  charge.  The  current  through  the  final  inductor  produces  a  voltage  with  the  polarity  shown  in 
view  C.  When  the  field  collapses,  the  inductor  acts  as  a  battery  and  forces  current  through  the  capacitor  in 
the  opposite  direction,  causing  it  to  discharge  (view  D).  Since  the  amount  of  energy  stored  in  the 
magnetic  field  is  the  same  as  that  in  the  capacitor,  the  capacitor  discharges  to  zero. 


3-30 


SHORT  CIRCUIT 


0 

-E/2 


VOLTAGE 


0 

-1/2 


CURRENT 


VOLTAGE  AND  CURRENT  CHANGE  MOVES  DOWN 
LINE  AS  USUAL 


C 


COLLAPSE  OF  FIELD  IS  SAME  AS  BATTERY  OF 
OPPOSITE  POLARITY 


0  . 

VOLTAGE  REDUCED  TO  ZERO 


-E/2- 

0  ■ 

-1/2  . 


CURRENT  DOUBLED 

I 


Figure  3-25. — Reflection  from  a  short-circuited  line. 

Now  there  is  no  voltage  to  maintain  the  current  through  the  next  to  the  last  inductor.  Therefore,  this 
inductor  discharges  the  next  to  the  last  capacitor. 

As  each  capacitor  is  discharged  to  zero,  the  next  inductor  effectively  becomes  a  new  source  of 
voltage.  The  amplitude  of  each  of  these  voltages  is  equal  to  E/2,  but  the  polarity  is  the  opposite  of  the 
battery  at  the  input  end  of  the  line.  The  collapsing  field  around  each  inductor,  in  turn,  produces  a  voltage 
that  forces  the  current  to  continue  flowing  in  the  same  direction,  adding  to  the  current  from  the  source  to 
make  it  21.  This  action  continues  until  all  the  capacitors  are  discharged  (view  E). 

Reflected  waves  from  a  short-circuited  transmission  line  are  characterized  as  follows: 

•  The  reflected  voltage  has  the  opposite  polarity  but  the  same  amplitude  as  the  incident  wave. 

•  The  reflected  current  has  the  same  polarity  and  the  same  amplitude  as  the  incident  current. 


3-31 


REFLECTION  OF  AC  VOLTAGE  FROM  AN  OPEN  CIRCUIT 


In  most  cases  where  rf  lines  are  used,  the  voltages  applied  to  the  sending  end  are  ac  voltages.  The 
action  at  the  receiving  end  of  the  line  is  exactly  the  same  for  ac  as  for  dc.  In  the  open-ended  line,  shown  in 
figure  3-26,  view  A,  the  generated  ac  voltage  is  distributed  along  the  line,  shown  in  view  B.  This  voltage 
is  distributed  in  such  a  way  that  as  each  instantaneous  voltage  arrives  at  the  end,  it  is  reflected  with  the 
same  polarity  and  amplitude.  When  ac  is  used,  this  reflection  is  in  phase.  Each  of  the  reflected  voltages 
travels  back  along  the  line  until  it  reaches  the  generator.  If  the  generator  impedance  is  the  same  as  the  line 
impedance,  energy  arriving  at  the  generator  is  absorbed  and  not  reflected  again.  Now  two  voltages  are  on 
the  line. 

A.  RF  LINE 


VOLTAGE  THAT  WOULD 
HAVE  CONTI NUED  ON 
HAD  LINE  BEEN  LONGER 


RESULTANT  WAVE 

C.  INCIDENT  AND  REFLECTED  CURRENTADD  TO  FORM  RESULTANT  WAVE 
I  I  I  I 

Figure  3-26. — Formation  of  standing  waves. 

View  B  shows  how  two  waves  of  the  same  frequency  and  amplitude  moving  in  opposite  directions 
on  the  same  conductor  will  combine  to  form  a  resultant  wave.  The  small  solid  line  is  moving  steadily 
from  left  to  right  and  is  the  INCIDENT  WAVE  (from  the  source).  The  broken-line  waveform  is  moving 
from  right  to  left  and  is  the  REFLECTED  WAVE.  The  resultant  waveform,  the  heavy  line,  is  found  by 
algebraically  adding  instantaneous  values  of  the  two  waveforms.  The  resultant  waveform  has  an 


3-32 


instantaneous  peak  amplitude  that  is  equal  to  the  sum  of  the  peak  amplitudes  of  the  incident  and  reflected 
waves.  Since  most  indicating  instruments  are  unable  to  separate  these  voltages,  they  show  the  vector  sum. 
An  oscilloscope  is  usually  used  to  study  the  instantaneous  voltages  on  rf  lines. 

Since  two  waves  of  voltage  are  moving  on  the  line,  you  need  to  know  how  to  distinguish  between  the 
two.  The  voltages  moving  toward  the  receiving  end  are  called  INCIDENT  VOLTAGES,  and  the  whole 
waveshape  is  called  the  INCIDENT  WAVE.  The  wave  moving  back  to  the  sending  end  after  reflection  is 
called  the  REFLECTED  WAVE.  The  resultant  voltage  curve  (view  B  of  figure  3-26)  shows  that  the 
voltage  is  maximum  at  the  end  of  the  line,  a  condition  that  occurs  across  an  open  circuit. 

Another  step  in  investigating  the  open-circuited  rf  line  is  to  see  how  the  current  waves  act.  The 
incident  current  wave  is  the  solid  line  in  figure  3-26,  view  C.  The  voltage  is  represented  by  the  dotted 
line.  The  current  is  in  phase  with  the  voltage  while  traveling  toward  the  receiving  end.  At  the  end  of  the 
line,  the  current  is  reflected  in  the  opposite  polarity;  that  is,  it  is  shifted  180  degrees  in  phase,  but  its 
amplitude  remains  the  same.  The  reflected  wave  of  current  is  shown  by  dashed  lines  in  view  C.  The 
heavy -line  curve  represents  the  sum  of  the  two  instantaneous  currents  and  is  the  resultant  wave.  Notice 
that  current  is  zero  at  the  end  of  the  line.  This  is  reasonable,  since  there  can  be  no  current  flow  through  an 
open  circuit. 

Views  B  and  C  of  figure  3-26  show  the  voltage  and  current  distribution  along  a  transmission  line  at  a 
point  about  1/8  after  a  maximum  voltage  or  current  reaches  the  end  of  the  line.  Since  the  instantaneous 
values  are  continuously  changing  during  the  generation  of  a  complete  cycle,  a  large  number  of  these 
pictures  are  required  to  show  the  many  different  relationships. 

Figure  3-27  shows  the  incident  and  reflected  waveshapes  at  several  different  times.  The  diagrams  in 
the  left  column  of  figure  3-27  (representing  voltage)  show  the  incident  wave  and  its  reflection  without 
change  in  polarity.  In  figure  3-27,  waveform  (1),  the  incident  wave  and  the  reflected  wave  are  added 
algebraically  to  produce  the  resultant  wave  indicated  by  the  heavy  line.  In  waveform  (2),  a  zero  point 
preceding  the  negative-going  cycle  of  the  incident  wave  is  at  the  end  of  the  line.  The  reflected  wave  and 
incident  wave  are  180  degrees  out  of  phase  at  all  points.  (The  reflected  wave  is  the  positive  cycle  that  just 
preceded  the  negative  cycle  now  approaching  the  end  of  the  line.)  The  resultant  of  the  incident  and 
reflected  waves  is  zero  at  all  points  along  the  line.  In  waveform  (3),  the  waves  have  moved  1/8X.  along  the 
line;  the  incident  wave  has  moved  45  degrees  to  the  right,  and  the  reflected  wave  has  moved  45  degrees  to 
the  left.  The  resultant  voltage,  shown  by  the  heavy  line,  has  a  maximum  negative  at  the  end  of  the  line 
and  a  maximum  positive  I /2k  from  the  end  of  the  line. 


3-33 


VOLTAGE  CURRENT 

REFLECTIONS 


Figure  3-27. — Instantaneous  values  of  incident  and  reflected  waves  on  an  open-ended  line. 

3-34 


In  waveform  (4),  the  incident  wave  is  at  a  maximum  negative  value  at  the  end  of  the  line.  The  wave 
has  moved  another  45  degrees  to  the  right  from  the  wave  in  the  preceding  illustration.  The  reflected  wave 
has  also  moved  45  degrees,  but  to  the  left.  The  reflected  wave  is  in  phase  with  the  incident  wave.  The 
resultant  of  these  two  waves,  shown  by  the  dark  line,  again  has  a  negative  maximum  at  the  end  of  the  line 
and  a  positive  maximum  1/2A,  from  the  end  of  the  line.  Notice  that  these  maxima  have  a  greater  amplitude 
than  those  in  waveform  (3). 

In  waveform  (5),  the  incident  wave  has  moved  another  45  degrees  to  the  right  and  the  reflected  wave 
45  degrees  to  the  left.  The  resultant  again  is  maximum  negative  at  the  end  and  positive  maximum  1/2A, 
from  the  end.  The  maxima  are  lower  than  those  in  waveform  (4).  In  waveform  (6),  the  incident  and 
reflected  wave  have  moved  another  1/8X.  The  two  waves  again  are  180  degrees  out  of  phase,  giving  a 
resultant  wave  with  no  amplitude.  The  incident  and  reflected  waves  continue  moving  in  opposite 
directions,  adding  to  produce  the  resultant  waveshapes  shown  in  waveforms  (7)  and  (8).  Notice  that  the 
maximum  voltage  in  each  resultant  wave  is  at  the  end  and  1/2A,  from  the  end. 

Study  each  part  of  figure  3-27  carefully  and  you  will  get  a  clear  picture  of  how  the  resultant 
waveforms  of  voltage  are  produced.  You  will  also  see  that  the  resultant  voltage  wave  on  an  open-ended 
line  is  always  zero  at  1/4A,  and  3/4A,  from  the  end  of  the  transmission  line.  Since  the  zero  and  maximum 
points  are  always  in  the  same  place,  the  resultant  of  the  incident  and  the  reflected  wave  is  called  a 
STANDING  WAVE  of  voltage. 

The  right-hand  column  in  figure  3-27  shows  the  current  waveshapes  on  the  open-ended  line.  Since 
the  current  is  reflected  out  of  phase  at  an  open  end,  the  resultant  waveshapes  differ  from  those  for  voltage. 
The  two  out-of-phase  components  always  cancel  at  the  end  of  the  transmission  line,  so  the  resultant  is 
always  zero  at  that  point.  If  you  check  all  the  resultant  waveshapes  shown  in  the  right-hand  column  of 
figure  3-27,  you  will  see  that  a  zero  point  always  occurs  at  the  end  and  at  a  point  1/2A,  from  the  end. 
Maximum  voltages  occur  1/4A,  and  3/4A,  from  the  end. 

When  an  ac  meter  is  used  to  measure  the  voltages  and  currents  along  a  line,  the  polarity  is  not 
indicated.  If  you  plot  all  the  current  and  voltage  readings  along  the  length  of  the  line,  you  will  get  curves 
like  the  ones  shown  in  figure  3-28.  Notice  that  all  are  positive.  These  curves  are  the  conventional  method 
of  showing  current  and  voltage  standing  waves  on  rf  lines. 


Figure  3-28. — Conventional  picture  of  standing  waves. 

When  an  rf  line  is  terminated  in  a  short  circuit,  reflection  is  complete,  but  the  effect  on  voltage  and 
current  differs  from  that  in  an  open-ended  line.  Voltage  is  reflected  in  opposite  phase,  while  current  is 
reflected  in  phase.  Again  refer  to  the  series  of  pictures  shown  in  figure  3-27.  However,  this  time  the  left 
column  represents  current,  since  it  shows  reflection  in  phase;  and  the  right  column  of  pictures  now 
represents  the  voltage  changes  on  the  shorted  line,  since  it  shows  reflection  out  of  phase. 


3-35 


The  composite  diagram  in  figure  3-29  shows  all  resultant  curves  on  a  full-wavelength  section  of  line 
over  a  complete  cycle.  Notice  that  the  amplitude  of  the  voltage  varies  between  zero  and  maximum  in  both 
directions  at  the  center  and  at  both  ends  as  well  but,  one -fourth  of  the  distance  from  each  end  the  voltage 
is  always  zero.  The  resultant  waveshape  is  referred  to  as  a  standing  wave  of  voltage.  Standing  waves, 
then,  are  caused  by  reflections,  which  occur  only  when  the  line  is  not  terminated  in  its  characteristic 
impedance. 


LENGTH  OF  LINE   ► 


COMPOSITE  PICTURE  OF  RESULTANTS  IN 
LEFT  COLUMN  OF  FIGURE  3-27 


X      3/4  X    1/2X     1/4X  0 


B  MAX 
t 

AMPLITUDE 
I 

ZERO 


RELATIVE  AMPLITUDE  AT  EACH  POINT 
OVER  A  PERIOD  OF  TIME 


COMPOSITE  PICTURE  OF  RESULTANTS  IN 
RIGHT  COLUMN  OF  FIGU  RE  3-27 


X     3/4 X    1/2X     1/4  \  0 


RELATIVE  AMPLITUDE  AT  EACH  POINT 
OVER  A  PERIOD  OF  TIME 


E 


E 


COMBINED  VOLTAGE  AND  CURRENT  PICTURE 

Figure  3-29. — Composite  results  of  instantaneous  waves. 
3-36 


The  voltage  at  the  center  and  the  ends  varies  at  a  sinusoidal  rate  between  the  limits  shown.  At  the 
one-fourth  the  three -fourths  points,  the  voltage  is  always  zero.  A  continuous  series  of  diagrams  such  as 
these  is  difficult  to  see  with  conventional  test  equipment,  which  reads  the  effective  or  average  voltage 
over  several  cycles.  The  curve  of  amplitude  over  the  length  of  line  for  several  cycles  is  shown  in  figure 
3-29,  view  B.  A  meter  will  read  zero  at  the  points  shown  and  will  show  a  maximum  voltage  at  the  center, 
no  matter  how  many  cycles  pass. 

As  shown  in  view  D,  the  amplitude  varies  along  the  length  of  the  line.  In  this  case  it  is  zero  at  the 
end  and  center  but  maximum  at  the  one -fourth  and  three -fourths  points.  The  entire  diagram  of  the  open- 
ended  line  conditions  is  shown  in  view  E.  The  standing  waves  of  voltage  and  current  appear  together. 
Observe  that  one  is  maximum  when  the  other  is  minimum.  The  current  and  voltage  standing  waves  are 
one-quarter  cycle,  or  90  degrees,  out  of  phase  with  one  another. 

REFLECTION  OF  AC  VOLTAGE  FROM  A  SHORT  CIRCUIT 

Reflection  is  complete  when  an  rf  line  is  terminated  in  a  short  circuit,  but  the  effect  on  voltage  and 
current  differs  from  the  effect  obtained  in  an  open-ended  line.  Voltage  is  reflected  in  opposite  phase, 
while  current  is  reflected  in  phase.  Again  look  at  the  series  of  diagrams  in  figure  3-27.  The  left  column 
represents  current,  and  the  right  column  shows  voltage  changes  on  the  shorted  line.  The  standard 
representation  of  standing  waves  on  a  shorted  line  is  shown  in  figure  3-30;  the  voltage  is  a  solid  line,  and 
the  current  is  a  dashed  line.  The  voltage  is  zero  at  the  end  and  center  (1/2A)  and  maximum  at  the  1/4A-  and 
3/4A,  points,  while  the  current  is  maximum  at  the  end  and  center  and  minimum  at  the  1/4A,  and  3/4A,  points. 


LINE 


Figure  3-30. — Standing  waves  on  a  shorted  line. 

As  we  discussed  voltage  and  current  waves  on  transmission  lines,  we  pointed  out  several  differences 
between  open  and  shorted  lines.  Basic  differences  also  appear  in  the  standing-wave  patterns  for  open  and 
shorted  lines.  You  can  see  these  differences  by  comparing  figure  3-29,  view  E,  and  figure  3-30.  Notice 
that  the  current  and  voltage  standing  waves  are  shifted  90  degrees  with  respect  to  the  termination.  At  the 
open  end  of  a  line,  voltage  is  maximum  (zero  if  there  are  no  losses  in  the  line).  At  a  short  circuit,  current 
is  maximum  and  voltage  is  minimum. 

Q23.   Two  types  of  waves  are  formed  on  a  transmission  line.  What  names  are  given  to  these  waves? 


3-37 


Q24.  In  figure  3-27,  which  waveforms  on  the  left  have  a  resultant  wave  of  zero,  and  what  is  indicated  by 
these  waves? 

Q25.  On  an  open-ended  transmission  line,  the  voltage  is  always  zero  at  what  distance  from  each  end  of 
the  line? 

TERMINATING  A  TRANSMISSION  LINE 

A  transmission  line  is  either  NONRESONANT  or  RESONANT.  First,  let  us  define  the  terms 
nonresonant  lines  and  resonant  lines.  A  nonresonant  line  is  a  line  that  has  no  standing  waves  of  current 
and  voltage.  A  resonant  line  is  a  line  that  has  standing  waves  of  current  and  voltage. 

Nonresonant  Lines 

A  nonresonant  line  is  either  infinitely  long  or  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance.  Since  no 
reflections  occur,  all  the  energy  traveling  down  the  line  is  absorbed  by  the  load  which  terminates  the  line. 
Since  no  standing  waves  are  present,  this  type  of  line  is  sometimes  spoken  of  as  a  FLAT  line.  In  addition, 
because  the  load  impedance  of  such  a  line  is  equal  to  Z0,  no  special  tuning  devices  are  required  to  effect  a 
maximum  power  transfer;  hence,  the  line  is  also  called  an  UNTUNED  line. 

Resonant  Lines 

A  resonant  line  has  a  finite  length  and  is  not  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance.  Therefore 
reflections  of  energy  do  occur.  The  load  impedance  is  different  from  the  Z0  of  the  line;  therefore,  the  input 
impedance  may  not  be  purely  resistive  but  may  have  reactive  components.  Tuning  devices  are  used  to 
eliminate  the  reactance  and  to  bring  about  maximum  power  transfer  from  the  source  to  the  line. 
Therefore,  a  resonant  line  is  sometimes  called  a  TUNED  line.  The  line  also  may  be  used  for  a  resonant  or 
tuned  circuit. 

A  resonant  line  is  sometimes  said  to  be  resonant  at  an  applied  frequency.  This  means  that  at  one 
frequency  the  line  acts  as  a  resonant  circuit.  It  may  act  either  as  a  high-resistive  circuit  (parallel  resonant) 
or  as  a  low-resistive  circuit  (series  resonant).  The  line  may  be  made  to  act  in  this  manner  by  either  open- 
or  short-circuiting  it  at  the  output  end  and  cutting  it  to  some  multiple  of  a  quarter-wavelength. 

At  the  points  of  voltage  maxima  and  minima  on  a  short-circuited  or  open-circuited  line,  the  line 
impedance  is  resistive.  On  a  short-circuited  line,  each  point  at  an  odd  number  of  quarter-wavelengths 
from  the  receiving  end  has  a  high  impedance  (figure  3-31,  view  A).  If  the  frequency  of  the  applied 
voltage  to  the  line  is  varied,  this  impedance  decreases  as  the  effective  length  of  the  line  changes.  This 
variation  is  exactly  the  same  as  the  change  in  the  impedance  of  a  parallel-resonant  circuit  when  the 
applied  frequency  is  varied. 


3-38 


Figure  3-31. — Sending-end  impedance  of  various  lengths  and  terminations. 

At  all  even  numbered  quarter-wavelength  points  from  the  short  circuit,  the  impedance  is  extremely 
low.  When  the  frequency  of  the  voltage  applied  to  the  line  is  varied,  the  impedance  at  these  points 
increases  just  as  the  impedance  of  a  series-resonant  circuit  varies  when  the  frequency  applied  to  it  is 
changed.  The  same  is  true  for  an  open-ended  line  (figure  3-31,  view  B)  except  that  the  points  of  high  and 
low  impedance  are  reversed. 

At  this  point  let  us  review  some  of  the  characteristics  of  resonant  circuits  so  we  can  see  how  resonant 
line  sections  may  be  used  in  place  of  LC  circuits. 

A  PARALLEL-RESONANT  circuit  has  the  following  characteristics: 

•  At  resonance  the  impedance  appears  as  a  very  high  resistance.  A  loss-free  circuit  has  infinite 
impedance  (an  open  circuit).  Other  than  at  resonance,  the  impedance  decreases  rapidly. 

•  If  the  circuit  is  resonant  at  a  point  above  the  generator  frequency  (the  generator  frequency  is  too 
low),  more  current  flows  through  the  coil  than  through  the  capacitor.  This  happens  because  XL 
decreases  with  a  decrease  in  frequency  but  Xc  increases. 

A  SERIES-RESONANT  circuit  has  these  characteristics: 


3-39 


•  At  resonance  the  impedance  appears  as  a  very  low  resistance.  A  loss-free  circuit  has  zero 
impedance  (a  short  circuit).  Other  than  at  resonance  the  impedance  increases  rapidly. 

•  If  the  circuit  is  resonant  at  a  point  above  the  generator  frequency  (the  generator  frequency  is 
too  low),  then  Xc  is  larger  than  XL  and  the  circuit  acts  capacitively. 

•  If  the  circuit  is  resonant  at  a  point  below  the  generator  frequency  (the  generator  frequency  is 
too  high),  then  XL  is  larger  than  Xc  and  the  circuit  acts  inductively. 

Since  the  impedance  a  generator  sees  at  the  quarter-wave  point  in  a  shorted  line  is  that  of  a  parallel- 
resonant  circuit,  a  shorted  quarter-wave-  length  of  line  may  be  used  as  a  parallel-resonant  circuit  (figure 
3-31,  view  C).  An  open  quarter-wavelength  of  line  may  be  used  as  a  series-resonant  circuit  (view  D).  The 
Q  of  such  a  resonant  line  is  much  greater  than  can  be  obtained  with  lumped  capacitance  and  inductance. 

Impedance  for  Various  Lengths  of  Open  Lines 

In  figure  3-32,  the  impedance  (Z)  the  generator  sees  for  various  lengths  of  line  is  shown  at  the  top. 
The  curves  above  the  letters  of  various  heights  show  the  relative  value  of  the  impedances  presented  to  the 
generator  for  the  various  line  lengths.  The  circuit  symbols  indicate  the  equivalent  electrical  circuits  for  the 
transmission  lines  at  each  particular  length.  The  standing  waves  of  voltage  and  current  are  shown  on  each 
length  of  line. 


3-40 


Figure  3-32. — Voltage,  current,  and  impedance  on  open  line. 

At  all  odd  quarter- wave  points  3/4X,  etc.),  the  voltage  is  minimum,  the  current  is  maximum, 

and  the  impedance  is  minimum.  Thus,  at  all  odd  quarter-wave  points,  the  open-ended  transmission  line 
acts  as  a  series-resonant  circuit.  The  impedance  is  equivalent  to  a  very  low  resistance,  prevented  from 
being  zero  only  by  small  circuit  losses. 

At  all  even  quarter-wave  points  (1/2X,  IX,  3/2X,  etc.),  the  voltage  is  maximum,  the  current  is 
minimum,  and  the  impedance  is  maximum.  Comparison  of  the  line  with  an  LC  resonant  circuit  shows  that 
at  an  even  number  of  quarter- wavelengths,  an  open  line  acts  as  a  parallel-resonant  circuit.  The  impedance 
is  therefore  an  extremely  high  resistance. 

In  addition,  resonant  open  lines  may  also  act  as  nearly  pure  capacitances  or  inductances.  The 
illustration  shows  that  an  open  line  less  than  a  quarter-wavelength  long  acts  as  a  capacitance.  Also,  it  acts 


3-41 


as  an  inductance  from  1/4  to  1/2  wavelength,  as  a  capacitance  from  1/2  to  3/4  wavelength,  and  as  an 
inductance  from  3/4  to  1  wavelength,  etc.  A  number  of  open  transmission  lines,  with  their  equivalent 
circuits,  are  shown  in  the  illustration. 

Impedance  of  Various  Lengths  of  Shorted  Lines 

Follow  figure  3-33  as  we  study  the  shorted  line.  At  the  odd  quarter-wavelength  points,  the  voltage  is 
high,  the  current  is  low,  and  the  impedance  is  high.  Since  these  conditions  are  similar  to  those  found  in  a 
parallel-resonant  circuit,  the  shorted  transmission  line  acts  as  a  parallel-resonant  circuit  at  these  lengths. 


Figure  3-33. — Voltage,  current,  and  impedance  on  shorted  line. 


3-42 


At  the  even  quarter-wave  points  voltage  is  minimum,  current  is  maximum,  and  impedance  is 
minimum.  Since  these  characteristics  are  similar  to  those  of  a  series-resonant  LC  circuit,  a  shorted 
transmission  line  whose  length  is  an  even  number  of  quarter-wavelengths  acts  as  a  series-resonant  circuit. 

Resonant  shorted  lines,  like  open-end  lines,  also  may  act  as  pure  capacitances  or  inductances.  The 
illustration  shows  that  a  shorted  line  less  than  1/4  wavelength  long  acts  as  an  inductance.  A  shorted  line 
with  a  length  of  from  1/4  to  1/2  wavelength  acts  as  a  capacitance.  From  1/2  to  3/4  wavelength,  the  line 
acts  as  an  inductance;  and  from  3/4  to  1  wavelength,  it  acts  as  a  capacitance,  and  so  on.  The  equivalent 
circuits  of  shorted  lines  of  various  lengths  are  shown  in  the  illustration.  Thus,  properly  chosen  line 
segments  may  be  used  as  parallel-resonant,  series-resonant,  inductive,  or  capacitive  circuits. 


STANDING  WAVES  ON  A  TRANSMISSION  LINE 

There  is  a  large  variety  of  terminations  for  rf  lines.  Each  type  of  termination  has  a  characteristic 
effect  on  the  standing  waves  on  the  line.  From  the  nature  of  the  standing  waves,  you  can  determine  the 
type  of  termination  that  produces  the  waves. 

TERMINATION  IN  Z0 

Termination  in  Z0  (characteristic  impedance)  will  cause  a  constant  reading  on  an  ac  meter  when  it  is 
moved  along  the  length  of  the  line.  As  illustrated  in  figure  3-34,  view  A,  the  curve,  provided  there  are  no 
losses  in  the  line,  will  be  a  straight  line.  If  there  are  losses  in  the  line,  the  amplitude  of  the  voltage  and 
current  will  diminish  as  they  move  down  the  line  (view  B).  The  losses  are  due  to  dc  resistance  in  the  line 
itself. 


3-43 


NO 

^0  LOSSES 


WITH 
LOSSES 


-ONE  WAVELENGTH- 


OPEN 


V  V  V  \/  V   x  , 


SHORT 


Xc=z0 


V  \/  \/  \/  V 


x,  =  z 


L=^0 


R>Z0 


H 


R<Z0 


Figure  3-34. — Effects  of  various  terminations  on  standing  waves. 

TERMINATION  IN  AN  OPEN  CIRCUIT 

In  an  open-circuited  rf  line  (figure  3-34,  view  C),  the  voltage  is  maximum  at  the  end,  but  the  current 
is  minimum.  The  distance  between  two  adjacent  zero  current  points  is  1/2X,  and  the  distance  between 
alternate  zero  current  points  is  Yk.  The  voltage  is  zero  at  a  distance  of  1/4X.  from  the  end  of  the  line.  This 
is  true  at  any  frequency.  A  voltage  peak  occurs  at  the  end  of  the  line,  at  1/2A,  from  the  end,  and  at  each 
1/2  A,  thereafter. 


3-44 


TERMINATION  IN  A  SHORT  CIRCUIT 


On  the  line  terminated  in  a  short  circuit,  shown  in  figure  3-34,  view  D,  the  voltage  is  zero  at  the  end 
and  maximum  at  1/4 A,  from  the  end.  The  current  is  maximum  at  the  end,  zero  at  1/4  A,  from  the  end,  and 
alternately  maximum  and  zero  every  1/4  A,  thereafter. 

TERMINATION  IN  CAPACITANCE 

When  a  line  is  terminated  in  capacitance,  the  capacitor  does  not  absorb  energy,  but  returns  all  of  the 
energy  to  the  circuit.  This  means  there  is  100  percent  reflection.  The  current  and  voltage  relationships  are 
somewhat  more  involved  than  in  previous  types  of  termination.  For  this  explanation,  assume  that  the 
capacitive  reactance  is  equal  to  the  Z0  of  the  line.  Current  and  voltage  are  in  phase  when  they  arrive  at  the 
end  of  the  line,  but  in  flowing  through  the  capacitor  and  the  characteristic  impedance  (Z0)  connected  in 
series,  they  shift  in  phase  relationship.  Current  and  voltage  arrive  in  phase  and  leave  out  of  phase.  This 
results  in  the  standing-wave  configuration  shown  in  figure  3-34,  view  E.  The  standing  wave  of  voltage  is 
minimum  at  a  distance  of  exactly  1/8A,  from  the  end.  If  the  capacitive  reactance  is  greater  than  Z0  (smaller 
capacitance),  the  termination  looks  more  like  an  open  circuit;  the  voltage  minimum  moves  away  from  the 
end.  If  the  capacitive  reactance  is  smaller  than  Zq,  the  minimum  moves  toward  the  end. 

TERMINATION  IN  INDUCTANCE 

When  the  line  is  terminated  in  an  inductance,  both  the  current  and  voltage  shift  in  phase  as  they 
arrive  at  the  end  of  the  line.  When  XL  is  equal  to  Z0,  the  resulting  standing  waves  are  as  shown  in  figure 
3-34,  view  F.  The  current  minimum  is  located  1/8X  from  the  end  of  the  line.  When  the  inductive  reactance 
is  increased,  the  standing  waves  appear  closer  to  the  end.  When  the  inductive  reactance  is  decreased,  the 
standing  waves  move  away  from  the  end  of  the  line. 

TERMINATION  IN  A  RESISTANCE  NOT  EQUAL  TO  THE  CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE 

(Z0) 

Whenever  the  termination  is  not  equal  to  Z0,  reflections  occur  on  the  line.  For  example,  if  the 
terminating  element  contains  resistance,  it  absorbs  some  energy,  but  if  the  resistive  element  does  not 
equal  the  Z0  of  the  line,  some  of  the  energy  is  reflected.  The  amount  of  voltage  reflected  may  be  found  by 
using  the  equation: 


Where: 

ER  =  the  reflected  voltage 

Ej  =  the  incident  voltage 

RR  =  the  terminating  resistance 

Z0=  the  characteristic  impedance  of  the  line 

If  you  try  different  values  of  RL  in  the  preceding  equation,  you  will  find  that  the  reflected  voltage  is 
equal  to  the  incident  voltage  only  when  RL  equals  0  or  is  infinitely  large.  When  RL  equals  Z0,  no  reflected 
voltage  occurs.  When  RLis  greater  than  Z0,  ER  is  positive,  but  less  than  E;.  As  RL  increases  and 


3-45 


approaches  an  infinite  value,  ER  increases  and  approaches  E,  in  value.  When  RL  is  smaller  than  Z0,  ER  has 
a  negative  value.  This  means  that  the  reflected  voltage  is  of  opposite  polarity  to  the  incident  wave  at  the 
termination  of  the  line.  As  RL  approaches  zero,  ER  approaches  E;  in  value.  The  smaller  the  value  of  ER,  the 
smaller  is  the  peak  amplitude  of  the  standing  waves  and  the  higher  are  the  minimum  values. 

TERMINATION  IN  A  RESISTANCE  GREATER  THAN  Z0 

When  RL  is  greater  than  Z0,  the  end  of  the  line  is  somewhat  like  an  open  circuit;  that  is,  standing 
waves  appear  on  the  line.  The  voltage  maximum  appears  at  the  end  of  the  line  and  also  at  half-wave 
intervals  back  from  the  end.  The  current  is  minimum  (not  zero)  at  the  end  of  the  line  and  maximum  at  the 
odd  quarter-wave  points.  Since  part  of  the  power  in  the  incident  wave  is  consumed  by  the  load  resistance, 
the  minimum  voltage  and  current  are  less  than  for  the  standing  waves  on  an  open-ended  line.  Figure  3-34, 
view  G,  illustrates  the  standing  waves  for  this  condition. 

TERMINATION  IN  A  RESISTANCE  LESS  THAN  Z0 

When  RL  is  less  than  Z0,  the  termination  appears  as  a  short  circuit.  The  standing  waves  are  shown  in 
figure  3-34,  view  H.  Notice  that  the  line  terminates  in  a  current  LOOP  (peak)  and  a  voltage  NODE 
(minimum).  The  values  of  the  maximum  and  minimum  voltage  and  current  approach  those  for  a  shorted 
line  as  the  value  of  RL  approaches  zero. 

A  line  does  not  have  to  be  any  particular  length  to  produce  standing  waves;  however,  it  cannot  be  an 
infinite  line.  Voltage  and  current  must  be  reflected  to  produce  standing  waves.  For  reflection  to  occur,  a 
line  must  not  be  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance.  Reflection  occurs  on  lines  terminated  in 
opens,  shorts,  capacitances,  and  inductances,  because  no  energy  is  absorbed  by  the  load.  If  the  line  is 
terminated  in  a  resistance  not  equal  to  the  characteristic  impedance  of  the  line,  some  energy  will  be 
absorbed  and  the  rest  will  be  reflected. 

The  voltage  and  current  relationships  for  open-ended  and  shorted  lines  are  opposite  to  each  other,  as 
shown  in  figure  3-34,  views  C  and  D.  The  points  of  maximum  and  minimum  voltage  and  current  are 
determined  from  the  output  end  of  the  line,  because  reflection  always  begins  at  that  end. 

Q26.  A  nonresonant  line  is  a  line  that  has  no  standing  waves  of  current  and  voltage  on  it  and  is 
considered  to  be  flat.  Why  is  this  true? 

Q27.  On  an  open  line,  the  voltage  and  impedance  are  maximum  at  what  points  on  the  line? 

STANDING- WAVE  RATIO 

The  measurement  of  standing  waves  on  a  transmission  line  yields  information  about  equipment 
operating  conditions.  Maximum  power  is  absorbed  by  the  load  when  ZL  =  Z0.  If  a  line  has  no  standing 
waves,  the  termination  for  that  line  is  correct  and  maximum  power  transfer  takes  place. 

You  have  probably  noticed  that  the  variation  of  standing  waves  shows  how  near  the  rf  line  is  to 
being  terminated  in  Z0.  A  wide  variation  in  voltage  along  the  length  means  a  termination  far  from  Z0.  A 
small  variation  means  termination  near  Z0.  Therefore,  the  ratio  of  the  maximum  to  the  minimum  is  a 
measure  of  the  perfection  of  the  termination  of  a  line.  This  ratio  is  called  the  STANDING- WAVE  RATIO 
(swr)  and  is  always  expressed  in  whole  numbers.  For  example,  a  ratio  of  1:1  describes  a  line  terminated  in 
its  characteristic  impedance  (Z0). 


3-46 


Voltage  Standing- Wave  Ratio 


The  ratio  of  maximum  voltage  to  minimum  voltage  on  a  line  is  called  the  VOLTAGE  STANDING- 
WAVE  RATIO  (vswr) .  Therefore : 


E 

vswr  =  mfe 


E  ■ 


The  vertical  lines  in  the  formula  indicate  that  the  enclosed  quantities  are  absolute  and  that  the  two 
values  are  taken  without  regard  to  polarity.  Depending  on  the  nature  of  the  standing  waves,  the  numerical 
value  of  vswr  ranges  from  a  value  of  1  (ZL  =  Z0,  no  standing  waves)  to  an  infinite  value  for  theoretically 
complete  reflection.  Since  there  is  always  a  small  loss  on  a  line,  the  minimum  voltage  is  never  zero  and 
the  vswr  is  always  some  finite  value.  However,  if  the  vswr  is  to  be  a  useful  quantity,  the  power  losses 
along  the  line  must  be  small  in  comparison  to  the  transmitted  power. 

Power  Standing- Wave  Ratio 

The  square  of  the  voltage  standing-wave  ratio  is  called  the  POWER  STANDING- WAVE  RATIO 
(pswr).  Therefore: 


pswr 


■  mniin 


This  ratio  is  useful  because  the  instruments  used  to  detect  standing  waves  react  to  the  square  of  the 
voltage.  Since  power  is  proportional  to  the  square  of  the  voltage,  the  ratio  of  the  square  of  the  maximum 
and  minimum  voltages  is  called  the  power  standing-wave  ratio.  In  a  sense,  the  name  is  misleading 
because  the  power  along  a  transmission  line  does  not  vary. 

Current  Standing- Wave  Ratio 

The  ratio  of  maximum  to  minimum  current  along  a  transmission  line  is  called  CURRENT 
STANDING-WAVE  RATIO  (iswr) .  Therefore : 


15WI  =■ 


This  ratio  is  the  same  as  that  for  voltages.  It  can  be  used  where  measurements  are  made  with  loops 
that  sample  the  magnetic  field  along  a  line.  It  gives  the  same  results  as  vswr  measurements. 

Q28.  At  what  point  on  an  open-circuited  rfline  do  voltage  peaks  occur? 

Q29.   What  is  the  square  of  the  voltage  standing-wave  ratio  called? 

Q30.   What  does  vswr  measure  ? 


3-47 


SUMMARY 

This  chapter  has  presented  information  on  the  characteristics  of  transmission  lines.  The  information 
that  follows  summarizes  the  important  points  of  this  chapter. 

TRANSMISSION  LINES  are  devices  for  guiding  electrical  energy  from  one  point  to  another. 

INPUT  IMPEDANCE  is  the  ratio  of  voltage  to  current  at  the  input  end  of  a  transmission  line. 

OUTPUT  IMPEDANCE  is  the  ratio  of  voltage  to  current  at  the  output  end  of  the  line. 

TWO-WIRE  OPEN  LINES  are  parallel  lines  and  have  uses  such  as  power  lines,  rural  telephone 
lines,  and  telegraph  lines.  This  type  of  line  has  high  radiation  losses  and  is  subject  to  noise  pickup. 


TWIN  LEAD  has  parallel  lines  and  is  most  often  used  to  connect  televisions  to  their  antennas. 


A  TWISTED  PAIR  consists  of  two  insulated  wires  twisted  together.  This  line  has  high  insulation 

loss. 


3-48 


A  SHIELDED  PAIR  has  parallel  conductors  separated  by  a  solid  dielectric  and  surrounded  by 
copper  braided  tubing.  The  conductors  are  balanced  to  ground. 


RIGID  COAXIAL  LINE  contains  two  concentric  conductors  insulated  from  each  other  by  spacers. 
Some  rigid  coaxial  lines  are  pressurized  with  an  inert  gas  to  prevent  moisture  from  entering. 
High-frequency  losses  are  less  than  with  other  lines. 


FLEXIBLE  COAXIAL  LINES  consist  of  a  flexible  inner  conductor  and  a  concentric  outer 
conductor  of  metal  braid.  The  two  are  separated  by  a  continuous  insulating  material. 


WAVEGUIDES  are  hollow  metal  tubes  used  to  transfer  energy  from  one  point  to  another.  The 
energy  travels  slower  in  a  waveguide  than  in  free  space. 


3-49 


CYLINDRICAL 


RECTANGULAR 


COPPER  LOSSES  can  result  from  power  (I2R)  loss,  in  the  form  of  heat,  or  skin  effect.  These 
losses  decrease  the  conductivity  of  a  line. 

DIELECTRIC  LOSSES  are  caused  by  the  heating  of  the  dielectric  material  between  conductors, 
taking  power  from  the  source. 

RADIATION  and  INDUCTION  LOSSES  are  caused  by  part  of  the  electromagnetic  fields  of  a 
conductor  being  dissipated  into  space  or  nearby  objects. 

A  transmission  line  is  either  electrically  LONG  or  SHORT  if  its  physical  length  is  not  equal  to  1/4A, 
for  the  frequency  it  is  to  carry. 

LUMPED  CONSTANTS  are  theoretical  properties  (inductance,  resistance,  and  capacitance)  of  a 
transmission  line  that  are  lumped  into  a  single  component. 


TRANS- 
MITTER 


L 


R 


VWKjj_fljtv    *  VW*-i/ 


ANTENNA 

/' 

/ 

/ 


DISTRIBUTED  CONSTANTS  are  constants  of  inductance,  capacitance  and  resistance  that  are 
distributed  along  the  transmission  line. 


3-50 


n  q       n  n 

^  ^\  O  A  ^, 
^TiiiiiirtiiiiitiiTTi 


r\  f\  r\  £\ 


INDUCTANCE 


11111111111 

TTTTTTTTTTT 


CAPACITANCE 


V\AA/WWWVWW*AA/VWWWVWW\A/W 


RESISTANCE 


LEAKAGE  CURRENT  flows  between  the  wires  of  a  transmission  line  through  the  dielectric.  The 
dielectric  acts  as  a  resistor. 


An  ELECTROMAGNETIC  FIELD  exists  along  transmission  line  when  current  flows  through  it. 


3-51 


CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE,  Z0,  is  the  ratio  of  E  to  I  at  every  point  along  the  line.  For 
maximum  transfer  of  electrical  power,  the  characteristic  impedance  and  load  impedance  must  be  matched. 


WV^-r 


The  VELOCITY  at  which  a  wave  travels  over  a  given  length  of  transmission  line  can  be  found  by 
using  the  formula: 


A  transmission  line  that  is  not  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance  is  said  to  be  FINITE. 

When  dc  is  applied  to  an  OPEN-ENDED  line,  the  voltage  is  reflected  back  from  the  open  end 
without  any  change  in  polarity,  amplitude,  or  shape.  Current  is  reflected  back  with  the  same  amplitude 
and  shape  but  with  opposite  polarity. 


3-52 


When  dc  is  applied  to  a  SHORT-CIRCUITED  line,  the  current  is  reflected  back  with  the  same 
amplitude,  and  polarity.  The  voltage  is  reflected  back  with  the  same  amplitude  but  with  opposite  polarity. 

When  ac  is  applied  to  an  OPEN-END  line,  voltage  is  always  reflected  back  in  phase  with  the 
incident  wave  and  current  is  reflected  back  out  of  phase. 


VOLTAGE  THAT  WOULD 
HAVE  CONTINUED  ON 
HAD  LINE  BEEN  LONGER 


When  ac  is  applied  to  a  SHORT-CIRCUITED  line,  voltage  is  reflected  in  opposite  phase,  while 
current  is  reflected  in  phase. 


3-53 


REFLECTION 


VOLTAGE  CURRENT 


A  NONRESONANT  line  has  NO  STANDING  WAVES  of  current  and  voltage  and  is  either 
infinitely  long  or  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance. 

A  RESONANT  line  has  STANDING  WAVES  of  current  and  voltage  and  is  of  finite  length  and  is 
NOT  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance. 

On  an  open-ended  resonant  line,  and  at  all  odd  1/4X.  points,  the  voltage  is  minimum,  the  current  is 
maximum,  and  the  impedance  is  minimum.  At  all  even  MAX  points,  the  voltage  is  maximum,  the  current 
is  minimum  and  the  impedance  is  maximum. 


3-54 


There  are  a  variety  of  TERMINATIONS  for  rf  lines.  Each  termination  has  an  effect  on  the  standing 
waves  on  the  line. 


3-55 


A  transmission  line  can  be  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance  as  an  open-  or  short-circuit,  or 
in  capacitance  or  inductance. 

Whenever  the  termination  on  a  transmission  line  is  NOT  EQUAL  TO  Z  0,  there  are  reflections  on  the 
line.  The  amount  of  voltage  reflected  may  be  found  by  using  the  equation: 


When  the  termination  on  a  transmission  line  EQUALS  Z0,  there  is  NO  reflected  voltage. 

The  measurement  of  standing  waves  on  a  transmission  line  yields  information  about  operating 
conditions.  If  there  are  NO  standing  waves,  the  termination  for  that  line  is  correct  and  maximum  power 
transfer  takes  place. 

The  STANDING  WAVE  RATIO  is  the  measurement  of  maximum  voltage  (current)  to  minimum 
voltage  (current)  on  a  transmission  line  and  measures  the  perfection  of  the  termination  of  the  line.  A  ratio 
of  1 : 1  describes  a  line  terminated  in  its  characteristic  impedance. 


3-56 


ANSWERS  TO  QUESTIONS  Ql.  THROUGH  Q30. 

Al.  Transmission  line. 

A2.  Input  end,  generator  end,  transmitter  end,  sending  end,  and  source. 

A3.  Output  end,  receiving  end,  load  end  and  sink. 

A4.  Parallel  two-wire,  twisted  pair,  shielded  pair,  coaxial  line  and  waveguide. 

A5.  Power  lines,  rural  telephone  lines,  and  telegraph  lines. 

A6.  High  radiation  losses  and  noise  pickup. 

A7.  Twin  lead. 

A8.  The  conductors  are  balanced  to  ground. 

A9.  Air  coaxial  ( rigid)  and  solid  coaxial  (flexible). 

A10.  The  ability  to  minimize  radiation  losses. 

All.  Expensive  to  construct,  must  be  kept  dry,  and  high  frequency  losses  limit  the  practical  length  of 
the  line. 

A12.  Cylindrical  and  rectangular. 

A13.  Copper,  dielectric,  and  radiation. 

A14.  Copper  losses. 

A15.  Dielectric  losses. 

A16.  X  =  20  meters. 

A17.  (1)  Type  of  line  used,  (2)  dielectric  in  the  line,  and  (3)  length  of  line. 

A18.  Inductance  is  expressed  in  microhenrys  per  unit  length,  capacitance  is  expressed  in  picofarads  per 
unit  length,  and  resistance  is  expressed  in  ohms  per  unit  length. 

A19.   The  small  amount  of  current  that  flows  through  the  dielectric  between  two  wires  of  a  transmission 
line  and  is  expressed  in  micromhos  per  unit  length. 

A20.  When  the  characteristic  impedance  of  the  transmission  line  and  the  load  impedance  are  equal. 

A21.  Z0  and  it  is  the  ratio  ofE  to  I  at  every  point  along  the  line. 

A22.  Between  50  and  600  ohms. 

A23.  Incident  waves  from  generator  to  load.  Reflected  waves  from  load  back  to  generator. 

A24.  2  and  6  have  zero  resultant  wave  and  they  indicate  that  the  incident  and  reflected  waves  are  180 
degrees  out  of  phase  at  all  parts. 

A25.  One-fourth  the  distance  from  each  end  of  the  line. 

3-57 


A26.  The  load  impedance  of  such  a  line  is  equal  to  Zq. 

A27.  Even  quarter-wave  points  (1/2X,  IX,  3/2X,  etc.). 

A28.  At  1/2  wavelength  from  the  end  and  at  every  1/2  wavelength  along  the  line. 

A29.  Power  standing-wave  ratio  (pswr). 

A30.  The  existence  of  voltage  variations  on  a  line. 


3-58 


CHAPTER  4 

ANTENNAS 

LEARNING  OBJECTIVES 

Upon  completion  of  this  chapter  you  will  be  able  to: 

1 .  State  the  basic  principles  of  antenna  radiation  and  list  the  parts  of  an  antenna. 

2.  Explain  current  and  voltage  distribution  on  an  antenna. 

3.  Describe  how  electromagnetic  energy  is  radiated  from  an  antenna. 

4.  Explain  polarization,  gain,  and  radiation  resistance  characteristics  of  an  antenna. 

5.  Describe  the  theory  of  operation  of  half-  wave  and  quarter-wave  antennas. 

6.  List  the  various  array  antennas. 

7.  Describe  the  directional  array  antennas  presented  and  explain  the  basic  operation  of  each. 

8.  Identify  various  special  antennas  presented,  such  as  long-wire,  V,  rhombic,  turnstile, 
ground-plane,  and  corner-reflector;  describe  the  operation  of  each. 

9.  List  safety  precautions  when  working  aloft  and  around  antennas. 

INTRODUCTION 

If  you  had  been  around  in  the  early  days  of  electronics,  you  would  have  considered  an  ANTENNA 
(AERIAL)  to  be  little  more  than  a  piece  of  wire  strung  between  two  trees  or  upright  poles.  In  those  days, 
technicians  assumed  that  longer  antennas  automatically  provided  better  reception  than  shorter  antennas. 
They  also  believed  that  a  mysterious  MEDIUM  filled  all  space,  and  that  an  antenna  used  this  medium  to 
send  and  receive  its  energy.  These  two  assumptions  have  since  been  discarded.  Modern  antennas  have 
evolved  to  the  point  that  highly  directional,  specially  designed  antennas  are  used  to  relay  worldwide 
communications  in  space  through  the  use  of  satellites  and  Earth  station  antennas  (fig.  4-1).  Present 
transmission  theories  are  based  on  the  assumption  that  space  itself  is  the  only  medium  necessary  to 
propagate  (transmit)  radio  energy. 


4-1 


SOLAR 


Figure  4-1. — Satellite/earth  station  communications  system. 

A  tremendous  amount  of  knowledge  and  information  has  been  gained  about  the  design  of  antennas 
and  radio-wave  propagation.  Still,  many  old-time  technicians  will  tell  you  that  when  it  comes  to  designing 
the  length  of  an  antenna,  the  best  procedure  is  to  perform  all  calculations  and  try  out  the  antenna.  If  it 
doesn't  work  right,  use  a  cut-and-try  method  until  it  does.  Fortunately,  enough  information  has  been 
collected  over  the  last  few  decades  that  it  is  now  possible  to  predict  the  behavior  of  antennas.  This  chapter 
will  discuss  and  explain  the  basic  design  and  operation  of  antennas. 


PRINCIPLES  OF  ANTENNA  RADIATION 

After  an  rf  signal  has  been  generated  in  a  transmitter,  some  means  must  be  used  to  radiate  this  signal 
through  space  to  a  receiver.  The  device  that  does  this  job  is  the  antenna.  The  transmitter  signal  energy  is 
sent  into  space  by  a  TRANSMITTING  ANTENNA;  the  rf  signal  is  then  picked  up  from  space  by  a 
RECEIVING  ANTENNA. 

The  rf  energy  is  transmitted  into  space  in  the  form  of  an  electromagnetic  field.  As  the  traveling 
electromagnetic  field  arrives  at  the  receiving  antenna,  a  voltage  is  induced  into  the  antenna  (a  conductor). 
The  rf  voltages  induced  into  the  receiving  antenna  are  then  passed  into  the  receiver  and  converted  back 
into  the  transmitted  rf  information. 

The  design  of  the  antenna  system  is  very  important  in  a  transmitting  station.  The  antenna  must  be 
able  to  radiate  efficiently  so  the  power  supplied  by  the  transmitter  is  not  wasted.  An  efficient  transmitting 
antenna  must  have  exact  dimensions.  The  dimensions  are  determined  by  the  transmitting  frequencies.  The 
dimensions  of  the  receiving  antenna  are  not  critical  for  relatively  low  radio  frequencies.  However,  as  the 
frequency  of  the  signal  being  received  increases,  the  design  and  installation  of  the  receiving  antenna 
become  more  critical.  An  example  of  this  is  a  television  receiving  antenna.  If  you  raise  it  a  few  more 
inches  from  the  ground  or  give  a  slight  turn  in  direction,  you  can  change  a  snowy  blur  into  a  clear  picture. 


4-2 


The  conventional  antenna  is  a  conductor,  or  system  of  conductors,  that  radiates  or  intercepts 
electromagnetic  wave  energy.  An  ideal  antenna  has  a  definite  length  and  a  uniform  diameter,  and  is 
completely  isolated  in  space.  However,  this  ideal  antenna  is  not  realistic.  Many  factors  make  the  design  of 
an  antenna  for  a  communications  system  a  more  complex  problem  than  you  would  expect.  These  factors 
include  the  height  of  the  radiator  above  the  earth,  the  conductivity  of  the  earth  below  it,  and  the  shape  and 
dimensions  of  the  antenna.  All  of  these  factors  affect  the  radiated-field  pattern  of  the  antenna  in  space. 
Another  problem  in  antenna  design  is  that  the  radiation  pattern  of  the  antenna  must  be  directed  between 
certain  angles  in  a  horizontal  or  vertical  plane,  or  both. 

Most  practical  transmitting  antennas  are  divided  into  two  basic  classifications,  HERTZ  (half-wave) 
ANTENNAS  and  MARCONI  (quarter-wave)  ANTENNAS.  Hertz  antennas  are  generally  installed  some 
distance  above  the  ground  and  are  positioned  to  radiate  either  vertically  or  horizontally.  Marconi  antennas 
operate  with  one  end  grounded  and  are  mounted  perpendicular  to  the  Earth  or  to  a  surface  acting  as  a 
ground.  Hertz  antennas  are  generally  used  for  frequencies  above  2  megahertz.  Marconi  antennas  are  used 
for  frequencies  below  2  megahertz  and  may  be  used  at  higher  frequencies  in  certain  applications. 

A  complete  antenna  system  consists  of  three  parts:  (1)  The  COUPLING  DEVICE,  (2)  the  FEEDER, 
and  (3)  the  ANTENNA,  as  shown  in  figure  4-2.  The  coupling  device  (coupling  coil)  connects  the 
transmitter  to  the  feeder.  The  feeder  is  a  transmission  line  that  carries  energy  to  the  antenna.  The  antenna 
radiates  this  energy  into  space. 


The  factors  that  determine  the  type,  size,  and  shape  of  the  antenna  are  (1)  the  frequency  of  operation 
of  the  transmitter,  (2)  the  amount  of  power  to  be  radiated,  and  (3)  the  general  direction  of  the  receiving 
set.  Typical  antennas  are  shown  in  figure  4-3. 


Figure  4-2. — Typical  antenna  system. 


4-3 


Figure  4-3. — Typical  antennas. 


CURRENT  AND  VOLTAGE  DISTRIBUTION  ON  AN  ANTENNA 

A  current  flowing  in  a  wire  whose  length  is  properly  related  to  the  rf  produces  an  electro  magnetic 
field.  This  field  is  radiated  from  the  wire  and  is  set  free  in  space.  We  will  discuss  how  these  waves  are  set 
free  later  in  this  chapter.  Remember,  the  principles  of  radiation  of  electromagnetic  energy  are  based  on 
two  laws: 

1 .  A  MOVING  ELECTRIC  FIELD  CREATES  A  MAGNETIC  (H)  FIELD. 

2.  A  MOVING  MAGNETIC  FIELD  CREATES  AN  ELECTRIC  (E)  FIELD. 

In  space,  these  two  fields  will  be  in  phase  and  perpendicular  to  each  other  at  any  given  time. 
Although  a  conductor  is  usually  considered  present  when  a  moving  electric  or  magnetic  field  is 
mentioned,  the  laws  that  govern  these  fields  say  nothing  about  a  conductor.  Therefore,  these  laws  hold 
true  whether  a  conductor  is  present  or  not. 


4-4 


Figure  4-4  shows  the  current  and  voltage  distribution  on  a  half-wave  (Hertz)  antenna.  In  view  A,  a 
piece  of  wire  is  cut  in  half  and  attached  to  the  terminals  of  a  high-frequency  ac  generator.  The  frequency 
of  the  generator  is  set  so  that  each  half  of  the  wire  is  1/4  wavelength  of  the  output.  The  result  is  a  common 
type  of  antenna  known  as  a  DIPOLE. 


-  GENERATOR 

A.  HALF  W  ANTENNA 


DIRECTION  OF  CURRENT  DISTRIBUTION 
CURRENT  FLOW— 7_  __CURVE  -7 


B.  CURRENT  DISTRIBUTION 


.--  4-44- 
.^^+44444 
444444444 
44444444444- 
444444444+444 
y  44-4-4444-4-44444+4 
r  44444444444444-44 
444+44444+444+444 
4444444444444+444 

POSITIVE  CHARGES 


C.  CHARGE  DISTRIBUTION 

Figure  4-4. — Current  and  voltage  distribution  on  an  antenna. 

At  a  given  time  the  right  side  of  the  generator  is  positive  and  the  left  side  negative.  Remember  that 
like  charges  repel.  Because  of  this,  electrons  will  flow  away  from  the  negative  terminal  as  far  as  possible, 
but  will  be  attracted  to  the  positive  terminal.  View  B  shows  the  direction  and  distribution  of  electron  flow. 
The  distribution  curve  shows  that  most  current  flows  in  the  center  and  none  flows  at  the  ends.  The  current 
distribution  over  the  antenna  will  always  be  the  same  no  matter  how  much  or  how  little  current  is  flowing. 
However,  current  at  any  given  point  on  the  antenna  will  vary  directly  with  the  amount  of  voltage 
developed  by  the  generator. 

One-quarter  cycle  after  electrons  have  begun  to  flow,  the  generator  will  develop  its  maximum 
voltage  and  the  current  will  decrease  to  0.  At  that  time  the  condition  shown  in  view  C  will  exist.  No 
current  will  be  flowing,  but  a  maximum  number  of  electrons  will  be  at  the  left  end  of  the  line  and  a 
minimum  number  at  the  right  end.  The  charge  distribution  view  C  along  the  wire  will  vary  as  the  voltage 
of  the  generator  varies.  Therefore,  you  may  draw  the  following  conclusions: 


4-5 


1 .  A  current  flows  in  the  antenna  with  an  amplitude  that  varies  with  the  generator  voltage. 

2.  A  sinusoidal  distribution  of  charge  exists  on  the  antenna.  Every  1/2  cycle,  the  charges  reverse 
polarity. 

3.  The  sinusoidal  variation  in  charge  magnitude  lags  the  sinusoidal  variation  in  current  by  1/4  cycle. 
Ql.   What  are  the  two  basic  classifications  of  antennas? 

Q2.   What  are  the  three  parts  of  a  complete  antenna  system? 
Q3.   What  three  factors  determine  the  type,  size,  and  shape  of  an  antenna? 
RADIATION  OF  ELECTROMAGNETIC  ENERGY 


The  electromagnetic  radiation  from  an  antenna  is  made  up  of  two  components,  the  E  field  and  the  H 
field.  We  discussed  these  fields  in  chapters  1  and  2.  The  two  fields  occur  90  degrees  out  of  phase  with 
each  other.  These  fields  add  and  produce  a  single  electromagnetic  field.  The  total  energy  in  the  radiated 
wave  remains  constant  in  space  except  for  some  absorption  of  energy  by  the  Earth.  However,  as  the  wave 
advances,  the  energy  spreads  out  over  a  greater  area  and,  at  any  given  point,  decreases  as  the  distance 
increases. 

Various  factors  in  the  antenna  circuit  affect  the  radiation  of  these  waves.  In  figure  4-5,  for  example, 
if  an  alternating  current  is  applied  at  the  A  end  of  the  length  of  wire  from  A  to  B,  the  wave  will  travel 
along  the  wire  until  it  reaches  the  B  end.  Since  the  B  end  is  free,  an  open  circuit  exists  and  the  wave 
cannot  travel  farther.  This  is  a  point  of  high  impedance.  The  wave  bounces  back  (reflects)  from  this  point 
of  high  impedance  and  travels  toward  the  starting  point,  where  it  is  again  reflected.  The  energy  of  the 
wave  would  be  gradually  dissipated  by  the  resistance  of  the  wire  of  this  back-and-forth  motion 
(oscillation);  however,  each  time  it  reaches  the  starting  point,  the  wave  is  reinforced  by  an  amount 
sufficient  to  replace  the  energy  lost.  This  results  in  continuous  oscillations  of  energy  along  the  wire  and  a 
high  voltage  at  the  A  end  of  the  wire.  These  oscillations  are  applied  to  the  antenna  at  a  rate  equal  to  the 
frequency  of  the  rf  voltage. 


RF  SOURCE 


■1/2  WAVELENGTH 


B 


WIRE 


Figure  4-5. — Antenna  and  rf  source. 

These  impulses  must  be  properly  timed  to  sustain  oscillations  in  the  antenna.  The  rate  at  which  the 
waves  travel  along  the  wire  is  constant  at  approximately  300,000,000  meters  per  second.  The  length  of 


4-6 


the  antenna  must  be  such  that  a  wave  will  travel  from  one  end  to  the  other  and  back  again  during  the 
period  of  1  cycle  of  the  rf  voltage.  Remember,  the  distance  a  wave  travels  during  the  period  of  1  cycle  is 
known  as  the  wavelength  and  is  found  by  dividing  the  rate  of  travel  by  the  frequency. 

Look  at  the  current  and  voltage  (charge)  distribution  on  the  antenna  in  figure  4-6.  A  maximum 
movement  of  electrons  is  in  the  center  of  the  antenna  at  all  times;  therefore,  the  center  of  the  antenna  is  at 
a  low  impedance.  This  condition  is  called  a  STANDING  WAVE  of  current.  The  points  of  high  current 
and  high  voltage  are  known  as  current  and  voltage  LOOPS.  The  points  of  minimum  current  and  minimum 
voltage  are  known  as  current  and  voltage  NODES.  View  A  shows  a  current  loop  and  current  nodes.  View 
B  shows  voltage  loops  and  a  voltage  node.  View  C  shows  the  resultant  voltage  and  current  loops  and 
nodes.  The  presence  of  standing  waves  describes  the  condition  of  resonance  in  an  antenna.  At  resonance 
the  waves  travel  back  and  forth  in  the  antenna  reinforcing  each  other  and  the  electromagnetic  waves  are 
transmitted  into  space  at  maximum  radiation.  When  the  antenna  is  not  at  resonance,  the  waves  tend  to 
cancel  each  other  and  lose  energy  in  the  form  of  heat. 


LOOP 


't—  ANTENNA 

A.  CURRENT 


C.  CURRENT  AND  VOLTAGE 


Figure  4-6. — Standing  waves  of  voltage  and  current  on  an  antenna. 

Q4.  If  a  wave  travels  exactly  the  length  of  an  antenna  from  one  end  to  the  other  and  back  during  the 
period  of  1  cycle,  what  is  the  length  of  the  antenna? 


4-7 


Q5.   What  is  the  term  used  to  identify  the  points  of  high  current  and  high  voltage  on  an  antenna? 

Q6.   What  is  the  term  used  to  identify  the  points  of  minimum  current  and  minimum  voltage  on  an 
antenna? 


ANTENNA  CHARACTERISTICS 

You  can  define  an  antenna  as  a  conductor  or  group  of  conductors  used  either  for  radiating 
electromagnetic  energy  into  space  or  for  collecting  it  from  space.  Electrical  energy  from  the  transmitter  is 
converted  into  electromagnetic  energy  by  the  antenna  and  radiated  into  space.  On  the  receiving  end, 
electromagnetic  energy  is  converted  into  electrical  energy  by  the  antenna  and  is  fed  into  the  receiver. 

Fortunately,  separate  antennas  seldom  are  required  for  both  transmitting  and  receiving  rf  energy. 
Any  antenna  can  transfer  energy  from  space  to  its  input  receiver  with  the  same  efficiency  that  it  transfers 
energy  from  the  transmitter  into  space.  Of  course,  this  is  assuming  that  the  same  frequency  is  used  in  both 
cases.  This  property  of  interchangeability  of  the  same  antenna  for  transmitting  and  receiving  is  known  as 
antenna  RECIPROCITY.  Antenna  reciprocity  is  possible  because  antenna  characteristics  are  essentially 
the  same  for  sending  and  receiving  electromagnetic  energy. 

RECIPROCITY  OF  ANTENNAS 

In  general,  the  various  properties  of  an  antenna  apply  equally,  regardless  of  whether  you  use  the 
antenna  for  transmitting  or  receiving.  The  more  efficient  a  certain  antenna  is  for  transmitting,  the  more 
efficient  it  will  be  for  receiving  on  the  same  frequency.  Likewise,  the  directive  properties  of  a  given 
antenna  also  will  be  the  same  whether  it  is  used  for  transmitting  or  receiving. 

Assume,  for  example,  that  a  certain  antenna  used  with  a  transmitter  radiates  a  maximum  amount  of 
energy  at  right  angles  to  the  axis  of  the  antenna,  as  shown  in  figure  4-7,  view  A.  Note  the  minimum 
amount  of  radiation  along  the  axis  of  the  antenna.  Now,  if  this  same  antenna  were  used  as  a  receiving 
antenna,  as  shown  in  view  B,  it  would  receive  best  in  the  same  directions  in  which  it  produced  maximum 
radiation;  that  is,  at  right  angles  to  the  axis  of  the  antenna. 


4-8 


MINIMUM  RADIATION! 


A.  TRANSMITTING  ANTENNA 


MINIMUM  RECEPTION 


B.  RECEIVING  ANTENNA 


Figure  4-7. — Reciprocity  of  antennas. 


ANTENNA  GAIN 

Another  characteristic  of  a  given  antenna  that  remains  the  same  whether  the  antenna  is  used  for 
transmitting  or  receiving  is  GAIN.  Some  antennas  are  highly  directional  that  is,  more  energy  is 
propagated  in  certain  directions  than  in  others.  The  ratio  between  the  amount  of  energy  propagated  in 
these  directions  compared  to  the  energy  that  would  be  propagated  if  the  antenna  were  not  directional  is 
known  as  its  gain.  When  a  transmitting  antenna  with  a  certain  gain  is  used  as  a  receiving  antenna,  it  will 
also  have  the  same  gain  for  receiving. 


POLARIZATION 


Let's  review  polarization  briefly.  In  chapter  2  you  learned  that  the  radiation  field  is  composed  of 
electric  and  magnetic  lines  of  force.  These  lines  of  force  are  always  at  right  angles  to  each  other.  Their 
intensities  rise  and  fall  together,  reaching  their  maximums  90  degrees  apart.  The  electric  field  determines 
the  direction  of  polarization  of  the  wave.  In  a  vertically  polarized  wave,  the  electric  lines  of  force  lie  in  a 
vertical  direction.  In  a  horizontally  polarized  wave,  the  electric  lines  of  force  lie  in  a  horizontal  direction. 
Circular  polarization  has  the  electric  lines  of  force  rotating  through  360  degrees  with  every  cycle  of  rf 
energy. 

The  electric  field  was  chosen  as  the  reference  field  because  the  intensity  of  the  wave  is  usually 
measured  in  terms  of  the  electric  field  intensity  (volts,  millivolts,  or  microvolts  per  meter).  When  a 
single-wire  antenna  is  used  to  extract  energy  from  a  passing  radio  wave,  maximum  pickup  will  result 
when  the  antenna  is  oriented  in  the  same  direction  as  the  electric  field.  Thus  a  vertical  antenna  is  used  for 
the  efficient  reception  of  vertically  polarized  waves,  and  a  horizontal  antenna  is  used  for  the  reception  of 
horizontally  polarized  waves.  In  some  cases  the  orientation  of  the  electric  field  does  not  remain  constant. 


4-9 


Instead,  the  field  rotates  as  the  wave  travels  through  space.  Under  these  conditions  both  horizontal  and 
vertical  components  of  the  field  exist  and  the  wave  is  said  to  have  an  elliptical  polarization. 

Q7.  The  various  properties  of  a  transmitting  antenna  can  apply  equally  to  the  same  antenna  when  it  is 
used  as  a  receiving  antenna.  What  term  is  used  for  this  property? 

Q8.  The  direction  of  what  field  is  used  to  designate  the  polarization  of  a  wave? 

Q9.  If  a  wave's  electric  lines  of force  rotate  through  360  degrees  with  every  cycle  of  rf  energy,  what  is 
the  polarization  of  this  wave? 

Polarization  Requirements  for  Various  Frequencies 

Ground-wave  transmission  is  widely  used  at  medium  and  low  frequencies.  Horizontal  polarization 
cannot  be  used  at  these  frequencies  because  the  electric  lines  of  force  are  parallel  to  and  touch  the  earth. 
Since  the  earth  acts  as  a  fairly  good  conductor  at  low  frequencies,  it  would  short  out  the  horizontal 
electric  lines  of  force  and  prevent  the  radio  wave  from  traveling  very  far.  Vertical  electric  lines  of  force, 
on  the  other  hand,  are  bothered  very  little  by  the  earth.  Therefore  vertical  polarization  is  used  for 
ground-wave  transmission,  allowing  the  radio  wave  to  travel  a  considerable  distance  along  the  ground 
surface  with  minimum  attenuation. 

Sky-wave  transmission  is  used  at  high  frequencies.  Either  horizontal  or  vertical  polarization  can  be 
used  with  sky-wave  transmission  because  the  sky  wave  arrives  at  the  receiving  antenna  elliptically 
polarized.  This  is  the  result  of  the  wave  traveling  obliquely  through  the  Earth's  magnetic  field  and  striking 
the  ionosphere.  The  radio  wave  is  given  a  twisting  motion  as  it  strikes  the  ionosphere.  Its  orientation 
continues  to  change  because  of  the  unstable  nature  of  the  ionosphere.  The  relative  amplitudes  and  phase 
differences  between  the  horizontal  and  vertical  components  of  the  received  wave  also  change.  Therefore, 
the  transmitting  and  receiving  antennas  can  be  mounted  either  horizontally  or  vertically. 

Although  either  horizontally  or  vertically  polarized  antennas  can  be  used  for  high  frequencies, 
horizontally  polarized  antennas  have  certain  advantages  and  are  therefore  preferred.  One  advantage  is  that 
vertically  polarized  interference  signals,  such  as  those  produced  by  automobile  ignition  systems  and 
electrical  appliances,  are  minimized  by  horizontal  polarization.  Also,  less  absorption  of  radiated  energy 
by  buildings  or  wiring  occurs  when  these  antennas  are  used.  Another  advantage  is  that  support  structures 
for  these  antennas  are  of  more  convenient  size  than  those  for  vertically  polarized  antennas. 

For  frequencies  in  the  vhf  or  uhf  range,  either  horizontal  or  vertical  polarization  is  satisfactory.  These 
radio  waves  travel  directly  from  the  transmitting  antenna  to  the  receiving  antenna  without  entering  the 
ionosphere.  The  original  polarization  produced  at  the  transmitting  antenna  is  maintained  throughout  the 
entire  travel  of  the  wave  to  the  receiver.  Therefore,  if  a  horizontally  polarized  antenna  is  used  for 
transmitting,  a  horizontally  polarized  antenna  must  be  used  for  receiving.  The  requirements  would  be  the 
same  for  a  vertical  transmitting  and  receiving  antenna  system. 

For  satellite  communications,  parallel  frequencies  can  be  used  without  interference  by  using 
polarized  radiation.  The  system  setup  is  shown  in  figure  4-8.  One  pair  of  satellite  antennas  is  vertically 
polarized  and  another  pair  is  horizontally  polarized.  Either  vertically  or  horizontally  polarized 
transmissions  are  received  by  the  respective  antenna  and  retransmitted  in  the  same  polarization.  For 
example,  transmissions  may  be  made  in  the  3.7  to  3.74  GHz  range  on  the  vertical  polarization  path  and  in 
the  3.72  to  3.76  GHz  range  on  the  horizontal  polarization  path  without  adjacent  frequency  (co-channel) 
interference. 


4-10 


FILTER  #1 


3.7-3.74  GHZ 
TRANSPONDER 


DOWN 
CONVERTER 


VERTICAL 
I— l  POLARIZATION 


RECEIVING 
ANTENNA 


FILTER  #2 


VERTICAL 
POLARIZATION 
TRANSMITTING 
ANTENNA 


3.72-3.76  GHZ 
TRANSPONDER 


DOWN 
CONVERTER 


HORIZONTAL 
POLARIZATION 
RECEIVING 
ANTENNA 


HORIZONTAL 
POLARIZATION 
TRANSMITTING 
ANTENNA 


Figure  4-8. — Satellite  transmissions  using  polarized  radiation. 

Advantages  of  Vertical  Polarization 

Simple  vertical  antennas  can  be  used  to  provide  OMNIDIRECTIONAL  (all  directions) 
communication.  This  is  an  advantage  when  communications  must  take  place  from  a  moving  vehicle. 

In  some  overland  communications,  such  as  in  vehicular  installations,  antenna  heights  are  limited  to  3 
meters  (10  feet)  or  less.  In  such  instances  vertical  polarization  results  in  a  stronger  receiver  signal  than 
does  horizontal  polarization  at  frequencies  up  to  about  50  megahertz.  From  approximately  50  to  100 
megahertz,  vertical  polarization  results  in  a  slightly  stronger  signal  than  does  horizontal  polarization  with 
antennas  at  the  same  height.  Above  100  megahertz,  the  difference  in  signal  strength  is  negligible. 

For  transmission  over  bodies  of  water,  vertical  polarization  is  much  better  than  horizontal 
polarization  for  antennas  at  the  lower  heights.  As  the  frequency  increases,  the  minimum  antenna  height 
decreases.  At  30  megahertz,  vertical  polarization  is  better  for  antenna  heights  below  about  91  meters  (300 
feet);  at  85  megahertz,  antenna  heights  below  15  meters  (50  feet);  and  still  lower  heights  at  the  high 
frequencies.  Therefore,  at  ordinary  antenna  mast  heights  of  12  meters  (40  feet),  vertical  polarization  is 
advantageous  for  frequencies  less  than  about  1 00  megahertz. 

Radiation  is  somewhat  less  affected  by  reflections  from  aircraft  flying  over  the  transmission  path 
when  vertical  polarization  is  used  instead  of  horizontal  polarization.  With  horizontal  polarization,  such 
reflections  cause  variations  in  received  signal  strength.  This  factor  is  important  in  locations  where  aircraft 
traffic  is  heavy. 

When  vertical  polarization  is  used,  less  interference  is  produced  or  picked  up  because  of  strong  vhf 
and  uhf  broadcast  transmissions  (television  and  frn).  This  is  because  vhf  and  uhf  transmissions  use 
horizontal  polarization.  This  factor  is  important  when  an  antenna  must  be  located  in  an  urban  area  having 
several  television  and  frn  broadcast  stations. 


4-11 


Advantages  of  Horizontal  Polarization 

A  simple  horizontal  antenna  is  bi-directional.  This  characteristic  is  useful  when  you  desire  to 
minimize  interference  from  certain  directions.  Horizontal  antennas  are  less  likely  to  pick  up  man-made 
interference,  which  ordinarily  is  vertically  polarized. 

When  antennas  are  located  near  dense  forests  or  among  buildings,  horizontally  polarized  waves 
suffer  lower  losses  than  vertically  polarized  waves,  especially  above  100  megahertz.  Small  changes  in 
antenna  locations  do  not  cause  large  variations  in  the  field  intensity  of  horizontally  polarized  waves. 
When  vertical  polarization  is  used,  a  change  of  only  a  few  meters  in  the  antenna  location  may  have  a 
considerable  effect  on  the  received  signal  strength.  This  is  the  result  of  interference  patterns  that  produce 
standing  waves  in  space  when  spurious  reflections  from  trees  or  buildings  occur. 

When  simple  antennas  are  used,  the  transmission  line,  which  is  usually  vertical,  is  less  affected  by  a 
horizontally  mounted  antenna.  When  the  antenna  is  mounted  at  right  angles  to  the  transmission  line  and 
horizontal  polarization  is  used,  the  line  is  kept  out  of  the  direct  field  of  the  antenna.  As  a  result,  the 
radiation  pattern  and  electrical  characteristics  of  the  antenna  are  practically  unaffected  by  the  presence  of 
the  vertical  transmission  line. 

Q10.   What  type  of polarization  should  be  used  at  medium  and  low  frequencies? 

Qll.   What  is  an  advantage  of  using  horizontal  polarization  at  high  frequencies? 

Q12.   What  type  of polarization  should  be  used  if  an  antenna  is  mounted  on  a  moving  vehicle  at 
frequencies  below  50  megahertz? 

RADIATION  RESISTANCE 

Radiated  energy  is  the  useful  part  of  the  transmitter's  signal.  However,  it  represents  as  much  of  a  loss 
to  the  antenna  as  the  energy  lost  in  heating  the  antenna  wire.  In  either  case,  the  dissipated  power  is  equal 
to  I2R.  In  the  case  of  heat  losses,  the  R  is  real  resistance.  In  the  case  of  radiation,  R  is  an  assumed 
resistance;  if  this  resistance  were  actually  present,  it  would  dissipate  the  same  amount  of  power  that  the 
antenna  takes  to  radiate  the  energy.  This  assumed  resistance  is  referred  to  as  the  RADIATION 
RESISTANCE. 

Radiation  resistance  varies  at  different  points  on  the  antenna.  This  resistance  is  always  measured  at  a 
current  loop.  For  the  antenna  in  free  space,  that  is,  entirely  removed  from  any  objects  that  might  affect  its 
operation,  the  radiation  resistance  is  73  ohms.  A  practical  antenna  located  over  a  ground  plane  may  have 
any  value  of  radiation  resistance  from  0  to  approximately  100  ohms.  The  exact  value  of  radiation 
resistance  depends  on  the  height  of  the  antenna  above  the  ground.  For  most  half-wave  wire  antennas,  the 
radiation  resistance  is  about  65  ohms.  It  will  usually  vary  between  55  and  600  ohms  for  antennas 
constructed  of  rod  or  tubing.  The  actual  value  of  radiation  resistance,  so  long  as  it  is  50  ohms  or  more,  has 
little  effect  on  the  radiation  efficiency  of  the  antenna.  This  is  because  the  ohmic  resistance  is  about  1  ohm 
for  conductors  of  large  diameter.  The  ohmic  resistance  does  not  become  important  until  the  radiation 
resistance  drops  to  a  value  less  than  10  ohms.  This  may  be  the  case  when  several  antennas  are  coupled 
together. 

RADIATION  TYPES  AND  PATTERNS 

The  energy  radiated  from  an  antenna  forms  a  field  having  a  definite  RADIATION  PATTERN.  A 
radiation  pattern  is  a  plot  of  the  radiated  energy  from  an  antenna.  This  energy  is  measured  at  various 
angles  at  a  constant  distance  from  the  antenna.  The  shape  of  this  pattern  depends  on  the  type  of  antenna 


4-12 


used.  In  this  section,  we  will  introduce  the  basic  types  of  radiation  (isotropic  and  anisotropic)  and  their 
radiation  patterns. 

Isotropic  Radiation 

Some  antenna  sources  radiate  energy  equally  in  all  directions.  Radiation  of  this  type  is  known  as 
ISOTROPIC  RADIATION.  We  all  know  the  Sun  radiates  energy  in  all  directions.  The  energy  radiated 
from  the  Sun  measured  at  any  fixed  distance  and  from  any  angle  will  be  approximately  the  same.  Assume 
that  a  measuring  device  is  moved  around  the  Sun  and  stopped  at  the  points  indicated  in  figure  4-9  to  make 
a  measurement  of  the  amount  of  radiation.  At  any  point  around  the  circle,  the  distance  from  the  measuring 
device  to  the  Sun  is  the  same.  The  measured  radiation  will  also  be  the  same.  The  Sun  is  therefore 
considered  an  isotropic  radiator. 


4 


Figure  4-9. — Isotropic  radiator. 

To  plot  this  pattern,  we  will  assume  that  the  radiation  is  measured  on  a  scale  of  0  to  10  units  and  that 
the  measured  amount  of  radiation  is  7  units  at  all  points.  We  will  then  plot  our  measurements  on  two 
different  types  of  graphs,  rectangular-  and  polar-coordinate  graphs.  The  RECTANGULAR- 
COORDINATE  GRAPH  of  the  measured  radiation,  shown  in  view  A  of  figure  4-10,  is  a  straight  line 
plotted  against  positions  along  the  circle.  View  B  shows  the  POLAR-COORDINATE  GRAPH  for  the 
same  isotropic  source. 


4-13 


0 


A.  RECTANGULAR-COORDINATE  GRAPH  B.  POLAR-COORDINATE  GRAPH 

Figure  4-10. — Comparison  of  rectangular-  and  polar-coordinate  graphs  for  an  isotropic  source. 

In  the  rectangular-coordinate  graph,  points  are  located  by  projection  from  a  pair  of  stationary, 
perpendicular  axes.  In  the  polar-coordinate  graph,  points  are  located  by  projection  along  a  rotating  axis 
(radius)  to  an  intersection  with  one  of  several  concentric,  equally-spaced  circles.  The  horizontal  axis  on 
the  rectangular-coordinate  graph  corresponds  to  the  circles  on  the  polar-coordinate  graph.  The  vertical 
axis  on  the  rectangular-coordinate  graph  corresponds  to  the  rotating  axis  (radius)  on  the  polar-coordinate 
graph. 

Rectangular-Coordinate  Pattern 

Look  at  view  A  of  figure  4-10.  The  numbered  positions  around  the  circle  are  laid  out  on  the 
HORIZONTAL  AXIS  of  the  graph  from  0  to  7  units.  The  measured  radiation  is  laid  out  on  the 
VERTICAL  AXIS  of  the  graph  from  0  to  10  units.  The  units  on  both  axes  are  chosen  so  the  pattern 
occupies  a  convenient  part  of  the  graph. 

The  horizontal  and  vertical  axes  are  at  a  right  angle  to  each  other.  The  point  where  the  axes  cross 
each  other  is  known  as  the  ORIGIN.  In  this  case,  the  origin  is  0  on  both  axes.  Now,  assume  that  a 
radiation  value  of  7  units  view  B  is  measured  at  position  2.  From  position  2  on  the  horizontal  axis,  a 
dotted  line  is  projected  upwards  that  runs  parallel  to  the  vertical  axis.  From  position  7  on  the  vertical  axis, 
a  line  is  projected  to  the  right  that  runs  parallel  to  the  horizontal  axis.  The  point  where  the  two  lines  cross 
(INTERCEPT)  represents  a  value  of  7  radiation  units  at  position  2.  This  is  the  only  point  on  the  graph  that 
can  represent  this  value. 

As  you  can  see  from  the  figure,  the  lines  used  to  plot  the  point  form  a  rectangle.  For  this  reason,  this 
type  of  plot  is  called  a  rectangular-coordinate  graph.  A  new  rectangle  is  formed  for  each  different  point 
plotted.  In  this  example,  the  points  plotted  lie  in  a  straight  line  extending  from  7  units  on  the  vertical  scale 
to  the  projection  of  position  7  on  the  horizontal  scale.  This  is  the  characteristic  pattern  in  rectangular 
coordinates  of  an  isotropic  source  of  radiation. 

Polar-Coordinate  Pattern 

The  polar-coordinate  graph  has  proved  to  be  of  great  use  in  studying  radiation  patterns.  Compare 
views  A  and  B  of  figure  4-10.  Note  the  great  difference  in  the  shape  of  the  radiation  pattern  when  it  is 


4-14 


transferred  from  the  rectangular-coordinate  graph  in  view  A  to  the  polar-coordinate  graph  in  view  B.  The 
scale  of  radiation  values  used  in  both  graphs  is  identical,  and  the  measurements  taken  are  both  the  same. 
However,  the  shape  of  the  pattern  is  drastically  different. 

Look  at  view  B  of  figure  4- 1 0  and  assume  that  the  center  of  the  concentric  circles  is  the  Sun.  Assume 
that  a  radius  is  drawn  from  the  Sun  (center  of  the  circle)  to  position  0  of  the  circle.  When  you  move  to 
position  1,  the  radius  moves  to  position  1;  when  you  move  to  position  2,  the  radius  also  moves  to  position 
2,  and  so  on. 

The  positions  where  a  measurement  was  taken  are  marked  as  0  through  7  on  the  graph.  Note  how  the 
position  of  the  radius  indicates  the  actual  direction  from  the  source  at  which  the  measurement  was  taken. 
This  is  a  distinct  advantage  over  the  rectangular-coordinate  graph  in  which  the  position  is  indicated  along 
a  straight-line  axis  and  has  no  physical  relation  to  the  actual  direction  of  measurement.  Now  that  we  have 
a  way  to  indicate  the  direction  of  measurement,  we  must  devise  a  way  to  indicate  the  magnitude  of  the 
radiation. 

Notice  that  the  rotating  axis  is  always  drawn  from  the  center  of  the  graph  to  some  position  on  the 
edge  of  the  graph.  As  the  axis  moves  toward  the  edge  of  the  graph,  it  passes  through  a  set  of 
equally-spaced,  concentric  circles.  In  this  example  view  B,  they  are  numbered  successively  from  1  to  10 
from  the  center  out.  These  circles  are  used  to  indicate  the  magnitude  of  the  radiation. 

The  advantages  of  the  polar-coordinate  graph  are  immediately  evident.  The  source,  which  is  at  the 
center  of  the  observation  circles,  is  also  at  the  center  of  the  graph.  By  looking  at  a  polar-coordinate  plot  of 
a  radiation  pattern,  you  can  immediately  see  the  direction  and  strength  of  radiation  put  out  by  the  source. 
Therefore,  the  polar-coordinate  graph  is  more  useful  than  the  rectangular-coordinate  graph  in  plotting 
radiation  patterns. 

Anisotropic  Radiation 

Most  radiators  emit  (radiate)  stronger  radiation  in  one  direction  than  in  another.  A  radiator  such  as 
this  is  referred  to  as  ANISOTROPIC.  An  example  of  an  anisotropic  radiator  is  an  ordinary  flashlight.  The 
beam  of  the  flashlight  lights  only  a  portion  of  the  space  surrounding  it.  If  a  circle  is  drawn  with  the 
flashlight  as  the  center,  as  shown  in  view  B  of  figure  4-11,  the  radiated  light  can  be  measured  at  different 
positions  around  the  circle.  Again,  as  with  the  isotropic  radiator,  all  positions  are  the  same  distance  from 
the  center,  but  at  different  angles.  However,  in  this  illustration  the  radiated  light  is  measured  at  16 
different  positions  on  the  circle. 


4-15 


Figure  4-11. — Anisotropic  radiator. 

Directly  behind  the  flashlight  (position  0)  the  radiation  measured  is  minimum.  Accordingly,  a  0 
value  is  assigned  to  this  position  in  the  rectangular-coordinate  graph  (fig.  4-11,  view  A).  This  radiation 
remains  at  minimum  until  position  4  is  reached.  Between  positions  4  and  6,  the  measuring  device  enters 
the  flashlight  beam.  You  can  see  this  transition  from  darkness  to  brightness  easily  in  view  B.  Radiation  is 
fairly  constant  between  positions  6  and  10.  Maximum  brightness  occurs  at  position  8,  which  is  directly  in 
the  path  of  the  flashlight  beam.  From  positions  10  to  12,  the  measuring  device  leaves  the  flashlight  beam 
and  the  radiation  measurement  falls  off  sharply.  At  position  13  the  radiation  is  again  at  0  and  stays  at  this 
value  back  to  position  0. 

Radiation  from  a  light  source  and  radiation  from  an  antenna  are  both  forms  of  electromagnetic 
waves.  Therefore,  the  measurement  of  radiation  of  an  antenna  follows  the  same  basic  procedure  as  that 
just  described  for  the  Sun  and  the  flashlight.  Before  proceeding  further  with  the  study  of  antenna  patterns, 
you  should  be  sure  you  understand  the  methods  used  to  graph  the  measured  radiation  (magnitude  of  the 
radiation).  Study  the  rectangular-  and  polar-coordinate  systems  of  plotting  presented  in  the  following 
section. 

Q13.   What  is  the  radiation  resistance  of  a  half-wave  antenna  in  free  space? 

Q14.  A  radiating  source  that  radiates  energy  stronger  in  one  direction  than  another  is  known  as  what 
type  of  radiator? 

Q15.  A  radiating  source  that  radiates  energy  equally  in  all  directions  is  known  as  what  type  of 
radiator? 

Q16.  A  flashlight  is  an  example  of  what  type  of  radiator? 

In  figure  4-11,  view  A,  the  radiation  pattern  of  the  flashlight  is  graphed  in  rectangular  coordinates. 
The  illustration  of  the  flashlight  beam  in  view  B  clearly  indicates  the  shape  of  the  flashlight  beam.  This  is 
not  evident  in  the  radiation  pattern  plotted  on  the  rectangular-coordinate  graph.  Now  look  at  figure  4-12. 
The  radiation  pattern  shown  in  this  figure  looks  very  much  like  the  actual  flashlight  beam.  The  pattern  in 
figure  4-12  is  plotted  using  the  same  values  as  those  of  figure  4-11,  view  A,  but  is  drawn  using  polar 
coordinates. 


4-16 


Figure  4-12. — Polar-coordinate  graph  for  anisotropic  radiator. 

The  positions  marked  off  on  the  two  polar-coordinate  graphs  in  figures  4-10  and  4-12  were  selected 
and  numbered  arbitrarily.  However,  a  standard  method  allows  the  positions  around  a  source  to  be  marked 
off  so  that  one  radiation  pattern  can  easily  be  compared  with  another.  This  method  is  based  on  the  fact 
that  a  circle  has  a  radius  of  360  degrees.  The  radius  extending  vertically  from  the  center  (position  0  in 
figure  4-10)  is  designated  0  degrees.  At  position  4  the  radius  is  at  a  right  angle  to  the  0-degree  radius. 
Accordingly,  the  radius  at  position  4  is  marked  90  degrees,  position  8  is  180  degrees,  position  12  is  270 
degrees,  and  position  16  is  360  degrees.  The  various  radii  drawn  on  the  graph  are  all  marked  according  to 
the  angle  each  radius  makes  with  the  reference  radius  at  0  degrees. 

The  radiation  pattern  in  figure  4-12  is  obtained  by  using  the  same  procedure  that  was  used  for  (figure 
4-10,  view  B).  The  radiation  measured  at  positions  1,  2,  3,  and  4  is  0.  Position  5  measures  approximately 
1  unit.  This  is  marked  on  the  graph  and  the  rotating  radius  moves  to  position  6.  At  this  position  a  reading 
of  5.5  units  is  taken.  As  before,  this  point  is  marked  on  the  graph.  The  procedure  is  repeated  around  the 
circle  and  a  reading  is  obtained  from  positions  6  through  1 1.  At  position  12  no  radiation  is  indicated,  and 
this  continues  on  to  position  16. 

The  polar-coordinate  graph  now  shows  a  definite  area  enclosed  by  the  radiation  pattern.  This  pattern 
indicates  the  general  direction  of  radiation  from  the  source.  The  enclosed  area  is  called  a  LOBE.  Outside 
of  this  area,  minimum  radiation  is  emitted  in  any  direction.  For  example,  at  position  2  the  radiation  is  0. 
Such  a  point  is  called  a  NULL.  In  real  situations,  some  radiation  is  usually  transmitted  in  all  directions. 
Therefore,  a  null  is  used  to  indicate  directions  of  minimum  radiation.  The  pattern  of  figure  4-12  shows 
one  lobe  and  one  continuous  null. 

ANTENNA  LOADING 

You  will  sometimes  want  to  use  one  antenna  system  for  transmitting  and  receiving  on  several 
different  frequencies.  Since  the  antenna  must  always  be  in  resonance  with  the  applied  frequency,  you  may 
need  to  either  physically  or  electrically  lengthen  or  shorten  the  antenna. 


4-17 


Except  for  trailing-wire  antennas  used  in  aircraft  installations  (which  may  be  lengthened  or 
shortened),  physically  lengthening  the  antenna  is  not  very  practical.  But  you  can  achieve  the  same  result 
by  changing  the  electrical  length  of  the  antenna.  To  change  the  electrical  length,  you  can  insert  either  an 
inductor  or  a  capacitor  in  series  with  the  antenna.  This  is  shown  in  figure  4-13,  views  A  and  B.  Changing 
the  electrical  length  by  this  method  is  known  as  LUMPED-IMPEDANCE  TUNING,  or  LOADING.  The 
electrical  length  of  any  antenna  wire  can  be  increased  or  decreased  by  loading.  If  the  antenna  is  too  short 
for  the  wavelength  being  used,  it  is  resonant  at  a  higher  frequency  than  that  at  which  it  is  being  excited. 
Therefore,  it  offers  a  capacitive  reactance  at  the  excitation  frequency.  This  capacitive  reactance  can  be 
compensated  for  by  introducing  a  lumped-inductive  reactance,  as  shown  in  view  A.  Similarly,  if  the 
antenna  is  too  long  for  the  transmitting  frequency,  it  offers  an  inductive  reactance.  Inductive  reactance 
can  be  compensated  for  by  introducing  a  lumped-capacitive  reactance,  as  shown  in  view  B.  An  antenna 
without  loading  is  represented  in  view  C. 

LOADING  TO  COMPENSATE  FOR  TOO  SHORT  AN  ANTENNA 

A 


LOADING  TO  COMPENSATE  FOR  TOO  LONG  AN  ANTENNA 

B 


NORMAL  ANTENNA  WITHOUT  LOADING 

c 

Figure  4-13. — Electrically  equal  antenna. 


BASIC  ANTENNAS 

Before  you  look  at  the  various  types  of  antennas,  consider  the  relationship  between  the  wavelength  at 
which  the  antenna  is  being  operated  and  the  actual  length  of  the  antenna.  An  antenna  does  not  necessarily 
radiate  or  receive  more  energy  when  it  is  made  longer.  Specific  dimensions  must  be  used  for  efficient 
antenna  operation. 

Nearly  all  antennas  have  been  developed  from  two  basic  types,  the  Hertz  and  the  Marconi.  The  basic 
Hertz  antenna  is  1/2  wavelength  long  at  the  operating  frequency  and  is  insulated  from  ground.  It  is  often 
called  a  DIPOLE  or  a  DOUBLET.  The  basic  Marconi  antenna  is  1/4  wavelength  long  and  is  either 
grounded  at  one  end  or  connected  to  a  network  of  wires  called  a  COUNTERPOISE.  The  ground  or 
counterpoise  provides  the  equivalent  of  an  additional  1/4  wavelength,  which  is  required  for  the  antenna  to 
resonate. 

HALF-WAVE  ANTENNAS 

A  half-wave  antenna  (referred  to  as  a  dipole,  Hertz,  or  doublet)  consists  of  two  lengths  of  wire  rod, 
or  tubing,  each  1/4  wavelength  long  at  a  certain  frequency.  It  is  the  basic  unit  from  which  many  complex 
antennas  are  constructed.  The  half-wave  antenna  operates  independently  of  ground;  therefore,  it  may  be 
installed  far  above  the  surface  of  the  Earth  or  other  absorbing  bodies.  For  a  dipole,  the  current  is 


4-18 


maximum  at  the  center  and  minimum  at  the  ends.  Voltage  is  minimum  at  the  center  and  maximum  at  the 
ends,  as  was  shown  in  figure  4-6. 

Radiation  Patterns 

In  the  following  discussion,  the  term  DIPOLE  is  used  to  mean  the  basic  half-wave  antenna.  The  term 
DOUBLET  is  used  to  indicate  an  antenna  that  is  very  short  compared  with  the  wavelength  of  the 
operating  frequency.  Physically,  it  has  the  same  shape  as  the  dipole. 

RADIATION  PATTERN  OF  A  DOUBLET.— The  doublet  is  the  simplest  form  of  a  practical 
antenna.  Its  radiation  pattern  can  be  plotted  like  the  radiation  pattern  of  the  flashlight  (fig.  4-12).  Figure 
4-14  shows  the  development  of  vertical  and  horizontal  patterns  for  a  doublet.  This  in  NOT  a  picture  of  the 
radiation,  but  three-dimensional  views  of  the  pattern  itself.  In  three  views  the  pattern  resembles  a 
doughnut.  From  the  dimensions  in  these  views,  two  types  of  polar-coordinate  patterns  can  be  drawn, 
horizontal  and  vertical.  The  HORIZONTAL  PATTERN  view  A  is  derived  from  the  solid  pattern  view  C 
by  slicing  it  horizontally.  This  produces  view  B,  which  is  converted  to  the  polar  coordinates  seen  in  view 
A.  The  horizontal  pattern  illustrates  that  the  radiation  is  constant  in  any  direction  along  the  horizontal 
plane. 


Figure  4-14. — Development  of  vertical  and  horizontal  patterns. 

A  VERTICAL  PATTERN  view  E  is  obtained  from  the  drawing  of  the  vertical  plane  view  D  of  the 
radiation  pattern  view  C.  The  radiation  pattern  view  C  is  sliced  in  half  along  a  vertical  plane  through  the 
antenna.  This  produces  the  vertical  plane  pattern  in  view  D.  Note  how  the  vertical  plane  in  view  D  of  the 
radiation  pattern  differs  from  the  horizontal  plane  in  view  B.  The  vertical  pattern  view  E  exhibits  two 
lobes  and  two  nulls.  The  difference  between  the  two  patterns  is  caused  by  two  facts:  (1)  no  radiation  is 


4-19 


emitted  from  the  ends  of  the  doublet;  and  (2)  maximum  radiation  comes  from  the  doublet  in  a  direction 
perpendicular  to  the  antenna  axis.  This  type  of  radiation  pattern  is  both  NONDIRECTIONAL  (in  a 
horizontal  plane)  and  DIRECTIONAL  (in  a  vertical  plane). 

From  a  practical  viewpoint,  the  doublet  antenna  can  be  mounted  either  vertically  or  horizontally.  The 
doublet  shown  in  figure  4-14  is  mounted  vertically,  and  the  radiated  energy  spreads  out  about  the  antenna 
in  every  direction  in  the  horizontal  plane.  Since  ordinarily  the  horizontal  plane  is  the  useful  plane,  this 
arrangement  is  termed  NONDIRECTIONAL.  The  directional  characteristics  of  the  antenna  in  other 
planes  is  ignored.  If  the  doublet  were  mounted  horizontally,  it  would  have  the  effect  of  turning  the  pattern 
on  edge,  reversing  the  patterns  given  in  figure  4-14.  The  antenna  would  then  be  directional  in  the 
horizontal  plane.  The  terms  "directional"  and  "nondirectional"  are  used  for  convenience  in  describing 
specific  radiation  patterns.  A  complete  description  always  involves  a  figure  in  three  dimensions,  as  in  the 
radiation  pattern  of  figure  4-14. 

Ql  7.   What  terms  are  often  used  to  describe  basic  half-wave  antennas? 

Q18.  If  a  basic  half-wave  antenna  is  mounted  vertically,  what  type  of  radiation  pattern  will  be 
produced? 

Q19.  In  which  plane  will  the  half-wave  antenna  be  operating  if  it  is  mounted  horizontally? 

RADIATION  PATTERN  OF  A  DIPOLE.—  The  radiation  pattern  of  a  dipole  (fig.  4-15)  is  similar 
to  that  of  the  doublet  (fig.  4-14).  Increasing  the  length  of  the  doublet  to  1/2  wavelength  has  the  effect  of 
flattening  out  the  radiation  pattern.  The  radiation  pattern  in  the  horizontal  plane  of  a  dipole  is  a  larger 
circle  than  that  of  the  doublet.  The  vertical-radiation  pattern  lobes  are  no  longer  circular.  They  are 
flattened  out  and  the  radiation  intensity  is  greater. 


Figure  4-15. — Radiation  pattern  of  a  dipole. 


4-20 


Methods  of  Feeding  Energy  to  an  Antenna 

Voltage  and  current  distribution  for  the  half-wave  antenna  (shown  in  figure  4-16)  is  the  same  as  that 
for  the  antenna  discussed  earlier  in  this  chapter.  A  point  closely  related  to  the  voltage  and  current 
distribution  on  an  antenna  is  the  method  of  feeding  the  transmitter  output  to  the  antenna.  The  simplest 
method  of  feeding  energy  to  the  half-wave  antenna  is  to  connect  one  end  through  a  capacitor  to  the  final 
output  stage  of  the  transmitter.  This  method  is  often  called  the  END-FEED  or  VOLTAGE-FEED  method. 
In  this  method  the  antenna  is  fed  at  a  point  of  high  voltage  (the  end). 


i 


A.  CURRENT  DISTRIBUTION 


B.  VOLTAGE  DISTRIBUTION 


Figure  4-16. — Standing  waves  of  current  and  voltage. 

Energy  may  also  be  fed  to  the  half-wave  antenna  by  dividing  the  antenna  at  its  center  and  connecting 
the  transmission  line  from  the  final  transmitter  output  stage  to  the  two  center  ends  of  the  halved  antenna. 
Since  the  antenna  is  now  being  fed  at  the  center  (a  point  of  low  voltage  and  high  current),  this  type  of  feed 
is  known  as  the  CENTER-FEED  or  CURRENT -FEED  method.  The  point  of  feed  is  important  in 
determining  the  type  of  transmission  line  to  be  used. 

QUARTER-WAVE  ANTENNAS 

As  you  have  studied  in  the  previous  sections,  a  1/2  wavelength  antenna  is  the  shortest  antenna  that 
can  be  used  in  free  space.  If  we  cut  a  half-wave  antenna  in  half  and  then  ground  one  end,  we  will  have  a 
grounded  quarter-wave  antenna.  This  antenna  will  resonate  at  the  same  frequency  as  the  ungrounded  half- 
wave  antenna.  Such  an  antenna  is  referred  to  as  a  QUARTER- WAVE  or  Marconi  antenna.  Quarter-wave 
antennas  are  widely  used  in  the  military.  Most  mobile  transmitting  and  receiving  antennas  (fig.  4-17)  are 
quarter-wave  antennas. 


4-21 


TWO-WAY  COMMUNICATION 
TO  SERVICE  OR  EMERGENCY 
VEHICLES  OR  RADIOTELEPHONES 


TWO-WAY 
COMMUNICATIONS  OF 
DATA  OR  VOICE 
TO  INDIVIDUALS 


CENTRAL  DISPATCH  OFFICE 
AND  TRANSMITTER  /  RECEIVER 


ONE-WAY  PAGING 
TO  INDIVIDUALS 


Figure  4-17. — Mobile  antennas. 

As  stated  above,  a  grounded  quarter-wave  antenna  will  resonate  at  the  same  frequency  as  an 
ungrounded  half-wave  antenna.  This  is  because  ground  has  high  conductivity  and  acts  as  an  electrical 
mirror  image.  This  characteristic  provides  the  missing  half  of  the  antenna,  as  shown  in  the  bottom  part  of 
figure  4-18.  In  other  words,  the  grounded  quarter-wave  antenna  acts  as  if  another  quarter-wave  were 
actually  down  in  the  earth. 


■QUARTER-WAVE 
ANTENNA 


IMAGE  ANTENNA- 


Figure  4-18. — Grounded  quarter-wave  antenna  image. 

Characteristics  of  Quarter-Wave  Antennas 

The  grounded  end  of  the  quarter-wave  antenna  has  a  low  input  impedance  and  has  low  voltage  and 
high  current  at  the  input  end,  as  shown  in  figure  4-18.  The  ungrounded  end  has  a  high  impedance,  which 
causes  high  voltage  and  low  current.  The  directional  characteristics  of  a  grounded  quarter-wave  antenna 
are  the  same  as  those  of  a  half-wave  antenna  in  free  space. 

As  explained  earlier,  ground  losses  affect  radiation  patterns  and  cause  high  signal  losses  for  some 
frequencies.  Such  losses  may  be  greatly  reduced  if  a  perfectly  conducting  ground  is  provided  in  the 


4-22 


vicinity  of  the  antenna.  This  is  the  purpose  of  a  GROUND  SCREEN  (figure  4-19,  view  A)  and 
COUNTERPOISE  view  B. 


CONDUCTORS  BURIED  A  FOOT 
OR  TWO  BELOV  SURFACE 


Figure  4-19. — Groundscreen  and  counterpoise. 

The  ground  screen  in  view  A  is  composed  of  a  series  of  conductors  buried  1  or  2  feet  (0.3  to  0.6 
meter)  below  the  surface  of  the  earth  and  arranged  in  a  radial  pattern.  These  conductors  reduce  losses  in 
the  ground  in  the  immediate  vicinity  of  the  antenna.  Such  a  radial  system  of  conductors  is  usually  1/2 
wavelength  in  diameter. 

A  counterpoise  view  B  is  used  when  easy  access  to  the  base  of  the  antenna  is  necessary.  It  is  also 
used  when  the  earth  is  not  a  good  conducting  surface,  such  as  ground  that  is  sandy  or  solid  rock.  The 
counterpoise  serves  the  same  purpose  as  the  ground  screen  but  it  is  usually  elevated  above  the  earth.  No 
specific  dimensions  are  necessary  in  the  construction  of  a  counterpoise  nor  is  the  number  of  wires 
particularly  critical.  A  practical  counterpoise  may  be  assembled  from  a  large  screen  of  chicken  wire  or 
some  similar  material.  This  screen  may  be  placed  on  the  ground,  but  better  results  are  obtained  if  it  is 
placed  a  few  feet  above  the  ground. 

Q20.  Since  the  radiation  pattern  of  a  dipole  is  similar  to  that  of  a  doublet,  what  will  happen  to  the 
pattern  if  the  length  of  the  doublet  is  increased? 

Q21.   What  is  the  simplest  method  of feeding  power  to  the  half-wave  antenna? 


4-23 


Q22.   What  is  the  radiation  pattern  of  a  quarter-wave  antenna? 
Q23.  Describe  the  physical  arrangement  of  a  ground  screen. 
FOLDED  DIPOLE 

The  use  of  parasitic  elements  and  various  stacking  arrangements  causes  a  reduction  in  the  radiation 
resistance  of  a  center-fed,  half-wave  antenna.  Under  these  conditions  obtaining  a  proper  impedance  match 
between  the  radiator  and  the  transmission  line  is  often  difficult.  A  convenient  method  of  overcoming 
these  difficulties  is  to  use  a  FOLDED  DIPOLE  in  place  of  the  center-fed  radiator.  (See  views  A  and  B  of 
figure  4-20). 


II       ORDINARY  DIPOLE 


Figure  4-20. — Folded-dipole  antennas. 

A  FOLDED  DIPOLE  is  an  ordinary  half-wave  antenna  that  has  one  or  more  additional  conductors 
connected  across  its  ends.  Additional  conductors  are  mounted  parallel  to  the  dipole  elements  at  a  distance 
equal  to  a  very  small  fraction  of  a  wavelength.  Spacing  of  several  inches  is  common. 

The  feed-point  impedance  can  be  further  increased  by  using  three  or  four  properly  spaced  parallel 
conductors.  Standard  feed-line  SPREADERS  are  used  to  maintain  this  spacing  when  required.  In  any 
folded  dipole,  the  increase  of  impedance  is  the  square  of  the  number  of  conductors  used  in  the  radiator. 
Thus,  a  three-wire  dipole  has  nine  times  (32)  the  feed-point  impedance  of  a  simple  center-fed  dipole.  A 
second  method  of  stepping  up  the  impedance  of  a  folded  dipole  is  to  use  two  conductors  with  different 
radii,  as  shown  in  view  B. 

The  directional  characteristics  of  a  folded  dipole  are  the  same  as  those  of  a  simple  dipole.  However, 
the  reactance  of  a  folded  dipole  varies  much  more  slowly  as  the  frequency  is  varied  from  resonance. 
Because  of  this  the  folded  dipole  can  be  used  over  a  much  wider  frequency  range  than  is  possible  with  a 
simple  dipole. 


4-24 


Q24.   What  is  the  difference  in  the  amount  of  impedance  between  a  three-wire  dipole  and  a  simple 
center-fed  dipole? 

Q25.   Which  has  a  wider  frequency  range,  a  simple  dipole  or  a  folded  dipole? 


ARRAY  ANTENNAS 

An  array  antenna  is  a  special  arrangement  of  basic  antenna  components  involving  new  factors  and 
concepts.  Before  you  begin  studying  about  arrays,  you  need  to  study  some  new  terminology. 

DEFINITION  OF  TERMS 

An  array  antenna  is  made  up  of  more  than  one  ELEMENT,  but  the  basic  element  is  generally  the 
dipole.  Sometimes  the  basic  element  is  made  longer  or  shorter  than  a  half-wave,  but  the  deviation  usually 
is  not  great. 

A  DRIVEN  element  is  similar  to  the  dipole  you  have  been  studying  and  is  connected  directly  to  the 
transmission  line.  It  obtains  its  power  directly  from  the  transmitter  or,  as  a  receiving  antenna,  it  delivers 
the  received  energy  directly  to  the  receiver.  A  PARASITIC  ELEMENT  is  located  near  the  driven  element 
from  which  it  gets  its  power.  It  is  placed  close  enough  to  the  driven  element  to  permit  coupling. 

A  parasitic  element  is  sometimes  placed  so  it  will  produce  maximum  radiation  (during  transmission) 
from  its  associated  driver.  When  it  operates  to  reinforce  energy  coming  from  the  driver  toward  itself,  the 
parasitic  element  is  referred  to  as  a  DIRECTOR.  If  a  parasitic  element  is  placed  so  it  causes  maximum 
energy  radiation  in  a  direction  away  from  itself  and  toward  the  driven  element,  that  parasitic  element  is 
called  a  REFLECTOR. 

If  all  of  the  elements  in  an  array  are  driven,  the  array  is  referred  to  as  a  DRIVEN  ARRAY 
(sometimes  as  a  CONNECTED  ARRAY).  If  one  or  more  elements  are  parasitic,  the  entire  system  usually 
is  considered  to  be  a  PARASITIC  ARRAY. 

MULTIELEMENT  ARRAYS  frequently  are  classified  according  to  their  directivity.  A 
BIDIRECTIONAL  ARRAY  radiates  in  opposite  directions  along  the  line  of  maximum  radiation.  A 
UNIDIRECTIONAL  ARRAY  radiates  in  only  one  general  direction. 

Arrays  can  be  described  with  respect  to  their  radiation  patterns  and  the  types  of  elements  of  which 
they  are  made.  However,  you  will  find  it  useful  to  identify  them  by  the  physical  placement  of  the 
elements  and  the  direction  of  radiation  with  respect  to  these  elements.  Generally  speaking,  the  term 
BROADSIDE  ARRAY  designates  an  array  in  which  the  direction  of  maximum  radiation  is  perpendicular 
to  the  plane  containing  these  elements.  In  actual  practice,  this  term  is  confined  to  those  arrays  in  which 
the  elements  themselves  are  also  broadside,  or  parallel,  with  respect  to  each  other. 

A  COLLINEAR  ARRAY  is  one  in  which  all  the  elements  lie  in  a  straight  line  with  no  radiation  at 
the  ends  of  the  array.  The  direction  of  maximum  radiation  is  perpendicular  to  the  axis  of  the  elements. 

An  END-FIRE  ARRAY  is  one  in  which  the  principal  direction  of  radiation  is  along  the  plane  of  the 
array  and  perpendicular  to  the  elements.  Radiation  is  from  the  end  of  the  array,  which  is  the  reason  this 
arrangement  is  referred  to  as  an  end-fire  array. 

Sometimes  a  system  uses  the  characteristics  of  more  than  one  of  the  three  types  mentioned.  For 
instance,  some  of  the  elements  may  be  collinear  while  others  may  be  parallel.  Such  an  arrangement  is 


4-25 


often  referred  to  as  a  COMBINATION  ARRAY  or  an  ARRAY  OF  ARRAYS.  Since  maximum  radiation 
occurs  at  right  angles  to  the  plane  of  the  array,  the  term  broadside  array  is  also  used. 


The  FRONT-TO-BACK  RATIO  is  the  ratio  of  the  energy  radiated  in  the  principal  direction 
compared  to  the  energy  radiated  in  the  opposite  direction  for  a  given  antenna. 

PHASING 

Various  reflected  and  refracted  components  of  the  propagated  wave  create  effects  of  reinforcement 
and  cancellation.  At  certain  distant  points  from  the  transmitter,  some  of  the  wave  components  meet  in 
space.  Reception  at  these  points  is  either  impaired  or  improved.  If  the  different  components  arrive  at  a 
given  point  in  the  same  phase,  they  add,  making  a  stronger  signal  available.  If  they  arrive  out  of  phase, 
they  cancel,  reducing  the  signal  strength. 

Radiation  Pattern 

Effects  similar  to  those  described  in  the  preceding  paragraph  can  be  produced  at  the  transmitting 
point  itself.  Consider  the  antennas  shown  in  figure  4-21,  views  A  and  B.  View  A  shows  an  unobstructed 
view  of  the  radiation  pattern  of  a  single  dipole.  In  view  B  two  dipoles,  shown  as  points  1  and  2,  are 
perpendicular  to  the  plane  of  the  page.  They  are  spaced  1/4  wavelength  apart  at  the  operating  frequency. 
The  radiation  pattern  from  either  antenna  1  or  2,  operating  alone,  would  be  uniform  in  all  directions  in 
this  plane,  as  shown  in  view  A.  Suppose  that  current  is  being  fed  to  both  antennas  from  the  same 
transmitter  in  such  a  way  that  the  current  fed  to  antenna  2  lags  the  current  in  antenna  1  by  90  degrees. 
Energy  radiating  from  antenna  1  toward  receiving  location  X  will  reach  antenna  2  after  1/4  cycle  of 
operation.  The  energy  from  both  antennas  will  add,  and  propagation  toward  X  will  be  strong. 


Figure  4-21. — Phasing  of  antenna  in  free  space. 

Radiation  from  antenna  2  toward  receiving  location  Y  will  reach  antenna  1  after  1/4  cycle.  The 
energy  in  antenna  1  was  1/4  cycle  behind  that  of  antenna  2  to  begin  with;  therefore,  the  radiation  from 
antenna  1  toward  receiving  point  Y  will  be  exactly  180  degrees  out  of  phase  with  that  of  antenna  2.  As  a 
result,  the  radiation  fields  will  cancel  and  there  will  be  no  radiation  toward  Y. 

At  receiving  points  away  from  the  line  of  radiation,  phase  differences  occur  between  0  and  180 
degrees,  producing  varying  amounts  of  energy  in  that  direction.  The  overall  effect  is  shown  by  the 


4-26 


radiation  pattern  shown  in  view  B.  The  physical  phase  relationship  caused  by  the  1/4-wavelength  spacing 
between  the  two  elements,  as  well  as  the  phase  of  the  currents  in  the  elements,  has  acted  to  change  the 
radiation  pattern  of  the  individual  antennas. 

Stub  Phasing 

In  the  case  just  discussed,  the  currents  fed  to  the  two  antennas  from  the  same  transmitter  were  90 
degrees  out  of  phase.  Sections  of  transmission  line,  called  STUBS,  are  frequently  used  for  this  purpose. 
These  stubs  can  be  adjusted  to  produce  any  desired  phase  relationship  between  connected  elements. 

When  two  collinear  half-wave  elements  are  connected  directly  so  their  currents  are  in  the  same 
phase,  the  effect  is  the  same  as  that  of  a  full-wave  antenna,  as  shown  in  figure  4-22,  view  A.  The  current 
in  the  first  1/2  wavelength  is  exactly  180  degrees  out  of  phase  with  that  in  the  second  1/2  wavelength. 
This  is  the  opposite  of  the  desired  condition.  In  the  illustration,  arrows  are  used  to  indicate  the  direction  of 
current  flow  in  the  antenna.  (Using  arrows  is  a  convenient  means  of  determining  the  phase  on  more 
complicated  arrays.) 


B 


Figure  4-22. — Phasing  of  connected  elements. 

When  the  two  elements  are  connected  by  a  shorted  1/4-wavelength  stub,  as  shown  in  view  B,  current 
travels  down  one  side  of  the  stub  and  up  the  other.  It  travels  a  distance  of  a  1/2  wavelength  in  the  stub 
itself.  As  a  result,  the  current  moves  through  1/2  cycle  of  change.  When  the  current  reaches  the  second 
element,  it  is  in  the  desired  phase.  Since  the  current  on  one  side  of  the  stub  is  equal  and  opposite  to  the 
current  on  the  other  side,  the  fields  produced  here  cancel  and  no  radiation  is  transmitted  from  the  stub 
itself. 


4-27 


DIRECTIVITY 


The  DIRECTIVITY  of  an  antenna  or  an  array  can  be  determined  by  looking  at  its  radiation  pattern. 
In  an  array  propagating  a  given  amount  of  energy,  more  radiation  takes  place  in  certain  directions  than  in 
others.  The  elements  in  the  array  can  be  altered  in  such  a  way  that  they  change  the  pattern  and  distribute  it 
more  uniformly  in  all  directions.  The  elements  can  be  considered  as  a  group  of  antennas  fed  from  a 
common  source  and  facing  different  directions.  On  the  other  hand,  the  elements  could  be  arranged  so  that 
the  radiation  would  be  focused  in  a  single  direction.  With  no  increase  in  power  from  the  transmitter,  the 
amount  of  radiation  in  a  given  direction  would  be  greater.  Since  the  input  power  has  no  increase,  this 
increased  directivity  is  achieved  at  the  expense  of  gain  in  other  directions. 

Directivity  and  Interference 

In  many  applications,  sharp  directivity  is  desirable  although  no  need  exists  for  added  gain.  Examine 
the  physical  disposition  of  the  units  shown  in  figure  4-23.  Transmitters  1  and  2  are  sending  information  to 
receivers  1  and  2,  respectively,  along  the  paths  shown  by  the  solid  arrows.  The  distance  between 
transmitter  1  and  receiver  1  or  between  transmitter  2  and  receiver  2  is  short  and  does  not  require  high- 
power  transmission.  The  antennas  of  the  transmitters  propagate  well  in  all  directions.  However,  receiver  1 
picks  up  some  of  the  signals  from  transmitter  2,  and  receiver  2  picks  up  some  of  the  signals  from 
transmitter  1 ,  as  shown  by  the  broken  arrows.  This  effect  is  emphasized  if  the  receiving  antennas  intercept 
energy  equally  well  in  all  directions. 


Figure  4-23. — Directivity  and  interference. 

The  use  of  highly  directional  arrays  as  radiators  from  the  transmitters  tends  to  solve  the  problem.  The 
signals  are  beamed  along  the  paths  of  the  solid  arrows  and  provide  very  low  radiation  along  the  paths  of 
the  broken  arrows.  Further  improvement  along  these  lines  is  obtained  by  the  use  of  narrowly  directed 
arrays  as  receiving  antennas.  The  effect  of  this  arrangement  is  to  select  the  desired  signal  while 
discriminating  against  all  other  signals.  This  same  approach  can  be  used  to  overcome  other  types  of 
radiated  interference.  In  such  cases,  preventing  radiation  in  certain  directions  is  more  important  than 
producing  greater  gain  in  other  directions. 

Look  at  the  differences  between  the  field  patterns  of  the  single-element  antenna  and  the  array,  as 
illustrated  in  figure  4-24.  View  A  shows  the  relative  field-strength  pattern  for  a  horizontally  polarized 
single  antenna.  View  B  shows  the  horizontal-radiation  pattern  for  an  array.  The  antenna  in  view  A 


4-28 


radiates  fairly  efficiently  in  the  desired  direction  toward  receiving  point  X.  It  radiates  equally  as 
efficiently  toward  Y,  although  no  radiation  is  desired  in  this  direction.  The  antenna  in  view  B  radiates 
strongly  to  point  X,  but  very  little  in  the  direction  of  point  Y,  which  results  in  more  satisfactory  operation. 


A.  SINGLE  ANTENNA        B.  ARRAY  PATTERN 
PATTERN 

Figure  4-24. — Single  antenna  versus  array. 

Major  and  Minor  Lobes 

The  pattern  shown  in  figure  4-24,  view  B,  has  radiation  concentrated  in  two  lobes.  The  radiation 
intensity  in  one  lobe  is  considerably  stronger  than  in  the  other.  The  lobe  toward  point  X  is  called  a 
MAJOR  LOBE;  the  other  is  a  MINOR  LOBE.  Since  the  complex  radiation  patterns  associated  with 
arrays  frequently  contain  several  lobes  of  varying  intensity,  you  should  learn  to  use  appropriate 
terminology.  In  general,  major  lobes  are  those  in  which  the  greatest  amount  of  radiation  occurs.  Minor 
lobes  are  those  in  which  the  radiation  intensity  is  least. 

Q26.   What  is  the  purpose  of  antenna  stubs? 

Q27.   What  is  the  primary  difference  between  the  major  and  minor  lobes  of  a  radiation  pattern? 

DIRECTIONAL  ARRAYS 

You  have  already  learned  about  radiation  patterns  and  directivity  of  radiation.  These  topics  are 
important  to  you  because  using  an  antenna  with  an  improper  radiation  pattern  or  with  the  wrong 
directivity  will  decrease  the  overall  performance  of  the  system.  In  the  following  paragraphs,  we  discuss  in 
more  detail  the  various  types  of  directional  antenna  arrays  mentioned  briefly  in  the  "definition  of  terms" 
paragraph  above. 

Collinear  Array 

The  pattern  radiated  by  the  collinear  array  is  similar  to  that  produced  by  a  single  dipole.  The  addition 
of  the  second  radiator,  however,  tends  to  intensify  the  pattern.  Compare  the  radiation  pattern  of  the  dipole 
(view  A  of  figure  4-25)  and  the  two-element  antenna  in  view  B.  You  will  see  that  each  pattern  consists  of 
two  major  lobes  in  opposite  directions  along  the  same  axis,  QQ1 .  There  is  little  or  no  radiation  along  the 


4-29 


PP1  axis.  QQ1  represents  the  line  of  maximum  propagation.  You  can  see  that  radiation  is  stronger  with  an 
added  element.  The  pattern  in  view  B  is  sharper,  or  more  directive,  than  that  in  view  A.  This  means  that 
the  gain  along  the  line  of  maximum  energy  propagation  is  increased  and  the  beam  width  is  decreased.  As 
more  elements  are  added,  the  effect  is  heightened,  as  shown  in  view  C.  Unimportant  minor  lobes  are 
generated  as  more  elements  are  added. 


A.  ONE  ELEMENT  E.  TWO  ELEMENTS  C.  FOUR  ELEMENTS 


Figure  4-25. — Single  half-wave  antenna  versus  two  half-wave  antennas  in  phase. 

More  than  four  elements  are  seldom  used  because  accumulated  losses  cause  the  elements  farther 
from  the  point  of  feeding  to  have  less  current  than  the  nearer  ones.  This  introduces  an  unbalanced 
condition  in  the  system  and  impairs  its  efficiency.  Space  limitations  often  are  another  reason  for 
restricting  the  number  of  elements.  Since  this  type  of  array  is  in  a  single  line,  rather  than  in  a  vertically 
stacked  arrangement,  the  use  of  too  many  elements  results  in  an  antenna  several  wavelengths  long. 

RADIATION  PATTERN. — The  characteristic  radiation  pattern  of  a  given  array  is  obtained  at  the 
frequency  or  band  of  frequencies  at  which  the  system  is  resonant.  The  gain  and  directivity  characteristics 
are  lost  when  the  antenna  is  not  used  at  or  near  this  frequency  and  the  array  tunes  too  sharply.  A  collinear 
antenna  is  more  effective  than  an  end-fire  array  when  used  off  its  tuned  frequency.  This  feature  is 
considered  when  transmission  or  reception  is  to  be  over  a  wide  frequency  band.  When  more  than  two 
elements  are  used,  this  advantage  largely  disappears. 

LENGTH  AND  PHASING.— Although  the  1/2  wavelength  is  the  basis  for  the  collinear  element, 
you  will  find  that  greater  lengths  are  often  used.  Effective  arrays  of  this  type  have  been  constructed  in 
which  the  elements  are  0.7  and  even  0.8  wavelength  long.  This  type  of  array  provides  efficient  operation 
at  more  than  one  frequency  or  over  a  wider  frequency  range.  Whatever  length  is  decided  upon,  all  of  the 
elements  in  a  particular  array  should  closely  adhere  to  that  length.  If  elements  of  different  lengths  are 
combined,  current  phasing  and  distribution  are  changed,  throwing  the  system  out  of  balance  and  seriously 
affecting  the  radiation  pattern. 

Q28.   What  is  the  maximum  number  of  elements  ordinarily  used  in  a  collinear  array? 
Q29.   Why  is  the  number  of  elements  used  in  a  collinear  array  limited? 
Q30.  How  can  the  frequency  range  of  a  collinear  array  be  increased? 

Q31.  How  is  directivity  of  a  collinear  array  affected  when  the  number  of  elements  is  increased? 

SPACING. — The  lower  relative  efficiency  of  collinear  arrays  of  many  elements,  compared  with 
other  multi-element  arrays,  relates  directly  to  spacing  and  mutual  impedance  effects.  Mutual  impedance  is 


4-30 


an  important  factor  to  be  considered  when  any  two  elements  are  parallel  and  are  spaced  so  that 
considerable  coupling  is  between  them.  There  is  very  little  mutual  impedance  between  collinear  sections. 
Where  impedance  does  exist,  it  is  caused  by  the  coupling  between  the  ends  of  adjacent  elements.  Placing 
the  ends  of  elements  close  together  is  frequently  necessary  because  of  construction  problems,  especially 
where  long  lengths  of  wire  are  involved. 

The  effects  of  spacing  and  the  advantages  of  proper  spacing  can  be  demonstrated  by  some  practical 
examples.  A  collinear  array  consisting  of  two  half-wave  elements  with  1/4-wavelength  spacing  between 
centers  has  a  gain  of  1.8  dB.  If  the  ends  of  these  same  dipoles  are  separated  so  that  the  distance  from 
center  to  center  is  3/4  wavelengths  and  they  are  driven  from  the  same  source,  the  gain  increases  to 
approximately  2.9  dB. 

A  three-dipole  array  with  negligible  spacing  between  elements  gives  a  gain  of  3.3  dB.  In  other 
words,  when  two  elements  are  used  with  wider  spacing,  the  gain  obtained  is  approximately  equal  to  the 
gain  obtainable  from  three  elements  with  close  spacing.  The  spacing  of  this  array  permits  simpler 
construction,  since  only  two  dipoles  are  used.  It  also  allows  the  antenna  to  occupy  less  space. 
Construction  problems  usually  dictate  small-array  spacing. 

Broadside  Arrays 

A  broadside  array  is  shown  in  figure  4-26,  view  A.  Physically,  it  looks  somewhat  like  a  ladder. 
When  the  array  and  the  elements  in  it  are  polarized  horizontally,  it  looks  like  an  upright  ladder.  When  the 
array  is  polarized  vertically,  it  looks  like  a  ladder  lying  on  one  side  (view  B).  View  C  is  an  illustration  of 
the  radiation  pattern  of  a  broadside  array.  Horizontally  polarized  arrays  using  more  than  two  elements  are 
not  common.  This  is  because  the  requirement  that  the  bottom  of  the  array  be  a  significant  distance  above 
the  earth  presents  construction  problems.  Compared  with  collinear  arrays,  broadside  arrays  tune  sharply, 
but  lose  efficiency  rapidly  when  not  operated  on  the  frequencies  for  which  they  are  designed. 


A.  ARRAY  B.  SIDE  VIEW  OF  ARRAY  C.  TOP  VIEV  OF  ARRAY 


Figure  4-26. — Typical  broadside  array. 

RADIATION  PATTERN. — Figure  4-27  shows  an  end  view  of  two  parallel  half-wave  antennas  (A 
and  B)  operating  in  the  same  phase  and  located  1/2  wavelength  apart.  At  a  point  (P)  far  removed  from  the 
antennas,  the  antennas  appear  as  a  single  point.  Energy  radiating  toward  P  from  antenna  A  starts  out  in 
phase  with  the  energy  radiating  from  antenna  B  in  the  same  direction.  Propagation  from  each  antenna 
travels  over  the  same  distance  to  point  P,  arriving  there  in  phase.  The  antennas  reinforce  each  other  in  this 
direction,  making  a  strong  signal  available  at  P.  Field  strength  measured  at  P  is  greater  than  it  would  be  if 
the  total  power  supplied  to  both  antennas  had  been  fed  to  a  single  dipole.  Radiation  toward  point  PI  is 
built  up  in  the  same  manner. 


4-31 


Q 
i 


*  PI 


t 

Q1 

Figure  4-27. — Parallel  elements  in  phase. 

Next  consider  a  wavefront  traveling  toward  point  Q  from  antenna  B.  By  the  time  it  reaches  antenna 
A,  1/2  wavelength  away,  1/2  cycle  has  elapsed.  Therefore  energy  from  antenna  B  meets  the  energy  from 
antenna  A  180  degrees  out  of  phase.  As  a  result,  the  energy  moving  toward  point  Q  from  the  two  sources 
cancels.  In  a  like  manner,  radiation  from  antenna  A  traveling  toward  point  Ql  meets  and  cancels  the 
radiation  in  the  same  direction  from  antenna  B.  As  a  result,  little  propagation  takes  place  in  either 
direction  along  the  QQ1  axis.  Most  of  the  energy  is  concentrated  in  both  directions  along  the  PP1  axis. 
When  both  antenna  elements  are  fed  from  the  same  source,  the  result  is  the  basic  broadside  array. 

When  more  than  two  elements  are  used  in  a  broadside  arrangement,  they  are  all  parallel  and  in  the 
same  plane,  as  shown  in  figure  4-26,  view  B.  Current  phase,  indicated  by  the  arrows,  must  be  the  same  for 
all  elements.  The  radiation  pattern  shown  in  figure  4-26,  view  C,  is  always  bi-directional.  This  pattern  is 
sharper  than  the  one  shown  in  figure  4-27  because  of  the  additional  two  elements.  Directivity  and  gain 
depend  on  the  number  of  elements  and  the  spacing  between  them. 

GAIN  AND  DIRECTIVITY. — The  physical  disposition  of  dipoles  operated  broadside  to  each  other 
allows  for  much  greater  coupling  between  them  than  can  occur  between  collinear  elements.  Moving  the 
parallel  antenna  elements  closer  together  or  farther  apart  affects  the  actual  impedance  of  the  entire  array 
and  the  overall  radiation  resistance  as  well.  As  the  spacing  between  broadside  elements  increases,  the 
effect  on  the  radiation  pattern  is  a  sharpening  of  the  major  lobes.  When  the  array  consists  of  only  two 
dipoles  spaced  exactly  1/2  wavelength  apart,  no  minor  lobes  are  generated  at  all.  Increasing  the  distance 
between  the  elements  beyond  that  point,  however,  tends  to  throw  off  the  phase  relationship  between  the 
original  current  in  one  element  and  the  current  induced  in  it  by  the  other  element.  The  result  is  that, 
although  the  major  lobes  are  sharpened,  minor  lobes  are  introduced,  even  with  two  elements.  These, 
however,  are  not  large  enough  to  be  of  concern. 

If  you  add  the  same  number  of  elements  to  both  a  broadside  array  and  a  collinear  array,  the  gain  of 
the  broadside  array  will  be  greater.  Reduced  radiation  resistance  resulting  from  the  efficient  coupling 
between  dipoles  accounts  for  most  of  this  gain.  However,  certain  practical  factors  limit  the  number  of 


4-32 


elements  that  may  be  used.  The  construction  problem  increases  with  the  number  of  elements,  especially 
when  they  are  polarized  horizontally. 

Q32.   What  is  the  primary  cause  of  broadside  arrays  losing  efficiency  when  not  operating  at  their 
designed  frequency? 

Q33.   When  more  than  two  elements  are  used  in  a  broadside  array,  how  are  the  elements  arranged? 

Q34.  As  the  spacing  between  elements  in  a  broadside  array  increases,  what  is  the  effect  on  the  major 
lobes? 

End-Fire  Arrays 

An  end-fire  array  looks  similar  to  a  broadside  array.  The  ladder-like  appearance  is  characteristic  of 
both  (fig.  4-28,  view  A).  The  currents  in  the  elements  of  the  end- fire  array,  however,  are  usually  180 
degrees  out  of  phase  with  each  other  as  indicated  by  the  arrows.  The  construction  of  the  end-fire  array  is 
like  that  of  a  ladder  lying  on  its  side  (elements  horizontal).  The  dipoles  in  an  end- fire  array  are  closer 
together  (1/8 -wavelength  to  1/4  -wavelength  spacing)  than  they  are  for  a  broadside  array. 


A.  TOP  VIEW  OF  ARRAY 


-* — O  O  O-  O  — 

B.  SIDE  VIEW  OF  ARRAY 

Figure  4-28. — Typical  end-fire  array. 

Closer  spacing  between  elements  permits  compactness  of  construction.  For  this  reason  an  end-fire 
array  is  preferred  to  other  arrays  when  high  gain  or  sharp  directivity  is  desired  in  a  confined  space. 
However,  the  close  coupling  creates  certain  disadvantages.  Radiation  resistance  is  extremely  low, 
sometimes  as  low  as  10  ohms,  making  antenna  losses  greater.  The  end- fire  array  is  confined  to  a  single 
frequency.  With  changes  in  climatic  or  atmospheric  conditions,  the  danger  of  detuning  exists. 

RADIATION  PATTERN. — The  radiation  pattern  for  a  pair  of  parallel  half-wave  elements  fed  180 
degrees  out  of  phase  is  shown  in  figure  4-29,  view  A.  The  elements  shown  are  spaced  1/2  wavelength 
apart.  In  practice,  smaller  spacings  are  used.  Radiation  from  elements  L  and  M  traveling  toward  point  P 
begins  180  degrees  out  of  phase.  Moving  the  same  distance  over  approximately  parallel  paths,  the 
respective  wavefronts  from  these  elements  remain  180  degrees  out  of  phase.  In  other  words,  maximum 
cancellation  takes  place  in  the  direction  of  P.  The  same  condition  is  true  for  the  opposite  direction  (toward 
PI).  The  P  to  PI  axis  is  the  line  of  least  radiation  for  the  end-fire  array. 


4-33 


Figure  4-29. — Parallel  elements  180  degrees  out  of  phase. 

Consider  what  happens  along  the  QQ1  axis.  Energy  radiating  from  element  M  toward  Q  reaches 
element  L  in  about  1/2  cycle  (180  degrees)  after  it  leaves  its  source.  Since  element  L  was  fed  180  degrees 
out  of  phase  with  element  M,  the  wavefronts  are  now  in  the  same  phase  and  are  both  moving  toward  Q 
reinforcing  each  other.  Similar  reinforcement  occurs  along  the  same  axis  toward  Ql .  This  simultaneous 
movement  towards  Q  and  Q 1  develops  a  bi-directional  pattern.  This  is  not  always  true  in  end- fire 
operation.  Another  application  of  the  end-fire  principle  is  one  in  which  the  elements  are  spaced  1/4 
wavelength  apart  and  phased  90  degrees  from  each  other  to  produce  a  unidirectional  pattern. 

In  figure  4-29,  view  A,  elements  A  and  B  are  perpendicular  to  the  plane  represented  by  the  page; 
therefore,  only  the  ends  of  the  antennas  appear.  In  view  B  the  antennas  are  rotated  a  quarter  of  a  circle  in 
space  around  the  QQ1  axis  so  that  they  are  seen  in  the  plane  of  the  elements  themselves.  Therefore,  the 
PP1  axis,  now  perpendicular  to  the  page,  is  not  seen  as  a  line.  The  RR1  axis,  now  seen  as  a  line,  is 
perpendicular  to  the  PP1  axis  as  well  as  to  the  QQ1  axis.  The  end-fire  array  is  directional  in  this  plane 
also,  although  not  quite  as  sharply.  The  reason  for  the  greater  broadness  of  the  lobes  can  be  seen  by 
following  the  path  of  energy  radiating  from  the  midpoint  of  element  B  toward  point  S  in  view  B.  This 
energy  passes  the  A  element  at  one  end  after  traveling  slightly  more  than  the  perpendicular  distance 
between  the  dipoles.  Energy,  therefore,  does  not  combine  in  exact  phase  toward  point  S.  Although 
maximum  radiation  cannot  take  place  in  this  direction,  energy  from  the  two  sources  combines  closely 
enough  in  phase  to  produce  considerable  reinforcement.  A  similar  situation  exists  for  wavefronts  traveling 
toward  T.  However,  the  wider  angle  from  Q  to  T  produces  a  greater  phase  difference  and  results  in  a 
decrease  in  the  strength  of  the  combined  wave. 

Directivity  occurs  from  either  one  or  both  ends  of  the  end-fire  array,  along  the  axis  of  the  array,  as 
shown  by  the  broken  arrows  in  figure  4-28,  view  A;  hence,  the  term  end-fire  is  used. 

The  major  lobe  or  lobes  occur  along  the  axis  of  the  array.  The  pattern  is  sharper  in  the  plane  that  is  at 
right  angles  to  the  plane  containing  the  elements  (figure  4-29,  view  A).  If  the  elements  are  not  exact 
half-wave  dipoles,  operation  is  not  significantly  affected.  However,  because  of  the  required  balance  of 
phase  relationships  and  critical  feeding,  the  array  must  be  symmetrical.  Folded  dipoles,  such  as  the  one 
shown  in  figure  4-20,  view  A,  are  used  frequently  because  the  impedance  at  their  terminals  is  higher.  This 
is  an  effective  way  of  avoiding  excessive  antenna  losses.  Another  expedient  to  reduce  losses  is  the  use  of 
tubular  elements  of  wide  diameter. 

GAIN  AND  DIRECTIVITY. — In  end-fire  arrays,  directivity  increases  with  the  addition  of  more 
elements  and  with  spacings  approaching  the  optimum.  The  directive  pattern  for  a  two-element, 


4-34 


bi-directional  system  is  illustrated  in  figure  4-29.  View  A  shows  radiation  along  the  array  axis  in  a  plane 
perpendicular  to  the  dipoles,  and  view  B  shows  radiation  along  the  array  axis  in  the  plane  of  the  elements. 
These  patterns  were  developed  with  a  180-degree  phase  difference  between  the  elements.  Additional 
elements  introduce  small,  minor  lobes. 

With  a  90-degree  phase  difference  in  the  energy  fed  to  a  pair  of  end-fire  elements  spaced 
approximately  1/4  wavelength  apart,  unidirectional  radiation  can  be  obtained.  The  pattern  perpendicular 
to  the  plane  of  the  two  elements  is  shown  in  figure  4-30,  view  A.  The  pattern  shown  in  view  B,  taken  in 
the  same  plane,  is  for  a  six-element  array  with  90-degree  phasing  between  adjacent  elements.  Since  both 
patterns  show  relative  gain  only,  the  increase  in  gain  produced  by  the  six-element  array  is  not  evident. 
End-fire  arrays  are  the  only  unidirectional  arrays  wholly  made  up  of  driven  elements. 


Q35.   What  are  some  disadvantages  of  the  end-fire  array? 
Q36.   Where  does  the  major  lobe  in  the  end-fire  array  occur? 

Q37.  To  maintain  the  required  balance  of phase  relationships  and  critical  feeding,  how  must  the 
end-fire  array  be  constructed? 

Parasitic  Arrays 

If  a  small  light  bulb  were  placed  in  the  center  of  a  large  room,  the  illumination  would  be  very  poor. 
However,  if  a  reflector  were  placed  behind  the  bulb,  the  space  in  front  of  the  reflector  would  be  brighter 
and  the  space  behind  the  reflector  would  be  dimmer.  The  light  rays  would  be  concentrated.  Also,  if  a  lens 
were  placed  in  front  of  the  bulb,  the  light  would  be  even  more  concentrated  and  a  very  bright  spot  would 
appear  on  the  wall  in  front  of  the  lens.  A  flashlight  is  a  practical  combination  of  the  small  bulb,  the 
reflector,  and  the  lens.  The  energy  from  an  antenna  can  be  reflected  and  concentrated  in  a  similar  manner. 

Although  we  do  not  usually  discuss  the  gain  of  a  flashlight,  we  can  continue  the  comparison  of  an 
antenna  and  a  flashlight  to  explain  the  meaning  of  antenna  gain.  Suppose  the  spot  on  the  wall  in  front  of 
the  flashlight  becomes  1 0  times  brighter  than  it  was  when  only  the  open  bulb  was  used.  The  lens  and 
reflector  have  then  produced  a  10-fold  gain  in  light.  For  antennas,  the  simple  half-wave  antenna 
corresponds  to  the  open  bulb  in  the  flashlight.  Suppose  an  antenna  system  concentrates  the  radio  waves  so 


A 


B 


Figure  4-30. — Unidirectional  end-fire  arrays. 


4-35 


that  at  a  particular  point  the  field  strength  is  1 0  times  more  than  it  would  be  at  the  same  distance  from  a 
half-wave  antenna.  The  antenna  system  is  then  said  to  have  a  gain  of  10. 

Parasitic  arrays  represent  another  method  of  achieving  high  antenna  gains.  A  parasitic  array  consists 
of  one  or  more  parasitic  elements  placed  in  parallel  with  each  other  and,  in  most  cases,  at  the  same 
line-of-sight  level.  The  parasitic  element  is  fed  inductively  by  radiated  energy  coming  from  the  driven 
element  connected  to  the  transmitter.  It  is  in  NO  way  connected  directly  to  the  driven  element. 

When  the  parasitic  element  is  placed  so  that  it  radiates  away  from  the  driven  element,  the  element  is 
a  director.  When  the  parasitic  element  is  placed  so  that  it  radiates  toward  the  driven  element,  the  parasitic 
element  is  a  reflector. 

The  directivity  pattern  resulting  from  the  action  of  parasitic  elements  depends  on  two  factors.  These 
are  (1)  the  tuning,  determined  by  the  length  of  the  parasitic  element;  and  (2)  the  spacing  between  the 
parasitic  and  driven  elements.  To  a  lesser  degree,  it  also  depends  on  the  diameter  of  the  parasitic  element, 
since  diameter  has  an  effect  on  tuning. 

OPERATION. — When  a  parasitic  element  is  placed  a  fraction  of  a  wavelength  away  from  the 
driven  element  and  is  of  approximately  resonant  length,  it  will  re -radiate  the  energy  it  intercepts.  The 
parasitic  element  is  effectively  a  tuned  circuit  coupled  to  the  driven  element,  much  as  the  two  windings  of 
a  transformer  are  coupled  together.  The  radiated  energy  from  the  driven  element  causes  a  voltage  to  be 
developed  in  the  parasitic  element,  which,  in  turn,  sets  up  a  magnetic  field.  This  magnetic  field  extends 
over  to  the  driven  element,  which  then  has  a  voltage  induced  in  it.  The  magnitude  and  phase  of  the 
induced  voltage  depend  on  the  length  of  the  parasitic  element  and  the  spacing  between  the  elements.  In 
actual  practice  the  length  and  spacing  are  arranged  so  that  the  phase  and  magnitude  of  the  induced  voltage 
cause  a  unidirectional,  horizontal-radiation  pattern  and  an  increase  in  gain. 

In  the  parasitic  array  in  figure  4-31,  view  A,  the  parasitic  and  driven  elements  are  spaced  1/4 
wavelength  apart.  The  radiated  signal  coming  from  the  driven  element  strikes  the  parasitic  element  after 
1/4  cycle.  The  voltage  developed  in  the  parasitic  element  is  180  degrees  out  of  phase  with  that  of  the 
driven  element.  This  is  because  of  the  distance  traveled  (90  degrees)  and  because  the  induced  current  lags 
the  inducing  flux  by  90  degrees  (90  +  90  =  180  degrees).  The  magnetic  field  set  up  by  the  parasitic 
element  induces  a  voltage  in  the  driven  element  1/4  cycle  later  because  the  spacing  between  the  elements 
is  1/4  wavelength.  This  induced  voltage  is  in  phase  with  that  in  the  driven  element  and  causes  an  increase 
in  radiation  in  the  direction  indicated  in  figure  4-3 1 ,  view  A.  Since  the  direction  of  the  radiated  energy  is 
stronger  in  the  direction  away  from  the  parasitic  element  (toward  the  driven  element),  the  parasitic 
element  is  called  a  reflector.  The  radiation  pattern  as  it  would  appear  if  you  were  looking  down  on  the 
antenna  is  shown  in  view  B.  The  pattern  as  it  would  look  if  viewed  from  the  ends  of  the  elements  is 
shown  in  view  C. 


4-36 


RADIATED 
SIGNAL 


  FEEDER- 


DRIVEN 
ELEMENT 


\ 

PARASITIC  ELEMENT 
(REFLECTOR) 


RADIATED 
SIGNAL 

▲ 

1 


X 


B 


RADIATED 
SIGNAL 


i 

X 


Figure  4-31. — Patterns  obtained  using  a  reflector  with  proper  spacing. 

Because  the  voltage  induced  in  the  reflector  is  180  degrees  out  of  phase  with  the  signal  produced  at 
the  driven  element,  a  reduction  in  signal  strength  exists  behind  the  reflector.  Since  the  magnitude  of  an 
induced  voltage  never  quite  equals  that  of  the  inducing  voltage,  even  in  very  closely  coupled  circuits,  the 
energy  behind  the  reflector  (minor  lobe)  is  not  reduced  to  0. 

The  spacing  between  the  reflector  and  the  driven  element  can  be  reduced  to  about  15  percent  of  a 
wavelength.  The  parasitic  element  must  be  made  electrically  inductive  before  it  will  act  as  a  reflector.  If 


4-37 


this  element  is  made  about  5  percent  longer  than  1/2  wavelength,  it  will  act  as  a  reflector  when  the 
spacing  is  1 5  percent  of  a  wavelength. 

Changing  the  spacing  and  length  can  change  the  radiation  pattern  so  that  maximum  radiation  is  on 
the  same  side  of  the  driven  element  as  the  parasitic  element.  In  this  instance  the  parasitic  element  is  called 
a  director. 

Combining  a  reflector  and  a  director  with  the  driven  element  causes  a  decrease  in  back  radiation  and 
an  increase  in  directivity.  This  combination  results  in  the  two  main  advantages  of  a  parasitic  array — 
unidirectivity  and  increased  gain.  If  the  parasitic  array  is  rotated,  it  can  pick  up  or  transmit  in  different 
directions  because  of  the  reduction  of  transmitted  energy  in  all  but  the  desired  direction.  An  antenna  of 
this  type  is  called  a  ROTARY  ARRAY.  Size  for  size,  both  the  gain  and  directivity  of  parasitic  arrays  are 
greater  than  those  of  driven  arrays.  The  disadvantage  of  parasitic  arrays  is  that  their  adjustment  is  critical 
and  they  do  not  operate  over  a  wide  frequency  range. 

GAIN  AND  DIRECTIVITY. — Changing  the  spacing  between  either  the  director  or  the  reflector 
and  the  driven  element  results  in  a  change  in  the  radiation  pattern.  More  gain  and  directivity  are  obtained 
by  changing  the  length  of  the  parasitic  elements. 

The  FRONT-TO-BACK  RATIO  of  an  array  is  the  proportion  of  energy  radiated  in  the  principal 
direction  of  radiation  to  the  energy  radiated  in  the  opposite  direction.  A  high  front-to-back  ratio  is 
desirable  because  this  means  that  a  minimum  amount  of  energy  is  radiated  in  the  undesired  direction. 
Since  completely  suppressing  all  such  radiation  is  impossible,  an  infinite  ratio  cannot  be  achieved.  In 
actual  practice,  however,  rather  high  values  can  be  attained.  Usually  the  length  and  spacing  of  the 
parasitic  elements  are  adjusted  so  that  a  maximum  front-to-back  ratio  is  obtained,  rather  than  maximum 
gain  in  the  desired  direction. 

Q38.   What  two  factors  determine  the  directivity  pattern  of  the  parasitic  array? 

Q39.   What  two  main  advantages  of  a  parasitic  array  can  be  obtained  by  combining  a  reflector  and  a 
director  with  the  driven  element? 

Q40.  The  parasitic  array  can  be  rotated  to  receive  or  transmit  in  different  directions.  What  is  the  name 
given  to  such  an  antenna? 

Q41.   What  are  the  disadvantages  of  the  parasitic  array? 

Multielement  Parasitic  Array 

A  MULTIELEMENT  PARASITIC  array  is  one  that  contains  two  or  more  parasitic  elements  with  the 
driven  element.  If  the  array  contains  two  parasitic  elements  (a  reflector  and  a  director)  in  addition  to  the 
driven  element,  it  is  usually  known  as  a  THREE-ELEMENT  ARRAY.  If  three  parasitic  elements  are 
used,  the  array  is  known  as  a  FOUR-ELEMENT  ARRAY,  and  so  on.  Generally  speaking,  if  more 
parasitic  elements  are  added  to  a  three-element  array,  each  added  element  is  a  director.  The  field  behind  a 
reflector  is  so  small  that  additional  reflectors  would  have  little  effect  on  the  overall  radiation  pattern.  In 
radar,  from  one  to  five  directors  are  used. 

CONSTRUCTION. — The  parasitic  elements  of  a  multi-element  parasitic  array  usually  are 
positioned  as  shown  in  figure  4-32,  views  A  and  B.  Proper  spacings  and  lengths  are  determined 
experimentally.  A  folded  dipole  (view  B)  is  often  used  as  the  driven  element  to  obtain  greater  values  of 
radiation  resistance. 


4-38 


Figure  4-32. — Yagi  antenna. 

YAGI  ANTENNAS— An  example  of  a  multielement  parasitic  array  is  the  YAGI  ANTENNA 
(figure  4-32,  views  A  and  B).  The  spacings  between  the  elements  are  not  uniform.  The  radiation  from  the 
different  elements  arrives  in  phase  in  the  forward  direction,  but  out  of  phase  by  various  amounts  in  the 
other  directions. 

The  director  and  the  reflector  in  the  Yagi  antenna  are  usually  welded  to  a  conducting  rod  or  tube  at 
their  centers.  This  support  does  not  interfere  with  the  operation  of  the  antenna.  Since  the  driven  element  is 
center-fed,  it  is  not  welded  to  the  supporting  rod.  The  center  impedance  can  be  increased  by  using  a 
folded  dipole  as  the  driven  element. 

The  Yagi  antenna  shown  in  figure  4-32,  view  A,  has  three  directors.  In  general,  the  greater  number 
of  parasitic  elements  used,  the  greater  the  gain.  However,  a  greater  number  of  such  elements  causes  the 
array  to  have  a  narrower  frequency  response  as  well  as  a  narrower  beamwidth.  Therefore,  proper 
adjustment  of  the  antenna  is  critical.  The  gain  does  not  increase  directly  with  the  number  of  elements 
used.  For  example,  a  three-element  Yagi  array  has  a  relative  power  gain  of  5  dB.  Adding  another  director 
results  in  a  2  dB  increase.  Additional  directors  have  less  and  less  effect. 

A  typical  Yagi  array  used  for  receiving  and  transmitting  energy  is  shown  with  a  support  frame  in 
figure  4-33.  This  antenna  is  used  by  the  military  services.  It  operates  at  frequencies  of  from  12  to  50 
megahertz  and  consists  of  two  separate  arrays  (one  high-frequency  and  one  low-frequency  antenna  array) 
mounted  on  one  frame.  The  various  elements  are  indicated  in  the  figure.  The  high-frequency  (hf)  array 
consists  of  one  reflector,  one  driven  element,  and  two  directors;  the  low-frequency  (If)  array  has  the  same 
arrangement  with  one  less  director.  The  lengths  of  the  elements  in  the  high-frequency  array  are  shorter 
than  those  in  the  low-frequency  array.  The  physical  lengths  of  the  elements  in  the  individual  arrays  are 
equal,  but  the  electrical  lengths  can  be  varied  by  means  of  the  tuning  stubs  at  the  center  of  the  elements. 
The  array  can  be  rotated  in  any  desired  direction  by  a  remotely  controlled,  electrically  driven,  antenna 
rotator. 


4-39 


DIRECTOR 
(HF) 


REFLECTOR 
(LF) 


Figure  4-33. — A  typical  parasitic  array  used  for  transmitting  and  receiving. 

Q42.   What  is  the  advantage  of  adding  parasitic  elements  to  a  Yagi  array? 
Q43.  The  Yagi  antenna  is  an  example  of  what  type  of  array? 


SPECIAL  ANTENNAS 

In  this  section  we  will  cover  some  special  communications  and  radar  antennas.  Some  of  these 
antennas  we  touch  on  briefly  since  they  are  covered  thoroughly  in  other  courses. 

Previously  discussed  antennas  operate  with  standing  waves  of  current  and  voltage  along  the  wires. 
This  section  deals  principally  with  antenna  systems  in  which  the  current  is  practically  uniform  in  all  parts 
of  the  antenna.  In  its  basic  form,  such  an  antenna  consists  of  a  single  wire  grounded  at  the  far  end  through 
a  resistor.  The  resistor  has  a  value  equal  to  the  characteristic  impedance  of  the  antenna.  This  termination, 
just  as  in  the  case  of  an  ordinary  transmission  line,  eliminates  standing  waves.  The  current,  therefore, 
decreases  uniformly  along  the  wire  as  the  terminated  end  is  approached.  This  decrease  is  caused  by  the 
loss  of  energy  through  radiation.  The  energy  remaining  at  the  end  of  the  antenna  is  dissipated  in  the 
terminating  resistor.  For  such  an  antenna  to  be  a  good  radiator,  its  length  must  be  fairly  long.  Also,  the 
wire  must  not  be  too  close  to  the  ground.  The  return  path  through  the  ground  will  cause  cancellation  of 
the  radiation.  If  the  wire  is  sufficiently  long,  it  will  be  practically  nonresonant  over  a  wide  range  of 
operating  frequencies. 


4-40 


LONG-WIRE  ANTENNA 


A  LONG- WIRE  ANTENNA  is  an  antenna  that  is  a  wavelength  or  longer  at  the  operating  frequency. 
In  general,  the  gain  achieved  with  long-wire  antennas  is  not  as  great  as  the  gain  obtained  from  the 
multielement  arrays  studied  in  the  previous  section.  But  the  long-wire  antenna  has  advantages  of  its  own. 
The  construction  of  long-wire  antennas  is  simple,  both  electrically  and  mechanically,  with  no  particularly 
critical  dimensions  or  adjustments.  The  long-wire  antenna  will  work  well  and  give  satisfactory  gain  and 
directivity  over  a  frequency  range  up  to  twice  the  value  for  which  it  was  cut.  In  addition,  it  will  accept 
power  and  radiate  it  efficiently  on  any  frequency  for  which  its  overall  length  is  not  less  than 
approximately  1/2  wavelength.  Another  factor  is  that  long-wire  antennas  have  directional  patterns  that  are 
sharp  in  both  the  horizontal  and  vertical  planes.  Also,  they  tend  to  concentrate  the  radiation  at  the  low 
vertical  angles.  Another  type  of  long-wire  antenna  is  the  BEVERAGE  ANTENNA,  also  called  a  WAVE 
ANTENNA.  It  is  a  horizontal,  long-wire  antenna  designed  especially  for  the  reception  and  transmission 
of  low-frequency,  vertically  polarized  ground  waves.  It  consists  of  a  single  wire,  two  or  more 
wavelengths  long,  supported  3  to  6  meters  above  the  ground,  and  terminated  in  its  characteristic 
impedance,  as  shown  in  figure  4-34. 


TRANSMITTER 


TERMINATING 
RESISTOR 


Figure  4-34. — Beverage  antenna. 

Q44.  To  radiate  power  efficiently,  a  long-wire  antenna  must  have  what  minimum  overall  length? 
Q45.   What  is  another  name  for  the  Beverage  antenna? 
V  ANTENNA 

A  V  ANTENNA  is  a  bi-directional  antenna  used  widely  in  military  and  commercial 
communications.  It  consists  of  two  conductors  arranged  to  form  a  V.  Each  conductor  is  fed  with  currents 
of  opposite  polarity. 

The  V  is  formed  at  such  an  angle  that  the  main  lobes  reinforce  along  the  line  bisecting  the  V  and 
make  a  very  effective  directional  antenna  (see  figure  4-35).  Connecting  the  two-wire  feed  line  to  the  apex 
of  the  V  and  exciting  the  two  sides  of  the  V  180  degrees  out  of  phase  cause  the  lobes  to  add  along  the  line 
of  the  bisector  and  to  cancel  in  other  directions,  as  shown  in  figure  4-36.  The  lobes  are  designated  1,  2,  3, 
and  4  on  leg  AA',  and  5,  6,  7,  and  8  on  leg  BB'.  When  the  proper  angle  between  AA'  and  BB'  is  chosen, 
lobes  1  and  4  have  the  same  direction  and  combine  with  lobes  7  and  6,  respectively.  This  combination  of 
two  major  lobes  from  each  leg  results  in  the  formation  of  two  stronger  lobes,  which  lie  along  an 
imaginary  line  bisecting  the  enclosed  angle.  Lobes  2,  3,  5,  and  8  tend  to  cancel  each  other,  as  do  the 
smaller  lobes,  which  are  approximately  at  right  angles  to  the  wire  legs  of  the  V.  The  resultant  waveform 
pattern  is  shown  at  the  right  of  the  V  antenna  in  figure  4-36. 


4-41 


TRANSMISSION  LINE 


WAVE  DIRECTION 
 » 


Figure  4-35. — Basic  V  antenna. 


Figure  4-36. — Formation  of  directional  radiation  pattern  from  a  resonant  V  antenna. 


Q46.   What  is  the  polarity  of  the  currents  that  feed  the  V  antenna? 

RHOMBIC  ANTENNA 

The  highest  development  of  the  long-wire  antenna  is  the  RHOMBIC  ANTENNA  (see  figure  4-37).  It 
consists  of  four  conductors  joined  to  form  a  rhombus,  or  diamond  shape.  The  antenna  is  placed  end  to  end 
and  terminated  by  a  noninductive  resistor  to  produce  a  uni-directional  pattern.  A  rhombic  antenna  can  be 
made  of  two  obtuse-angle  V  antennas  that  are  placed  side  by  side,  erected  in  a  horizontal  plane,  and 
terminated  so  the  antenna  is  nonresonant  and  unidirectional. 


4-42 


A.  TOP  VIEW 


MAXIMUM 
RADIATION 


B.  SIDE  VIEW 


Figure  4-37. — Basic  rhombic  antenna. 

The  rhombic  antenna  is  WIDELY  used  for  long-distance,  high-frequency  transmission  and  reception. 
It  is  one  of  the  most  popular  fixed-station  antennas  because  it  is  very  useful  in  point-to-point 
communications. 

Advantages 

The  rhombic  antenna  is  useful  over  a  wide  frequency  range.  Although  some  changes  in  gain, 
directivity,  and  characteristic  impedance  do  occur  with  a  change  in  operating  frequency,  these  changes  are 
small  enough  to  be  neglected. 

The  rhombic  antenna  is  much  easier  to  construct  and  maintain  than  other  antennas  of  comparable 
gain  and  directivity.  Only  four  supporting  poles  of  common  heights  from  15  to  20  meters  are  needed  for 
the  antenna. 

The  rhombic  antenna  also  has  the  advantage  of  being  noncritical  as  far  as  operation  and  adjustment 
are  concerned.  This  is  because  of  the  broad  frequency  characteristics  of  the  antenna. 

Still  another  advantage  is  that  the  voltages  present  on  the  antenna  are  much  lower  than  those 
produced  by  the  same  input  power  on  a  resonant  antenna.  This  is  particularly  important  when  high 
transmitter  powers  are  used  or  when  high-altitude  operation  is  required. 


4-43 


Disadvantages 

The  rhombic  antenna  is  not  without  its  disadvantages.  The  principal  one  is  that  a  fairly  large  antenna 
site  is  required  for  its  erection.  Each  leg  is  made  at  least  1  or  2  wavelengths  long  at  the  lowest  operating 
frequency.  When  increased  gain  and  directivity  are  required,  legs  of  from  8  to  12  wavelengths  are  used. 
These  requirements  mean  that  high-frequency  rhombic  antennas  have  wires  of  several  hundred  feet  in 
length.  Therefore,  they  are  used  only  when  a  large  plot  of  land  is  available. 

Another  disadvantage  is  that  the  horizontal  and  vertical  patterns  depend  on  each  other.  If  a  rhombic 
antenna  is  made  to  have  a  narrow  horizontal  beam,  the  beam  is  also  lower  in  the  vertical  direction. 
Therefore,  obtaining  high  vertical-angle  radiation  is  impossible  except  with  a  very  broad  horizontal 
pattern  and  low  gain.  Rhombic  antennas  are  used,  however,  for  long-distance  sky  wave  coverage  at  the 
high  frequencies.  Under  these  conditions  low  vertical  angles  of  radiation  (less  than  20  degrees)  are 
desirable.  With  the  rhombic  antenna,  a  considerable  amount  of  the  input  power  is  dissipated  uselessly  in 
the  terminating  resistor.  However,  this  resistor  is  necessary  to  make  the  antenna  unidirectional.  The  great 
gain  of  the  antenna  more  than  makes  up  for  this  loss. 

Radiation  Patterns 

Figure  4-38  shows  the  individual  radiation  patterns  produced  by  the  four  legs  of  the  rhombic  antenna 
and  the  resultant  radiation  pattern.  The  principle  of  operation  is  the  same  as  for  the  V  and  the 
half-rhombic  antennas. 


A.  INDIVIDUAL  RADIATION  PATTERNS         B.  RESULTANT  RADIATION  PATTERNS 


Figure  4-38. — Formation  of  a  rhombic  antenna  beam. 

Terminating  Resistor 

The  terminating  resistor  plays  an  important  part  in  the  operation  of  the  rhombic  antenna.  Upon  it 
depend  the  unidirectivity  of  the  antenna  and  the  lack  of  resonance  effects.  An  antenna  should  be  properly 
terminated  so  it  will  have  a  constant  impedance  at  its  input.  Terminating  the  antenna  properly  will  also 
allow  it  to  be  operated  over  a  wide  frequency  range  without  the  necessity  for  changing  the  coupling 
adjustments  at  the  transmitter.  Discrimination  against  signals  coming  from  the  rear  is  of  great  importance 


4-44 


for  reception.  The  reduction  of  back  radiation  is  perhaps  of  lesser  importance  for  transmission.  When  an 
antenna  is  terminated  with  resistance,  the  energy  that  would  be  radiated  backward  is  absorbed  in  the 
resistor. 

Q47.   What  is  the  main  disadvantage  of  the  rhombic  antenna? 

TURNSTILE  ANTENNA 

The  TURNSTILE  ANTENNA  is  one  of  the  many  types  that  has  been  developed  primarily  for 
omnidirectional  vhf  communications.  The  basic  turnstile  consists  of  two  horizontal  half-wave  antennas 
mounted  at  right  angles  to  each  other  in  the  same  horizontal  plane.  When  these  two  antennas  are  excited 
with  equal  currents  90  degrees  out  of  phase,  the  typical  figure -eight  patterns  of  the  two  antennas  merge  to 
produce  the  nearly  circular  pattern  shown  in  figure  4-39,  view  A.  Pairs  of  such  antennas  are  frequently 
stacked,  as  shown  in  figure  4-40.  Each  pair  is  called  a  BAY.  In  figure  4-40  two  bays  are  used  and  are 
spaced  1/2  wavelength  apart,  and  the  corresponding  elements  are  excited  in  phase.  These  conditions  cause 
a  part  of  the  vertical  radiation  from  each  bay  to  cancel  that  of  the  other  bay.  This  results  in  a  decrease  in 
energy  radiated  at  high  vertical  angles  and  increases  the  energy  radiated  in  the  horizontal  plane.  Stacking 
a  number  of  bays  can  alter  the  vertical  radiation  pattern,  causing  a  substantial  gain  in  a  horizontal 
direction  without  altering  the  overall  horizontal  directivity  pattern.  Figure  4-39,  view  B,  compares  the 
circular  vertical  radiation  pattern  of  a  single-bay  turnstile  with  the  sharp  pattern  of  a  four-bay  turnstile 
array.  A  three-dimensional  radiation  pattern  of  a  four-bay  turnstile  antenna  is  shown  in  figure  4-39,  view 
C. 


PATTERN  OF  A-A' 


ABC 

Figure  4-39. — Turnstile  antenna  radiation  pattern. 


4-45 


SIMPLE  OR  FOLDED  DIPOLES 


PHASING  SECTION 


LINES  TO  TRANSMITTER 
OR  LOWER  BAY 


Figure  4-40. — Stacked  turnstile  antennas. 

GROUND-PLANE  ANTENNA 

A  vertical  quarter-wave  antenna  several  wavelengths  above  ground  produces  a  high  angle  of 
radiation  that  is  very  undesirable  at  vhf  and  uhf  frequencies.  The  most  common  means  of  producing  a  low 
angle  of  radiation  from  such  an  antenna  is  to  work  the  radiator  against  a  simulated  ground  called  a 
GROUND  PLANE.  A  simulated  ground  may  be  made  from  a  large  metal  sheet  or  several  wires  or  rods 
radiating  from  the  base  of  the  radiator.  An  antenna  so  constructed  is  known  as  a  GROUND-PLANE 
ANTENNA.  Two  ground-plane  antennas  are  shown  in  figure  4-41,  views  A  and  B. 


A  B 

Figure  4-41. — Ground-plane  antennas. 

CORNER  REFLECTOR 

When  a  unidirectional  radiation  pattern  is  desired,  it  can  be  obtained  by  the  use  of  a  corner  reflector 
with  a  half-wave  dipole.  A  CORNER-REFLECTOR  ANTENNA  is  a  half-wave  radiator  with  a  reflector. 
The  reflector  consists  of  two  flat  metal  surfaces  meeting  at  an  angle  immediately  behind  the  radiator.  In 
other  words,  the  radiator  is  set  in  the  plane  of  a  line  bisecting  the  corner  angle  formed  by  the  reflector 


4-46 


sheets.  The  construction  of  a  corner  reflector  is  shown  in  figure  4-42.  Corner-reflector  antennas  are 
mounted  with  the  radiator  and  the  reflector  in  the  horizontal  position  when  horizontal  polarization  is 
desired.  In  such  cases  the  radiation  pattern  is  very  narrow  in  the  vertical  plane,  with  maximum  signal 
being  radiated  in  line  with  the  bisector  of  the  corner  angle.  The  directivity  in  the  horizontal  plane  is 
approximately  the  same  as  for  any  half-wave  radiator  having  a  single -rod  type  reflector  behind  it.  If  the 
antenna  is  mounted  with  the  radiator  and  the  corner  reflector  in  the  vertical  position,  as  shown  in  view  A, 
maximum  radiation  is  produced  in  a  very  narrow  horizontal  beam.  Radiation  in  a  vertical  plane  will  be  the 
same  as  for  a  similar  radiator  with  a  single-rod  type  reflector  behind  it. 


Figure  4-42. — Corner-reflector  antennas. 

Q48.    What  is  the  primary  reason  for  the  development  of  the  turnstile  antenna? 

RF  SAFETY  PRECAUTIONS 

Although  electromagnetic  radiation  from  transmission  lines  and  antennas  is  usually  of  insufficient 
strength  to  electrocute  personnel,  it  can  lead  to  other  accidents  and  compound  injuries.  Voltages  may  be 
induced  in  ungrounded  metal  objects,  such  as  wire  guys,  wire  cable  (hawser),  hand  rails,  or  ladders.  If  you 
come  in  contact  with  these  objects,  you  could  receive  a  shock  or  rf  burn.  This  shock  can  cause  you  to 
jump  or  fall  into  nearby  mechanical  equipment  or,  when  working  aloft,  to  fall  from  an  elevated  work  area. 
Take  care  to  ensure  that  all  transmission  lines  or  antennas  are  deenergized  before  working  near  or  on 
them. 

Either  check  or  have  someone  check  all  guys,  cables,  rails,  and  ladders  around  your  work  area  for  rf 
shock  dangers.  Use  working  aloft  "chits"  and  safety  harnesses  for  your  own  safety.  Signing  a  "working 
aloft  chit"  signifies  that  all  equipment  is  in  a  nonradiating  status.  The  person  who  signs  the  chit  should 
ensure  that  no  rf  danger  exists  in  areas  where  you  or  other  personnel  will  be  working. 

Nearby  ships  or  parked  aircraft  are  another  source  of  rf  energy  that  you  must  consider  when  you 
check  a  work  area  for  safety.  Combustible  materials  can  be  ignited  and  cause  severe  fires  from  arcs  or 
heat  generated  by  rf  energy.  Also,  rf  radiation  can  detonate  ordnance  devices  by  inducing  currents  in  the 
internal  wiring  of  the  devices  or  in  the  external  test  equipment  or  leads  connected  to  them. 

ALWAYS  obey  rf  radiation  warning  signs  and  keep  a  safe  distance  from  radiating  antennas.  The  six 
types  of  warning  signs  for  rf  radiation  hazards  are  shown  in  figure  4-43. 


4-47 


1/8"  BORDER 


TO  BE  LOCATED  AT  FUEL  HANDLING  AREAS  WHICH  ARE  SUBJECTED 
TO  RF  RADIATION 


TOP  PORTION 


1  RADAR  SYMBOL  TO  BE  MATTE  ALUMINUM 

2  WARNING  RADIATION  HA7ARD  I  FTTFRS  TO  BE 
MATTE  ALUMINUM 

3  BACKGROUND  OFTHIS  PORTION  TO  BE  RED  523M  REV 


LOWER  PORTI 
REVERSE  SIDE 


INSTRUCTIONS  FOR  INSTALLATION 


TO  BE  LOCATED  ON  OR  ADJACENT  TO  RADAR  SET  CONTROL 


TOP  PORTION 


CENTER  PORTION 


1  TOP  PORTION  OF  1.375"  I  0  BE  RED  NO.  523M 
REV  BACKGROUND 

2  RADAR  SYMBOL  SHALL  BE  MATTE  ALUMINUM 

3  WARNING  RADIATION  HAZARD  LETTERSTO  BE 
MATTE  ALUMINUM 

1  CENTER  PORTION  OF  1.1 25"  TO  BE  BLACK  NO.  500M 
REV  BACKGROUND 

2  LETTERS  TO  BE  MATTE  ALUMINUM 


LOWER  PORTION 
REVERSE  SIDE  — 


NSTRUCTIONS  FOR  INSTALLATION 


Figure  4-43. — Examples  of  rf  radiation  warning  signs. 


4-48 


RF  BURNS 


Close  or  direct  contact  with  rf  transmission  lines  or  antennas  may  result  in  rf  burns.  These  are 
usually  deep,  penetrating,  third-degree  burns.  To  heal  properly,  these  burns  must  heal  from  the  inside  to 
the  skin's  surface.  To  prevent  infection,  you  must  give  proper  attention  to  all  rf  burns,  including  the  small 
"pinhole"  burns.  Petrolatum  gauze  can  be  used  to  cover  these  burns  temporarily,  before  the  injured  person 
reports  to  medical  facilities  for  further  treatment. 

DIELECTRIC  HEATING 

DIELECTRIC  HEATING  is  the  heating  of  an  insulating  material  by  placing  it  in  a  high-frequency 
electric  field.  The  heat  results  from  internal  losses  during  the  rapid  reversal  of  polarization  of  molecules 
in  the  dielectric  material. 

In  the  case  of  a  human  in  an  rf  field,  the  body  acts  as  a  dielectric.  If  the  power  in  the  rf  field  exceeds 
10  milliwatts  per  centimeter,  a  person  in  that  field  will  have  a  noticeable  rise  in  body  temperature.  The 
eyes  are  highly  susceptible  to  dielectric  heating.  For  this  reason,  you  should  not  look  directly  into  devices 
radiating  rf  energy.  The  vital  organs  of  the  body  also  are  susceptible  to  dielectric  heating.  For  your  own 
safety,  you  must  NOT  stand  directly  in  the  path  of  rf  radiating  devices. 

PRECAUTIONS  WHEN  WORKING  ALOFT 

When  radio  or  radar  antennas  are  energized  by  transmitters,  you  must  not  go  aloft  unless  advance 
tests  show  that  little  or  no  danger  exists.  A  casualty  can  occur  from  even  a  small  spark  drawn  from  a 
charged  piece  of  metal  or  rigging.  Although  the  spark  itself  may  be  harmless,  the  "surprise"  may  cause 
you  to  let  go  of  the  antenna  involuntarily  and  you  may  fall.  There  is  also  a  shock  hazard  if  nearby 
antennas  are  energized. 

Rotating  antennas  also  might  cause  you  to  fall  when  you  are  working  aloft.  Motor  safety  switches 
controlling  the  motion  of  rotating  antennas  must  be  tagged  and  locked  open  before  you  go  aloft  near  such 
antennas. 

When  working  near  a  stack,  you  should  draw  and  wear  the  recommended  oxygen  breathing 
apparatus.  Among  other  toxic  substances,  stack  gas  contains  carbon  monoxide.  Carbon  monoxide  is  too 
unstable  to  build  up  to  a  high  concentration  in  the  open,  but  prolonged  exposure  to  even  small  quantities 
is  dangerous. 


SUMMARY 

This  chapter  has  presented  information  on  the  various  types  of  antennas.  The  information  that 
follows  summarizes  the  important  points  of  this  chapter. 

An  ANTENNA  is  a  conductor,  or  system  of  conductors,  that  radiates  or  receives  energy  in  the  form 
of  electromagnetic  waves. 

HERTZ  (half-wave)  and  MARCONI  (quarter-wave)  are  the  two  basic  classifications  of  antennas. 

RECIPROCITY  of  antennas  means  that  the  various  properties  of  the  antenna  apply  equally  to 
transmitting  and  receiving. 


4-49 


MINIMUM  RADIATION 


RADIATION  RESISTANCE  is  the  amount  of  resistance  which,  if  inserted  in  place  of  the  antenna, 
would  consume  the  same  amount  of  power  that  is  actually  radiated  by  the  antenna. 

RADIATION  PATTERNS  can  be  plotted  on  a  rectangular-  or  polar-coordinate  graph.  These 
patterns  are  a  measurement  of  the  energy  leaving  an  antenna. 


An  ISOTROPIC  RADIATOR  radiates  energy  equally  in  all  directions. 


4-50 


A 


An  ANISOTROPIC  RADIATOR  radiates  energy  directionally. 


MAXIMUM  RADIATION 

r- 



\ 

 I  I  I  Jfil_l  I  I  I  I  I  I  jsl  I  I  I  

0     1    :    3    A    5    i    7    t     1  14  11    11  13  14  15  1* 
POSITION  ON  CIRCLE  ft- 


A 


12 


B 


A  LOBE  is  the  area  of  a  radiation  pattern  that  is  covered  by  radiation. 
A  NULL  is  the  area  of  a  radiation  pattern  that  has  minimum  radiation. 


4-51 


ANTENNA  LOADING  is  the  method  used  to  change  the  electrical  length  of  an  antenna.  This  keeps 
the  antenna  in  resonance  with  the  applied  frequency.  It  is  accomplished  by  inserting  a  variable  inductor  or 
capacitor  in  series  with  the  antenna. 


jVVVVVVV\. 


LOADING  TO  COMPENSATE  FOR  TOO  SHORT  AN  ANTENNA 

A 


LOADING  TO  COMPENSATE  FOR  TOO  LONG  AN  ANTENNA 

B 


NORMAL  ANTENNA  WITHOUT  LOADING 

c 


A  HALF-WAVE  ANTENNA  (Hertz)  consists  of  two  lengths  of  rod  or  tubing,  each  a  quarter-wave 
long  at  a  certain  frequency,  which  radiates  a  doughnut  pattern. 


4-52 


ANTENNA 
(INSIDEJ 


A  QUARTER-WAVE  ANTENNA  (Marconi)  is  a  half-wave  antenna  cut  in  half  with  one  end 
grounded.  The  ground  furnishes  the  missing  half  of  the  antenna. 


-  QUARTER-WAVE 
ANTENNA 


IMAGE  ANTENNA- 


The  GROUND  SCREEN  and  the  COUNTERPOISE  are  used  to  reduce  losses  caused  by  the 
ground  in  the  immediate  vicinity  of  the  antenna.  The  ground  screen  is  buried  below  the  surface  of  the 
earth.  The  counterpoise  is  installed  above  the  ground. 


4-53 


The  FOLDED  DIPOLE  consists  of  a  dipole  radiator,  which  is  connected  in  parallel  at  its  ends  to  a 
half-wave  radiator. 


=11 

II       ORDINARY  DIPOLE 


FOLDED  DIPOLE 


AN  ARRAY  is  a  combination  of  half-wave  elements  operating  together  as  a  single  antenna.  It 
provides  more  gain  and  greater  directivity  than  single  element  antennas. 

A  DRIVEN  ARRAY  derives  its  power  directly  from  the  source. 

A  PARASITIC  ARRAY  derives  its  power  by  coupling  the  energy  from  other  elements  of  the 
antenna. 


4-54 


The  BIDIRECTIONAL  ARRAY  radiates  energy  equally  in  two  opposing  directions. 

The  UNIDIRECTIONAL  ARRAY  radiates  energy  efficiently  in  a  single  direction. 

The  COLLINEAR  ARRAY  has  elements  in  a  straight  line.  Maximum  radiation  occurs  at  right 
angles  to  this  line. 

The  BROADSIDE  ARRAY  has  elements  parallel  and  in  the  same  plane.  Maximum  radiation 
develops  in  the  plane  at  right  angles  to  the  plane  of  the  elements. 


The  END-FIRE  ARRAY  has  elements  parallel  to  each  other  and  in  the  same  plane.  Maximum 
radiation  occurs  along  the  axis  of  the  array. 


A.  TOP  VIEW  OF  ARRAY 


-O  O  O-  O- 

B.  SIDE  VIEW  OF  ARRAY 


MATCHING  STUBS  are  used  between  elements  to  maintain  current  in  the  proper  phase. 

The  GAIN  OF  A  COLLINEAR  ANTENNA  is  greatest  when  the  elements  are  spaced  from  0.4  to 
0.5  wavelength  apart  or  when  the  number  of  elements  is  increased. 

The  OPTIMUM  GAIN  OF  A  BROADSIDE  ARRAY  is  obtained  when  the  elements  are  spaced 
0.65  wavelength  apart. 


4-55 


A  PARASITIC  ARRAY  consists  of  one  or  more  parasitic  elements  with  a  driven  element.  The 
amount  of  power  gain  and  directivity  depends  on  the  lengths  of  the  parasitic  elements  and  the  spacing 
between  them. 


MULTIELEMENT  ARRAYS,  such  as  the  YAGI,  have  a  narrow  frequency  response  as  well  as  a 
narrow  beamwidth. 


A  LONG-WIRE  ANTENNA  is  an  antenna  that  is  a  wavelength  or  more  long  at  the  operating 
frequency.  These  antennas  have  directive  patterns  that  are  sharp  in  both  the  horizontal  and  vertical  planes. 


4-56 


A  V  ANTENNA  is  a  bi-directional  antenna  consisting  of  two  horizontal,  long  wires  arranged  to 
form  a  V. 


The  RHOMBIC  ANTENNA  uses  four  conductors  joined  to  form  a  rhombus  shape.  This  antenna 
has  a  wide  frequency  range,  is  easy  to  construct  and  maintain,  and  is  noncritical  as  far  as  operation  and 
adjustment  are  concerned. 


4-57 


The  TURNSTILE  ANTENNA  consists  of  two  horizontal,  half-wire  antennas  mounted  at  right 
angles  to  each  other. 


ANSWERS  TO  QUESTIONS  Ql.  THROUGH  Q48. 

Al.  Half-wave  (Hertz)  and  quarter-wave  (Marconi). 
A2.  Coupling  device,  feeder,  and  antenna. 

A3.  Frequency  of  operation  of  the  transmitter,  amount  of power  to  be  radiated,  and  general  direction 
of  the  receiving  set. 


4-58 


A4.  One-half  the  wavelength. 

A5.  Current  and  voltage  loops. 

A6.  Current  and  voltage  nodes. 

A  7.  Reciprocity  of  antennas. 

A8.  Electric  (E)  field. 

A9.  Circular  polarization. 

A 10.  Vertical  polarization. 

All.  Less  interference  is  experienced  by  man-made  noise  sources. 

A12.  Vertical  polarization. 

A13.  73  ohms. 

A 14.  Anisotropic  radiator. 

A15.  Isotropic  radiator. 

A 16.  Anisotropic  radiator. 

A17.  Dipole,  doublet  and  Hertz. 

A18.  Nondirectional. 

A 19.  Vertical  plane. 

A20.  The  pattern  would  flatten. 

A21.  To  connect  one  end  through  a  capacitor  to  the  final  output  stage  of  the  transmitter. 

A22.  A  circular  radiation  pattern  in  the  horizontal  plane,  or  same  as  a  half  wave. 

A23.  It  is  composed  of  a  series  of  conductors  arranged  in  a  radial  pattern  and  buried  1  to  2  feet  below 
the  ground. 

A24.  Nine  times  the  feed-point  impedance. 

A25.  Folded  dipole. 

A26.  To  produce  desired  phase  relationship  between  connected  elements. 

A27.  Major  lobes  have  the  greatest  amount  of  radiation. 

A28.  Four. 

A29.  As  more  elements  are  added,  an  unbalanced  condition  in  the  system  occurs  which  impairs 
efficiency. 

A30.  By  increasing  the  lengths  of  the  elements  of  the  array. 


4-59 


A3 1.  Directivity  increases. 

A3  2.  Lower  radiation  resistance. 

A33.  Parallel  and  in  the  same  plane. 

A34.  They  sharpen. 

A35.  Extremely  low  radiation  resistance,  confined  to  one  frequency,  and  affected  by  atmospheric 
conditions. 

A36.  Along  the  major  axis 

A3  7.  Symmetrically. 

A38.  Length  of  the  parasitic  element  (tuning)  and  spacing  between  the  parasitic  and  driven  elements. 

A39.  Increased  gain  and  directivity. 

A40.  Rotary  array. 

A41.  Their  adjustment  is  critical  and  they  do  not  operate  over  a  wide  frequency  range. 

A42.  Increased  gain. 

A43.  Multielement  parasitic  array. 

A44.  One-half  wavelength. 

A45.  Wave  antenna. 

A46.  Opposite. 

A47.  It  requires  a  large  antenna  site. 

A48.  For  omnidirectional  vhf  communications. 


4-60 


APPENDIX  I 

GLOSSARY 


ABSORPTION — (1)  Absorbing  light  waves.  Does  not  allow  any  reflection  or  refraction. 

(2)  Atmospheric  absorption  of  rf  energy  with  no  reflection  or  refraction  (adversely  affects  long 
distance  communications). 

ACOUSTICS— The  science  of  sound. 

AMPLITUDE — The  portion  of  a  cycle  measured  from  a  reference  line  to  a  maximum  value  above  (or  to 
a  maximum  value  below)  the  line. 

ANGLE  OF  INCIDENCE— The  angle  between  the  incident  wave  and  the  normal. 

ANGLE  OF  REFLECTION— The  angle  between  the  reflected  wave  and  the  normal. 

ANGLE  OF  REFRACTION — The  angle  between  the  normal  and  the  path  of  a  wave  through  the  second 
medium. 

ANGSTROM  UNIT— The  unit  used  to  define  the  wavelength  of  light  waves. 

ANISOTROPIC — The  property  of  a  radiator  to  emit  strong  radiation  in  one  direction. 

ANTENNA — A  conductor  or  set  of  conductors  used  either  to  radiate  rf  energy  into  space  or  to  collect  rf 
energy  from  space. 

ARRAY  OF  ARRAYS— Same  as  COMBINATION  ARRAY. 

BAY — Part  of  an  antenna  array. 

BEVERAGE  ANTENNA — A  horizontal,  longwire  antenna  designed  for  reception  and  transmission  of 
low-frequency,  vertically  polarized  ground  waves. 

BIDIRECTIONAL  ARRAY — An  array  that  radiates  in  opposite  directions  along  the  line  of  maximum 
radiation. 

BROADSIDE  ARRAY — An  array  in  which  the  direction  of  maximum  radiation  is  perpendicular  to  the 
plane  containing  the  elements. 

CENTER-FEED  METHOD — Connecting  the  center  of  an  antenna  to  a  transmission  line,  which  is  then 
connected  to  the  final  (output)  stage  of  the  transmitter. 

CHARACTERISTIC  IMPEDANCE— The  ratio  of  voltage  to  current  at  any  given  point  on  a 
transmission  line.  Represented  by  a  value  of  impedance. 

COAXIAL  LINE — A  type  of  transmission  line  that  contains  two  concentric  conductors. 

COLLINEAR  ARRAY — An  array  with  all  the  elements  in  a  straight  line.  Maximum  radiation  is 
perpendicular  to  the  axis  of  the  elements. 

COMBINATION  ARRAY — An  array  system  that  uses  the  characteristics  of  more  than  one  array. 


AI-1 


COMPLEMENTARY  (SECONDARY)  COLORS  OF  LIGHT— The  colors  of  light  produced  when 
two  of  the  primaries  are  mixed  in  overlapping  beams  of  light.  The  complementary  colors  of  light  are 
magenta,  yellow,  and  cyan. 

COMPLEX  WAVE — A  wave  produced  by  combining  two  or  more  pure  tones  at  the  same  time. 

COMPRESSION  WAVES — Longitudinal  waves  that  have  been  compressed  (made  more  dense)  as  they 
move  away  from  the  source. 

CONDUCTANCE — The  opposite  of  resistance  in  transmission  lines.  The  minute  amount  of  resistance 
that  is  present  in  the  insulator  of  a  transmission  line. 

CONNECTED  ARRAY— Another  term  for  DRIVEN  ARRAY. 

COPPER  LOSSES — The  I2R  loss  in  a  conductor  caused  by  the  current  flow  through  the  resistance  of  the 
conductor. 

CORNER-REFLECTOR  ANTENNA— A  half-wave  antenna  with  a  reflector  consisting  of  two  flat 
metal  surfaces  meeting  at  an  angle  behind  the  radiator. 

COUNTERPOISE — A  network  of  wire  that  is  connected  to  a  quarter-wave  antenna  at  one  end  and 
provides  the  equivalent  of  an  additional  1/4  wavelength. 

COUPLING  DEVICE — A  coupling  coil  that  connects  the  transmitter  to  the  feeder. 

CREST  (TOP) — The  peak  of  the  positive  alternation  (maximum  value  above  the  line)  of  a  wave. 

CRITICAL  ANGLE — The  maximum  angle  at  which  radio  waves  can  be  transmitted  and  still  be 
refracted  back  to  earth. 

CRITICAL  FREQUENCY — The  maximum  frequency  at  which  a  radio  wave  can  be  transmitted 
vertically  and  still  be  refracted  back  to  earth. 

CURRENT-FEED  METHOD— Same  as  CENTER-FEED  METHOD. 

CURRENT  STANDING- WAVE  RATIO  (ISWR)— The  ratio  of  maximum  to  minimum  current  along  a 
transmission  line. 

CYCLE — One  complete  alternation  of  a  sine  wave  that  has  a  maximum  value  above  and  a  maximum 
value  below  the  reference  line. 

DAMPING — Reduction  of  energy  by  absorption. 

DENSITY — (1)  The  compactness  of  a  substance.  (2)  Mass  per  unit  volume. 
DETECTOR — The  device  that  responds  to  a  wave  or  disturbance. 

DIELECTRIC  HEATING — The  heating  of  an  insulating  material  by  placing  it  in  a  high  frequency 
electric  field. 

DIELECTRIC  LOSSES — The  losses  resulting  from  the  heating  effect  on  the  dielectric  material  between 
conductors. 

DIFFRACTION — The  bending  of  the  paths  of  waves  when  the  waves  meet  some  form  of  obstruction. 


AI-2 


DIFFUSION — The  scattering  of  reflected  light  waves  (beams)  from  an  object,  such  as  white  paper. 

DIPOLE — A  common  type  of  half-wave  antenna  made  from  a  straight  piece  of  wire  cut  in  half.  Each 
half  operates  at  a  quarter  wavelength  of  the  output. 

DIRECTIONAL— Radiation  that  varies  with  direction. 

DIRECTOR — The  parasitic  element  of  an  array  that  reinforces  energy  coming  from  the  driver  toward 
itself. 

DIRECTIVITY — The  property  of  an  array  that  causes  more  radiation  to  take  place  in  certain  directions 
than  in  others. 

DISPERSION — The  refraction  of  light  waves  that  causes  the  different  frequencies  to  bend  at  slightly 
different  angles. 

DISTRIBUTED  CONSTANTS— The  constants  of  inductance,  capacitance,  and  resistance  in  a 
transmission  line.  The  constants  are  spread  along  the  entire  length  of  the  line  and  cannot  be 
distinguished  separately. 

DOPPLER  EFFECT — The  apparent  change  in  frequency  or  pitch  when  a  sound  source  moves  either 
toward  or  away  from  a  listener. 

DOUBLET — Another  name  for  the  dipole  antenna. 

DRIVEN  ARRAY — An  array  in  which  all  of  the  elements  are  driven. 

DRIVEN  ELEMENT — An  element  of  an  antenna  (transmitting  or  receiving)  that  is  connected  directly 
to  the  transmission  line. 

ECHO — The  reflection  of  the  original  sound  wave  as  it  bounces  off  a  distant  surface. 

ELASTICITY — The  ability  of  a  substance  to  return  to  its  original  state. 

ELECTROMAGNETIC  FIELD— The  combination  of  an  electric  (E)  field  and  a  magnetic  (H)  field. 

ELECTROMAGNETIC  INTERFERENCE— Man-made  or  natural  interference  that  degrades  the 
quality  of  reception  of  radio  waves. 

ELECTROMAGNETIC  RADIATION— The  radiation  of  radio  waves  into  space. 

ELECTRIC  (E)  FIELD — The  field  produced  as  a  result  of  a  voltage  charge  on  a  conductor  or  antenna. 

ELEMENT — A  part  of  an  antenna  that  can  be  either  an  active  radiator  or  a  parasitic  radiator. 

END-FEED  METHOD — Connecting  one  end  of  an  antenna  through  a  capacitor  to  the  final  output  stage 
of  a  transmitter. 

END-FIRE  ARRAY — An  array  in  which  the  direction  of  radiation  is  parallel  to  the  axis  of  the  array. 
FADING — Variations  in  signal  strength  by  atmospheric  conditions. 
FEEDER — A  transmission  line  that  carries  energy  to  the  antenna. 


AI-3 


FLAT  LINE — A  transmission  line  that  has  no  standing  waves.  This  line  requires  no  special  tuning 
device  to  transfer  maximum  power. 

FLEXIBLE  COAXIAL  LINE — A  coaxial  line  made  with  a  flexible  inner  conductor  insulated  from  the 
outer  conductor  by  a  solid,  continuous  insulating  material. 

FOLDED  DIPOLE — An  ordinary  half-wave  antenna  (dipole)  that  has  one  or  more  additional  conductors 
connected  across  the  ends  parallel  to  each  other. 

FOUR-ELEMENT  ARRAY — An  array  with  three  parasitic  elements  and  one  driven  element. 

FREE-SPACE  LOSS — The  loss  of  energy  of  a  radio  wave  because  of  the  spreading  of  the  wavefront  as 
it  travels  from  the  transmitter. 

FREQUENCY — The  number  of  cycles  that  occur  in  one  second.  Usually  expressed  in  hertz. 

FREQUENCY  DIVERSITY — Transmitting  (and  receiving)  of  radio  waves  on  two  different  frequencies 
simultaneously. 

FRONT-TO-BACK  RATIO — The  ratio  of  the  energy  radiated  in  the  principal  direction  to  the  energy 
radiated  in  the  opposite  direction. 

FUNDAMENTAL  FREQUENCY— The  basic  frequency  or  first  harmonic  frequency. 

GAIN — The  ratio  between  the  amount  of  energy  propagated  from  an  antenna  that  is  directional  to  the 
energy  from  the  same  antenna  that  would  be  propagated  if  the  antenna  were  not  directional. 

GENERATOR  END— See  INPUT  END. 

GROUND  PLANE — The  portion  of  a  groundplane  antenna  that  acts  as  ground. 

GROUND-PLANE  ANTENNA — A  type  of  antenna  that  uses  a  ground  plane  as  a  simulated  ground  to 
produce  low-angle  radiation. 

GROUND  REFLECTION  LOSS— The  loss  of  rf  energy  each  time  a  radio  wave  is  reflected  from  the 
Earth's  surface. 

GROUND  SCREEN — A  series  of  conductors  buried  below  the  surface  of  the  earth  and  arranged  in  a 
radial  pattern.  Used  to  reduce  losses  in  the  ground. 

GROUND  WAVES — Radio  waves  that  travel  near  the  surface  of  the  Earth. 

HALF- WAVE  DIPOLE  ANTENNA— An  antenna  consisting  of  two  rods  (1/4  wavelength  each)  in  a 
straight  line,  that  radiates  electromagnetic  energy. 

HARMONIC — A  frequency  that  is  a  whole  number  multiple  of  a  smaller  base  frequency. 

HERTZ  ANTENNA — A  half -wave  antenna  installed  some  distance  above  ground  and  positioned  either 
vertically  or  horizontally. 

HORIZONTAL  AXIS— On  a  graph,  the  straight  line  axis  plotted  from  left  to  right. 

HORIZONTAL  PATTERN — The  part  of  a  radiation  pattern  that  is  radiated  in  all  directions  along  the 
horizontal  plane. 


AI-4 


HORIZONTALLY  POLARIZED— Waves  that  are  radiated  with  their  E  field  component  parallel  to  the 
Earth's  surface. 

INCIDENT  WAVE — (1)  The  wave  that  strikes  the  surface  of  a  medium.  (2)  The  wave  that  travels  from 
the  sending  end  to  the  receiving  end  of  a  transmission  line. 

INDUCTION  FIELD — The  electromagnetic  field  produced  about  an  antenna  when  current  and  voltage 
are  present  on  the  same  antenna. 

INDUCTION  LOSSES — The  losses  that  occur  when  the  electromagnetic  field  around  a  conductor  cuts 
through  a  nearby  metallic  object  and  induces  a  current  into  that  object. 

INFRASONIC  (SUBSONIC)— Sounds  below  15  hertz. 

INPUT  END — The  end  of  a  two-wire  transmission  line  that  is  connected  to  a  source. 

INPUT  IMPEDANCE — The  impedance  presented  to  the  transmitter  by  the  transmission  line  and  its 
load. 

INTENSITY  (OF  SOUND)— The  measurement  of  the  amplitude  of  sound  energy.  Sometimes 
mistakenly  called  loudness. 

INTERCEPT — The  point  where  two  lines  drawn  on  a  graph  cross  each  other. 

INTERFERENCE — Any  disturbance  that  produces  an  undesirable  response  or  degrades  a  wave. 

IONOSPHERE — The  most  important  region  of  the  atmosphere  extending  from  3 1  miles  to  250  miles 
above  the  earth.  Contains  four  cloud-like  layers  that  affect  radio  waves. 

IONOSPHERIC  STORMS — Disturbances  in  the  earth's  magnetic  field  that  make  communications 
practical  only  at  lower  frequencies. 

IONIZATION — The  process  of  upsetting  electrical  neutrality. 

ISOTROPIC  RADIATION— The  radiation  of  energy  equally  in  all  directions. 

LEAKAGE  CURRENT — The  small  amount  of  current  that  flows  between  the  conductors  of  a 
transmission  line  through  the  dielectric. 

LIGHT  RAYS — Straight  lines  that  represent  light  waves  emitting  from  a  source. 

LOAD  END— See  OUTPUT  END. 

LOADING— See  LUMPED-IMPEDANCE  TUNING. 

LOBE — An  area  of  a  radiation  pattern  plotted  on  a  polar-coordinate  graph  that  represents  maximum 
radiation. 

LONG-WIRE  ANTENNA — An  antenna  that  is  a  wavelength  or  more  long  at  its  operating  frequency. 

LONGITUDINAL  WAVES — Waves  in  which  the  disturbance  (back  and  forth  motion)  takes  place  in 
the  direction  of  propagation.  Sometimes  called  compression  waves. 

LOOP — The  curves  of  a  standing  wave  or  antenna  that  represent  amplitude  of  current  or  voltage. 


AI-5 


LOWEST  USABLE  FREQUENCY— The  minimum  operating  frequency  that  can  be  used  for 
communications  between  two  points. 

LUMPED  CONSTANTS — The  properties  of  inductance,  capacitance,  and  resistance  in  a  transmission 
line. 

LUMPED-IMPEDANCE  TUNING — The  insertion  of  an  inductor  or  capacitor  in  series  with  an  antenna 
to  lengthen  or  shorten  the  antenna  electrically. 

MAGNETIC  (H)  FIELD — The  field  produced  when  current  flows  through  a  conductor  or  antenna. 

MAJOR  LOBE — The  lobe  in  which  the  greatest  amount  of  radiation  occurs. 

MARCONI  ANTENNA — A  quarter-wave  antenna  oriented  perpendicular  to  the  earth  and  operated  with 
one  end  grounded. 

MAXIMUM  USABLE  FREQUENCY —  Maximum  frequency  that  can  be  used  for  communications 
between  two  locations  for  a  given  time  of  day  and  a  given  angle  of  incidence. 

MEDIUM — The  substance  through  which  a  wave  travels  from  one  point  to  the  next.  Air,  water,  wood, 
etc.,  are  examples  of  a  medium. 

MINOR  LOBE — The  lobe  in  which  the  radiation  intensity  is  less  than  a  major  lobe. 

MULTIELEMENT  ARRAY — An  array  consisting  of  one  or  more  arrays  and  classified  as  to  directivity. 

MULTIELEMENT  PARASITIC  ARRAY—  An  array  that  contains  two  or  more  parasitic  elements  and 
a  driven  element. 

MULTIPATH — The  multiple  paths  a  radio  wave  may  follow  between  transmitter  and  receiver. 
NATURAL  HORIZON— The  line-of-sight  horizon. 

NEGATIVE  ALTERNATION— The  portion  of  a  sine  wave  below  the  reference  line. 

NODE — The  fixed  minimum  points  of  voltage  or  current  on  a  standing  wave  or  antenna. 

NOISE  (OF  SOUND) — An  unwanted  disturbance  caused  by  spurious  waves  that  originate  from  man- 
made  or  natural  sources. 

NONDIRECTIONAL— See  OMNIDIRECTIONAL. 

NONLUMINOUS  BODIES— Objects  that  either  reflect  or  diffuse  light  that  falls  upon  them. 

NONRESONANT  LINE — A  transmission  line  that  has  no  standing  waves  of  current  or  voltage. 

NORMAL — The  imaginary  line  perpendicular  to  the  point  at  which  the  incident  wave  strikes  the 
reflecting  surface.  Also  called  the  perpendicular. 

NULL — On  a  polar-coordinate  graph,  the  area  that  represents  minimum  or  0  radiation. 

OMNIDIRECTIONAL— Transmitting  in  all  directions. 

OPAQUE — A  type  of  substance  that  does  not  transmit  any  light  rays. 

OPEN-ENDED  LINE — A  transmission  line  that  has  an  infinitely  large  terminating  impedance. 

AI-6 


OPTIMUM  WORKING  FREQUENCY— The  most  practical  operating  frequency  that  can  be  used  with 
the  least  amount  of  problems;  roughly  85  percent  of  the  maximum  usable  frequency. 

ORIGIN — The  point  on  a  graph  where  the  vertical  and  horizontal  axes  cross  each  other. 

OUTPUT  END — The  end  of  a  transmission  line  that  is  opposite  the  source. 

OUTPUT  IMPEDANCE — The  impedance  presented  to  the  load  by  the  transmission  line  and  its  source. 
PARALLEL  RESONANT  CIRCUIT— A  circuit  that  acts  as  a  high  impedance  at  resonance. 
PARALLEL-WIRE — A  type  of  transmission  line  consisting  of  two  parallel  wires. 
PARASITIC  ARRAY — An  array  that  has  one  or  more  parasitic  elements. 

PARASITIC  ELEMENT — The  passive  element  of  an  antenna  array  that  is  connected  to  neither  the 
transmission  line  nor  the  driven  element. 

PERIOD — The  amount  of  time  required  for  completion  of  one  full  cycle. 

PITCH — A  term  used  to  describe  the  frequency  of  a  sound  heard  by  the  human  ear. 

PLANE  OF  POLARIZATION— The  plane  (vertical  or  horizontal)  with  respect  to  the  earth  in  which  the 
E  field  propagates. 

POINT  OF  ZERO  DISPLACEMENT— See  REFERENCE  LINE. 

POLAR-COORDINATE  GRAPH — A  graph  whose  axes  consist  of  a  series  of  circles  with  a  common 
center  and  a  rotating  radius  extending  from  the  center  of  the  concentric  circles. 

POSITIVE  ALTERNATION— The  portion  of  a  sine  wave  above  the  reference  line. 

POWER  LOSS — The  heat  loss  in  a  conductor  as  current  flows  through  it. 

POWER  STANDING- WAVE  RATIO  (PSWR)— The  ratio  of  the  square  of  the  maximum  and 
minimum  voltages  of  a  transmission  line. 

PRIMARY  COLORS  (OF  LIGHT)— The  three  primary  colors  of  light  (red,  green,  and  blue),  from 
which  all  other  colors  may  be  derived. 

PRISM — A  triangular-shaped  glass  that  refracts  and  disperses  light  waves  into  component  wavelengths. 

PROPAGATION — Waves  traveling  through  a  medium. 

QUALITY  (OF  SOUND)— The  factor  that  distinguishes  tones  of  pitch  and  loudness. 
QUARTER- WAVE  ANTENNA— Same  as  the  Marconi  antenna. 

RADIATION  FIELD — The  electromagnetic  field  that  detaches  itself  from  an  antenna  and  travels 
through  space. 

RADIATION  LOSSES — The  losses  that  occur  when  magnetic  lines  of  force  about  a  conductor  are 
projected  into  space  as  radiation  and  are  not  returned  to  the  conductor  as  the  cycle  alternates. 

RADIATION  PATTERN — A  plot  of  the  radiated  energy  from  an  antenna. 


AI-7 


RADIATION  RESISTANCE — The  resistance,  which  if  inserted  in  place  of  an  antenna,  would  consume 
the  same  amount  of  power  as  that  radiated  by  the  antenna. 

RADIO  FREQUENCIES— Electromagnetic  frequencies  that  fall  between  3  kilohertz  and  300  gigahertz 
and  are  used  for  radio  communications. 

RADIO  HORIZON — The  boundary  beyond  the  natural  horizon  in  which  radio  waves  cannot  be 
propagated  over  the  earth's  surface. 

RADIO  WAVE — (1)  A  form  of  radiant  energy  that  can  neither  be  seen  nor  felt.  (2)  An  electromagnetic 
wave  generated  by  a  transmitter. 

RAREFIED  WAVE — A  longitudinal  wave  that  has  been  expanded  or  rarefied  (made  less  dense)  as  it 
moves  away  from  the  source. 

RECEIVER — The  object  that  responds  to  a  wave  or  disturbance.  Same  as  detector. 

RECEIVING  ANTENNA — The  device  used  to  pick  up  an  rf  signal  from  space. 

RECEIVING  END— See  OUTPUT  END. 

RECIPROCITY — The  property  of  interchangeability  of  the  same  antenna  for  transmitting  and  receiving. 

RECTANGULAR-COORDINATE  GRAPH— A  graph  in  which  straight-line  axes  (horizontal  and 
vertical)  are  perpendicular. 

REFERENCE  LINE — The  position  a  particle  of  matter  would  occupy  if  it  were  not  disturbed  by  wave 
motion. 

REFLECTED  WAVE — (1)  The  wave  that  reflects  back  from  a  medium.  (2)  Waves  traveling  from  the 
load  back  to  the  generator  on  a  transmission  line.  (3)  The  wave  moving  back  to  the  sending  end  of  a 
transmission  line  after  reflection  has  occurred. 

REFLECTION  WAVES — Waves  that  are  neither  transmitted  nor  absorbed,  but  are  reflected  from  the 
surface  of  the  medium  they  encounter. 

REFLECTOR — The  parasitic  element  of  an  array  that  causes  maximum  energy  radiation  in  a  direction 
toward  the  driven  element. 

REFRACTION — The  changing  of  direction  as  a  wave  leaves  one  medium  and  enters  another  medium  of 
a  different  density. 

RERADIATION — The  reception  and  retransmission  of  radio  waves  caused  by  turbulence  in  the 
troposphere. 

RESONANCE — The  condition  produced  when  the  frequency  of  vibrations  are  the  same  as  the  natural 
frequency  (of  a  cavity).  The  vibrations  reinforce  each  other. 

RESONANT  LINE — A  transmission  line  that  has  standing  waves  of  current  and  voltage. 

REST  POSITION— See  REFERENCE  LINE. 

REVERBERATION— The  multiple  reflections  of  sound  waves. 


AI-8 


RHOMBIC  ANTENNA — A  diamond-shaped  antenna  used  widely  for  long-distance,  high-frequency 
transmission  and  reception. 

RIGID  COAXIAL  LINE — A  coxial  line  consisting  of  a  central,  insulated  wire  (inner  conductor) 
mounted  inside  a  tubular  outer  conductor. 

SCATTER  ANGLE — The  angle  at  which  the  receiving  antenna  must  be  aimed  to  capture  the  scattered 
energy  of  tropospheric  scatter. 

SELF-INDUCTION — The  phenomenon  caused  by  the  expanding  and  collapsing  fields  of  an  electron 
which  encircles  other  electrons  and  retards  the  movement  of  the  encircled  electrons. 

SELF-LUMINOUS  BODIES— Objects  that  produce  their  own  light. 

SENDING  END— See  INPUT  END. 

SERIES  RESONANT  CIRCUIT— A  circuit  that  acts  as  a  low  impedance  at  resonance. 

SHIELDED  PAIR — A  line  consisting  of  parallel  conductors  separated  from  each  other  and  surrounded 
by  a  solid  dielectric. 

SHORT-CIRCUITED  LINE — A  transmission  line  that  has  a  terminating  impedance  equal  to  0. 
SINK— See  OUTPUT  END. 

SKIN  EFFECT — The  flow  of  ac  current  near  the  surface  of  a  conductor  at  rf  frequencies. 

SKIP  DISTANCE — The  distance  from  a  transmitter  to  the  point  where  the  sky  wave  is  first  returned  to 
earth. 

SKIP  ZONE — A  zone  of  silence  between  the  point  where  the  ground  wave  becomes  too  weak  for 
reception  and  the  point  where  the  sky  wave  is  first  returned  to  earth. 

SKY  WAVES — Radio  waves  reflected  back  to  earth  from  the  ionosphere. 

SONIC — Pertaining  to  sounds  capable  of  being  heard  by  the  human  ear. 

SOURCE — (1)  The  object  that  produces  waves  or  disturbance.  (2)  The  name  given  to  the  end  of  a  two- 
wire  transmission  line  that  is  connected  to  a  source. 

SPACE  DIVERSITY — Reception  of  radio  waves  by  two  or  more  antennas  spaced  some  distance  apart. 

SPACE  WAVE — A  radio  wave  that  travels  directly  from  the  transmitter  to  the  receiver  and  remains  in 
the  troposphere. 

SPECTRUM — (1)  The  entire  range  of  electromagnetic  waves.  (2)  VISIBLE.  The  range  of 

electromagnetic  waves  that  stimulate  the  sense  of  sight.  (3)  ELECTROMAGNETIC.  The  entire 
range  of  electromagnetic  waves  arranged  in  order  of  their  frequencies. 

SPORADIC  E  LAYER — Irregular  cloud-like  patches  of  unusually  high  ionization.  Often  forms  at 
heights  near  the  normal  E  layer. 

SPREADER — Insulator  used  with  transmission  lines  and  antennas  to  keep  the  parallel  wires  separated. 


AI-9 


STANDING  WAVE — The  distribution  of  voltage  and  current  formed  by  the  incident  and  reflected 
waves  which  have  minimum  and  maximum  points  on  a  resultant  wave  that  appears  to  stand  still. 

STANDING- WAVE  RATIO  (SWR) — The  ratio  of  the  maximum  (voltage,  current)  to  the  minimum 
(voltage,  current)  of  a  transmission  line.  Measures  the  perfection  of  the  termination  of  the  line. 

STRATOSPHERE — Located  between  the  troposphere  and  the  ionosphere.  Has  little  effect  on  radio 
waves. 

STUB — Short  section  of  a  transmission  line  used  to  match  the  impedance  of  a  transmission  line  to  an 
antenna.  Can  also  be  used  to  produce  desired  phase  relationships  between  connected  elements  of  an 
antenna. 

SUDDEN  IONOSPHERIC  DISTURBANCE— An  irregular  ionospheric  disturbance  that  can  totally 
blank  out  hf  radio  communications. 

SUPERSONIC — Speed  greater  than  the  speed  of  sound. 

SURFACE  WAVE — A  radio  wave  that  travels  along  the  contours  of  the  earth,  thereby  being  highly 
attenuated. 

TEMPERATURE  INVERSION — The  condition  in  which  warm  air  is  formed  above  a  layer  of  cool  air 
that  is  near  the  earth's  surface. 

THREE-ELEMENT  ARRAY — An  array  with  two  parasitic  elements  (reflector  and  director)  and  a 
driven  element. 

TONES— Musical  sounds. 

TRANSLUCENT — A  type  of  substance,  such  as  frosted  glass,  through  which  some  light  rays  can  pass 
but  through  which  objects  cannot  be  seen  clearly. 

TRANSMISSION  LINE — A  device  designed  to  guide  electrical  energy  from  one  point  to  another. 

TRANSMITTING  ANTENNA — The  device  used  to  send  the  transmitted  signal  energy  into  space. 

TRANSPARENT — A  type  of  substance,  such  as  glass,  that  transmits  almost  all  of  the  light  waves  that 
fall  upon  it. 

TRANSMISSION  MEDIUMS — The  various  types  of  lines  and  waveguides  used  as  transmission  lines. 
TRANSMITTER  END— See  INPUT  END. 

TRANSVERSE  WAVE  MOTION— The  up  and  down  motion  of  a  wave  as  the  wave  moves  outward. 

TROPOSPHERE — The  portion  of  the  atmosphere  closest  to  the  earth's  surface,  where  all  weather 
phenomena  take  place. 

TROPOSPHERIC  SCATTER— The  propagation  of  radio  waves  in  the  troposphere  by  means  of  scatter. 

TROUGH  (BOTTOM) — The  peak  of  the  negative  alternation  (maximum  value  below  the  line). 

TUNED  LINE — Another  name  for  the  resonant  line.  This  line  uses  tuning  devices  to  eliminate  the 
reactance  and  to  transfer  maximum  power  from  the  source  to  the  line. 


AI-10 


TURNSTILE  ANTENNA — A  type  of  antenna  used  in  vhf  communications  that  is  omnidirectional  and 
consists  of  two  horizontal  half -wave  antennas  mounted  at  right  angles  to  each  other  in  the  same 
horizontal  plane. 

TWISTED  PAIR — A  line  consisting  of  two  insulated  wires  twisted  together  to  form  a  flexible  line 
without  the  use  of  spacers. 

TWO-WIRE  OPEN  LINE — A  parallel  line  consisting  of  two  wires  that  are  generally  spaced  from  2  to  6 
inches  apart  by  insulating  spacers. 

TWO-WIRE  RIBBON  (TWIN  LEAD)— A  parallel  line  similar  to  a  two-wire  open  line  except  that 
uniform  spacing  is  assured  by  embedding  the  two  wires  in  a  low-loss  dielectric. 

ULTRASONIC— Sounds  above  20,000  hertz. 

UNIDIRECTIONAL  ARRAY — An  array  that  radiates  in  only  one  general  direction. 
UNTUNED  LINE — Another  name  for  the  flat  or  nonresonant  line. 

V  ANTENNA — A  bi-directional  antenna,  shaped  like  a  V,  which  is  widely  used  for  communications. 

VELOCITY — The  rate  at  which  a  disturbance  travels  through  a  medium. 

VERTICAL  AXIS — On  a  graph,  the  straight  line  axis  oriented  from  bottom  to  top. 

VERTICAL  PATTERN— The  part  of  a  radiation  pattern  that  is  radiated  in  the  vertical  plane. 

VERTICALLY  POLARIZED— Waves  radiated  with  the  E  field  component  perpendicular  to  the  earth's 
surface. 

VOLTAGE-FEED  METHOD— Same  as  END  FEED  METHOD. 

VOLTAGE  STANDING- WAVE  RATIO  (VSWR)— The  ratio  of  maximum  to  minimum  voltage  of  a 
transmission  line. 

WAVE  ANTENNA— Same  as  BEVERAGE  ANTENNA. 

WAVE  MOTION — A  recurring  disturbance  advancing  through  space  with  or  without  the  use  of  a 
physical  medium. 

WAVE  TRAIN — A  continuous  series  of  waves  with  the  same  amplitude  and  wavelength. 

WAVEFRONT — A  small  section  of  an  expanding  sphere  of  electromagnetic  radiation,  perpendicular  to 
the  direction  of  travel  of  the  energy. 

WAVEGUIDE — A  hollow  metal  tube  used  as  a  transmission  line  to  guide  energy  from  one  point  to 
another. 

WAVELENGTH — (1)  The  distance  in  space  occupied  by  1  cycle  of  a  radio  wave  at  any  given  instant. 
(2)  The  distance  a  disturbance  travels  during  one  period  of  vibration. 

YAGI  ANTENNA — A  multielement  parasitic  array.  Elements  lie  in  the  same  plane  as  those  of  the  end- 
fire  array. 


AI-11 


MODULE  10  INDEX 


A 

Absorption  in  the  ionosphere,  2-24 
Absorption  of  light,  1-31 
Acoustics,  soundwaves,  1-23 
Amplitude,  wave  motion,  1-7 
Antennas,  4-1 

antenna  characteristics,  4-8 

array  antennas,  4-25 

operation  of  basic  antennas,  4-18 

principles  of  antenna  radiation,  4-2 

radiation  of  electromagnetic  energy,  4-6 

rf  safety  precautions,  4-47 

special  antennas,  4-40 
Atmospheric  propagation,  2-11 

diffraction,  2-13 

reflection,  2-11 

refraction,  2-12 

B 

Basic  antennas,  operation  of,  4-18 
Broadside  arrays,  4-3 1 
Bums,  if,  4-50 

C 

Characteristic  impedance  of  a  transmission 

line,  3-14 
Collinear  array,  4-29 
Color  and  frequencies,  1-27 
Color  and  light,  1-28 

Comparison  of  light  waves  and  sound  waves, 
1-32 

Corner  reflector,  4-46 

Current  and  voltage  distribution  on  an  antenna, 
4-4 

Cycle,  wave  motion,  1-8 
D 

Density  and  velocity  of  transmission,  sound 

waves,  1-22 
Determining  characteristic  impedance,  3-26 


Dielectric  heating,  4-49 

Diffraction,  atmospheric  propagation,  2-13 

Diffraction,  wave  motion,  1-16 

Diffusion  of  light,  1-31 

Directivity,  4-28 

Distributed  constants,  3-11 

Doppler  effect,  wave  motion,  1-16 

E 

Echo,  acoustics,  1-23 
Electromagnetic  fields,  2-2 

induction  field,  2-2 

radiation  fields,  2-4 
Electromagnetic  fields  about  a  transmission 
line,  3-13 

Electromagnetic  interference  (EMI),  2-28 

control  of  EMI,  2-29 

man-made,  2-28 

natural,  2-29 
Electromagnetic  spectrum,  1-33 
Electromagnetic  theory  of  light,  1-26 
Electromagnetic  waves,  1-33 

basic  antenna,  1-34 

components,  1-35 
End- fire  array,  4-33 

F 

Fading,  radio  wave  propagation,  2-26 
multipath,  2-26 
selective,  2-27 

Folded  dipole,  4-24 

Frequency  and  time,  wave  motion,  1-9 

Frequency  selection  considerations,  radio 
waves,  2-32 
lowest  usable  frequency,  2-32 
maximum  usable  frequency,  2-32 
optimum  working  frequency,  2-33 

G 

Gain,  antenna,  4-9 
Glossary,  AI-1  to  AI-11 


INDEX- 1 


Ground-plane  antenna,  4-46 
H 

Half- wave  antennas,  4-18 
I 

Induction  field,  electromagnetic  fields,  2-2 
Intensity  of  sound,  1  -20 
Interference,  acoustics,  1-24 
Introduction  to  transmission  lines,  3-1 
Ionosphere,  2-15 

ionization,  2-19 

layers,  2-19 

recombination,  2-19 

L 

Length  of  a  transmission  line,  3-8 
Light  waves,  1-25 

comparison  of  light  waves  and  sound 
waves,  1-32 

electromagnetic  theory  of  light,  1-26 

frequencies  and  color,  1-27 

frequencies  and  wavelengths,  1-27 

light  and  color,  1-28 

luminous  bodies,  1-28 

propagation  of  light,  1-25 

properties  of  light,  1-28 
Loading,  antenna,  4-17 
Longitudinal  waves,  wave  motion,  1-5 
Long- wire  antennas,  4-4 1 
Losses  in  transmission  lines,  3-7 
Luminous  bodies,  1-28 
Lumped  constants,  3-10 

M 

Medium,  wave  motion,  1-6 
Mediums,  types  of  transmission,  3-2 
Multipath  fading,  2-26 

N 

Noise,  acoustics,  1-25 


P 

Parasitic  arrays,  4-35 
Phasing,  4-26 
Pitch  of  sound,  1-20 
Polarization,  4-9 
Polarization,  radio  waves,  2-10 
Precipitation  attenuation,  2-34 

fog,  2-35 

hail,  2-35 

rain,  2-34 

snow,  2-35 
Principles  of  antenna  radiation,  4-2 
Principles  of  transmission  lines,  3-1 

length  of  a  transmission  line,  3-8 

losses  in  transmission  lines,  3-7 

reflections  on  a  transmission  line,  3-28 

terminology,  3-2 

transmission  line  theory,  3-10 

types  of  transmission  mediums,  3-2 
Propagation  paths,  2-24 
Properties  of  light,  1-25 

Q 

Quality  of  sound,  1-21 
Quarter- wave  antennas,  4-21 

R 

Radiation  fields,  2-4 

Radiation  of  electromagnetic  energy,  4-6 
Radiation  resistance,  4-12 
Radiation  types  and  patterns,  4-12 
Radio  wave  propagation,  2-1 

effect  of  the  earths  atmosphere  on  radio 
waves,  2-14 

electromagnetic  fields,  2-2 

radio  waves,  2-6 

tropospheric  propagation,  2-36 

weather  versus  propagation,  2-34 
Radio  wave  transmission,  2-15 

ground  wave,  2-16 

sky  wave,  2-18 


INDEX-2 


Reciprocity  of  antennas,  4-8 

Reflection,  atmospheric  propagation,  2-11 

Reflection  of  light,  1-30 

Reflection,  wave  motion,  1-13 

Reflections  on  a  transmission  line,  3-28 

Refraction,  acoustics,  1-23 

Refraction,  atmospheric  propagation,  2-12 

Refraction  in  the  ionosphere,  2-20 

angle  of  incidence,  2-22 

density  of  layer,  2-21 

frequency,  2-21 

skip  distance/skip  zone,  2-24 
Refraction  of  light,  1-30 
Refraction,  wave  motion,  1-14 
Resonance,  acoustics,  1-24 
Reverberation,  acoustics,  1-24 
Rhombic  antennas,  4-42 

S 

Safety  precautions,  if,  4-47 
Selective  fading,  2-27 
Sound  waves,  1-17 

acoustics,  1-23 

characteristics,  1-19 

density  and  velocity  of  transmission,  1-22 

requirements  for  sound,  1-18 

terms,  1-19 
Special  antennas,  4-40 
Speed  of  light,  1-30 

Standing  waves  on  a  transmission  line,  3-43 
T 

Temperature  inversion,  2-35 
Terminating  a  transmission  line,  3-38 
Termination,  3-43 
Terminology,  3-2 
Transmission  line  theory,  3-10 
Transmission  losses,  radio  wave  propagation, 
2-27 

freespace  loss,  2-28 
ground  reflection  loss,  2-28 


Transmission  mediums,  types  of,  3-2 
Transverse  waves,  1-5 
Tropospheric  propagation,  2-36 

application  of  tropospheric  scatter,  2-38 

tropospheric  scattering,  2-37 
Turnstile  antenna,  4-45 

V 

V  antennas,  4-41 

Variations  in  the  ionosphere,  2-29 

irregular  variations,  2-30 

regular  variations,  2-29 
Velocity  of  wave  propagation,  3-24 
Voltage  change  along  a  transmission  line,  3-18 

W 

Wave  motion,  principles  of,  1-2 
characteristics,  1-9 
in  water,  1-3 
longitudinal  waves,  1  -5 
medium,  1-6 
terms,  1-7 

transverse  waves,  1  -5 
Wave  propagation,  1-1 

electromagnetic  spectrum,  1-33 

electromagnetic  waves,  1-33 

light  waves,  1  -25 

principles  of  wave  motion,  1-2 

sound  waves,  1-17 
Wavelength  to  frequency  conversions,  radio 

waves,  2-8 
Wavelength,  wave  motion,  1-8 
Wavelengths  and  frequencies,  1-27 
Weather  versus  propagation,  2-34 

precipitation  attenuation,  2-34 

temperature  inversion,  2-35 
Working  aloft,  precautions,  4-49 


INDEX-3 


Assignment  Questions 


Information:  The  text  pages  that  you  are  to  study  are 
provided  at  the  beginning  of  the  assignment  questions. 


ASSIGNMENT  1 

Textbook  assignment:  Chapter  1,  "Wave  Propagation,"  pages  1-1  through  1-48. 


1-1.  What  is  the  major  advantage  of  the 
telegraph  over  earlier  methods  of 
communication? 

1.  Range 

2.  Speed 

3.  Security 

4.  Reliability 

1-2.  The  spreading  out  of  radio  waves  is 

referred  to  as  propagation  and  is  used  in 
which  of  the  following  Navy  equipment? 

1.  Detection 

2.  Communication 

3.  Radar  and  navigation 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

1-3.  Radio-frequency  waves  CANNOT  be 
seen  for  which  of  the  following  reasons? 

1 .  Because  radio-frequency  energy  is 
low  powered 

2.  Because  radio-frequency  waves  are 
below  the  sensitivity  range  of  the 
human  eye 

3.  Because  the  human  eye  detects  only 
magnetic  energy 

4.  Because  radio-frequency  waves  are 
above  the  sensitivity  range  of  the 
human  eye 

1-4.  Radio  waves  travel  at  what  speed? 

1 .  Speed  of  sound 

2.  Speed  of  light 

3.  Speed  of  the  Earth's  rotation 

4.  Speed  of  the  Earth's  orbit  around  the 
sun 


1-5.  Which  of  the  following  types  of  energy 
CANNOT  be  seen,  heard,  or  felt? 

1 .  Radio  waves 

2.  Sound  waves 

3.  Heat  waves 

4.  Light  waves 

1-6.  A  stone  dropped  into  water  creates  a 

series  of  expanding  circles  on  the  surface 
of  the  water.  This  is  an  example  of  which 
of  the  following  types  of  wave  motion? 

1.  Transverse 

2.  Concentric 

3.  Longitudinal 

4.  Compression 

1-7.  A  sound  wave  that  moves  back  and  forth 
in  the  direction  of  propagation  is  an 
example  of  which  of  the  following  types 
of  wave  motion? 

1.  Composite 

2.  Concentric 

3.  Transverse 

4.  Longitudinal 

1-8.  Which  of  the  following  terms  is  used  for 
the  vehicle  through  which  a  wave  travels 
from  point  to  point? 

1.  Medium 

2.  Source 

3.  Detector 

4.  Receiver 

1-9.  Which  of  the  following  is  NOT  an 

element  necessary  to  propagate  sound? 

1.  Medium 

2.  Source 

3.  Detector 

4.  Reference 


1 


1-10.  If  a  wave  has  a  velocity  of  4,800  feet  per 
second  and  a  wave-length  of  5  feet,  what 
is  the  frequency  of  the  wave? 

1.  9.6  Hz 

2.  96  Hz 

3.  960  Hz 

4.  9,600  Hz 


V»  1/2  SECOND- 


Figure  1-A. — Waveform. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTIONS  1-11 
THROUGH  1-15,  REFER  TO  FIGURE  1-A. 

1-11.  The  waveform  in  the  figure  is  what  type 
of  wave? 

1.  Sine 

2.  Square 

3.  Sawtooth 

4.  Trapezoidal 

1-12.  The  distance  between  which  of  the 
following  points  represents  the 
completion  of  a  full  cycle  of  alternating 
current? 

1.  AtoC 

2.  B  to  D 

3.  CtoE 

4.  D  to  F 

1-13.  The  distance  between  which  of  the 
following  points  represents  a  full 
wavelength? 

1.  AtoD 

2.  AtoE 

3.  D  to  E 

4.  EtoF 


1-14.  What  is  the  frequency  of  the  wave? 

1.  0.5  Hz 

2.  2.5  Hz 

3.  5.0  Hz 

4.  7.5  Hz 

1-15.  What  is  the  period  of  the  wave? 

1.  100  milliseconds 

2.  200  milliseconds 

3.  250  milliseconds 

4.  500  milliseconds 


Figure  1-B. — Wave  angles. 


IN  ANSWERING  QUESTIONS  1-16 
THROUGH  1-19,  REFER  TO  FIGURE  1-B. 

1-16.  What  line  in  the  figure  indicates  the 
incident  wave? 

1.  A  to  B 

2.  B  to  E 

3.  CtoB 

4.  D  to  H 

1-17.  Angle  "x"  is  which  of  the  following 
angles? 

1.  Normal 

2.  Incidence 

3.  Reflection 

4.  Refraction 


2 


1-18.  Line  E  to  F  represents  which  of  the 
following  waves? 

1.  Normal 

2.  Incident 

3.  Refracted 

4.  Reflected 

1-19.  Line  D  to  H  represents  which  of  the 
following  references? 

1.  Normal 

2.  Perpendicular 

3.  Both  1  and  2  above 

4.  Reflected  line 

1-20.  Which  of  the  following  statements  about 
a  wave  is  the  law  of  reflection? 

1.  The  angle  of  incidence  is  equal  to  the 
refracted  wave 

2.  The  angle  of  incidence  is  not  equal  to 
the  refracted  wave 

3.  The  angle  of  incidence  is  equal  to  the 
angle  of  reflection 

4.  The  angle  of  incidence  is  not  equal  to 
the  angle  of  reflection 

1-21.  If  a  wave  passes  first  through  a  dense 
medium  and  then  through  a  less  dense 
medium,  which  of  the  following  angle  - 
of-refraction  conditions  exists? 

1 .  The  angle  of  refraction  is  greater  than 
the  angle  of  incidence 

2.  The  angle  of  refraction  is  less  than  the 
angle  of  incidence 

3.  The  angle  of  refraction  is  equal  to  the 
angle  of  incidence 

4.  The  wave  will  pass  through  in  a 
straight  line 

1-22.  The  reception  of  an  AM-band  radio 

signal  over  mountains  can  be  explained 
by  which  of  the  following  principles  of 
wave  propagation? 


1-23.  What  wave  propagation  principle 

accounts  for  the  apparent  increase  in 
frequency  as  a  train  whistle  approaches 
and  the  apparent  decrease  in  frequency  as 
it  moves  away? 

1.  Refraction 

2.  Reflection 

3.  Diffraction 

4.  Doppler  effect 

1-24.  Longitudinal  wave  disturbances  that 
travel  through  a  medium  are  known  as 
what  type  of  waves? 

1.  Air 

2.  Sound 

3.  Radio 

4.  Light 

1-25.  What  are  the  three  audible  frequency 
ranges? 

1 .  Subsonic,  sonic,  and  supersonic 

2.  Infrasonic,  sonic,  and  ultrasonic 

3.  Infrasonic,  subsonic,  and  ultrasonic 

4.  Infrasonic,  subsonic,  and  supersonic 

1-26.  If  a  bell  is  placed  in  a  jar  and  the  air  in 
the  jar  is  replaced  with  a  gas  of  a  higher 
density,  what  is  the  effect,  if  any,  on  the 
speed  of  the  sound  when  the  bell  is  rung? 

1.  The  sound  stops 

2.  The  sound  travels  faster 

3.  The  sound  travels  slower 

4.  The  sound  is  not  affected 

1-27.  Varying  which  of  the  following  wave 
characteristics  will  cause  the  length  of 
sound  waves  to  vary? 

1.  Phase 

2.  Quality 

3.  Amplitude 

4.  Frequency 


1.  Reflection 

2.  Refraction 

3.  Diffraction 

4.  Doppler  effect 


3 


1-28.  What  are  the  three  basic  characteristics 
of  sound? 

1.  Amplitude,  intensity,  and  quality 

2.  Amplitude,  pitch,  and  tone 

3.  Pitch,  intensity,  and  quality 

4.  Pitch,  frequency,  and  quality 

1-29.  If  several  musical  instruments  are 

playing  the  same  note,  you  should  be 
able  to  distinguish  one  instrument  from 
another  because  of  which  of  the 
following  characteristics  of  sound? 

1.  Quality 

2.  Overtones 

3.  Frequency 

4.  Intensity 

1-30.  Through  which  of  the  following 

mediums  will  sound  travel  fastest,  at  the 
indicated  temperature? 

1.  Air  at    68°  F 

2.  Lead  at  20°  C 

3.  Steel  at  32°  F 

4.  Steel  at  20°  C 

1-31.  In  sound  terminology,  which  of  the 

following  terms  is  the  same  as  a  wave 
reflection? 

1.  Echo 

2.  Image 

3.  Acoustics 

4.  Refraction 

1-32.  Multiple  reflections  of  sound  waves  are 
referred  to  as 


1-33.  Two  out-of-phase  waves  of  the  same 
frequency  that  are  moving  through  the 
same  medium  are  said  to  present  which 
of  the  following  types  of  interference? 

1.  Additive 

2.  Constructive 

3.  Both  1  and  2  above 

4.  Subtractive 

1-34.  A  cavity  that  vibrates  at  its  own  natural 
frequency  and  produces  a  sound  that  is 
louder  than  at  other  frequencies  is 
demonstrating  which  of  the  following 
sound  characteristics? 

1.  Noise 

2.  Quality 

3.  Resonance 

4.  Reverberation 

1-35.  Energy  in  the  form  of  light  can  be 

produced  through  which  of  the  following 
means? 

1.  Chemical 

2.  Electrical 

3.  Mechanical 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

1-36.  The  scientist,  J.  C.  Maxwell,  developed 
the  theory  that  small  packets  of 
electromagnetic  energy  called  photons 
produce 

1.  sound 

2.  noise 

3.  echoes 

4.  light 


1.  noise  1-37.  A  large  volume  of  light  radiating  in  a 

2.  acoustics  given  direction  is  referred  to  as  a 

3.  interference 

4.  reverberation  1.  ray 

2.  beam 

3.  shaft 

4.  pencil 


4 


1-38.  Which  of  the  following  units  of 

measurement  is/are  used  to  measure  very 
short  wavelengths  of  light? 

1 .  Angstrom  (A) 

2.  Millimicron 

3.  Both  1  and  2  above 

4.  Millimeter 

1-39.  What  are  the  primary  colors  of  light? 

1.  Red,  blue,  and  yellow 

2.  Red,  blue,  and  green 

3.  Red,  violet,  and  indigo 

4.  Blue,  green,  and  violet 

1-40.  What  are  the  secondary  colors  of  light? 

1.  Orange,  yellow,  and  blue -green 

2.  Magenta,  yellow,  and  cyan 

3.  Purple,  yellow,  and  black 

4.  Red,  white,  and  blue 

1-41.  What  causes  sunlight  to  separate  into 
different  wavelengths  and  display  a 
rainbow  of  colors  when  passed  through  a 
prism? 

1.  Refraction 

2.  Reflection 

3.  Dispersion 

4.  Diffraction 

1-42.  The  sun,  gas  flames,  and  electric  light 
filaments  are  visible  because  they  are 

1.  opaque 

2.  transparent 

3.  nonluminous 

4.  self-luminous 

1-43.  Substances  that  transmit  almost  all  of  the 
light  waves  falling  upon  them  possess 
which  of  the  following  properties? 


1-44.  Some  substances  are  able  to  transmit 
light  waves  but  objects  cannot  be  seen 
through  them.  Which  of  the  following 
properties  does  this  statement  describe? 

1.  Opaqueness 

2.  Transparence 

3.  Translucence 

4.  Self-lumination 

1-45.  The  speed  of  light  depends  on  the 

medium  through  which  light  travels.  For 
which  of  the  following  reasons  does  light 
travel  through  empty  space  faster  than 
through  an  object  such  as  glass? 

1.  Space  is  less  dense  than  glass 

2.  Space  is  more  dense  than  glass 

3.  Glass  reflects  the  light  back  to  the 
source 

4.  Glass  refracts  the  light,  causing  the 
light  to  travel  in  all  directions 

1-46.  If  a  light  wave  strikes  a  sheet  of  glass  at  a 
perpendicular  angle,  what  is  the  effect,  if 
any,  on  the  light  wave? 

1 .  The  wave  is  completely  absorbed 

2.  The  wave  is  reflected  back  toward  the 
source 

3.  The  wave  is  refracted  as  it  passes 
through  the  glass 

4.  The  wave  is  unchanged  and  continues 
in  a  straight  line 

1-47.  The  amount  of  absorption  of  the  light 

that  strikes  an  object  is  determined  by  the 
object's 

1.  color 

2.  purity 

3.  density 

4.  complexity 


1.  Opaqueness 

2.  Transparence 

3.  Translucence 

4.  Self-lumination 


5 


1-48. 


1-49. 


In  a  comparison  of  waves  of  light  and 
sound  as  they  travel  from  an  air  into 
water,  how  is  the  speed  of  (a)  light  waves 
and  (b)  sound  waves  affected? 


1 .  (a)  Increased 

2.  (a)  Increased 

3.  (a)  Decreased 

4.  (a)  Decreased 


(b)  increased 
(b)  decreased 
(b)  decreased 
(b)  increased 


Which  of  the  following  waves  are  NOT  a 
form  of  electromagnetic  energy? 


1-53.  The  electric  field  and  magnetic  field 

combine  to  form  which  of  the  following 
types  of  waves? 

1 .  Spherical 

2.  Elliptical 

3.  Electromagnetic 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

1-54.  The  magnetic  field  radiated  from  an 
antenna  is  produced  by  what  electrical 
property? 


1 .  Heat  waves 

2.  Sound  waves 

3.  Light  waves 

4.  Radio  waves 


1.  Voltage 

2.  Current 

3.  Reactance 

4.  Resistance 


1-50.  The  electromagnetic  spectrum  represents 
the  entire  range  of  electromagnetic  waves 
arranged  in  the  order  of  their 


1-55.  The  electric  field  radiated  from  an 

antenna  is  produced  by  what  electrical 
property? 


1.  color 

2.  frequency 

3.  visibility 

4.  application 


1.  Voltage 

2.  Current 

3.  Reactance 

4.  Resistance 


1-51.  Which  of  the  following  portions  of  the 
frequency  spectrum  contains  the  highest 
frequency? 


1-56.  Applying  rf  energy  to  the  elements  of  an 
antenna  results  in  what  phase  relationship 
between  voltage  and  current? 


1-52. 


1.  X-ray 

2.  Radar 

3.  Light 

4.  Cosmic 

Which  of  the  following  electronic 
devices  is  used  to  radiate  and/or  collect 
electromagnetic  waves? 


1-57. 


1 .  Voltage  lags  current  by  90  degrees 

2.  Voltage  leads  current  by  90  degrees 

3.  Voltage  and  current  are  180  degrees 
out  of  phase 

4.  Voltage  and  current  are  in  phase 

What  field  exists  close  to  the  conductor 
of  an  antenna  and  carries  the  current? 


1.  Antenna 

2.  Receiver 

3.  Transmitter 

4.  Transmission  line 


1.  Electric 

2.  Magnetic 

3.  Induction 

4.  Radiation 


6 


1-58.  What  field  travels  through  space  after 

being  detached  from  the  current-carrying 
rod  of  an  antenna? 

1.  Electric 

2.  Magnetic 

3.  Induction 

4.  Radiation 

1-59.  Electric  and  magnetic  fields  on  an 

antenna  reach  their  maximum  intensity  at 
which  of  the  following  times? 

1 .  When  they  are  a  full  cycle  apart 

2.  When  they  are  three-quarter  cycle 
apart 

3.  When  they  are  a  half-cycle  apart 

4.  When  they  are  a  quarter-cycle  apart 


7 


ASSIGNMENT  2 

Textbook  assignment:  Chapter  2,  "Radio  Wave  Propagation,"  pages  2-1  through  2-47. 


2-1.  The  induction  field  is  made  up  of  which  of 
the  following  fields? 

1 .  E  field  only 

2.  H  field  only 

3.  Both  E  and  H  fields 

2-2.  After  the  radiation  field  leaves  an  antenna, 
what  is  the  relationship  between  the  E  and 
H  fields  with  respect  to  (a)  phase  and 
(b)  physical  displacement  in  space? 


2-6.  A  frequency  of  3.5  GHz  falls  into  what  rf 
band? 

1.  High 

2.  Very  high 

3.  Super  high 

4.  Extremely  high 

2-7.  A  radio  wavelength  expressed  as  250 
meters  may  also  be  expressed  as  how 
many  feet? 


1.  (a)  In  phase 

2.  (a)  Out  of  phase 

3.  (a)  In  phase 

4.  (a)  Out  of  phase 


(b)  90  degrees 
(b)  90  degrees 
(b)  180  degrees 
(b)  180  degrees 


2-3.  What  is  the  first  harmonic  of  a  radio  wave 
that  has  a  fundamental  frequency  of  2,000 
kHz? 

1.  6,000  kHz 

2.  2,000  kHz 

3.  3,000  kHz 

4.  4,000  kHz 

2-4.  In  a  radio  wave  with  a  fundamental 
frequency  of  1.5  kHz,  which  of  the 
following  frequencies  is  NOT  a  harmonic? 

1.  6,000  kHz 

2.  5,000  kHz 

3.  3,000  kHz 

4.  4,000  kHz 

2-5.  A  radio  wave  with  a  frequency  of  32  kHz 
is  part  of  which  of  the  following  frequency 
bands? 

1.  The  If  band 

2.  The  mf  band 

3.  The  hf  band 

4.  The  vhf  band 


2-8. 


1.  410 

2.  820 

3.  1,230 

4.  1,640 

An  increase  in  the  frequency  of  a  radio 
wave  will  have  what  effect,  if  any,  on  the 
velocity  of  the  radio  wave? 


1.  Increase 

2.  Decrease 

3.  None 

2-9.  An  increase  in  frequency  of  a  radio  wave 
will  have  what  effect,  if  any,  on  the 
wavelength  of  the  radio  wave? 

1.  Increase 

2.  Decrease 

3.  None 

2-10.  What  is  the  frequency,  in  kiloHertz,  of  a 
radio  wave  that  is  40  meters  long? 

1.  75 

2.  750 

3.  7,500 

4.  75,000 


8 


2-11.  What  is  the  approximate  wavelength,  in 
feet,  of  a  radio  wave  with  a  frequency  of 
5,000  kHz? 

1.  197  feet 

2.  1,970  feet 

3.  19,700  feet 

4.  197,000  feet 

2-12.  The  polarity  of  a  radio  wave  is  determined 
by  the  orientation  of  (a)  what  moving  field 
with  respect  to  (b)  what  reference? 


1 .  (a)  Electric 

2.  (a)  Electric 

3.  (a)  Magnetic 

4.  (a)  Magneti 


(b)  earth 
(b)  antenna 
(b)  antenna 
(b)  earth 


2-13. 


Energy  radiated  from  an  antenna  is 
considered  horizontally  polarized  under 
which  of  the  following  conditions? 

1 .  If  the  wavefront  is  in  the  horizontal 
plane 

2.  If  the  magnetic  field  is  in  the  horizontal 
plane 

3.  If  the  electric  field  is  in  the  horizontal 
plane 

4.  If  the  induction  field  is  in  the 
horizontal  plane 


2-14.  The  ability  of  a  reflecting  surface  to  reflect 
a  specific  radio  wave  depends  on  which  of 
the  following  factors? 

1 .  Striking  angle 

2.  Wavelength  of  the  wave 

3.  Size  of  the  reflecting  area 

4.  All  of  the  above 


THIS  SPACE  LEFT  BLANK 
INTENTIONALLY. 


EARTH'S  SURFACE 

Figure  2-A. — Reflected  radio  waves. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTION  2-15,  REFER  TO 
FIGURE  2-A. 

2-15.  If  the  two  reflected  radio  waves  shown  in 
the  figure  are  received  at  the  same  instant 
at  the  receiving  site,  what  will  be  the 
effect,  if  any,  on  signal  quality? 

1 .  A  stronger  signal  will  be  produced 

2.  A  weak  or  fading  signal  will  be 
produced 

3.  The  signal  will  be  completely  canceled 
out 

4.  None 

2-16.  The  bending  of  a  radio  wave  because  of  a 
change  in  its  velocity  through  a  medium  is 
known  as 

1.  refraction 

2.  reflection 

3.  deflection 

4.  diffraction 

2-17.  Radio  communications  can  be  diffracted 

to  exceptionally  long  distances  through  the 
use  of  (a)  what  frequency  band  at  (b)  what 
relative  power  level? 

1 .  (a)  Very  low  frequency 
(b)  Low  power 

2.  (a)  Very  high  frequency 
(b)  Low  power 

3.  (a)  Very  low  frequency 
(b)  High  power 

4.  (a)  Very  high  frequency 
(b)  High  power 


9 


2-18.  Electrically  charged  particles  that  affect 
the  propagation  of  radio  waves  are  found 
in  what  atmospheric  layer? 

1.  Troposphere 

2.  Ionosphere 

3.  Chronosphere 

4.  Stratosphere 

2-19.  Most  weather  phenomena  take  place  in 
which  of  the  following  region  of  the 
atmosphere? 

1.  Troposphere 

2.  Ionosphere 

3.  Chronosphere 

4.  Stratosphere 

2-20.  Radio  wave  propagation  has  the  least 

effect  because  of  its  constancy  on  which 
of  the  following  atmospheric  layers? 

1.  Troposphere 

2.  Ionosphere 

3.  Chronosphere 

4.  Stratosphere 

2-21.  Long  range,  surface -wave 

communications  are  best  achieved  when 
the  signal  is  transmitted  over  seawater 
with  (a)  what  polarization  at  (b)  what 
relative  frequency? 

1.  (a)  Vertical  (b)  Low 

2.  (a)  Vertical  (b)  High 

3.  (a)  Horizontal  (b)  High 

4.  (a)  Horizontal  (b)  Low 

2-22.  The  Navy's  long-range  vlf  broadcasts  are 
possible  because  of  the  advantages  of 
which  of  the  following  types  of 
propagation? 

1.  Diffraction 

2.  Ionospheric  refraction 

3.  Repeated  reflection  and  refraction 

4.  Both  2  and  3  above 


2-23.  A  space  wave  (a)  is  primarily  a  result  of 
refraction  in  what  atmospheric  layer  and 
(b)  extends  approximately  what  distance 
beyond  the  horizon? 

1 .  (a)  Ionosphere 

(b)  One -tenth  farther 

2.  (a)  Ionosphere 

(b)  One -third  farther 

3.  (a)  Troposphere 

(b)  One -third  farther 

4.  (a)  Troposphere 

(b)  One -tenth  farther 

2-24.  The  signal  of  a  space  wave  is  sometimes 
significantly  reduced  at  the  receiving  site 
because  of  which  of  the  following 
interactions? 

1.  Space-wave  refraction 

2.  Space -wave  reflections 

3.  Ground -wave  diffraction 

4.  Ground-wave  reflections 

2-25.  For  long-range  communications  in  the  hf 
band,  which  of  the  following  types  of 
waves  is  most  satisfactory? 

1 .  Sky  wave 

2.  Space  wave 

3.  Surface  wave 

4.  Reflected  ground  wave 

2-26.  Ionization  in  the  atmosphere  is  produced 
chiefly  by  which  of  the  following  types  of 
radiation? 

1.  Alpha  radiation 

2.  Cosmic  radiation 

3.  Infrared  radiation 

4.  Ultraviolet  radiation 

2-27.  Ultraviolet  waves  of  higher  frequencies 
produce  ionized  layers  at  what  relative 
altitude(s)? 

1.  Lower 

2.  Higher 

3.  Both  1  and  2  above 


10 


2-28.  The  density  of  ionized  layers  is  normally 
greatest  during  which  of  the  following 
periods? 

1.  At  night 

2.  Before  sunrise 

3.  Between  early  morning  and  late 
afternoon 

4.  Between  afternoon  and  sunset 

2-29.  Compared  to  the  other  ionospheric  layers 
at  higher  altitudes,  the  ionization  density 
of  the  D  layer  is 

1 .  about  the  same 

2.  relatively  low 

3.  relatively  high 

2-30.  What  two  layers  in  the  ionosphere 

recombine  and  largely  disappear  at  night? 

1.  DandF 

2.  DandE 

3.  EandF2 

4.  Fl  and  F2 

2-3 1 .  For  hf -radio  communications  covering 

long  distances,  what  is  the  most  important 
layer  of  the  ionosphere? 

1.  C 

2.  D 

3.  E 

4.  F 

2-32.  Refraction  of  a  sky  wave  in  the  ionosphere 
is  influenced  by  which  of  the  following 
factors? 

1.  Ionospheric  density 

2.  Frequency  of  the  wave 

3.  Angle  of  incidence  of  the  wave 

4.  All  of  the  above 


2-33.  A  10-MHz  wave  entering  the  ionosphere 
at  an  angle  greater  than  its  critical  angle 
will  pass  through  the  ionosphere  and  be 
lost  in  space  unless  which  of  the  following 
actions  is  taken? 

1.  The  ground  wave  is  canceled 

2.  The  frequency  of  the  wave  is  increased 

3.  The  frequency  of  the  wave  is  decreased 

4.  The  ground  wave  is  reinforced 

2-34.  The  distance  between  the  transmitter  and 
the  nearest  point  at  which  refracted  waves 
return  to  earth  is  referred  to  as  the 

1 .  skip  distance 

2.  return  distance 

3.  reception  distance 

4.  ground-wave  distance 

2-35.  When  ground-wave  coverage  is  LESS 

than  the  distance  between  the  transmitter 
and  the  nearest  point  at  which  the 
refracted  waves  return  to  earth,  which  of 
the  following  reception  possibilities 
should  you  expect? 

1 .  No  sky-wave 

2.  Weak  ground  wave 

3.  A  zone  of  silence 

4.  Strong  ground  wave 

2-36.  The  greatest  amount  of  absorption  takes 

place  in  the  ionosphere  under  which  of  the 
following  conditions? 

1.  When  sky  wave  intensity  is  the  greatest 

2.  When  collision  of  particles  is  least 

3.  When  the  density  of  the  ionized  layer 
is  the  greatest 

4.  When  precipitation  is  greatest 

2-37.  Which  of  the  following  layers  provide  the 
greatest  amount  of  absorption  to  the 
ionospheric  wave? 


1.  DandE 

2.  DandFl 

3.  EandFl 

4.  Fl  and  F2 


11 


2-38.  If  the  signal  strength  of  an  incoming  signal  2-43. 
is  reduced  for  a  prolonged  period,  what 
type  of  fading  is  most  likely  involved? 

1 .  Selective 

2.  Multipath 

3.  Absorption 

4.  Polarization 

2-39.  Radio  waves  that  arrive  at  a  receiving  site  2-44. 
along  different  paths  can  cause  signal 
fading  if  these  waves  have  different 

1.  velocities 

2.  amplitudes 

3.  phase  relationships 

4.  modulation  percentages 

2-40.  The  technique  of  reducing  multipath 

fading  by  using  several  receiving  antennas  2-45. 
at  different  locations  is  known  as  what 
type  of  diversity? 

1.  Space 

2.  Receiver 

3.  Frequency 

4.  Modulation 

2-41.  The  amount  of  rf  energy  lost  because  of  2-46. 
ground  reflections  depends  on  which  of 
the  following  factors? 

1 .  Angle  of  incidence 

2.  Ground  irregularities 

3.  Frequency  of  the  wave 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

2-47. 

2-42.  Receiving  sites  located  near  industrial 
areas  can  expect  to  have  exceptionally 
large  losses  in  signal  quality  as  a  result  of 
which  of  the  following  propagation 
situations? 

1.  Absorption 

2.  Multihop  refraction 

3.  Natural  interference 

4.  Man-made  interference 


Which  of  the  following  ionospheric 
variation  causes  densities  to  vary  with  the 
axial  rotation  of  the  sun? 

1 .  Daily  variation 

2.  Seasonal  variation 

3.  27 -day  sunspot  cycle 

4.  1 1  -year  sunspot  cycle 

Which  of  the  following  ionospheric 
variation  causes  densities  to  vary  with  the 
position  of  the  earth  in  its  orbit  around  the 
sun? 

1 .  Daily  variation 

2.  Seasonal  variation 

3.  27 -day  sunspot  cycle 

4.  1 1  -year  sunspot  cycle 

Which  of  the  following  ionospheric 
variation  causes  densities  to  vary  with  the 
time  of  the  day? 

1 .  Daily  variation 

2.  Seasonal  variation 

3.  27 -day  sunspot  cycle 

4.  1 1  -year  sunspot  cycle 

What  relative  range  of  operating 
frequencies  is  required  during  periods  of 
maximum  sunspot  activity? 

1.  Lower 

2.  Medium 

3.  Higher 

What  factor  significantly  affects  the 
frequency  of  occurrence  of  the  sporadic-E 
layer? 

1.  Seasons 

2.  Latitude 

3.  Weather  conditions 

4.  Ionospheric  storms 


12 


2-48.  What  effect  can  the  sporadic -E  layer  have 
on  the  propagation  of  sky  waves? 

1.  Causes  multipath  interference 

2.  Permits  long  distance  communications 
at  unusually  high  frequencies 

3.  Permits  short-distance  communications 
in  the  normal  skip  zone 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

2-49.  A  sudden  and  intense  burst  of  ultraviolet 
light  is  especially  disruptive  to 
communications  in  which  of  the  following 
frequency  bands? 

1.  Hf 

2.  Mf 

3.  Lf 

4.  Vlf 

2-50.  The  density  of  what  ionosphere  layer 

increases  because  of  a  violent  eruption  on 
the  surface  of  the  sun? 

1.  D 

2.  E 

3.  Fl 

4.  F2 

2-5 1 .  Which  irregular  variation  in  ionospheric 
conditions  can  cause  a  waiting  period  of 
several  days  before  communications 
return  to  normal? 

1 .  Sporadic  E 

2.  Ionospheric  storms 

3.  Sudden  ionospheric  disturbance 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

2-52.  For  a  radio  wave  entering  the  atmosphere 
of  the  earth  at  a  given  angle,  the  highest 
frequency  at  which  refraction  will  occur  is 
known  by  which  of  the  following  terms? 

1 .  Usable  frequency 

2.  Refraction  frequency 

3.  Maximum  usable  frequency 

4.  Optimum  working  frequency 


2-53.  The  most  consistent  communications  can 
be  expected  at  which  of  the  following 
frequencies? 

1 .  Critical  frequency 

2.  Maximum  usable  frequency 

3.  Maximum  working  frequency 

4.  Optimum  working  frequency 

2-54.  If  the  optimum  working  frequency  for  a 

communications  link  is  4,250  kHz,  what  is 
the  approximate  maximum  usable 
frequency? 

1.  4,500  kHz 

2.  5,000  kHz 

3.  5,500  kHz 

4.  6,000  kHz 

2-55.  In  determining  the  success  of  radio 
transmission,  which  of  the  following 
factors  is  the  LEAST  predictable? 

1 .  Antenna  capabilities 

2.  Weather  conditions  along  the  path  of 
communication 

3.  Density  of  ionized  layers 

4.  Presence  of  ionized  layers 

2-56.  At  frequencies  above  100  MHz,  the 
greatest  attenuation  of  rf  energy  from 
raindrops  is  caused  by  which  of  the 
following  factors? 

1.  Ducting 

2.  Heat  loss 

3.  Scattering 

4.  Absorption 

2-57.  Under  certain  conditions,  such  as  ducting, 
line-of-sight  radio  waves  often  propagate 
for  distances  far  beyond  their  normal 
ranges  because  of  which  of  the  following 
factors? 

1 .  Low  cloud  masses 

2.  Ionospheric  storms 

3.  Temperature  inversions 

4.  Frequency  fluctuations 


13 


2-58.  When  ducting  is  present  in  the 

atmosphere,  multihop  refraction  of 
line-of-sight  transmission  can  occur 
because  of  which  of  the  following  factors? 

1 .  Operating  frequency  of  the  transmitter 

2.  Height  of  the  transmitting  antenna 

3.  Angle  of  incidence  of  the  radio  wave 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

2-59.  A  propagation  technique  used  to  extend 

uhf  transmission  range  beyond  the  horizon 
uses  which  of  the  following  propagation 
characteristics? 

1 .  Ground  reflection 

2.  Ionospheric  scatter 

3.  Tropospheric  scatter 

4.  Atmospheric  refraction 

2-60.  Communications  by  tropospheric  scatter 
can  be  affected  by  which  of  the  following 
conditions? 

1 .  Sunspot  activity 

2.  Atmospheric  conditions 

3.  Ionospheric  disturbances 

4.  All  of  the  above 

2-61.  What  effect,  if  any,  does  the  radiation 
angle  of  a  transmitting  antenna  have  on 
the  reception  of  communications  by 
tropospheric  scatter? 

1 .  The  lower  the  angle,  the  weaker  the 
signal 

2.  The  lower  the  angle,  the  stronger  the 
signal 

3.  The  lower  the  angle,  the  more 
susceptible  the  signal  is  to  distortion 

4.  None 


2-62.  Which  of  the  following  descriptions  of 
tropospheric  scatter  signal  reception  is 
NOT  true? 

1 .  Receiver  signal  strength  decreases  as 
the  turbulence  height  is  increased 

2.  The  level  of  reception  depends  on  the 
number  of  turbulences  causing  scatter 

3.  The  energy  received  is  the  portion  of 
the  wave  reradiated  by  the  turbulence 

4.  Increased  communications  distance 
enables  more  turbulence  to  act  on  the 
signal,  thereby  raising  the  received 
signal  level 

2-63.  The  tropospheric  scatter  signal  is  often 

characterized  by  very  rapid  fading  caused 
by  which  of  the  following  factors? 

1.  Extreme  path  lengths 

2.  Multipath  propagation 

3.  Turbulence  in  the  atmosphere 

4.  Angle  of  the  transmitted  beam 

2-64.  For  which  of  the  following 

communications  situations  would 
turbulence  in  the  troposphere  scatter 
transmission? 

1 .  10  MHz,  range  200  miles 

2.  30  MHz,  range  800  miles 

3.  50  MHz,  range  600  miles 

4.  100  MHz,  range  400  miles 


14 


ASSIGNMENT  3 

Textbook  assignment:  Chapter  3,  "Principles  of  Transmission  Lines,"  pages  3-1  through  3-58. 


3-1 .  A  transmission  line  is  designed  to  perform 
which  of  the  following  functions? 

1 .  Disperse  energy  in  all  directions 

2.  Detune  a  transmitter  to  match  the  load 

3.  Guide  electrical  energy  from  point  to 
point 

4.  Replace  the  antenna  in  a 
communications  system 

3-2.  All  transmission  lines  must  have  two  ends, 
the  input  end  and  the  output  end.  What 
other  name  is  given  to  the  input  end? 

1 .  Sending  end 

2.  Generator  end 

3.  Transmitter  end 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

3-3.  A  measurement  of  the  voltage  to  current 
ratio  (Ein/I  in)  at  the  input  end  of  a 
transmission  line  is  called  the 

1.  input-gain  rate 

2.  input  impedance 

3.  output  impedance 

4.  voltage-gain  ratio 

3-4.  Which  of  the  following  lines  is  NOT  a 
transmission  medium? 

1 .  Load  line 

2.  Coaxial  line 

3.  Two-wire  line 

4.  Twisted-pair  line 

3-5.  Electrical  power  lines  are  most  often  made 
of  which  of  the  following  types  of 
transmission  lines? 

1 .  Twin-lead  line 

2.  Shielded-pair  line 

3.  Two-wire  open  line 

4.  Two-wire  ribbon  line 


3-6.  Uniform  capacitance  throughout  the 

length  of  the  line  is  an  advantage  of  which 
of  the  following  transmission  lines? 

1.  Coaxial  line 

2.  Twistedpair 

3.  Shielded  pair 

4.  Two-wire  open  line 

3-7.  What  is  the  primary  advantage  of  a  rigid 
coaxial  line? 

1 .  Low  radiation  losses 

2.  Inexpensive  construction 

3.  Low  high-frequency  losses 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

3-8.  Which  of  the  following  wave -guides  is 
seldom  used  because  of  its  large  energy 
loss  characteristics? 

1.  Metallic 

2.  Dielectric 

3.  Elliptical 

4.  Cylindrical 

3-9.  To  some  degree,  transmission  lines  always 
exhibit  which  of  the  following  types  of 
losses? 

1.  I2R 

2.  Inductor 

3.  Dielectric 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

3-10.  Skin  effect  is  classified  as  which  of  the 
following  types  of  loss? 

1.  Copper 

2.  Voltage 

3.  Induction 

4.  Dielectric 


15 


3-11.  What  transmission- line  loss  is  caused  by 
magnetic  lines  of  force  not  returning  to  the 
conductor? 

1.  Copper 

2.  Radiation 

3.  Induction 

4.  Dielectric 

3-12.  What  is  the  electrical  wave-length  of  1 
cycle  if  the  frequency  is  60  hertz? 

1.  125,000  meters 

2.  1,250,000  meters 

3.  5,000,000  meters 

4.  20,000,000  meters 

3-13.  A  transmission  line  10  meters  in  length  is 
considered  to  be  electrically  long  at  which 
of  the  following  frequencies? 

1.  60kilohertz 

2.  600kilohertz 

3.  6  megahertz 

4.  60  megahertz 

3-14.  The  conductance  value  of  a  transmission 
line  represents  which  of  the  following 
values? 

1 .  Expected  value  of  current  flow  through 
the  insulation 

2.  Expected  value  of  voltage  supplied  by 
the  transmitter 

3.  Value  of  the  lump  and  distributed 
constants  of  the  line  divided  by 
impedance 

4.  Value  of  the  lump  and  distributed 
constants  of  the  line  divided  by 
impedance 

3-15.  Electrical  constants  in  a  transmission  line 
are  distributed  in  which  of  the  following 
ways? 

1 .  Into  a  single  device 

2.  Along  the  length  of  the  line 

3.  According  to  the  thickness  of  the  line 

4.  According  to  the  cross-sectional  area 
of  the  line 


3-16.  Leakage  current  in  a  two-wire 

transmission  line  is  the  current  that  flows 
through  what  component? 

1 .  The  resistor 

2.  The  inductor 

3.  The  insulator 

4.  The  conductor 

3-17.  Conductance  is  the  reciprocal  of  what 
electrical  property? 

1.  Inductance 

2.  Resistance 

3.  Capacitance 

4.  Reciprocity 

3-18.  A  transmission  line  that  has  current 

flowing  through  it  has  which,  if  any,  of  the 
following  fields  about  it? 

1 .  Electric  field  only 

2.  Magnetic  field  only 

3.  Both  electric  and  magnetic  fields 

4.  None  of  the  above 

3-19.  Maximum  transfer  of  energy  from  the 

source  to  the  transmission  line  takes  place 
when  what  impedance  relationship  exists 
between  the  source  and  the  transmission 
line? 

1 .  When  the  load  impedance  equals 
source  impedance 

2.  When  the  load  impedance  is  twice  the 
source  impedance 

3 .  When  the  load  impedance  is  half  the 
source  impedance 

4.  When  the  load  impedance  is  one -fourth 
the  source  impedance 

3-20.  The  characteristic  impedance  (Z0)  of  a 
transmission  line  is  calculated  by  using 
which  of  the  following  ratios? 

1 .  Rs  to  Rioad  of  the  line 

2.  Imax  to  Imin  at  every  point  along  the  line 

3.  E  to  I  at  every  point  along  the  line 

4.  Ein  to  E0  of  the  line 


16 


3-21.  For  a  given  voltage,  what  determines  the 
amount  of  current  that  will  flow  in  a 
transmission  line? 

1.  Conductance 

2.  Spacing  of  the  wires 

3.  Diameter  of  the  wires 

4.  Characteristic  impedance 

3-22.  When  the  impedance  of  a  transmission 
line  is  measured,  which  of  the  following 
values  frequently  is  NOT  considered? 

1.  Inductance 

2.  Resistance 

3.  Conductance 

4.  Capacitance 

3-23.  The  characteristic  impedance  of  a  long 
transmission  line  may  be  determined  by 
using  which  of  the  following  methods? 

1 .  Trial  and  error 

2.  Calculating  the  impedance  of  the  entire 
line 

3.  Calculating  the  impedances  at  each  end 
of  the  line 

4.  Adding  the  impedances  of  successive 
short  sections 

3-24.  When  should  lumped  values  for 

transmission-line  constants  be  used  to 
calculate  characteristic  impedance? 

1 .  When  the  line  is  short  compared  to  one 
wavelength 

2.  When  the  line  is  long  compared  to  one 
wavelength 

3.  When  the  line  is  infinitely  long 

3-25.  In  actual  practice,  the  characteristic 
impedance  of  a  transmission  line  is 
usually  within  which  of  the  following 
resistance  ranges? 

1.  Oto       0.9  ohm 

2.  1  to     49  ohms 

3.  50  to    600  ohms 

4.  601  to  1,000  ohms 


3-26.  The  input  impedance  of  a  transmission 
line  is  affected  by  which  of  the  following 
properties? 

1 .  Radiation  loss 

2.  Series  inductance 

3.  Parallel  capacitance 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

3-27.  When  a  dc  voltage  is  applied  to  a 

transmission  line  and  the  load  absorbs  all 
the  energy,  what  is  the  resulting 
relationship  between  current  and  voltage? 

1 .  They  are  in  phase  with  each  other 

2.  They  are  equal  to  Z0  of  the  line 

3.  They  are  out  of  phase  with  each  other 

4.  They  are  evenly  distributed  along  the 
line 

3-28.  The  initial  waves  that  travel  from  the 

source  to  the  load  of  a  transmission  line 
are  referred  to  as  what  type  of  waves? 

1.  Incident 

2.  Refracted 

3.  Reflected 

4.  Diffracted 

3-29.  Waves  that  travel  from  the  output  end  to 
the  input  end  of  a  transmission  line  are 
referred  to  as  what  type  of  waves? 

1.  Incident 

2.  Refracted 

3.  Reflected 

4.  Diffracted 


17 


Figure  3-A. — Equivalent  infinite  transmission  line. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTION  3-30,  REFER  TO 
FIGURE  3-A. 


3-30.  When  a  dc  voltage  is  applied  to  the 

equivalent  infinite  line  in  the  figure,  which 
of  the  following  conditions  occurs  along 
the  length  of  the  line? 

1 .  Standing  waves  of  voltage  form 

2.  Standing  waves  of  current  form 

3.  Current  flows  indefinitely 

4.  Voltage  appears  for  a  short  time 


Figure  3-B. — Equivalent  transmission  line. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTION  3-31,  REFER  TO 
FIGURE  3-B. 


3-31.  Compared  to  a  dc  input,  what  relative 

amount  of  time  is  required  for  an  ac  input 
voltage  to  travel  the  length  of  the  line 
shown  in  the  circuit? 

1.  Less 

2.  Same 

3.  More 


3-32.  The  instantaneous  voltage  on  an  infinite 
transmission  line  can  be  plotted  against 
time  by  using  which  of  the  following 
instruments? 

1 .  A  wavemeter 

2.  A  multimeter 

3.  An  oscilloscope 

4.  A  spectrum  analyzer 

3-33.  On  an  infinite  transmission  line  with  an  ac 
voltage  applied,  which  of  the  following  is 
an  accurate  description  of  the  effective 
voltage  distribution  along  the  line? 

1 .  Voltage  is  0  at  all  points 

2.  Voltage  is  constant  at  all  points 

3.  Voltage  varies  at  a  sine-wave  rate 

4.  Voltage  varies  at  double  the  sine-wave 
rate 

3-34.  The  velocity  of  propagation  on  a 

transmission  line  is  controlled  by  which  of 
the  following  line  characteristics? 

1.  Conductance 

2.  Inductance  only 

3.  Capacitance  only 

4.  Capacitance  and  inductance 

3-35.  The  total  charge  on  a  transmission  line  is 
equal  to  the  current  multiplied  by  which  of 
the  following  factors? 

1.  Time 

2.  Power 

3.  Voltage 

4.  Resistance 


18 


3-36. 


3-37. 


3-38. 


With  only  capacitance  and  inductance  of 
the  line  given,  the  time  (T)  required  for  a 
voltage  change  to  travel  down  a 
transmission  line  can  be  found  by  what 
formula?  The  characteristic  impedance  for 
an  infinite  transmission  line  can  be  figured 
using  which  of  the  following  ratios? 


1. 


T  = 


2.    T  =  -TEC 


3-    T  =  L+C 


4-    T  =  L-C 


The  characteristic  impedance  for  an 
infinite  transmission  line  can  be  figured 
using  which  of  the  following  ratios? 

1 .  Input  current  to  velocity 

2.  Input  voltage  to  input  current 

3.  Input  voltage  to  line  resistance 

4.  Input  current  to  line  resistance 

The  characteristic  impedance  of  a 
transmission  line  can  be  figured  by  using 
which  of  the  following  formulas? 


LC 


2.     Z  D  =  JLC 


Figure  3-C. — Equivalent  transmission  line. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTIONS  3-39  AND  3-40, 
REFER  TO  FIGURE  3-C.  ASSUME  THAT  THE 
LINE  IS  1,200  FEET  LONG.  A  150-FOOT 
SECTION  IS  MEASURED  TO  DETERMINE  L 
AND  C.  THE  150-FOOT  SECTION  HAS  AN 
INDUCTANCE  OF  0.36  MILLIHENRIES  AND 
A  CAPACITANCE  OF  1,000  PICOFARADS. 

3-39.  What  is  the  characteristic  impedance  of 
the  line? 

1.  400  ohms 

2.  600  ohms 

3.  800  ohms 

4.  900  ohms 

3-40.  What  is  the  velocity  of  the  wave  on  the 
150-foot  section? 

1.  210,000,000  fps 

2.  225,000,000  fps 

3.  250,000,000  fps 

4.  275,000,000  fps 

3-41.  If  a  transmission  line  is  open-ended,  which 
of  the  following  conditions  describes  its 
terminating  impedance? 


1.  Finite 

2.  Infinitely  large 

3.  Equal  to  load  impedance 

4.  Equal  to  source  impedance 


19 


3-42.  When  a  transmission  line  is  not  terminated 
in  its  characteristic  impedance  (Z0),  what 
happens  to  the  incident  energy  that  is  NOT 
transferred  to  the  load? 

1 .  It  is  returned  along  the  transmission 
line 

2.  It  is  radiated  into  space 

3.  It  is  absorbed  by  the  line 

4.  It  is  converted  to  heat  energy 


CIRCUIT 


Figure  3-D. — Open-ended  transmission  line. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTIONS  3-43  AND  3-44, 
REFER  TO  FIGURE  3-D. 

3-43.  When  the  dc  voltage  reaches  the  open  end 
of  the  transmission  line  in  the  figure  and  is 
reflected,  it  has  which,  if  any,  of  the 
following  changes? 

1 .  Increased  amplitude 

2.  Decreased  amplitude 

3.  The  opposite  polarity 

4.  None  of  the  above 

3-44.  When  the  dc  current  reaches  the  open  end 
of  the  transmission  line  and  is  reflected,  it 
has  which,  if  any,  of  the  following 
changes? 


Figure  3-E. — Short-circuited  transmission  line. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTIONS  3-45  AND  3-46, 
REFER  TO  FIGURE  3-E. 

3-45.  When  the  dc  voltage  reaches  the  shorted 
end  of  the  transmission  line,  it  is  reflected. 
It  has  which,  if  any,  of  the  following 
changes? 

1 .  Increased  amplitude 

2.  Decreased  amplitude 

3.  The  opposite  polarity 

4.  None 

3-46.  When  the  dc  current  reaches  the  shorted 
end  of  the  transmission  line,  it  is  reflected. 
It  has  which,  if  any,  of  the  following 
changes? 

1 .  Decrease  amplitude 

2.  Increase  amplitude 

3.  Increased  polarity 

4.  None  of  the  above 


1 .  Increased  amplitude 

2.  Decreased  amplitude 

3.  The  opposite  polarity 

4.  None  of  the  above 


20 


3-47.  In  an  open-ended  transmission  line  with 
an  ac  signal  applied,  what  is  the  phase 
relationship  between  the  incident  and 
reflected  voltage  waves? 

1.  In  phase 

2.  45  degrees  out  of  phase 

3.  90  degrees  out  of  phase 

4.  1 80  degrees  out  of  phase 

3-48.  The  resultant  of  the  incident  and  reflected 
voltage  waves  is  called  the  standing  wave. 
Its  value  is  figured  by  using  which  of  the 
following  procedures? 

1 .  Adding  the  effective  values  of  the  two 
waveforms 

2.  Algebraically  adding  the  instantaneous 
values  of  the  two  waveforms 

3.  Algebraically  subtracting  the 
instantaneous  values  of  the  two 
waveforms 

4.  Taking  the  square  root  of  the  product 
of  the  incident  and  reflected  voltages 

3-49.  On  an  open-ended  transmission  line  that  is 
carrying  an  ac  signal,  what  is  the  total 
number  of  moving  voltage  waves? 

1.  One 

2.  Two 

3.  Three 

4.  Four 

3-50.  At  the  end  of  an  open-ended  transmission 
line,  which,  if  any,  of  the  following 
voltage  waves  is  at  its  maximum  value? 

1.  Incident 

2.  Reflected 

3.  Resultant 

4.  None 

3-51.  On  a  transmission  line  that  is  carrying  an 
ac  signal,  what  is  the  relative  value  of  the 
resultant  voltage  wave  1/4  wavelength 
from  the  open  end? 

1 .  Maximum  positive 

2.  Maximum  negative 

3.  Zero 


3-52.  In  an  open-ended  transmission  line,  the 
resultant  ac  current  waveform  is  always 
zero  at  what  point(s)? 

1 .  At  the  open  end  only 

2.  1/2  wavelength  from  the  open-end  only 

3.  At  the  open  end  and  1/2  wavelength 
from  the  open-end 

3-53.  The  resultant  waveform  obtained  by 

adding  the  incident  wave  to  the  reflected 
wave  is  referred  to  as  a/an 

1 .  standing  wave 

2.  negative  wave 

3.  algebraic  wave 

4.  concentrated  wave 

3-54.  On  an  open-ended  transmission  line,  what 
is  the  phase  relationship  between  the 
standing  waves  of  voltage  and  current? 

1.  In  phase 

2.  45  degrees  out  of  phase 

3.  90  degrees  out  of  phase 

4.  1 80  degrees  out  of  phase 

3-55.  Which  of  the  following  conditions  exist  at 
the  end  of  a  shorted  transmission  line? 

1 .  Maximum  voltage  and  minimum 
current 

2.  Maximum  voltage  and  maximum 
current 

3.  Minimum  voltage  and  maximum 
current 

4.  Minimum  voltage  and  minimum 
current 

3-56.  Transmission  line  is  considered  to  be 

nonresonant  (flat)  when  it  is  terminated  in 
which  of  the  following  ways? 

1 .  In  an  impedance  equal  to  Z0 

2.  In  an  impedance  that  is  infinite 

3.  In  an  inductive  reactance  greater  than 
Z0 

4.  In  a  capacitive  reactance  greater  than 
Z0 


21 


3-57.  Of  the  following  terms,  which  one  is  used  3-62. 
for  the  nonresonant  transmission  line? 

1 .  A  tuned  line 

2.  A  shorted  line 

3.  An  untuned  line 

4.  A  terminated  line 

3-58.  A  transmission  line  that  is  resonant  is 

sometimes  referred  to  as  which  of  the  3-63. 
following  types  of  lines? 

1.  Tuned 

2.  Matched 

3.  Untuned 

4.  Unmatched 

3-59.  A  short-circuited  section  of  transmission 
line  that  is  an  odd  number  of  quarter- 
wavelengths  long  shows  the  same 
characteristics  as  which  of  the  following  3-64. 
devices? 

1 .  A  series-resonant  circuit 

2.  A  parallel-resonant  circuit 

3.  An  inductive  reactance  equal  to  Z0 

4.  A  capacitive  reactance  equal  to  Z0 

3-60.  Which  of  the  following  circuits  appears  as 
a  very  high  resistance  at  resonance? 

3-65. 

1.  Nonresonant 

2.  Series-resonant 

3.  Parallel-resonant 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

3-61 .  When  a  series-resonant  circuit  is  resonant 
at  a  frequency  above  the  generator 
frequency,  it  acts  as  what  type  of  circuit? 

3-66. 

1.  Open 

2.  Resistive 

3.  Inductive 

4.  Capacitive 


Which  of  the  following  sections  of 
transmission  line  can  be  used  as  a  parallel- 
resonant  circuit? 

1.  A  shorted  1/4-wavelength  section 

2.  An  open   1/4-wavelength  section 

3.  A  shorted  1/2-wave length  section 

4.  An  open  3/4-wavelength  section 

A  generator  connected  to  an  open-ended 
line  greater  than  1/4  wave-length  but  less 
than  1/2  wave-length  senses  which  of  the 
following  circuit  component 
characteristics? 

1 .  Zero  reactance 

2.  Low  resistance 

3.  Inductive  reactance 

4.  Capacitive  reactance 

Which  of  the  following  conditions  of 
current  (I)  and  impedance  (Z)  exist  at  even 
quarter-wave  points  on  a  shorted 
transmission  line? 

1 .  Low  I,  low  Z 

2.  Low  I,  high  Z 

3.  High  I,  high  Z 

4.  High  I,  low  Z 

What  is  the  maximum  distance,  in 
wavelengths  (X),  between  adjacent  zero- 
current  points  on  an  open-circuited  line? 

1.  1  X 

2.  1/2  I 

3.  1/4  I 

4.  1/8  I 

When  a  line  is  terminated  in  a  capacitance, 
the  capacitor  performs  which,  if  any,  of 
the  following  circuit  actions? 

1 .  It  absorbs  all  the  energy 

2.  It  reflects  all  the  energy 

3 .  It  reacts  as  if  it  were  a  short 

4.  None 


22 


3-67.  When  a  transmission  line  is  terminated  in 
an  inductive  reactance,  which,  if  any,  of 
the  following  phase  shifts  takes  place  with 
respect  to  the  current  and  voltage? 

1 .  Only  voltage  is  phase-shifted 

2.  Only  current  is  phase-shifted 

3.  Both  voltage  and  current  are  phase- 
shifted 

4.  None 

3-68.  When  a  transmission  line  is  terminated  in 
a  resistance  greater  than  Z0,  which  of  the 
following  conditions  exist? 

1 .  The  end  of  the  line  appears  as  an  open 
circuit 

2.  Standing  waves  appear  on  the  line 

3.  Voltage  is  maximum  and  current  is 
minimum  at  the  end  of  the  line 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

3-69.  On  a  transmission  line,  reflections  begin  at 
which  of  the  following  locations? 

1.  At  the  load 

2.  At  the  source 

3.  At  the  middle 

4.  At  the  half-wavelength  point 

3-70.  The  ratio  of  maximum  voltage  to 

minimum  voltage  on  a  transmission  line  is 
referred  to  as  the 

1.  rswr 

2.  pswr 

3.  vswr 

4.  iswr 

3-71.  Which  of  the  following  ratios  samples  the 
magnetic  field  along  a  line? 

1.  Vswr 

2.  Pswr 

3.  Iswr 

4.  Rswr 


23 


ASSIGNMENT  4 

Textbook  assignment:  Chapter  4,  "Antennas,"  pages  4-1  through  4-60. 


4- 1 .  Radio  energy  is  transmitted  through 
which  of  the  following  mediums? 

1.  Rock 

2.  Soil 

3.  Water 

4.  Space 

4-2.  Energy  is  transmitted  from  a  transmitter 
into  space  using  which  of  the  following 
devices? 

1.  A  receiver 

2.  A  delay  line 

3.  A  receiving  antenna 

4.  A  transmitting  antenna 

4-3.  Transmitted  rf  energy  takes  what  form  as 
it  is  sent  into  space? 

1 .  A  magnetic  field  only 

2.  An  electric  field  only 

3.  An  electromagnetic  field 

4.  A  static  dielectric  field 

4-4.  The  dimensions  of  a  transmitting  antenna 
are  determined  by  which  of  the  following 
factors? 

1.  Transmitted  power 

2.  Transmitted  frequency 

3.  Distance  to  the  receiver 

4.  Antenna  height  above  the  ground 

4-5.  A  device  used  to  radiate  or  receive 

electromagnetic  wave  energy  is  referred 
to  as  a/an 

1.  feeder 

2.  antenna 

3.  transmitter 

4.  coupling  device 


4-6.  An  antenna  that  can  be  mounted  to 
radiate  rf  energy  either  vertically  or 
horizontally  is  classified  as  which  of  the 
following  types? 

1.  Hertz 

2.  Marconi 

3.  Quarter- wave 

4.  Both  2  and  3  above 

4-7.  A  complete  antenna  system  consists  of 
which  of  the  following  components? 

1 .  A  feeder,  a  coupling  device,  and  a 
transmitter 

2.  A  feeder  line,  a  coupling  device,  and 
an  antenna 

3.  An  antenna,  a  transmission  line,  and  a 
receiver 

4.  An  impedance-matching  device,  a 
feeder,  and  a  transmission  line 

4-8.  What  component  in  an  antenna  system 
transfers  energy  from  the  transmitter  to 
the  antenna? 

1 .  A  feeder 

2.  A  delay  line 

3.  A  choke  joint 

4.  A  rotating  joint 

4-9.  The  type,  size,  and  shape  of  an  antenna 
are  determined  by  which  of  the  following 
factors? 

1 .  Power  output  of  the  transmitter 

2.  Transmitter  frequency 

3.  Direction  to  the  receiver 

4.  Each  of  the  above 


24 


4-10.  Moving  electric  and  magnetic  fields  in 
space  have  what  (a)  phase  and 
(b)  angular  relationships? 

1 .  (a)  In  phase 

(b)  Perpendicular 

2.  (a)  In  phase 

(b)  Displaced  45° 

3.  (a)  Out  of  phase 
(b)  Displaced  45° 

4.  (a)  Out  of  phase 
(b)  Perpendicular 

4-11.  What  is  the  length  of  each  half  of  the 
wire  for  a  dipole  antenna? 

1.  Wavelength 

2.  3/4  wavelength 

3.  1/2  wavelength 

4.  1/4  wavelength 

4-12.  On  a  dipole  antenna,  the  sinusoidal 

variation  in  charge  magnitude  lags  the 
sinusoidal  variation  in  current  by  what 
amount? 

1 .  1  cycle 

2.  1/2  cycle 

3.  1/4  cycle 

4.  1/8  cycle 

4-13.  On  a  standing  wave,  the  points  of  high 
current  and  voltage  are  identified  by 
which  of  the  following  terms? 

1.  Peaks 

2.  Nodes 

3.  Poles 

4.  Loops 

4-14.  The  presence  of  standing  waves  indicates 
which  of  the  following  conditions  of  an 
antenna? 

1.  Resonance 

2.  Saturation 

3.  Nonresonance 

4.  Minimum  efficiency 


4-15.  The  antenna  property  that  allows  the 
same  antenna  to  both  transmit  and 
receive  energy  is 

1.  gain 

2.  resonance 

3.  reciprocity 

4.  directivity 

4-16.  There  is  a  ratio  between  the  amount  of 
energy  propagated  in  certain  directions 
by  a  directional  antenna  compared  to  the 
energy  that  would  be  propagated  in  these 
directions  if  the  antenna  were  not 
directional.  This  ratio  is  known  as  which 
of  the  following  antenna  characteristics? 

1.  Gain 

2.  Directivity 

3.  Reciprocity 

4.  Polarization 

4-17.  The  polarization  plane  of  the  radiation 
field  is  determined  by  which  of  the 
following  fields? 

1 .  Electric  field  only 

2.  Magnetic  field  only 

3.  Electromagnetic  field 

4-18.  For  best  reception  of  a  signal  from  a 
horizontally  polarized  antenna,  the 
receiving  antenna  should  be  mounted  so 
that  it  has  what  relationship  with  the 
transmitting  antenna? 

1.  0  degrees 

2.  45  degrees 

3.  90  degrees 

4.  135  degrees 

4-19.  An  electric  field  that  rotates  as  it  travels 
through  space  exhibits  what  type  of 
polarization? 

1.  Vertical 

2.  Spherical 

3.  Elliptical 

4.  Horizontal 


25 


4-20.  For  ground-wave  transmissions,  what 
type  of  polarization  is  required? 

1.  Vertical 

2.  Spherical 

3.  Elliptical 

4.  Horizontal 

4-2 1 .  For  high-frequency  operation,  which  of 
the  following  antenna  polarization 
patterns  is  preferred? 

1.  Vertically  polarized 

2.  Spherically  polarized 

3.  Elliptically  polarized 

4.  Horizontally  polarized 

4-22.  Omnidirectional  transmission  is  obtained 
from  which  of  the  following  antennas? 

1 .  Elliptically  polarized 

2.  Horizontal  half-wave 

3.  Vertical  half-wave 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

4-23.  With  an  antenna  height  of  40  feet  and  a 
transmitter  frequency  of  90  megahertz, 
which  of  the  following  antenna  radiation 
patterns  is  best  for  transmitting  over 
bodies  of  water? 

1.  Vertically  polarized 

2.  Spherically  polarized 

3.  Elliptically  polarized 

4.  Horizontally  polarized 

4-24.  To  select  a  desired  signal  and 

discriminate  against  interfering  signals 
from  strong  vhf  and  uhf  broadcast 
transmissions,  which  of  the  following 
actions  should  you  take? 

1 .  Increase  receiver  gain 

2.  Make  the  transmitting  antenna  bi- 
directional 

3.  Use  a  vertically  polarized  receiving 
antenna 

4.  Use  narrowly  directional  arrays  as 
receiving  antennas 


4-25.  A  vertically  mounted  transmission  line  is 
LEAST  affected  by  which  of  the 
following  antenna  radiation  patterns? 

1 .  Vertically  polarized 

2.  Spherically  polarized 

3.  Horizontally  polarized 

4.  Elliptically  polarized 

4-26.  An  antenna  with  which  of  the  following 
radiation  resistance  values  will  exhibit 
reduced  efficiency? 

1.  39  ohms 

2.  82  ohms 

3.  107  ohms 

4.  150  ohms 

4-27.  An  isotropic  radiator  radiates  energy  in 
which  of  the  following  patterns? 

1.  Vertical 

2.  Bi-directional 

3.  Unidirectional 

4.  Omnidirectional 

4-28.  An  ordinary  flashlight  is  an  example  of 
what  type  of  radiator? 

1.  Isotropic 

2.  Polarized 

3.  Anisotropic 

4.  Stroboscopic 


THIS  SPACE  LEFT  BLANK 
INTENTIONALLY. 


26 


o 

I— 


RADIATION 
-PATTERN 


POSITION  ON  ORCLE 


Figure  4-A. — Rectangular-coordinate  graph. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTION  4-29,  REFER 
TO  FIGURE  4-A. 

4-29.  How  many  points  on  the  graph  can 

represent  the  value  of  7  radiation  units  at 
position  2  of  the  circle? 

1.  One 

2.  Two 

3.  Three 

4.  Four 


0.  16  (360".  c°; 


Figure  4-B. — Polar-coordinate  graph. 

IN  ANSWERING  QUESTIONS  4-30  AND 
4-31,  REFER  TO  FIGURE  4-B. 


4-30.  Compared  with  the  rectangular- 
coordinate  graph,  the  polar-coordinate 
graph  has  the  advantage  of  showing 
which  of  the  following  antenna 
characteristics? 

1.  Polarization 

2.  Radiation  pattern 

3.  Phase  relationship 

4.  Gain  versus  directivity 

4-3 1 .  The  area  enclosed  by  the  radiation 
pattern  is  the 

1.  lobe 

2.  null 

3.  axis 

4.  coordinate 

4-32.  Inserting  an  inductor  or  capacitor  in 

series  with  an  antenna  is  one  method  of 
electrically  changing  the  electrical  length 
of  an  antenna.  What  is  this  method 
called? 

1.  Loading 

2.  Inserting 

3.  Unloading 

4.  Decoupling 

4-33.  Many  complex  antennas  are  constructed 
from  what  basic  antenna? 

1.  The  Marconi  antenna 

2.  The  full-wave  antenna 

3.  The  half-wave  antenna 

4.  The  quarter-wave  antenna 

4-34.  On  an  energized  half-wave  antenna, 
which  of  the  following  electrical 
conditions  exist? 

1 .  Voltage  is  maximum  at  the  ends 

2.  Voltage  is  minimum  at  the  ends 

3.  Current  is  maximum  at  the  ends 

4.  Impedance  is  minimum  at  the  center 


27 


4-35.  Which  of  the  following  radiation  patterns 
is/are  exhibited  by  a  simple  vertical 
doublet  antenna? 

1 .  Nondirectional  in  the  horizontal  plane 

2.  Directional  in  the  vertical  plane 

3.  Both  1  and  2  above 

4.  Spherical  in  all  planes 

4-36.  A  method  of  feeding  energy  to  a  half- 
wave  antenna  is  to  connect  one  end 
through  a  capacitor  to  the  output  stage. 
What  is  this  method  of  feeding  called? 

1 .  End  feed 

2.  Voltage  feed 

3.  Both  1  and  2  above 

4.  Current  feed 

4-37.  An  antenna  supplied  by  the  center-feed 
method  is  fed  at  what  point? 

1 .  Low  voltage  and  low  current 

2.  Low  voltage  and  high  current 

3.  High  voltage  and  low  current 

4.  High  voltage  and  high  current 

4-38.  The  basic  Marconi  antenna  has  which  of 
the  following  characteristics? 

1 .  One-quarter  wavelength  and 
ungrounded 

2.  One-half  wavelength  and  grounded  at 
one  end 

3.  One-half  wavelength  and  insulated 
from  ground 

4.  One-quarter  wavelength  and 
grounded  at  one  end 

4-39.  The  Marconi  antenna  behaves  as  a  dipole 
for  which  of  the  following  reasons? 

1 .  It  is  fed  at  one  end 

2.  An  image  antenna  is  formed  by 
reflections  from  the  ground 

3.  A  quarter-wavelength  of  conductor  is 
buried  in  the  ground  and  forms  the 
rest  of  the  dipole 

4.  The  applied  signal  is  rectified  so  that 
only  half  the  signal  will  appear  on  the 
quarter-wave  antenna 


4-40.  A  series  of  conductors  arranged  in  a 

radial  pattern  and  buried  in  the  ground 
beneath  the  antenna  is  referred  to  as  a 

1 .  ground  spur 

2.  counterpoise 

3.  ground  screen 

4.  ground  reflector 

4-4 1 .  A  folded  dipole  can  be  used  instead  of  a 
simple,  center-fed  dipole  for  which  of  the 
following  purposes? 

1 .  Matching  voltage 

2.  Matching  impedance 

3.  Increasing  directivity 

4.  Decreasing  directivity 

4-42.  An  antenna  arrangement  that  has 

elements  aligned  in  a  straight  line  is 
referred  to  as  what  type  array? 

1.  Isotropic 

2.  Collinear 

3.  Line-of-sight 

4.  Unidirectional 

4-43.  To  have  current  in  two  adjoining 

collinear  half-wave  elements  in  proper 
phase,  they  must  be  connected  by  which 
of  the  following  stubs? 

1 .  A  shorted  half-wave  stub 

2.  An  open  quarter-wave  stub 

3.  A  shorted  eighth-wave  stub 

4.  A  shorted  quarter-wave  stub 

4-44.  To  select  a  desired  signal  and 

discriminate  against  interfering  signals, 
the  receiving  antenna  should  have  which 
of  the  following  characteristics? 

1 .  Be  omnidirectional 

2.  Be  highly  directional 

3.  Be  vertically  polarized 

4.  Be  horizontally  polarized 


28 


4-45.  Adding  more  elements  to  a  collinear 
antenna  array  produces  which  of  the 
following  effects? 

1 .  Increased  gain 

2.  Decreased  gain 

3.  Decreased  directivity 

4.  Mismatched  impedances 

4-46.  What  is  the  maximum  number  of 

elements  ordinarily  used  in  a  collinear 
array? 

1.  One 

2.  Two 

3.  Three 

4.  Four 

4-47.  Constructing  a  collinear  array  with 

elements  longer  than  1/2  wavelength  has 
which  of  the  following  effects  on  antenna 
characteristics? 

1 .  Increased  gain 

2.  Decreased  gain 

3.  Increased  frequency  range 

4.  Decreased  frequency  range 

4-48.  In  a  two-element  collinear  array, 

maximum  gain  is  obtained  when  the 
center-to-center  spacing  between  the 
ends  of  the  elements  is  approximately 
what  electrical  distance? 

1.  Wavelength 

2.  0.15  wavelength 

3.  0.5  wavelength 

4.  0.75  wavelength 

4-49.  Compared  with  collinear  arrays, 
broadside  arrays  have  which  of  the 
following  advantages? 

1.  Sharper  tuning 

2.  Broader  bandwidth 

3.  Broader  frequency  response 

4.  Less  coupling  between  dipole 


4-50.  Optimum  gain  is  obtained  from  a 

broadside  array  when  the  spacing  of  its 
elements  is  which  of  the  following 
distances? 

1 .  One-half  wavelength 

2.  One-quarter  wavelength 

3.  Greater  than  one-half  wavelength 

4.  Slightly  less  than  one-quarter 

4-5 1 .  An  end-fire  array  physically  resembles 
the  collinear  array  except  that  it  is  more 
compact.  What  disadvantage  does  the 
endfire  array  possess? 

1 .  It  has  lower  gain 

2.  It  has  low  radiation  resistance 

3.  It  has  loose  coupling 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

4-52.  What  is  the  range  of  electrical  spacing 
between  the  elements  of  an  end-fire 
array? 

1.  3/4  to  1  wavelength 

2.  1/2  to  3/4  wavelength 

3.  1/4  to  1/2  wavelength 

4.  1/8  to  1/4  wavelength 

4-53.  The  end-fire  array  produces  what  type  of 
lobes,  if  any,  along  the  axis  of  the  array? 

1 .  Minor  lobes 

2.  Major  lobes 

3.  None 

4-54.  Assuming  that  the  elements  are  correctly 
spaced,  the  directivity  of  an  end-fire 
array  may  be  increased  by  which  of  the 
following  actions? 

1 .  Increasing  the  frequency 

2.  Decreasing  the  frequency 

3.  Decreasing  the  number  of  elements 

4.  Increasing  the  number  of  elements 


29 


4-55.  A  unidirectional  pattern  can  be  obtained 
from  an  end-fire  array  by  using  what 
phase  relationship  between  the  energy 
fed  to  adjacent  elements? 

1.  0° 

2.  45° 

3.  90° 

4.  180° 

4-56.  Energy  is  fed  to  a  parasitic  element  using 
what  method? 

1 .  Direct  coupling 

2.  Inductive  coupling 

3.  Capacitive  coupling 

4.  Transmission-line  coupling 

4-57.  The  directivity  pattern  resulting  from  the 
action  of  parasitic  elements  depends  on 
which  of  the  following  element 
characteristics? 

1 .  Length  of  the  element 

2.  Diameter  of  the  element 

3.  Spacing  between  parasitic  and  driven 
elements 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

4-58.  The  advantages  of  unidirectivity  and 
increased  gain  can  best  be  obtained  by 
using  which  of  the  following  elements  in 
a  parasitic  array? 

1 .  Driven  elements  only 

2.  Reflector  and  director  elements  only 

3.  Reflector,  director,  and  driven 
elements 

4.  Driven  and  director  elements  only 

4-59.  The  ratio  of  energy  radiated  by  an  array 
in  the  principal  direction  of  radiation  to 
the  energy  radiated  in  the  opposite 
direction  describes  which  of  the 
following  relationships? 

1 .  Side -to-side  ratio 

2.  Front-to-back  ratio 

3.  Driven-to-parasitic  ratio 

4.  Reflector-to-director  ratio 


4-60.  The  Yagi  antenna  is  an  example  of  what 
type  of  antenna  array? 

1.  Driven 

2.  End-fire 

3.  Multielement  parasitic 

4.  Single-element  parasitic 

4-6 1 .  The  addition  of  parasitic  elements  to  the 
Yagi  antenna  has  which  of  the  following 
effects  on  antenna  characteristics? 

1 .  Increased  gain 

2.  Narrower  beam  width 

3.  Narrower  frequency  response 

4.  Each  of  the  above 

4-62.  An  antenna  which  is  designed  especially 
for  vertically-polarized  ground  waves  at 
low  frequencies  is  the 

1 .  Yagi  antenna 

2.  Marconi  antenna 

3.  Beverage  antenna 

4.  V  antenna 

4-63.  What  is  the  phase  relationship  of  the 
signals  that  feed  the  V  antenna? 

1.  0° 

2.  45° 

3.  90° 

4.  180° 

4-64.  A  rhombic  antenna  is  essentially  a 

combination  of  which  of  the  following 
antennas? 

1 .  Two  stacked  long-wire  radiators 

2.  Two  V  antennas  placed  side  by  side 

3.  Two  collinear  arrays  in  parallel 

4.  Four  parallel  half-wave  radiators 

4-65.  A  rhombic  antenna  has  which  of  the 
following  advantages? 

1 .  Simple  construction 

2.  Wide  frequency  range 

3.  Noncritical  adjustment 

4.  Each  of  the  above 


30 


4-66.  The  principal  disadvantage  of  the 
rhombic  antenna  is  its 

1 .  poor  directivity 

2.  large  antenna  site 

3.  low  antenna  voltage 

4.  high-frequency  inefficiency 

4-67.  The  unidirectional  radiation  pattern  of 
the  rhombic  antenna  is  caused  by  which 
of  the  following  antenna  characteristics? 

1.  Size 

2.  Shape 

3.  Termination  resistance 

4.  Frequency  of  the  input  energy 

4-68.  Horizontal  half-wave  antennas  mounted 
at  right  angles  to  each  other  in  the  same 
horizontal  plane  make  up  which  of  the 
following  antennas? 

1.  Rhombic 

2.  Flat-top 

3.  Turnstile 

4.  Ground-plane 

4-69.  The  most  common  means  of  obtaining  a 
low-radiation  angle  from  a  vertical 
quarter-wave  antenna  is  by  what 
procedure? 

1.  Decreasing  power 

2.  Increasing  frequency 

3.  Adding  a  ground  plane 

4.  Rotating  the  antenna  to  a  horizontal 
plane 

4-70.  A  corner  reflector  antenna  is  used  for 
which  of  the  following  purposes? 

1 .  To  decrease  frequency  range 

2.  To  increase  frequency  range 

3.  To  produce  a  unidirectional  pattern 

4.  To  produce  an  omnidirectional 
pattern 


4-7 1 .  If  a  corner-reflector  antenna  is 

horizontally  polarized,  its  radiation 
pattern  will  take  on  what  shape? 

1 .  A  narrow  beam  in  the  horizontal 
plane 

2.  A  narrow  beam  in  the  vertical  plane 

3.  A  beam  similar  to  a  half-wave  dipole 
in  the  horizontal  plane 

4.  A  beam  similar  to  a  half-wave  dipole 
with  a  reflector  in  the  vertical  plane 

4-72.  When  radio  or  radar  antennas  are 

energized  by  transmitters,  you  must  not 
go  aloft  until  which  of  the  following 
requirements  are  met? 

1 .  A  safety  harness  has  been  issued  to 
you 

2.  All  transmitters  are  secured  and 
tagged 

3.  A  working  aloft  "chit"  has  been  filled 
out  and  signed  by  proper  authority 

4.  Each  of  the  above 


31